Document
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
  ________________________________________
FORM 20-F
________________________________________

o
REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
OR

x
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018
OR

o
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
OR

o
SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Date of event requiring this shell company report _________________________

For the transition period from ______________ to _____________

Commission file number: 1-10928

________________________________________
 INTERTAPE POLYMER GROUP INC.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
________________________________________
Canada
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
9999 Cavendish Blvd., Suite 200, Ville St. Laurent, Quebec, Canada H4M 2X5
(Address of principal executive offices)
Jeffrey Crystal, (941) 739-7522, jcrystal@itape.com, 100 Paramount Drive, Suite 300, Sarasota, Florida 34232
(Name, Telephone, E-mail, and Address of Company Contact Person)
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Not applicable
(Title of Class)




Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
Title of each class
 
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Shares, without nominal or par value
 
Toronto Stock Exchange
Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:
Not applicable
(Title of Class)
Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report. As of December 31, 2018, there were 58,650,310 common shares outstanding.
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    x  Yes    o No
If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.    o  Yes     x  No
Note – Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    x  Yes    o No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    x  Yes    ☐  No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or an emerging growth company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer,” and "emerging growth company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
Large accelerated filer  x            Accelerated filer  o           Non-accelerated filer  o Emerging growth company  o

If an emerging growth company that prepare its financial statements in accordance with US GAAP, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards† provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. o

†The term “new or revised financial accounting standard” refers to any update issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to its Accounting Standards Codification after April 5, 2012.
Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 US GAAP o        International Financial Reporting Standards as issued    x        Other o  
by the International Accounting Standards Board
If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.    o  Item 17    o  Item 18



If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).   o  Yes     x  No
(APPLICABLE ONLY TO ISSUERS INVOLVED IN BANKRUPTCY PROCEEDINGS DURING THE PAST FIVE YEARS)
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed all documents and reports required to be filed by Sections 12, 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 subsequent to the distribution of securities under a plan confirmed by a court.    o  Yes    o  No




TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
 
 
Page
PART I...................................................................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 1:
IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS....................................
 
 
 
ITEM 2:
OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE.......................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 3:
KEY INFORMATION............................................................................................................................
 
 
 
A.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA...................................................................................................
 
 
 
B.
CAPITALIZATION AND INDEBTEDNESS................................................................................
 
 
 
C.
REASONS FOR THE OFFER AND USE OF PROCEEDS..........................................................
 
 
 
D.
RISK FACTORS.............................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 4:
INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY ................................................................................................
 
 
 
A.
HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT OF THE COMPANY.............................................................
 
 
 
B.
BUSINESS OVERVIEW.................................................................................................................
 
 
 
(1
)
Products, Markets and Distribution.................................................................................................
(2
)
Customers and Sales........................................................................................................................
(3
)
Seasonality of the Company’s Main Business.................................................................................
(4
)
Equipment and Raw Materials........................................................................................................
(5
)
Marketing Channels.........................................................................................................................
(6
)
Trademarks and Patents...................................................................................................................
(7
)
Competition.....................................................................................................................................
(8
)
Environmental Initiatives and Regulation.......................................................................................
 
 
 
C.
ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE..............................................................................................
 
 
 
D.
PROPERTY, PLANTS AND EQUIPMENT...................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 4A:
UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
ITEM 5:
OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS (MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION & ANALYSIS)...............................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 6:
DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES..........................................................
 
 
 
A.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT............................................................................
 
 
 
B.
COMPENSATION.........................................................................................................................
 
 
 
C.
BOARD PRACTICES.....................................................................................................................
 
 
 
D.
EMPLOYEES.................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
E.
SHARE OWNERSHIP....................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 7:
MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS.........................................
 
 
 
A.
MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS...........................................................................................................
 
 
 
B.
RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS...........................................................................................
 
 
 
C.
INTERESTS OF EXPERTS AND COUNSEL...............................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 8:
FINANCIAL INFORMATION..............................................................................................................
 
 
 
A.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS AND OTHER FINANCIAL INFORMATION......................
 
 
 
B.
SIGNIFICANT CHANGES............................................................................................................
 
 
 

4


ITEM 9:
THE OFFER AND LISTING.................................................................................................................
 
 
 
A.
OFFER AND LISTING DETAILS.................................................................................................
 
 
 
B.
PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION............................................................................................................
 
 
 
C.
MARKETS......................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
D.
SELLING SHAREHOLDERS........................................................................................................
 
 
 
E.
DILUTION.....................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
F.
EXPENSES OF THE ISSUE..........................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 10:
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION...........................................................................................................
 
 
 
A.
SHARE CAPITAL..........................................................................................................................
 
 
 
B.
MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION.............................................................
 
 
 
C.
MATERIAL CONTRACTS............................................................................................................
 
 
 
D.
EXCHANGE CONTROLS.............................................................................................................
 
 
 
E.
TAXATION.....................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
F.
DIVIDENDS AND PAYING AGENTS..........................................................................................
 
 
 
G.
STATEMENT BY EXPERTS..........................................................................................................
 
 
 
H.
DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY........................................................................................................
 
 
 
I.
SUBSIDIARY INFORMATION.....................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 11:
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK........................
 
 
 
ITEM 12:
DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES.......................................
 
 
PART II.................................................................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 13:
DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES.................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 14:
MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS............................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 15:
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES.......................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 16:
[RESERVED].........................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 16A:
AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT.....................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 16B:
CODE OF ETHICS................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 16C:
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES.........................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 16D:
EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEE..........................
 
 
 
ITEM 16E:
PURCHASE OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS....
 
 
 
ITEM 16F:
CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT.........................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 16G:
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE............................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 16H:
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE............................................................................................................
 
 
PART III................................................................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 17:
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 18:
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.................................................................................................................
 
 
 
ITEM 19:
EXHIBITS..............................................................................................................................................
 
 
 
A.
Consolidated Financial Statements.........................................................................................................
 
 
 
B.
Exhibits:..................................................................................................................................................

5


Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
Certain statements and information included in this annual report on Form 20-F constitute “forward-looking information” within the meaning of applicable Canadian securities legislation and “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, (collectively, “forward-looking statements”), which are made in reliance upon the protections provided by such legislation for forward-looking statements. All statements other than statements of historical facts included in this annual report on Form 20-F, including statements regarding the Company’s industry and economic conditions, the Company’s outlook, plans, prospects, products, financial position, future transactions, acquisitions and partnerships, the expected financial performance and benefits of the Cantech, Polyair and Maiweave transactions, the expansion of operational synergies gained from the Cantech, Polyair and Maiweave acquisitions, the expected cost savings and synergies, including total annual synergies, annualized run rate synergies and operational cost synergies, from the Cantech, Polyair and Maiweave acquisitions, future sales and financial results, inventory, income tax and effective tax rate, availability of funds and credit, expected credit spread, level of indebtedness, payment of dividends, share repurchases, fluctuations in raw material costs, competition, capital and other significant expenditures, working capital requirements, pension plan contribution requirements and administration expenses, manufacturing facility closures and other restructurings, manufacturing facility rationalization initiatives, liquidity, the impact of new accounting standards, contractual commitments, judgments, estimates, assumptions, litigation, and business strategies, may constitute forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements are based on current beliefs, assumptions, expectations, estimates, forecasts and projections made by the management of Intertape Polymer Group Inc. (“Intertape,” “Intertape Polymer Group,” or the “Company”). Words such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “expect,” “continue,” “intend,” “estimate,” “anticipate,” “plan,” “believe,” “future,” “likely,” or “seek” or the negatives of these terms or variations of them or similar terminology are intended to identify such forward-looking statements. Although the Company believes that the expectations reflected in these forward-looking statements are reasonable, these statements, by their nature, involve risks and uncertainties and are not guarantees of future performance. Such statements are also subject to assumptions concerning, among other things: business conditions and growth or declines in the Company’s industry and the Company’s customers’ industries; changes in general economic, political, social, fiscal or other conditions in any of the countries where the Company operates; the Company’s customers’ industries and the general economy; the impact of changes to tariffs and other international trade developments; the anticipated benefits from the Company’s manufacturing facility closures, manufacturing facility rationalization initiatives, greenfield developments, and other restructuring efforts; selling prices; the impact of fluctuations in raw material prices and freight costs; the quality and market reception of the Company’s products; the expected strategic and financial benefits from the Company’s ongoing capital investment and mergers and acquisitions programs; the Company’s ability to integrate and realize synergies from acquisitions; the anticipated benefits from the Company’s capital expenditures; the Company’s anticipated business strategies; risks and costs inherent in litigation; risks and costs inherent in the Company’s intellectual property; the Company’s ability to maintain and improve quality and customer service; the Company’s ability to retain, and adequately develop and incentivize, its management team and key employees; anticipated trends in the Company’s business; anticipated cash flows from the Company’s operations; the Company’s flexibility to allocate capital after the Senior Unsecured Notes offering; availability of funds under the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility; the Company’s ability to continue to control costs; movements in the prices of key inputs such as raw material, energy and labor, government policies, including those specifically regarding the manufacturing industry, such as industrial licensing, environmental regulations, labor and safety regulations, import restrictions and duties, intellectual property laws, excise duties, sales taxes, and value added taxes; accidents and natural disasters; changes to accounting rules and standards; and other factors beyond our control. The Company can give no assurance that these statements and expectations will prove to have been correct. Actual outcomes and results may, and often do, differ from what is expressed, implied or projected in such forward-looking statements, and such differences may be material. Readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on any forward-looking statement. For additional information regarding some important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in these forward-looking statements and other risks and uncertainties, and the assumptions underlying the forward-looking statements, you are encouraged to read “Item 3. Key Information - Risk Factors,” “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects (Management’s Discussion & Analysis)” as well as statements located elsewhere in this annual report on Form 20-F and the other statements and factors contained in the Company’s filings with the Canadian securities regulators and the US Securities and Exchange Commission. Each of the forward-looking statements speaks only as of the date of this annual report on Form 20-F. The Company will not update these statements unless applicable securities laws require it to do so.


6


PART I
 

Item 1:
Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisers

Not applicable.

Item 2:
Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable

Not applicable.

Item 3:
Key Information

 
A.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
The selected financial data presented below for the five years ended December 31, 2018 is presented in US dollars and is derived from the Company’s consolidated financial statements and prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board. The information set forth below was extracted from the consolidated financial statements and related notes included in this annual report and annual reports previously filed and should be read in conjunction with such consolidated financial statements.
 
 
As of and for the Year Ended December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
 
(in thousands of US dollars, except shares and per share amounts)
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Statements of Consolidated Earnings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue
 
1,053,019

 
898,126

 
808,801

 
781,907

 
812,732

Earnings before income taxes
 
56,451

 
77,007

 
70,706

 
67,655

 
58,719

Net earnings attributable to Company shareholders
 
46,753

 
64,224

 
51,120

 
56,672

 
35,816

Net (loss) earnings attributable to non-controlling interests
 
(104
)
 
(266
)
 
17

 

 

Total net earnings
 
46,649

 
63,958

 
51,137

 
56,672

 
35,816

Earnings per share attributable to Company shareholders:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
0.79

 
1.09

 
0.87

 
0.95

 
0.59

Diluted
 
0.79

 
1.08

 
0.85

 
0.93

 
0.57

Balance Sheets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
1,004,840

 
715,872

 
580,597

 
487,262

 
466,676

Capital stock
 
350,267

 
350,759

 
351,203

 
347,325

 
357,840

Total equity
 
261,428

 
254,722

 
242,943

 
216,728

 
227,500

Total equity attributable to Company shareholders
 
249,847

 
248,133

 
236,536

 
216,728

 
227,500

Number of common shares outstanding
 
58,650,310

 
58,799,910

 
59,060,335

 
58,667,535

 
60,435,826

Dividends declared per share
 
0.56

 
0.56

 
0.54

 
0.50

 
0.40


 
B.
CAPITALIZATION AND INDEBTEDNESS
Not applicable.
 

7


 
C.
REASONS FOR THE OFFER AND USE OF PROCEEDS
Not applicable.
 
 
D.
RISK FACTORS
Current economic conditions and uncertain economic forecast could adversely affect the Company’s results of operations and financial conditions.
Unfavorable changes in the global economy have affected and may affect the demand for the products of the Company and its customers. Adverse economic conditions could also increase the likelihood of customer delinquencies. A prolonged period of economic decline would have a material adverse effect on the results of operations, gross margins, and the overall financial condition of the Company, as well as exacerbate the other risk factors set forth below.
Fluctuations in raw material costs or the unavailability of raw materials may adversely affect the Company’s profitability.
Historically, the Company has not always been able to pass on significant raw material cost increases through price increases to its customers. The Company’s results of operations in prior years, at times, have been negatively impacted by raw material cost increases. These increases adversely affected the Company’s profitability. As a result of raw material cost increases, the Company may increase prices (which could result in reduced market share) or may choose to keep prices the same (which could result in decreased margins). The Company’s profitability in the future may be adversely affected due to fluctuations in raw material prices. Additionally, the Company relies on its suppliers for deliveries of raw materials. If any of its suppliers are unable to deliver raw materials to the Company for an extended period of time, there is no assurance that the Company’s raw material requirements would be met by other suppliers on acceptable terms, or at all (although the Company has alternative suppliers for a number of the raw materials it uses), which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations.
Given that a significant portion of the Company’s major raw materials are by-products of crude oil and natural gas, the Company is subject to risks associated with energy markets. These markets are subject to volatility, which may result in increased raw material costs for the Company. A number of potential factors, such as legislation aimed at reducing greenhouse gas emissions, wars, terrorist attacks, natural disasters, heightened tariffs and other adverse international trade issues, and political unrest, may result in volatile energy markets and increased raw material costs for the Company.
Unfavorable consumer responses to price increases could have a material adverse impact on our sales and earnings.
From time to time, and especially in periods with rising raw material costs, we increase the prices of our products. Significant price increases could impact our earnings, depending on, among other factors, the pricing by competitors of similar products and the response by the customers to higher prices. Such price increases may result in lower volume of sales and a subsequent decrease in earnings.
The Company’s ability to achieve its growth objectives depends in part on the timing and market acceptance of its new products and its improved products, as well as its strategic acquisitions and capital expenditure initiatives proving to have the positive effects contemplated in the Company’s growth objectives.
The Company’s business plan includes the introduction of new products and the improvement of existing products, which are both developed internally and obtained through acquisitions. The Company’s ability to introduce these products successfully depends on the demand for the products, as well as their price, quality, and related customer service. In the event the market does not fully accept these products, or competitors introduce similar or superior products (or products perceived by the market to be similar or superior), the Company’s ability to expand its markets and generate organic growth could be negatively impacted which could have an adverse effect on its operating results.
In addition, the Company’s business plan and growth objectives contain certain goals based on potential acquisitions and capital expenditures. The Company cannot provide any assurances that it will be able to: identify future strategic acquisitions and adequately conduct due diligence; consummate these potential acquisitions on favorable terms, if at all; or if consummated, successfully integrate the operations and management of future acquisitions. Similarly, for potential capital expenditure projects (including any greenfield developments): we may be unable to identify positive projects; actual costs may exceed expected costs for such projects; we may be unable to complete such projects in a timely manner, if at all; such projects may require substantial

8


capital that we are unable to obtain on favorable terms, if at all; such projects may require numerous governmental permits and approvals, and we may be unable to obtain such permits and approvals in a timely manner and at a reasonable cost, if at all; such projects may not yield the expected benefits; and the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility’s covenants may limit our ability to develop such projects.
For a further description of the risks related to the Company’s acquisitions, see “Risk Factors – Acquisitions could expose the Company to significant business risks.” For a further description of the risks related to the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility, see “Risk Factors – The Company’s 2018 Credit Facility contains covenants that limit its flexibility and prevent the Company from taking certain actions.”
The Company’s competition and customer preferences could impact the Company’s profitability.
The markets for the Company’s products are highly competitive. Competition in its markets is primarily based upon the quality, breadth and performance characteristics of its products, customer service and price. The Company’s ability to compete successfully depends upon a variety of factors, including its ability to create new and improved products, effectively employ skilled personnel, increase manufacturing facility efficiencies, reduce manufacturing costs, and create complementary products for customer convenience of a single supplier, as well as its access to quality, low-cost raw materials.
Some of the Company’s competitors, particularly certain of those located in Asia, may, at times, have lower costs (i.e. raw material, energy and labor) and/or less restrictive environmental and governmental regulations to comply with than the Company. Other competitors may be larger in size or scope than the Company, which may allow them to achieve greater economies of scale on a global basis or allow them to better withstand periods of declining prices and adverse operating conditions.
Demand for the Company’s products and, in turn, its revenue and profit margins, are affected by customer preferences and changes in customer ordering patterns which may occur as a result of, among other things, changes in inventory levels and timing of purchases which may be triggered by price changes and incentive programs.
The Company’s customer contracts contain termination provisions that could decrease the Company’s future revenues and earnings.
Most of the Company’s customer contracts can be terminated by the customer on short notice without penalty. The Company’s customers are, therefore, not contractually obligated to continue to do business with it in the future. This creates uncertainty with respect to the revenues and earnings the Company may recognize with respect to its customer contracts.
The Company’s manufacturing facility rationalization initiatives, manufacturing cost reduction programs and capital expenditure projects may result in higher costs and less savings than anticipated.
The Company has implemented several manufacturing facility rationalization initiatives, manufacturing cost reduction programs and capital expenditure projects. Certain of these have not been, and others may not in the future be, completed as planned. As a result, the costs and capital expenditures incurred by the Company have in certain instances substantially exceeded, and may in the future substantially exceed, projections. In addition, the timing for achieving cost reductions has sometimes been, and may in the future be, later than expected. This could potentially result, and has in certain instances resulted, in additional debt incurred by the Company, increased costs, reduced profits, or reduced production. In addition, the anticipated manufacturing cost savings may be less than expected or may not materialize at all.
Acquisitions could expose the Company to significant business risks.
The Company has made and may continue to make strategic acquisitions that could, among other goals, complement its existing products; expand its customer base, range of products, production capacity and/or markets; improve distribution efficiencies; lower production costs; and/or enhance its technological capabilities. As with all acquisitions, there are business risks to which the Company is exposed as a result, including but not limited to financial and operating risks.
Financial risks from these acquisitions include: (a) the use of the Company’s cash resources; (b) paying a price that exceeds the future value realized from the acquisition; (c) potential known and unknown liabilities of the acquired businesses, as well as contractually-based time and monetary limitations on a seller’s obligation, or the related insurer’s contractual obligation if representation and warranty insurance is purchased, to indemnify the Company for such liabilities; (d) the incurrence of additional debt; (e) the dilutive effect of the issuance of any additional equity securities the Company issues as consideration for, or to finance, the acquisition; (f) the financial impact of incorrectly valuing goodwill and other intangible assets involved in any acquisitions; (g) potential future impairment write-downs of goodwill and indefinite-life intangibles and the amortization of other intangible

9


assets; (h) possible adverse tax and accounting effects; and (i) the risk that the Company incurs substantial amounts purchasing these manufacturing facilities and assumes significant contractual and other obligations with no guaranteed levels of revenue or that the Company may have to close or sell acquired facilities at the Company's cost, which may include substantial employee severance costs and asset write-offs.
Further, there are possible operational risks including: difficulty assimilating and integrating the operations, products, technology, information systems and personnel of acquired companies; losing key personnel of acquired entities; entry into markets in which the Company has no or limited prior experience; diversion of management’s attention; compliance with a different jurisdiction’s laws; failure to obtain or retain intellectual property rights for certain products; and difficulty honoring commitments made to customers of the acquired companies prior to the acquisition. The Company may incur significant acquisition, administrative and other costs in connection with these transactions, including costs related to the integration of acquired businesses. These acquisitions could expose the Company to significant integration risks and increased organizational complexity, including more complex and costly accounting processes and internal controls, which may challenge management and may adversely impact the realization of an increased contribution from said acquisitions. In addition, while we execute these acquisitions and related integration activities, our attention may possibly be diverted from our ongoing operations which may have a negative impact on our business. The failure to adequately anticipate and address these risks could adversely affect the Company’s business and financial performance.
Although the Company performs due diligence investigations of the businesses and assets that it acquires, and anticipates continuing to do so for future acquisitions, there may be liabilities related to the acquired business or assets that the Company fails to, or is unable to, uncover during its due diligence investigation and for which the Company, as a successor owner, may be responsible. We, along with third party advisors, typically perform due diligence on such risks when we purchase targets. Such diligence may, however, be deficient or the potential liabilities may be difficult or impossible to identify in diligence. When feasible, the Company seeks to minimize the impact of these types of potential liabilities by obtaining indemnities and warranties from the seller, which may in some instances be supported by deferring payment of a portion of the purchase price, and/or by purchasing representation and warranty insurance. However, these indemnities and warranties, if obtained, may not fully cover the liabilities because of their limited scope, amount or duration, the financial resources of the indemnitor or warrantor, or other reasons.
Some of our recent acquisitions involve, and potential future acquisitions may involve, operations outside of the US which are subject to various risks including those described in “Risk Factors – The Company faces risks related to its international operations.”    
The Company may be unable to realize anticipated cost and revenue synergies and expects to incur substantial expenses related to acquisitions, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

While the Company anticipates certain cost and revenue synergies from acquisitions, the Company’s ability to achieve such estimated cost and revenue synergies in the timeframe described, or at all, is subject to various assumptions by the Company’s management, which may or may not be realized, as well as the incurrence of other costs in its operations that offset all or a portion of such cost synergies. Consequently, the Company may not be able to realize cost and revenue synergies within an expected timeframe or at all. In addition, the Company may incur additional and/or unexpected costs in order to realize these cost and/or revenue synergies. Failure to achieve the expected cost and revenue synergies could significantly reduce the expected benefits associated with acquisitions and adversely affect the Company. In addition, the Company has incurred and will incur substantial expenses in connection with many acquisitions. The Company often incurs non-recurring costs associated with integrating the acquired operations and achieving the desired synergies. These fees and costs have been, and may continue to be, substantial. The substantial majority of non-recurring expenses consist of transaction costs related to acquisitions and include, among others, fees paid to financial, tax and legal advisors, employee benefit costs and filing fees. These costs described above, as well as other unanticipated costs and expenses, could have an adverse effect on the financial condition and operating results of the Company.

10


The Company’s 2018 Credit Facility and indenture contain covenants that limit the Company's flexibility and prevent the Company from taking certain actions.
The credit agreement and security agreements governing the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility and the indenture entered into in connection with the Notes Offering include a number of significant restrictive covenants. These covenants could limit the Company’s ability to plan for or react to market conditions, meet its capital needs and execute its business strategy. These covenants, among other things, limit the Company’s ability and the ability of its subsidiaries to incur additional debt; prepay other debt; pay dividends and make other restricted payments; create or permit certain liens; issue or sell capital stock of restricted subsidiaries; use the proceeds from sales of assets; make certain investments; create or permit restrictions on the ability of the non-guarantors to pay dividends or to make other distributions to the Company; enter into certain types of transactions with affiliates; engage in unrelated businesses; enter into sale and leaseback transactions; and consolidate or merge or sell the Company’s assets substantially as an entirety.
A number of these restrictions in the 2018 Credit Facility are more stringent regarding subsidiaries of the Company that are not party to the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility (collectively, the “Non-Guarantor Parties”). The Non-Guarantor Parties, other than certain other designated unrestricted subsidiaries, are limited in their ability to incur debt outside of the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility. In addition, the Company and its subsidiaries are limited in the amount of investments that they may make in the Non-Guarantor Parties and the amount of guaranties they may make in connection with debt incurred by the Non-Guarantor Parties outside of the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility.
The Company depends on its subsidiaries for cash to meet its obligations and pay any dividends.
The Company is a holding company. Its subsidiaries conduct all of its operations and own substantially all of its assets. Consequently, the Company’s cash flow and its ability to meet its obligations or pay dividends to its stockholders depend upon the cash flow of its subsidiaries and the payment of funds by its subsidiaries to the Company in the form of dividends, tax sharing payments or otherwise. The Company’s subsidiaries’ ability to provide funding will depend on, amongst others, their earnings, the terms of indebtedness from time to time, tax considerations and legal restrictions.
Payment of dividends may not continue in the future, and the payment of dividends is subject to restriction.
The Company’s dividend policy currently provides for an annualized dividend of $0.56 per share. The future declaration and payment of dividends, if any, will be at the discretion of the Board of Directors and will depend on a number of factors, including the Company’s financial and operating results, financial position, legal requirements, and anticipated cash requirements. The Company can give no assurance that dividends will be declared and paid in the future or, if declared and paid in the future, at the same level as in the past. Additionally, the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility restricts its ability to pay dividends if the Company does not meet its net leverage or interest coverage ratios, or if the Company is otherwise in default.
The Company’s outstanding debt could adversely affect its financial condition.
As of December 31, 2018, the Company had outstanding debt of $500.0 million, which represented 40.7% of its total capitalization. Of such total debt, approximately $247.1 million net of unamortized fees was secured. The Company’s outstanding indebtedness could adversely affect its financial condition. The Company’s outstanding indebtedness could also increase its vulnerability to adverse general economic and industry conditions; require the Company to dedicate a substantial portion of its cash flows from operating activities to payments on its indebtedness, thereby reducing the availability of the Company’s cash flows to fund working capital, capital expenditures, potential acquisitions, research and development efforts and other general corporate purposes; limit the Company’s flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in its business and the industry in which it operates; place the Company at a competitive disadvantage compared to its competitors that have less debt; and limit the Company’s ability to borrow additional funds on terms that are satisfactory to it or at all.
The Company may not be able to generate sufficient cash flow to meet its debt service obligations.
The Company’s ability to generate sufficient cash flows from operating activities to make scheduled payments on its debt obligations will depend on its future financial performance, which will be affected by a range of economic, competitive, regulatory, legislative and business factors, many of which are outside of the Company’s control. If the Company does not generate sufficient cash flows from operating activities to satisfy its debt obligations, the Company may have to undertake alternative financing plans, such as refinancing or restructuring its debt, selling assets, reducing or delaying capital investments or seeking to raise additional capital. The Company cannot assure that any refinancing would be possible or that any assets could be sold on acceptable terms or otherwise. The Company’s inability to generate sufficient cash flows to satisfy its debt obligations, or to refinance its obligations on commercially reasonable terms, would have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business,

11


financial condition and results of operations. In addition, any refinancing of the Company’s debt could be at higher interest rates and may require the Company to comply with more onerous covenants, which could further restrict its business operations. Also, any additional issuances of equity would dilute the Company’s shareholders.
Despite the Company’s level of indebtedness, it will likely be able to incur substantially more debt. Incurring such debt could further exacerbate the risks to the Company’s financial condition described above.
The Company will likely be able to incur substantial additional indebtedness in the future. Although the credit agreement governing the 2018 Credit Facility contains restrictions on the incurrence of additional indebtedness, these restrictions are subject to qualifications and exceptions and the indebtedness incurred in compliance with these restrictions could be substantial. The restrictions also do not prevent the Company from incurring obligations that do not constitute indebtedness. To the extent new debt is added to the Company’s currently anticipated debt levels, the substantial leverage risks described above would increase.
The failure to maintain effective internal control over financial reporting in accordance with applicable securities laws could adversely affect the Company.
Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the related rules and regulations of the US Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) as well as applicable rules and guidelines adopted by the Canadian securities regulators require annual management assessments of the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting and a report by the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm to express an opinion on these controls based on their audit. Due to inherent limitations, there can be no assurance that the Company’s system of internal control over financial reporting will be successful in preventing all errors, theft, and fraud, or in informing management of all material information in a timely manner. These risks will likely be exacerbated as the Company expands, particularly in foreign jurisdictions where employees may not be as accustomed to such laws and regulations. Also, if the Company cannot in the future favorably assess, or the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm is unable to provide an unqualified attestation report on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, investors may lose confidence in the reliability of the Company’s financial reports, which could adversely affect the Company.
Certain of the Company’s pension and other post-retirement benefit plans are partially funded or unfunded which could require Company contributions.
The Company’s pension and other post-retirement benefit plans currently have an unfunded deficit of $14.9 million as of December 31, 2018 as compared to $29.3 million at the end of 2017. For 2018 and 2017, the Company contributed $13.9 million and $4.2 million, respectively, to its wholly or partially funded pension plans and to beneficiaries for its unfunded other benefit plans. The Company may need to divert certain of its resources in the future in order to resolve this funding deficit. In addition, the Company cannot predict whether a change in factors such as pension asset performance or interest rates, will require the Company to make a contribution in excess of its current expectations. Also, the Company expects to contribute $1.5 million to satisfy its 2019 minimum funding requirement for its wholly or partially funded pension plans and to beneficiaries for its unfunded other benefit plans. Further, the Company may not have the funds necessary to meet future minimum pension funding requirements or be able to meet its pension benefit plan funding obligation through cash flows from operating activities.
The Company depends on the proper functioning of its information systems.
The Company is dependent on the proper functioning of information systems, some of which are owned and operated by third parties, including the Company's vendors, customers and/or suppliers, to store, process and transmit confidential information, including financial reporting, inventory management, procurement, invoicing and electronic communications belonging to its customers, its suppliers, its employees and/or the Company itself. The Company’s information systems are vulnerable to natural disasters, fire, casualty, theft, technical failures, terrorist acts, cyber security breaches, power loss, telecommunications failures, physical or software intrusions, computer viruses, and similar events. If the Company’s critical information systems fail or are otherwise unavailable, its operations could be disrupted, causing a material adverse effect on its business, operations and financial statements.

The Company relies on third parties to provide software, support and management with respect to a variety of business processes and activities as part of our information technology network, and we are utilizing cloud computing through certain of our third-party vendors. The security and privacy measures the Company and its vendors, customers and suppliers implement are critical to our business, our key relationships, and compliance with applicable law. Despite the Company's security measures and business continuity plans, these information technology networks may be vulnerable to damage, disruptions or shutdowns due to attacks by hackers, natural disasters or catastrophic events, or breaches due to errors or malfeasance by employees, contractors and others who have access to the networks and systems.

12


Any theft or misuse of information resulting from a security breach of the Company's or a third party's information technology networks and systems could result in, among other things, loss of significant and/or sensitive information, litigation by affected parties, financial obligations resulting from such theft or misuse, higher insurance premiums, governmental investigations, negative reactions from current and potential future customers (including potential negative financial ramifications under certain customer contract provisions) and poor publicity. Given the seemingly increasing frequency and severity of cyberattacks on commercial and governmental organizations in recent years, this threat may be heightened for the Company. Any of these consequences, in addition to the time and funds spent on monitoring and mitigating the Company’s exposure and responding to breaches, including the training of employees, the purchase of protective technologies and the hiring of additional employees and consultants to assist in these efforts, could adversely affect its financial results.
To date, the Company has not experienced a material cybersecurity breach and has prevented or adequately managed less impactful incidents. However, we suspect that risks and exposures related to cybersecurity attacks will remain high for the foreseeable future due to the rapidly evolving nature and sophistication of these threats. The Company maintains first and third-party cybersecurity insurance coverage in an attempt to mitigate such risks.
The Company faces risks related to its international operations.

The Company has customers and operations located outside the US and Canada. In 2018, sales to customers located outside the US and Canada represented approximately 12% of its sales. The Company’s international operations present it with a number of risks and challenges, including potential difficulties staffing and managing its foreign operations, potential difficulties managing a more extensive supply chain as compared to its sales efforts in the US and Canada, potential adverse changes in tax regulations affecting tax rates and the way the US and other countries tax multinational companies, the effective marketing of the Company’s products in other countries, tariffs and other trade barriers, less favorable intellectual property laws, longer customer payment cycles, exposure to economies that may be experiencing currency volatility or negative growth, exposure to political and economic instability and unsafe working conditions (including acts of terrorism, widespread criminal activities and outbreaks of war), certain cultural differences and different regulatory schemes and political environments applicable to its operations in these areas, such as environmental and health and safety compliance. As a result of the Company’s recent acquisitions of Powerband Industries Private Limited (d/b/a "Powerband") and Capstone Polyweave Private Limited (d/b/a "Capstone"), we expect that our business mix will rebalance to a greater percentage of international operations which should increase our exposure to these risks.

There have been recent changes, and future, additional changes may occur, to US and foreign trade and tax policies, including heightened import restrictions, import and export licenses, new tariffs, trade embargoes, government sanctions or trade barriers. Any of these restrictions could prevent or make it difficult for the Company to obtain certain raw materials and/or equipment needed to manufacture certain products. Increased tariffs could require the Company to increase its prices which likely would decrease demand for the Company’s products. In some situations, it may be difficult for the Company to effect a price increase for products whose raw materials are affected by tariffs, see “Risk Factor—Fluctuations in raw material costs or the unavailability of raw materials may adversely affect the Company’s profitability.” In addition, other countries may retaliate through their own restrictions and/or increased tariffs which would affect our ability to export products and therefore
adversely affect our sales.
The US Federal Reserve recently increased its benchmark interest rate and signaled that rates could continue to rise. While it is unclear whether these actions suggest a change in previous monetary policy positions, including but not limited to an elimination of quantitative easing over time, any such change or market expectation of such change may result in significantly higher long-term interest rates. Such a transition may be abrupt and may, among other things, reduce the availability and/or increase the costs of obtaining new debt and refinancing existing indebtedness, negatively impact the market price of our common stock, and potentially decrease demand for the products of the Company and its customers.
In addition, in June 2016, voters in the United Kingdom approved an advisory referendum to withdraw membership from the European Union (commonly referred to as “Brexit”), which is anticipated to occur in some form in early 2019. Brexit, and the negotiations between the United Kingdom and the European Union, could cause disruptions to, and create uncertainty surrounding, the Company’s business in Europe, including affecting the Company’s relationships with its existing and future customers, suppliers and employees.
Because the Company has operations in Europe, it is subject to the European General Data Protection Regulation (“GDPR”) enacted on May 25, 2018. The GDPR imposes additional obligations and risk upon the Company’s business and increases the penalties to which we could be subject in the event of any non-compliance. The Company may incur expenses in complying with the obligations imposed by the GDPR and the Company may be required to make changes in our business operations, all of which may adversely affect our revenue and our business overall. Additionally, because the GDPR’s standards are relatively new, we are unable to predict how they will be applied to us. Despite our best efforts to attempt to comply with the

13


GDPR, a regulator may determine that we have not done so and subject us to fines and public censure, which could harm our company.
Finally, the Company’s financial statements are reported in US dollars while a portion of its sales are made in other currencies, primarily the Canadian dollar, the Euro and the Indian Rupee. As a result, fluctuations in exchange rates between the US dollar and foreign currencies can have a negative impact on the Company’s reported operating results and financial condition. Moreover, in some cases, the currency of the Company’s sales does not match the currency in which it incurs costs, which can negatively affect its profitability. Fluctuations in exchange rates can also affect the relative competitive position of a particular facility where the facility faces competition from non-local producers, as well as the Company’s ability to successfully market its products in export markets.

The final impacts of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act could be materially different from our current estimates.

The Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (the “TCJA”) was enacted into law in the US on December 22, 2017. The new law made numerous changes to the previously existing US corporate tax laws, and includes provisions that have had an immediate effect on the Company’s business and will affect certain aspects of the Company’s business going forward. The changes included in the TCJA are broad and complex. The final impacts of the TCJA may differ from our current estimates, possibly materially, due to, among other things, changes in interpretations of the TCJA, any legislative action to address questions that arise because of the TCJA, any changes in accounting standards for income taxes or related interpretations in response to the TCJA, or any updates or changes to estimates the Company has utilized to calculate the transition impacts.
The Company’s operations are subject to comprehensive environmental regulation and involve expenditures which may be material in relation to its operating cash flow.
The Company’s operations are subject to extensive environmental regulation in each of the countries in which it maintains facilities. For example, US (federal, state and local), Canadian (federal, provincial and local), Portuguese (federal, state and local), and Indian (federal, state and local) environmental laws applicable to the Company include statutes and regulations intended to impose certain obligations with respect to site contamination and to allocate the cost of investigating, monitoring and remedying soil and groundwater contamination among specifically identified parties, as well as to prevent future soil and groundwater contamination; imposing ambient standards and, in some cases, emission standards, for air pollutants which present a risk to public health, welfare or the natural environment; governing the handling, management, treatment, storage and disposal of hazardous wastes and substances; regulating the chemical content of products; and regulating the discharge of pollutants into waterways.
The Company’s use of hazardous substances in its manufacturing processes and the generation of hazardous wastes not only by the Company, but by prior occupants of its facilities, suggest that hazardous substances may be present at or near certain of the Company’s facilities or may come to be located there in the future. Consequently, the Company is required to closely monitor its compliance under all the various environmental laws and regulations applicable to it. In addition, the Company arranges for the off-site disposal of hazardous substances generated in the ordinary course of its business. Under certain environmental laws, the Company may be responsible for remediation costs or other liabilities as a result of the use, release or disposal of hazardous substances at or from any property currently or formerly owned or operated or to which the Company sent waste for treatment or disposal. Liability under these laws may be imposed without regard to whether the Company was aware of, or caused, the contamination and, in some cases, liability may be joint or several.
The Company obtains Phase I or similar environmental site assessments, and Phase II environmental site assessments, if necessary, for most of the manufacturing facilities it owns or leases at the time it either acquires or leases such facilities. These assessments typically include general inspections and may involve soil sampling and/or groundwater analysis. These assessments may not reveal all potential environmental liabilities and current assessments are not available for all facilities. Consequently, there may be material environmental liabilities of which the Company is not aware. In addition, ongoing cleanup and containment operations may not be adequate for purposes of future laws and regulations. The conditions of the Company’s properties could also be affected in the future by neighboring operations or the conditions of the land in the vicinity of its properties. These developments and others, such as increasingly stringent environmental laws and regulations, increasingly strict enforcement of environmental laws and regulations, or claims for damage to property or injury to persons resulting from the environmental, health or safety impact of its operations, may cause the Company to incur significant costs and liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on it.

Phase II environmental site assessment reports conducted in the fall of 2017 documented the presence of soil and groundwater contamination at the Cantech facilities in Cornwall, Ontario, Canada and Montreal, Quebec, Canada. With respect to the owned Cantech facility located in Cornwall, Ontario, Canada, and the Cantech facility leased by the Company in Montreal, Quebec, environmental reports obtained in 2017 indicated the presence of certain contaminants at levels exceeding applicable

14


regulatory standards, including cyanide and toluene in soil samples, vinyl chloride in groundwater samples. These and any other environmental matters that may be discovered could be subject to additional investigation. To the extent the presence of such contaminants requires remediation work, results in any penalties or other amounts or gives rise to third party claims based on alleged migration of contaminants, there could be an adverse effect on the financial position of the Company.

The Company obtained an unlimited indemnification from the sellers of the Cantech business with respect to any environmental matter that pre-existed the acquisition and is not currently aware of any material amounts payable or claimed related to the foregoing.
The Company’s facilities are required to maintain numerous environmental permits and governmental approvals for its operations. Some of the environmental permits and governmental approvals that have been issued to the Company or to its facilities contain conditions and restrictions, including restrictions or limits on emissions and discharges of pollutants and contaminants, or may have limited terms. Maintaining these permits and complying with their terms as well as environmental laws and regulations applicable to the Company’s business could require the Company to incur material costs.
If the Company fails to satisfy these conditions or to comply with these restrictions or with applicable environmental laws and regulations, it may become subject to enforcement actions and the operation of the relevant facilities could be adversely affected. The Company may also be subject to fines, penalties, claims for injunctive relief or additional costs. The Company may not be able to renew, maintain or obtain all environmental permits and governmental approvals required for the continued operation or further development of the facilities, as a result of which the operation of the facilities may be limited or suspended.
The Company may become involved in litigation relating to its intellectual property rights, which could have an adverse impact on its business.
The Company relies on patent protection, as well as a combination of copyright, trade secret and trademark laws, nondisclosure and confidentiality agreements and other contractual restrictions to protect its proprietary technology. In addition to relying on patent protection, as well as a combination of copyright, trade secret and trademark laws, nondisclosure and confidentiality agreements and other contractual restrictions, the Company relies in some cases on unpatented proprietary know-how and trade secrets. The Company employs various methods, including its internal security systems, policies and procedures, to protect its proprietary know-how and trade secrets. These mechanisms may not, however, afford complete or sufficient protection, and misappropriation may still occur.
Litigation may be necessary to enforce these rights, which could result in substantial costs to the Company and a substantial diversion of management attention. Further, there can be no assurance that the Company will be able to enforce its patent or other rights, if any, and that others will not independently develop similar know-how and trade secrets or develop better production methods. If the Company does not adequately protect its intellectual property, its competitors or other parties could use the intellectual property that the Company has developed to enhance their products or make products similar to the Company’s and compete more efficiently with it, which could result in a decrease in the Company’s market share.
While the Company has attempted to ensure that its products and the operations of its business do not infringe other parties’ patents and proprietary rights, its competitors or other parties may assert that the Company’s products and operations may infringe upon patents held by them. In addition, because patent applications can take many years to issue, the Company might have products that infringe upon pending patents and other proprietary rights of which it is unaware. If any of the Company’s products infringe a valid patent, the Company could be prevented from selling such products unless the Company obtains a license or redesigns the products to avoid infringement. A license may not be available or may require the Company to pay substantial royalties. The Company may not be successful in attempts to redesign its products to avoid infringement. Infringement or other intellectual property claims, regardless of merit or ultimate outcome, can be expensive and time-consuming to resolve as well as divert management’s attention from the Company’s core business.
The Company may become involved in labor disputes or employees could form or join unions increasing the Company’s costs to do business.
Some of the Company’s employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. Other employees are not part of a union and there are no assurances that such employees will not form or join a union. Any attempt by employees to form or join a union could result in increased labor costs and adversely affect the Company’s business, its financial condition and/or results of operations.
Except for the strike which occurred at the Company’s Brantford, Ontario manufacturing facility in 2008, which is now closed, the Company has never experienced any work stoppages due to employee related disputes. Management believes that

15


it has a good relationship with its employees. However, there can be no assurance that work stoppages or other labor disturbances will not occur in the future. Such occurrences could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and/or results of operations.
The Company may become involved in litigation which could have an adverse impact on its business.
The Company, like other manufacturers and sellers, is subject to potential liabilities connected with its business operations, including potential liabilities and expenses associated with product defects, performance, reliability or delivery delays. The Company is threatened from time to time with, or is named as a defendant in, legal proceedings, including lawsuits based upon product liability, personal injury, breach of contract and lost profits or other consequential damages claims, in the ordinary course of conducting its business. A significant judgment against the Company, or the imposition of a significant fine or penalty resulting from a finding that the Company failed to comply with laws or regulations, or being named as a defendant on multiple claims could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and/or results of operations.
In the event of catastrophic loss of one of our key manufacturing facilities, our business would be adversely affected.
While we manufacture our products in a large number of diversified facilities and maintain insurance covering our facilities, a catastrophic loss of the use of all or a portion of one of our key manufacturing facilities due to accident, labor issues, weather conditions, natural disaster or otherwise, whether short or long-term, could have a material adverse effect on the Company. For example, significant rainfall and subsequent severe flooding on October 4, 2015 (the “South Carolina Flood”) resulted in considerable damage to, and the permanent closure of, the Columbia, South Carolina manufacturing facility eight to nine months in advance of its planned shutdown. Charges incurred as a result of the South Carolina Flood during the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 totalled $4.9 million and $6.5 million, respectively, before Insurance Proceeds.
Uninsured and underinsured losses and rising insurance costs could adversely affect the Company’s business.
The Company maintains property, business interruption, general liability, cybersecurity, directors and officer’s liability, environmental liability, workers compensation liability and other ancillary insurance on such terms as it deems appropriate. This may result in insurance coverage that, in the event of a substantial loss, would not be sufficient to pay for the full current market value or current replacement cost of the Company’s lost investment. Not all risks are covered by insurance, as such coverage is not feasible.
The Company’s cost of maintaining property, general liability and business interruption insurance and director and officer liability insurance is significant. The Company could experience higher insurance premiums as a result of adverse claims experience or because of general increases in premiums by insurance carriers for reasons unrelated to its own claims experience. Generally, the Company’s insurance policies must be renewed annually. The Company’s ability to continue to obtain insurance at affordable premiums also depends upon its ability to continue to operate with an acceptable claims record. A significant increase in the number of claims against the Company, the assertion of one or more claims in excess of its policy limits, or the inability to obtain adequate insurance coverage at acceptable rates, or any insurance coverage at all, could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and/or results of operations.
The Company’s success depends upon retaining the services of its management team and key employees.
The Company is dependent on its management team and expects that continued success will depend largely upon their efforts and abilities. The loss of the services of any key executive for any reason could have a material adverse effect on the Company. Success also depends upon the Company’s ability to identify, develop, and retain qualified employees.
Product liability could adversely affect the Company’s business.
Difficulties in product design, performance and reliability could result in lost sales, delays in customer acceptance of the Company’s products, customer complaints or lawsuits. Such difficulties could be detrimental to the Company’s market reputation. The Company’s products and the products supplied by third parties on behalf of the Company may not be error-free. Undetected errors or performance problems may be discovered in the future. The Company may not be able to successfully complete the development of planned or future products in a timely manner or adequately address product defects, which could harm the Company’s business and prospects. In addition, product defects may expose the Company to product liability claims, for which it may not have sufficient product liability insurance. Difficulties in product design, performance and reliability or product liability claims could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and/or results of operations.

16


Because the Company is a Canadian company, it may be difficult to enforce rights under US bankruptcy laws.
The Company and certain of its subsidiaries are incorporated under the laws of Canada and a substantial amount of its assets are located outside of the US Under bankruptcy laws in the US, courts typically assert jurisdiction over a debtor’s property, wherever located, including property situated in other countries. However, courts outside of the US may not recognize the US bankruptcy court’s jurisdiction over property located outside of the territorial limits of the US. Accordingly, should insolvency proceeding be commenced by or in respect of the Company in the US pursuant to US bankruptcy laws, difficulties may arise in administering such proceedings in a case involving a Canadian debtor with property located outside of the US, and any orders or judgments of a bankruptcy court in the US may not be enforceable outside the territorial limits of the US.
It may be difficult for investors to enforce civil liabilities against the Company under US federal and state securities laws.
The Company and certain of its subsidiaries are incorporated under the laws of Canada. Certain of their directors are residents of Canada and a portion of directors’ and executive officers’ assets may be located outside of the US. In addition, certain subsidiaries are located in other foreign jurisdictions. As a result, it may be difficult or impossible for US investors to effect service of process within the US upon the Company, its Canadian subsidiaries, or its other foreign subsidiaries, or those directors and officers, or to enforce against them judgments of courts of the US predicated upon the civil liability provisions of US federal securities laws or securities or blue sky laws of any state within the US. The Company believes that a judgment of a US court predicated solely upon the civil liability provisions of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended and/or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (“Exchange Act”), would likely be enforceable in Canada if the US court in which the judgment was obtained had a basis for jurisdiction in the matter that was recognized by a Canadian court for such purposes. The Company cannot make any assurances, however, that this will be the case. There is substantial doubt whether an action could be brought in Canada in the first instance on the basis of liability predicated solely upon such laws.

The Company has its registered office in the Province of Québec, Canada and, as a result, is subject to the securities laws of that province. In addition, the Company is a “reporting issuer” under the securities laws of each of the provinces of Canada and is therefore subject to the provisions thereof relating to, among other things, continuous disclosure and filing of insider reports by the Company’s “reporting insiders”, as applicable.

While the Company’s shares trade on the Toronto Stock Exchange, they trade on the OTC Pink Marketplace in the US, which may result in the possible absence of a liquid trading market for securities of US investors.

The Company’s common shares are traded in the US on the OTC Pink Marketplace. Trading on this market can be thin and characterized by wide fluctuations in trading prices, due to many factors that may have little to do with a company’s operations or business prospects. In addition, trading on this market is often sporadic, so shareholders may have some difficulty reselling any of their shares of common stock on this market.
Compliance with the SEC’s conflict mineral disclosure requirements results in additional compliance costs and may create reputational challenges.
The SEC adopted rules pursuant to Section 1502 of the Dodd-Frank Act setting forth disclosure requirements concerning the use or potential use of certain minerals and their derivatives, including tantalum, tin, gold and tungsten, that are mined from the Democratic Republic of Congo and adjoining countries, and deemed conflict minerals. These requirements have necessitated, and will continue to necessitate, due diligence efforts by the Company to assess whether such minerals are used in the Company’s products in order to make the relevant required disclosures. There are certain costs associated with complying with these new disclosure requirements, including diligence to determine the sources of those minerals that may be used or necessary to the production of the Company’s products. If the Company determines that certain of its products contain minerals that are not conflict-free or is unable to sufficiently verify the origins for all conflict minerals used in its products, the Company may face changes to its supply chain or challenges to its reputation, either of which could impact future sales.
The Company’s exemptions under the Exchange Act of 1934, as a foreign private issuer, limit the protections and information afforded investors.
The Company is a foreign private issuer within the meaning of the rules promulgated under the Exchange Act. As such, it is exempt from certain provisions applicable to US companies with securities registered under the Exchange Act, including: the rules under the Exchange Act requiring the filing with the SEC of quarterly reports on Form 10-Q or current reports on Form 8-K; the sections of the Exchange Act regulating the solicitation of proxies, consents or authorizations in respect of a security registered under the Exchange Act; and the sections of the Exchange Act requiring insiders to file public reports of their stock

17


ownership and trading activities and establishing insider liability for profits realized from any “short-swing” trading transaction (i.e., a purchase and sale, or sale and purchase, of the issuers’ equity securities within a period of less than six months). Because of these exemptions, purchasers of the Company’s securities are not afforded the same protections or information generally available to investors in public companies organized in the US. For the year ended December 31, 2008 and commencing for the year ended December 31, 2010 and going forward, the Company has elected to file its annual report on Form 20-F which also fulfills the requirements of the Annual Information Form required in Canada, thus necessitating only one report. The Company reports on Form 6-K and makes certain other filings (such as Form S-8, Form 11-K and Form SD), with the US Securities and Exchange Commission and publicly releases quarterly financial reports.
Our business could be negatively affected by the actions of activist shareholders.
Certain of our shareholders may from time to time advance shareholder proposals or otherwise attempt to effect changes or acquire control over our business. Such proposals or attempts are sometimes led by investors seeking to increase short-term shareholder value by advocating corporate actions such as financial restructuring, increased borrowing, special dividends, stock repurchases or even sales of assets or the entire company. Such an action focused on the short-term may be to the long-term detriment of the Company’s shareholders. If faced with actions by activist shareholders, we may not be able to respond effectively to such actions, which could be disruptive to our business.
We cannot assure our shareholders that our normal course issuer bid will enhance shareholder value, and share repurchases could increase the volatility of our share price.
We repurchase shares in the open market and otherwise for cancellation pursuant to normal course issuer bids (“NCIB”), which allow us to repurchase a certain number of shares during a specified period. Under our NCIB, we are authorized to repurchase up to an aggregate of approximately 4,000,000 common shares over the twelve-month period ending July 22, 2019. The timing and actual number of shares repurchased will depend on a variety of factors including the timing of open trading windows, price, corporate and regulatory requirements, and other market conditions. The existence of the NCIB, however, could also cause our share price to be higher than it would be in the absence of such a program and could potentially reduce the market liquidity for our subordinate voting shares.
 
Item 4:
Information on the Company

Information about the Company can be found on the Company’s website at www.itape.com and under the Company’s profile on SEDAR at www.sedar.com (Canada) and on the SEC's website at www.sec.gov (United States).

 
A.
HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT OF THE COMPANY
    
The Company’s corporate headquarters is located at 9999 Cavendish Blvd., Suite 200, Ville St. Laurent, Québec, Canada H4M 2X5 and the address and telephone number of its registered office is 800 Place Victoria, Suite 3700, Montréal, Québec H4Z 1E9, c/o Fasken Martineau Dumoulin LLP, (514) 397-7400.
    
The Company strives to create shareholder value primarily through four strategic priorities:

• Strengthening the Company's product bundle through increased capacity and new product extensions,
• Expanding the Company's global footprint,
• Providing protective solutions, and
• Driving operational excellence.

In furtherance of these objectives, the Company has significantly expanded its business through internal growth and strategic acquisitions in recent years.

The Company acquires businesses that either strategically fit within its existing business portfolio or expand its portfolio into a new and attractive business area. Since 2015, the Company has acquired seven companies with purchase prices totaling $324.1 million. The Company believes these acquisitions will provide continued growth and improve the Company's competitiveness in key markets and segments. The Company is actively considering additional acquisitions, investments and strategic alliances to strengthen its portfolio.

18


In 2016, the Company implemented a two-year program focused on significant manufacturing facility rationalization initiatives, which the Company expects will add capacity through the expansion of current facilities and opening of new facilities. From 2016 through 2018, the Company has invested approximately $211.1 million in capital expenditures. The new Midland, North Carolina facility, which serves the e-commerce segment with water-activated tape, had its first line operational in the third quarter of 2017 and is operating at capacity. The second line, which provides additional capacity for anticipated growth in e-commerce demand, was successfully commissioned in the first quarter of 2019 on time and on budget. Two greenfield facilities in India are each scheduled to commence operations in the first half of 2019. These three new operations, consisting of the second Midland line and the greenfield facilities in India, represent approximately $65 million in total expected capital spend upon completion.
Company History
The Company was established when Intertape Systems Inc., a predecessor of the Company, established a pressure-sensitive tape manufacturing facility in Montreal, Quebec, Canada. The Company was incorporated under the Canada Business Corporations Act on December 22, 1989 under the name “171695 Canada Inc.” On October 8, 1991, the Company filed a Certificate of Amendment changing its name to “Intertape Polymer Group Inc.” A Certificate of Amalgamation was filed by the Company on August 31, 1993, at which time the Company was amalgamated with EBAC Holdings Inc.
The Company entered the European shrink film market through its investment in Fibope in April 1995. The Company initially purchased a 50% equity interest in Fibope, acquiring the remaining 50% equity stake in July 2003. Fibope, which operates as an autonomous unit within the Company, produces a full range of shrink film products for sale in Europe. Raw materials are primarily sourced within Europe, with multiple sources utilized to ensure stability of supply and a competitive price environment.
In 2013, the Company transferred the manufacturing operations at its Richmond, Kentucky facility (which had ceased during the fourth quarter of 2012) to its Carbondale, Illinois facility and subsequently sold the Richmond, Kentucky facility in 2014. In addition, the Company consolidated its North American shrink film production at its Tremonton, Utah facility in 2013.
In October 2015, the Columbia, South Carolina facility (which the Company planned to relocate to a new property in Blythewood, South Carolina) was damaged by significant rainfall and severe flooding ("South Carolina Flood"). The damages sustained were considerable and resulted in the facility being permanently shut down and its duct tape, masking tape, and stencil production lines relocated to Blythewood, South Carolina earlier than planned. Since this relocation was completed in 2016, the Company has worked to restore production capabilities and commercialize its suite of masking tape and stencil product offerings produced in the Blythewood, South Carolina manufacturing facility. While navigating the challenges of doing so, the Company lost most of its sales in the South Carolina masking tape and stencil product lines and experienced significant delays in commercializing them in the new facility. During 2018, the Company finished commercialization of its post-South Carolina Flood stencil and remaining post-South Carolina Flood masking tape production. With the commercialization of these products, the Company continues to work on recapturing sales of its masking tape and stencil products. While the timing and extent of these recoveries are uncertain, the Company does expect incremental improvement over time. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for this project from inception to completion totalled $60.7 million.

On April 7, 2015, the Company purchased 100% of the issued and outstanding common stock of BP Acquisition Corporation (which wholly-owns a subsidiary, Better Packages, Inc.) (“Better Packages”), a leading supplier of water-activated tape dispensers. The Company paid an aggregate purchase price of $15.2 million, net of cash acquired. The purchase of Better Packages extended the Company’s product bundle and global presence in the rapidly growing e-commerce market.

Effective September 1, 2015, along with certain related transfers of certain intercompany receivables, payables and notes, on or about the same date, Intertape Polymer US Inc. was dissolved.

On November 2, 2015, the Company purchased 100% of the issued and outstanding common shares of RJM Manufacturing, Inc. (d/b/a “TaraTape”), a manufacturer of filament and pressure-sensitive tapes. The Company paid an aggregate purchase price of $11.0 million, net of cash acquired. As part of the Company’s plan to realize operational synergies from the TaraTape acquisition, the Company closed its Fairless Hills, Pennsylvania manufacturing facility and ceased its manufacturing operations as of December 31, 2016. In order to accommodate the related production volume, the Company leveraged production capacity in its Carbondale, Illinois and Danville, Virginia manufacturing facilities and will continue to do so.
On February 16, 2016, the Company announced it would invest $44 to $49 million in the construction of a greenfield manufacturing facility in Midland, North Carolina, with a goal of increasing its manufacturing capacity of water-activated tapes by the end of 2017 ("Midland WAT Project"). The first production line at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility was operational in the third quarter of 2017 and is operating at capacity. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for this project

19


since inception totalled $48.6 million of which $4.3 million was spent in 2015, $13.7 million in 2016, $29.6 million in 2017 and $1.0 million in 2018. As a result of the success of this project and the Company's expectation of further demand growth in water-activated tapes, in the third quarter of 2017, the Company began an initiative to double the capacity at the Midland, North Carolina facility by adding a second production line for an additional expected investment of $14 to $16 million ("Midland Expansion Project"). In February 2019, the Company successfully commissioned its second water-activated tape line at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility. The second production line is operating as planned in terms of timeline and is in line with expected capital expenditures. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for this project since inception totalled $13.4 million of which $5.4 million was spent in 2017 and $8.0 million in 2018.
On September 16, 2016, IPG Mauritius Ltd., a newly formed subsidiary of the Company, under a Share Purchase Agreement, dated September 2, 2016, purchased a 74% ownership stake in Powerband, a global supplier of acrylic adhesive-based carton sealing tapes and stretch films located in Daman, India, with the remaining 26% continuing to be held by the Desai family which founded the company in 1994. The Company paid an aggregate purchase price of $41.9 million, net of cash acquired. At the time, the Company also entered into various option agreements with the Desai family for the transfer of the remaining shares under certain limited circumstances. On July 4, 2017, the Company and the Desai family executed a binding term sheet that confirmed that the Company's call option on all of the shares owned by the Desai family had been triggered and substantially reaffirmed the exit terms of the Share Purchase Agreement. Execution of this term sheet resulted in the recognition of $12.7 million in present obligations recorded in call option redemption liability, and a corresponding reduction of equity as of December 31, 2017. On November 16, 2018, the Company closed on the exercised call option to acquire the outstanding 26% interest in Powerband for $9.9 million and now owns all of the issued and outstanding common shares of Powerband after this transaction.
In 2016, the Company approved a plan to expand the production capacity within the Daman, India manufacturing facility and to expand capacity by investing in the construction of a greenfield manufacturing facility in Dahej, India (the “Powerband Investment Projects”). Capital expenditures for the Powerband Investment Projects is estimated to total approximately $18 to $20 million. The plan for the additional capacity in the preexisting manufacturing facility was completed mid-2017. The greenfield facility was originally expected to be operating in 2018; however, in light of the ownership transition described above, the Company reevaluated and extended the timeline for the completion of the greenfield facility to the first half of 2019. The project is proceeding on time and on budget where to date facility construction has been completed and equipment installation and product trials have begun. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for these projects since inception totalled $15.7 million of which $1.5 million was spent in 2016, $7.3 million in 2017, and $6.9 million in 2018.
On June 23, 2017, as one of the initial steps in the establishment of the partnership in Capstone Polyweave Private Limited, a newly-formed enterprise in India (doing business as "Capstone"), the Company purchased substantially all of the issued and outstanding shares of Capstone ("Capstone Partnership") for cash consideration of $5.1 million, funded primarily from the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. At the time, the Company agreed to maintain a minimum 55% interest in Capstone for total cash consideration of approximately $13 million, financed with funds available under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. The Company’s investment in Capstone is intended to reinforce its strategic position in woven products through vertical integration.
On July 1, 2017, the Company acquired substantially all of the assets of Canadian Technical Tape Ltd. (d/b/a "Cantech"), a privately-owned North American supplier of industrial and specialty tapes based in Montreal, for an aggregate purchase price of $67.0 million, net of cash acquired. The assets included the shares of Cantech Industries Inc., Cantech’s US subsidiary (collectively, the “Cantech Acquisition”). The purchase price was financed with funds available under the Company's 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. The Cantech Acquisition enhanced the Company's product offering and adds additional distribution channels for the Company's products in Canada, the US and Europe. In the third quarter of 2018, the Company announced that it would close the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility to further expand on operational synergies gained from the Cantech Acquisition. As of December 31, 2018, the Johnson City manufacturing facility, which primarily produces carton sealing tape, had transferred substantially all of its production to other existing manufacturing facilities.
On August 8, 2017, the Company purchased additional shares of Capstone for cash consideration of $5.1 million funded primarily from the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. As of December 31, 2017, the Company and the non-controlling shareholders held 98.4% and 1.6% of the issued and outstanding shares of Capstone, respectively.

20


The Company also partnered with the non-controlling shareholders of Capstone, who are also the shareholders and operators of Airtrax Polymers Private Limited (doing business as "Airtrax"). Airtrax manufactures and sells woven products that are used in various applications, including applications in the building and construction industry. On May 11, 2018, the Company acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed certain liabilities of Airtrax. As part of the agreement, the minority shareholders of Capstone contributed in kind certain assets and liabilities valued at $13.4 million and formerly attributed to Airtrax’s woven product manufacturing operations in exchange for newly-issued shares of Capstone. On August 10, 2018, the Company acquired additional existing and newly-issued shares of Capstone in exchange for $3.6 million in cash as part of the same overall transaction. As a result of this purchase, the Company now has a controlling 55% ownership stake in Capstone with the minority shareholders of Capstone owning 45%. This last step concluded the set-up of the intended ownership structure of the Capstone Partnership.
The primary purpose of the Capstone Partnership is to finance the construction of a greenfield manufacturing facility to produce woven products primarily for the Company's global distribution ("Capstone Greenfield Project"). The Capstone Greenfield Project is expected to cost approximately $28 to $32 million in total. The Capstone Greenfield Project began in 2017 and to date facility construction has been completed and equipment installation and product trials have begun. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for this project since inception totalled $25.3 million of which $8.4 million was incurred in 2017 and $16.9 million in 2018. Commercial operations are expected to commence in the first half of 2019 as planned.
On August 3, 2018, the Company acquired 100% of the outstanding equity value in Polyair Inter Pack Inc. (“Polyair”) for an aggregate purchase price of $145.0 million, net of cash acquired. The purchase price was funded using funds available under the Company's 2018 Credit Facility. Polyair, formerly a private company, is in the protective packaging business with seven manufacturing facilities and a distribution center in North America. Polyair's products include bubble cushioning, foam, mailers and inflatable systems. The acquisition is expected to further strengthen the Company's product bundle and bring additional scale in protective packaging solutions.
On December 17, 2018, the Company acquired substantially all of the operating assets of Maiweave, LLC ("Maiweave") for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $20.8 million, net of cash acquired. Maiweave products are used in applications such as grain and salt pile covers, pit and pond liners, shelter fabrics, outdoor media, and lumber mill packaging. The acquisition is expected to strengthen the Company's existing product bundle and add additional capacity and scale in woven products.
The Company’s total capital expenditures in connection with property, plant and equipment were $75.8 million, $85.3 million, and $50.0 million for the years 2018, 2017, and 2016, respectively.
Capital expenditures for the year ended December 31, 2018 were primarily for property, plant and equipment to support the following strategic and growth initiatives: the Capstone Greenfield Project ($16.9 million), the Midland Expansion Project ($8.0 million), the Powerband Investment Projects ($6.9 million), the shrink film capacity expansion at the Tremonton, Utah manufacturing facility ("Utah Shrink Film Project") ($4.8 million), and the expansion of the Company’s specialty tape product offering ("Specialty Tape Project") ($1.0 million) and other initiatives.
Capital expenditures for the year ended December 31, 2017 were primarily for property, plant and equipment to support the following strategic and growth initiatives: Midland WAT Project ($29.6 million), the capacity expansion of stretch film production in the Danville, Virginia manufacturing facility ("Stretch Film Project") ($9.6 million), the Capstone Greenfield Project ($8.4 million), the Powerband Investment Projects ($7.3 million),the Midland Expansion Project ($5.4 million), the Specialty Tape Project) ($2.5 million), the Utah Shrink Film Project ($2.3 million) and the shrink film capacity expansion at the Portugal manufacturing facility ("Portuguese Shrink Film Project") ($1.0 million).
The Company has typically relied upon cash flows from operations and borrowings, to fund capital expenditures.
 
 
B.
BUSINESS OVERVIEW
The Company develops, manufactures and sells a variety of paper and film-based pressure-sensitive and water-activated tapes, polyethylene and specialized polyolefin packaging films, protective packaging, engineered coated products and complementary packaging systems for industrial and retail use. The Company provides packaging and protective solutions for industrial markets in North America, Europe and other geographies. The Company has approximately 3,500 employees with operations in 29 locations, including 22 manufacturing facilities in North America, two in Asia and one in Europe.
The Company’s products primarily consist of carton sealing tapes, including pressure-sensitive and water-activated tapes; packaging equipment; industrial and performance specialty tapes including masking, duct, electrical, foil, process indicator,

21


sheathing, sports and reinforced filament tapes; protective packaging solutions including inflatable systems, mailer products, bubble cushioning, paper void fill, thermal solutions and protective foam roll stock; stencil products; shrink film; stretch wrap; lumber wrap, structure fabrics, geomembrane fabrics; and non-manufactured flexible intermediate bulk containers. Most of the Company’s products are made from similar processes. A vast majority of the Company’s products, while brought to market through various distribution channels, generally have similar economic characteristics.
The Company has assembled a broad range of products by leveraging its manufacturing technologies, research and development capabilities, global sourcing expertise and strategic acquisitions. Over the years, the Company has made a number of strategic acquisitions intended to offer a broader range of products to better serve its markets. The Company’s extensive product line permits the Company to offer tailored solutions to a wide range of end-markets including food processing, general manufacturing, fulfillment, transportation, building and construction, consumer, oil and gas, agriculture, aerospace, appliance, sports and entertainment, marine, composites military and medical applications.
Overview of Periods
2016
On January 28, 2016 and September 2, 2016, the Company entered into amendments to its 2014 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement. The January 28, 2016 amendment included certain language clarifying when a change in control has occurred for purposes of the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. The September 2, 2016 amendment included certain changes to the covenants and other sections to permit the acquisition of Powerband, as well as some or all of the Powerband Investment Projects, along with certain customary provisions regarding recent European Union legislation.
On February 16, 2016, the Company announced it would invest $44 to $49 million in the Midland WAT Project, with a goal of increasing its manufacturing capacity of water-activated tapes by the end of 2017. The first production line at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility was operational in the third quarter of 2017 and is operating at capacity. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for this project since inception totalled $48.6 million of which $4.3 million was spent in 2015, $13.7 million in 2016, $29.6 million in 2017 and $1.0 million in 2018. As a result of the success of this project and the Company's expectation of further demand growth in water-activated tapes, in the third quarter of 2017, the Company began the Midland Expansion Project for an additional expected investment of $14 to $16 million. In February 2019, the Company successfully commissioned its second water-activated tape line at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility. The second production line is operating as planned in terms of timeline and is in line with expected capital expenditures. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for this project since inception totalled $13.4 million of which $5.4 million was spent in 2017 and $8.0 million in 2018. Additional capital expenditures of approximately $1 to $2 million are expected in 2019.

On May 9, 2016, the Board of Directors approved an amendment to the Performance Share Unit Plan ("PSU Plan") to provide the Company the option of settling PSUs in cash. In the event of cash settlement, the cash payment will equal the number of shares that would otherwise have been issued or delivered to the participant, multiplied by the volume weighted average trading price ("VWAP") of the shares on the TSX for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding the day of payment. The Board had full discretion to determine the form of settlement of the performance share units ("PSUs") and as of December 31, 2016, no such discretion had been used. As a result, the Company had no present obligation to settle the PSUs in cash and the amendment to the PSU Plan had no impact on the treatment of the PSUs as equity-settled share-based payment transactions as of December 31, 2016.

Additionally, on May 9, 2016, the Board of Directors approved an amendment to the PSU Plan that allowed for accelerated vesting of PSUs in the event of death, disability or retirement. This amendment required the immediate recognition of expense associated with awards outstanding for certain retirement-eligible participants, the impact of which was $0.4 million for the twelve months ended December 31, 2016 and was included in earnings in selling, general and administrative expenses ("SG&A").

The Company entered into an NCIB to repurchase for cancellation up to 2,000,000 common shares effective on July 10, 2014. The NCIB was subsequently renewed on July 10, 2015 and amended on November 11, 2015 to increase the total shares available for repurchase to 4,000,000 common shares. This NCIB, which was scheduled to expire on July 9, 2016, was renewed for a twelve-month period starting July 14, 2016 and set to expire on July 13, 2017. On September 23, 2016, the Company announced that in connection with its NCIB, the Company entered into an automatic share purchase plan pursuant to which the securities dealer acting as the Company’s agent for the NCIB may acquire, at its discretion, shares on the Company’s behalf during the “black-out” or “closed” periods under the Company’s stock trading policy, subject to certain parameters as to price and number of shares.


22


On August 10, 2016, the Board of Directors amended the Company’s dividend policy by increasing the annualized dividend by 7.7% from $0.52 to $0.56 per share. The Board’s decision to increase the dividend was based on the Company’s strong financial position and positive outlook.

On September 16, 2016, IPG Mauritius Ltd., a newly formed subsidiary of the Company, under a Share Purchase Agreement, dated September 2, 2016, purchased a 74% ownership stake in Powerband, a global supplier of acrylic adhesive-based carton sealing tapes and stretch films located in Daman, India, with the remaining 26% continuing to be held by the Desai family which founded the company in 1994. The Company paid an aggregate purchase price of $41.9 million, net of cash acquired. In 2016, the Company approved a plan to expand the production capacity within the Daman, India manufacturing facility and to expand capacity by investing in the construction of a greenfield carton sealing tape manufacturing facility in Dahej, India. Capital expenditures for the greenfield manufacturing facility are estimated to total approximately $18 to $20 million. The project is proceeding on time and on budget where to date facility construction has been completed and equipment installation and product trials have begun. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for these projects since inception totalled $15.7 million of which $1.5 million was spent in 2016, $7.3 million in 2017, and $6.9 million in 2018.

In October 2015, the Columbia, South Carolina facility was damaged as a result of the South Carolina Flood. The damages sustained were considerable and resulted in the facility being permanently shut down and its duct tape, masking tape, and stencil production lines relocated to Blythewood, South Carolina earlier than planned. On October 19, 2016, the Company and its insurers reached a settlement for the related property and business interruption claims in the amount of $30.0 million, subject to a $0.5 million deductible, covering substantially all of the claimed losses. As of December 31, 2016, the Company received a total of $29.5 million in insurance claim settlement proceeds of which $5.0 million was recorded in manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges in 2015 and $12.6 million and $9.8 million were recorded in cost of sales and manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges, respectively, in 2016. The remaining $2.1 million was recognized as a reduction of cost of sales in the first quarter of 2017.
As part of its plan to realize operational synergies from the TaraTape acquisition completed in November 2015, the Company closed its Fairless Hills, Pennsylvania manufacturing facility and ceased its manufacturing operations as of December 31, 2016. In order to accommodate the related production volume, the Company leveraged production capacity in its Carbondale, Illinois and Danville, Virginia manufacturing facilities and will continue to do so. As a result of the Fairless Hills facility closure, the Company increased its expectation of total annual synergies from this transaction to be between $4 and $6 million of additional adjusted EBITDA (1) by the end of 2017 from the previous estimate of between $2 and $4 million. In the fourth quarter of 2017, the Company achieved a run rate of $4.0 million in annual synergies associated with the closure and integration of TaraTape. In 2016, the Company recorded a charge to earnings of $6.0 million, which included $4.0 million in non-cash charges related to impairment of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets and inventory and $1.9 million in cash charges related to termination benefits, facility restoration costs and other commitments. In 2017, the Company recorded a benefit of $0.3 million primarily related to a facility restoration provision reversal following the completion of restoration activities.
(1) 
Adjusted EBITDA is a non-GAAP financial measure defined and reconciled to net earnings, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, later in this document.
2017

On January 27, 2017, June 9, 2017 and June 14, 2017, the Company entered into amendments to its 2014 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement. The January 27, 2017 amendment included certain changes to the covenants and other sections to permit the Powerband Investment Projects. The June 9, 2017 amendment increased the borrowing limit of the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility from $300 million to $450 million. The amended credit agreement continued to include an incremental accordion feature of $150 million, enabling the Company to further increase the credit limit if needed, subject to its existing terms and lender approval. The June 14, 2017 amendment included certain changes to the covenants and other sections to permit the Capstone Partnership.

On February 17, 2017, the Board of Directors approved amendments to the PSU Plan and Deferred Share Unit Plan ("DSU Plan") to provide for only cash settlement of PSU and deferred share unit ("DSU") awards, respectively. As a result of the amendment, the Company remeasured the fair value of the awards on the amendment date and continues to do so prospectively at each reporting period end date and at settlement. There was no incremental fair value granted as a result of these modifications. The corresponding liability is recorded on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet under the caption share-based compensation liabilities, current for amounts expected to settle in the next twelve months and share-based compensation liabilities, non-current for amounts expected to settle in more than twelve months. Changes in the fair value of the liability will be reflected in SG&A.

23


On June 23, 2017, as one of the initial steps in the establishment of the Capstone Partnership, the Company purchased substantially all of the issued and outstanding shares of Capstone for cash consideration of $5.1 million. On August 8, 2017, the Company purchased additional shares of Capstone for cash consideration of $5.1 million. As of December 31, 2017, the Company and the non-controlling shareholders held 98.4% and 1.6% of the issued and outstanding shares of Capstone, respectively.

On May 11, 2018, the Company acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed certain liabilities of Airtrax. As part of the agreement, the minority shareholders of Capstone contributed in kind certain assets and liabilities valued at $13.4 million and formerly attributed to Airtrax’s woven product manufacturing operations in exchange for newly-issued shares of Capstone. On August 10, 2018, the Company acquired additional existing and newly-issued shares of Capstone in exchange for $3.6 million in cash as part of the same overall transaction. As a result of this purchase, the Company now has a controlling 55% ownership stake in Capstone with the minority shareholders of Capstone owning 45%. This last step concluded the set-up of the intended ownership structure of the Capstone Partnership.
The primary purpose of the Capstone Partnership is to finance the construction of the Capstone Greenfield Project in order to produce woven products primarily for the Company's global distribution. The Capstone Greenfield Project is expected to cost approximately $28 to $32 million in total. The Capstone Greenfield Project began in 2017 and to date facility construction has been completed and equipment installation and product trials have begun. The Capstone Partnership's after-tax internal rates of return are expected to exceed the Company's hurdle rate of 15%. As of December 31, 2018, capital expenditures for this project since inception totalled $25.3 million of which $8.4 million was incurred in 2017 and $16.9 million in 2018. Commercial operations are expected to commence in the first half of 2019 as planned.

On July 1, 2017, the Company completed the Cantech Acquisition for an aggregate purchase price of $67.0 million, net of cash acquired. The purchase price was financed with funds available under the Company's 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. The Cantech Acquisition enhanced the Company's product offering and adds additional distribution channels for the Company's products in Canada, the US and Europe. In the third quarter of 2018, the Company announced that it would close the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility to further expand on operational synergies gained from the Cantech Acquisition. The Company estimates these changes will generate additional annual cost savings of between $1.5 and $2.0 million by reducing its manufacturing overhead footprint while simultaneously improving machine utilization in its existing plants. As a result, total annual synergies gained from the Cantech Acquisition are expected to be between $3.5 and $6.0 million by the end of 2019. During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company recorded closure charges of $7.2 million mainly related to non-cash impairments of property, plant and equipment and inventory as well as termination benefits and other labor related costs. The Company expects to incur total estimated cash costs of approximately $1.4 million over the course of 2019 and 2020 due to closure and post-closure activities. As of December 31, 2018, the Johnson City manufacturing facility, which primarily produces carton sealing tape, had transferred substantially all of its production to other existing manufacturing facilities.
As part of the Powerband Share Purchase Agreement, the Company entered into various option agreements with the non-controlling shareholders for the transfer of Powerband shares under certain limited circumstances. On July 4, 2017, the Company and the non-controlling shareholders of Powerband executed a binding term sheet that confirmed that the Company’s call option on all of the shares owned by the non-controlling shareholders had been triggered and substantially reaffirmed the exit terms of the Share Purchase Agreement executed between the parties on September 2, 2016. Execution of the term sheet resulted in the recognition of $12.7 million in present obligations recorded in call option redemption liability, and a corresponding reduction of equity as of December 31, 2017. On November 16, 2018, the Company closed on the exercised call option to acquire the outstanding 26% interest in Powerband for $9.9 million. The Company now owns all of the issued and outstanding common shares of Powerband.
On July 17, 2017, TSX approved the renewal of the Company's NCIB, under which the Company is entitled to repurchase for cancellation up to 4,000,000 common shares over the twelve-month period ending July 16, 2018. On September 1, 2017, the Company announced that, in connection with this renewed NCIB, it entered into an automatic share purchase plan with a Canadian securities dealer pursuant to which the securities dealer, acting as the Company's agent, could acquire at its discretion shares on the Company's behalf during a black-out or closed period under the Company's stock trading policy, subject to certain parameters as to price and number of shares. The Company subsequently terminated the automatic share purchase plan effective December 26, 2017.
In November 2017, the Company adopted an updated Code of Business Conduct and Ethics.


24


In 2017, the Company entered into interest swap agreements. The terms of the interest swap agreements are as follows:
Effective Date
 
Maturity
 
Notional amount
 
Settlement
 
Fixed interest
rate paid
June 8, 2017
 
June 20, 2022
 
$
40,000

 
Monthly
 
1.79
%
July 21, 2017
 
July 18, 2022
 
CDN$36,000

(1) 
Monthly
 
1.6825
%
August 20, 2018
 
August 18, 2023
 
$
60,000

 
Monthly
 
2.045
%
     
(1) 
The notional amount decreased by CDN$54.0 million during 2018 and will further decrease by CDN$18.0 million on July 18, 2021 and 2022.  

2018

In February 2018, one of the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiaries entered into a partially forgivable loan for up to €8.2 million ($10.2 million). The loan was entered into with Agencia para Investmento Comercio Externo de Portugal, EPE, the Portuguese agency for investment and external trade, as part of financing a capital expansion project. Based on the terms of the agreement, 60% of the loan will be forgiven in 2022 based on satisfying certain 2021 targets, including financial metrics and headcount additions. The partially forgivable loan is non-interest bearing and semi-annual installments of principal are due beginning in December 2020 through June 2026.

On February 6, 2018, Capstone entered into a Indian Rupee ("INR") 975.0 million ($15.0 million) credit facility ("2018 Capstone Credit Facility"). The 2018 Capstone Credit Facility consists of an INR 585.0 million ($9.0 million) term loan facility for financing capital expenditures and INR 390.0 million ($6.0 million) working capital facility and bears interest based on the prevailing Indian Marginal Cost-Lending Rate. Borrowings under the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility mature in June 2023, are guaranteed by the Parent Company, and are otherwise unsecured.

On March 7, 2018, the Board of Directors approved the addition of restricted share units ("RSUs") as an available cash-settled award type under the Amended and Restated Performance and Restricted Share Unit Plan ("PSU and RSU Plan"). Grants of RSUs to employees of the Company are on a discretionary basis and subject to the Board of Directors’ approval. The purpose of an RSU is to provide award holders with a proprietary interest in the Company to: (a) increase the incentives of those award holders who share primary responsibility for the management, growth and protection of the business of the Company; (b) furnish an incentive to such award holders to continue their services for the Company; and (c) provide a means through which the Company may attract potential employees.

On May 11, 2018, the Company acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed certain liabilities of Airtrax as part of a larger transaction involving Capstone and its minority shareholders. Airtrax manufactures and sells woven products used in various applications, including in the building and construction industry. Under the new arrangement, the Company now controls a fully-operative woven manufacturing facility in Chopanki, India and is continuing to partner with the minority shareholders of Capstone to serve the transferred Airtrax customers, while realizing savings from a low-cost manufacturing facility that is expected to support future revenue growth in woven products. As part of the agreement, the minority shareholders of Capstone contributed in kind certain assets and liabilities valued at $13.4 million and formerly attributed to Airtrax’s woven product manufacturing operations in exchange for newly-issued shares of Capstone. On August 10, 2018, the Company acquired additional existing and newly-issued shares of Capstone in exchange for $3.6 million in cash as part of the same overall transaction. As a result of this purchase, the Company now has a controlling 55% ownership stake in Capstone with the minority shareholders of Capstone owning 45%. This now concludes the set-up of the intended ownership structure of the Capstone Partnership.

On June 7, 2018, the Board of Directors appointed Mr. James Pantelidis as the new Chairman of the Board following the retirement of the former Chairman, Mr. George J. Bunze.

On June 14, 2018, the Company entered into a five-year, $600.0 million credit facility (“2018 Credit Facility”) with a syndicated lending group, refinancing and replacing the Company's previous $450.0 million credit facility that was due to mature in November 2019. The 2018 Credit Facility consists of a $400.0 million revolving credit facility and a $200.0 million term loan. The term loan amortizes $65.0 million until March 2023 ($5.0 million in 2018, $10.0 million in 2019, $12.5 million in 2020, $15.0 million in 2021, $17.5 million in 2022, and $5.0 million in 2023), and the remaining balance of the 2018 Credit Facility is due upon maturity in June 2023. The 2018 Credit Facility also includes an incremental accordion feature of $200.0 million, which enables the Company to increase the limit of this facility (subject to the credit agreement's terms and lender approval) if needed. The 2018 Credit Facility matures on June 14, 2023 and bears an interest rate based, at the Company’s option, on the London Inter-bank Offered Rate, the Federal Funds Rate, or Bank of America’s prime rate, plus a spread varying between 25 and 250 basis

25


points depending on the debt instrument's benchmark interest rate and the consolidated secured net leverage ratio. In securing the 2018 Credit Facility, the Company incurred debt issue costs amounting to $2.7 million.
    
On July 4, 2018, Powerband entered into an INR 1,300.0 million ($19.0 million) credit facility (“2018 Powerband Credit Facility”), replacing Powerband's previous outstanding term loan and revolving line of credit. In December 2018, Powerband amended the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility to reallocate and increase its credit limit by INR 100 million ($1.4 million). The 2018 Powerband Credit Facility is guaranteed by the Parent Company, and local assets (carrying amount of $30.2 million as of December 31, 2018) are required to be pledged. Powerband is prohibited from granting liens on its assets without the consent of the lender under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility. Funding under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility is not committed and could be withdrawn by the lender with 10 days' notice. Additionally, under the terms of the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility, Powerband's debt to net worth ratio (as defined by the credit agreement) must be maintained below 3.00.

On July 18, 2018, TSX approved the renewal of the Company's NCIB, under which the Company is entitled to repurchase for cancellation up to 4,000,000 common shares over the twelve-month period ending July 22, 2019. The purchases by the Company will be effected through the TSX or other alternative trading systems in Canada, and will be executed at the market price of the shares at the time of the purchase. As of March 12, 2019, the Company has repurchased 217,100 common shares under its NCIB for a total purchase price of approximately $2.6 million.

On August 3, 2018, the Company acquired 100% of the outstanding equity value in Polyair for an aggregate purchase price of $145.0 million, net of cash acquired. The purchase price was funded using funds available under the Company's 2018 Credit Facility. Polyair, formerly a private company, is in the protective packaging business with seven manufacturing facilities and a distribution center in North America. Polyair's products include bubble cushioning, foam, mailers and inflatable systems. The acquisition is expected to further strengthen the Company's product bundle and bring immediate and additional scale of protective packaging solutions.

On September 12, 2018, the Company made an $11.3 million discretionary contribution to its US defined benefit pension plans. These plans are now wholly funded on an accounting basis and as a result, the Company expects to reduce future contribution requirements and certain plan administration expenses.

On October 15, 2018, the Company completed the private placement of $250.0 million 7% senior unsecured notes due in 2026 (the "Senior Unsecured Notes"). The Senior Unsecured Notes resulted in net proceeds to the Company, after deducting $5.1 million in debt issue costs, of approximately $244.9 million. The Company used the net proceeds from the Senior Unsecured Notes to repay a portion of the borrowings outstanding under the 2018 Credit Facility and to pay related fees and expenses, as well as for general corporate purposes. The Company believes the Senior Unsecured Notes provides optimal flexibility to allocate capital to the business at a historically attractive fixed interest rate.

On November 16, 2018, the Company closed on its previously exercised call option to acquire the outstanding 26% interest in Powerband for $9.9 million. The Company held the option under a shareholders agreement with the minority shareholders of Powerband. The Company now owns all of the issued and outstanding common shares of Powerband.

On December 17, 2018, the Company acquired substantially all of the operating assets of Maiweave LLC (“Maiweave”) for total cash consideration of $20.8 million ("Maiweave Acquisition"). Maiweave is a private company based in Springfield, Ohio and an integrated US manufacturer of engineered coated polyolefin fabrics. Its products are used in applications such as grain and salt pile covers, pit and pond liners, shelter fabrics, outdoor media, and lumber mill packaging. The former owners of Maiweave have in escrow $3.1 million as of December 31, 2018, related to customary representations, warranties and covenants in the Maiweave purchase agreement. The Maiweave purchase agreement also contains customary indemnification provisions. As of December 31, 2018, there were no outstanding obligations or indemnifications relating to this acquisition.
(1)
    Products, Markets and Distribution

The Company's holistic combination of products positions it to serve the market with a broad and comprehensive range of packaging, protective and industrial product solutions. The Company believes that its broad and unique product bundle is a key competitive advantage. The portfolio of products is valuable to the Company’s customers as it contributes to the flexibility of our distributor partners by allowing them to offer a solutions-oriented approach to address specific end user needs, creates operating efficiencies and lowers operating costs. Management believes this flexibility is unique to the Company and differentiates the Company from competitors.


26


The Company's broad assortment of stocked products are available from distribution centers located in California and Virginia. These distribution centers are a key component of the Company's enhanced supply chain management strategy. Each distribution center offers a wide range of products which allows customers to benefit from access to the Company’s core products. As a result, the Company is able to efficiently supply a broad range of products following a customer order, which provides the intended flexibility to distributor partners while lowering their transaction costs.
(a) Tapes
The Company manufactures a variety of paper and film based tapes, including pressure-sensitive and water-activated carton sealing tapes, and industrial and performance specialty tapes including double-coated, duct, electrical and electronic, filament, flatback, foil, paper, polyethylene, process indicator, sheathing, sports and stencil products. The company also provides complementary packaging systems which dispense and/or apply the companies pressure-sensitive and water-activated tape products.
Management believes the Company is the only packaging company that manufactures carton sealing tapes using all four adhesive technologies: hot melt, acrylic, natural rubber and water-activated. As a vertically integrated manufacturer, the Company believes it has distinctive capabilities, relative to its competitors, to produce its own film and adhesives used in the manufacture of its finished tape.
The Company’s tape products are manufactured and primarily sold under the Company’s Intertape™, Central®, American®, Anchor®, Cantech® and Tuck® brands to industrial distributors and retailers and are manufactured for sale to third parties under private brands.
For the years ending December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, tapes accounted for 64%, 68%, and 67%, respectively, of the Company’s revenue.
The Company’s tape products consist of three main product groups, Carton Sealing Tapes, Industrial & Specialty Tapes and Complementary Packaging Systems.
Carton Sealing Tapes
Carton sealing tapes are sold primarily under the Intertapeand Central® brands to industrial distributors and leading retailers, as well as to third parties under private brands. Management believes the Company is the only company that produces carton sealing tapes using all four adhesive technologies: hot melt, acrylic, natural rubber and water- activated. The Company also sells the application equipment required for the dispensing of its carton sealing tapes.
Hot Melt Tape
Hot melt carton sealing tape is a polypropylene film coated with a synthetic rubber adhesive which is suitable for a wide range of applications. Typical applications include manual and automatic box sealing for industries such as moving and storage, general shipping and mailing, fulfillment, food processing, pharmaceutical and general manufacturing, as well as package repair and bundling. Some varieties can be used in cooler temperature applications (down to 35 degrees Fahrenheit) or to seal high recycled content boxes.
The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co., Shurtape Technologies LLC and Vibac Group.
Acrylic Tape
Acrylic carton sealing tape is a polypropylene film coated with a pressure-sensitive acrylic adhesive. The Company's product range can accommodate a variety of performance applications. This product is best suited for applications where resistance to aging, weathering and discoloration as well as ultraviolet light exposure tolerance, are important. Typical applications include manual and automatic box sealing for industries such as long-term storage, consumer and retail, food processing, produce, floral, and pharmaceutical.  This product can be used in cooler temperature box sealing applications (down to 32 degrees Fahrenheit).
The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co., GTA, Primetac (Pitamas), Vibac Group and other imported Asian products.

27


Natural Rubber Tape
Natural rubber carton sealing tape is a polypropylene film coated with natural rubber adhesive and is unique among the carton sealing tapes because of its robust adhesion properties. This tape is ideally suited for conditions involving hot, dusty, humid or cold environments. Typical uses include moving and storage industry applications, as well as packaging and shipping. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Vibac Group and imported products from Europe.
Water-Activated Tape
Water-activated carton sealing tape is typically manufactured using a filament reinforced kraft paper substrate and a starch based adhesive that is activated by water. Water-activated tape is used primarily in applications where a strong mechanical bond or tamper evidence is required. Typical end-use markets include retail fulfillment centers, third-party logistics providers (“3PLs”), furniture manufacturers and the apparel industry. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Holland Manufacturing Co. Inc. and other imported products.
Industrial & Specialty Tapes
The Company produces the following industrial and specialty products sold primarily under the Intertape™, American®, Anchor®, Cantech® and Tuck® brands: double-coated, duct, electrical and electronic, filament, flatback, foil, polyethylene, paper, process indicator, sheathing, sports and stencil products.
Double-Coated Tape
Double-coated tape is manufactured from a paper, foam, or film substrate and is coated on both sides with a variety of adhesive systems. Double-coated tape also uses a release liner made from paper or film that prevents the tape from sticking to itself. Double-coated tape is typically used to join two dissimilar surfaces. The Company’s double-coated tape products are used across a range of markets that include aerospace, graphics, transportation, converting and nameplates. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co., Tesa Tape, Inc., Scapa Group plc. and imported Asian products.
Duct Tape
Duct tape is manufactured from a polyethylene film that has been reinforced with scrim and coated with natural/synthetic rubber blend adhesive or specialty polymer adhesives. Duct tape is primarily used by general consumers for a wide range of applications. Duct tapes are also used in maintenance, repair and operations, in the HVAC (heating, ventilation and air conditioning) markets, construction and in the convention and entertainment industries. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Berry Plastics Corp., 3M Co., Shurtape Technologies, LLC. and imported Asian products.
Electrical and Electronic Tape
Electrical and electronic tape is manufactured from a number of different substrates, including paper, polyester, glass cloth and a variety of adhesive systems that include rubber, acrylic and silicone adhesives. Electrical and electronic tapes are engineered to meet stringent application specifications and many electrical and electronic tapes are Underwriters Laboratories (UL) component listed. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co., Nitto Denko, Saint Gobain and Bondtec.
Filament Tape
Filament tape is a film or paper-backed adhesive tape with fiberglass, polyester fibers embedded in the adhesive to provide high tensile strength. Primary applications for filament tape include temporary holding, bundling and unitizing (strapping), subsea umbilical cables (oil and gas), metal coil tabbing, and agricultural applications. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co. and Shurtape Technologies, LLC.
Flatback Tape
Flatback tape is manufactured using a smooth kraft paper substrate and is typically coated with a natural rubber/SIS blended adhesive. Flatback tape is designed with low elongation and is widely used in applications such as splicing where the tape should not be distorted. Typical applications for flatback tape include splicing, printable identification tapes, label products and carton closure. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co. and Shurtape Technologies, LLC.

28


Foil Tape
Foil tape is manufactured using an aluminum substrate and a variety of adhesive systems. The tape is designed for applications that range from HVAC, building and construction, aerospace, transportation, industrial, and general purpose. The products are UV resistant, have reflective and flame-retardant properties, and remain flexible to resist cracking and lifting around irregular or curved surfaces. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co., Berry Plastics and Avery Dennison Corp.
Paper Tape
Paper tape is manufactured from a crepe paper substrate coated with a natural rubber or a synthetic rubber adhesive. Paper tape is used for a variety of performance and general purpose end-use applications. Product applications include paint masking (consumer, contractor, automotive, aerospace and marine), splicing, bundling/packaging, and general light duty applications. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co., Shurtape Technologies, LLC, and Tesa Tape, Inc.
Polyethylene Tape
Polyethylene tapes are manufactured from a polyethylene film that is coated with a synthetic rubber adhesive, Polyethylene tapes are used primarily in the building & construction industry for a variety of applications including patching, sealing, bundling & wrapping, splicing & surface protection, floor marking, tarp repair and carpet seaming. The Company's primary competitors for these products are Berry Plastics Corp. and Scapa.
Process Indicator Tape
Indicator tape is primarily a paper-backed adhesive tape manufactured with a variety of adhesive systems. These products are designed to seal packs exposed to different sterilization processes (steam, ethylene-oxide, and plasma). The tape distinguishes between items processed and unprocessed by color change indicator lines printed on the backing. The Company's primary competitors for these products are 3M Co., Johnson & Johnson, and a number of smaller manufacturers from various geographies.
Sheathing Tape
Sheathing tape is manufactured from a treated polypropylene film substrate coated with an acrylic adhesive. Sheathing tape is primarily sold into the building and construction industry for applications involving the sealing of joints and seams of housewrap and insulation materials that form the building envelope. The Company's primary competitors for these products are 3M Co., and Berry Plastics.
Sports Tape
Sports tapes are manufactured from a cloth substrate and an adhesive coating. A variety of adhesive systems are used in the production of sports tapes. These tapes are used in the sports industry, both professional and amateur, as trainer’s tape and for various equipment protection applications. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Scapa and North American Tapes.
Stencil Products
Stencil products are manufactured from a calendared natural/synthetic rubber blended substrate with an acrylic adhesive and specially formulated adhesives. Stencil products are used in applications within the sign and monument manufacturing markets to protect a surface where high pressure blasting is required. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are 3M Co. and UBlast Stencil.
Complementary Packaging Systems
Machinery
The Company provides complementary packaging systems under the Better Packages® and Interpack™ brands. Machinery that makes up the Company’s Complementary Packaging Systems include, but are not limited to, mechanical systems for case sealing applications with the use of long roll carton sealing tape, as well as water-activated tape produced by the Company

29


and a variety of tape dispensers. These machines are used in production lines at the packaging level. They are also widely used in the fulfillment industries. These systems add value by providing efficient packaging processes to a variety of industrial customers. The company’s primary competitors in this market are 3M Co., Loveshaw, BestPack, Marsh and Phoenix.
(b)
Films
The Company manufactures shrink film and stretch wrap as well as a variety of polyethylene and specialized polyolefin films for industrial and retail use. As a vertically integrated manufacturer, the Company uses internally manufactured films to produce tape products. The Company’s film products are marketed under the Company’s brands including SuperFlex®, StretchFlex®, stretch wrap; ExlfilmPlus®, and Exlfilm® shrink film. The Company's film products are marketed to industrial distributors and retailers, and are manufactured for sale to third parties under private brands.
For the years ending December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, films accounted for 18%, 18%, 19%, respectively, of the Company’s revenue.
The Company primarily produces two film product lines: (1) SuperFlex® and StretchFlex® stretch wrap; and (2) ExlfilmPlus® and Exlfilm® shrink film.
Stretch Wrap
Stretch wrap is a single or multi-layer plastic film that can be stretched without application of heat and which has the characteristic of trying to return to its original length thereby applying force on the wrapped load. It is used industrially to wrap pallets of various products ensuring a solid load for shipping. The Company uses technology that it believes is state-of-the-art for the manufacturing of its stretch film products.
SuperFlex® is a high performance, light gauge stretch film which offers customers good security for their loads but at a low cost per load. Genesys®, Genesys®Ultra, ProLite® and Orbit Air™ B are SuperFlex® brand products. Amtopp, Berry Plastics Corp., Malpack (Canada), and Paragon Films produce competitive products.
StretchFlex® is the Company’s regular duty, typically a heavier gauge of stretch film which also provides the customer with secure loads at a low price per pound. SFI, SSC, SFIII, Hand Wrap II and Hand Wrap IV are StretchFlex® brand products. Competitors for this product include Berry Plastics Corp., Sigma Plastics Group and Amtopp.
Shrink Film
Shrink film is a specialty plastic film which shrinks under controlled heat to conform to a package’s shape. The process permits the over-wrapping of a vast array of products of varying sizes and dimensions with a single packaging line. ExlfilmPlus® and Exlfilm® are used to package paper products, food, toys, games, sporting goods, hardware and housewares and a variety of other products. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Sealed Air Corp., Clysar LLC and Syfan SAAD.
(c) Protective Packaging
The Company manufactures and markets a full line of protective packaging solutions: air pillows, bubble cushioning, mailers, paper void fill and cushioning, protective foam roll stock, protective packaging systems and thermal solutions. The Company’s protective packaging products are marketed under the Company’s brand and Polyair™.
For the years ending December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, protective packaging accounted for 5%, less than 1%, less than 1%, respectively, of the Company’s revenue.
Air Pillows
Air pillows are manufactured from polyethylene film and are inflated at the point of use with an inflatable system. Air pillows are used as packaging material for void fill and cushioning applications. The Company's product line also includes bubble-on-demand solutions, which are manufactured from polyethylene film and inflated into a cushioning product at point of use with the same inflatable systems as air pillows. Typical end-use markets for air pillows and bubble-on-demand include ecommerce fulfillment, third-party logistics providers ("3PLs"), retail fulfillment houses and contract packaging operations. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Pregis Corp., Sealed Air Corp., and Storopack, Inc.

30


Bubble Cushioning
Bubble cushioning, which is manufactured from polyethylene film and encapsulated air is one of the most commonly used forms of protective packaging for void fill and cushioning applications. Bubble cushioning is also used for wrapping and surface protection. Typical end-use markets for bubble cushioning include manufacturing, ecommerce fulfillment, third-party logistics providers ("3PLs"), retail fulfillment houses and contract packaging operations. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Sealed Air Corp and Pregis Corp.
Mailers
The Company's mailer product line includes paper bubble mailers, plastic bubble mailers and polyethylene courier mailers. Bubble mailers are manufactured from polyethylene bubble cushioning which is laminated to paper or polyethylene film. Mailers are durable and lightweight, can be custom printed, and available in standard sizes. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are PAC Worldwide and Sealed Air Corp.
Paper Void Fill & Cushioning
Paper void fill and cushioning consists of kraft paper which is automatically crumpled at the point of use with a paper system machine. Typical end-use markets for paper void fill and cushioning include manufacturing, ecommerce fulfillment, 3PLs, retail fulfillment houses and contract packaging operations. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Pregis Corp., Ranpak, Sealed Air Corp., and Storopack, Inc.
Protective Foam
Protective foam is a low-density polyethylene product that protects and cushions. Protective foam products provide an excellent surface protection and cushioning for everything from sporting goods to auto parts. This also includes specialized value-added products where films are laminated laminations which uses both foam and bubble in the manufacturing process. The Company’s primary competitors for this product are Pregis Corp and Sealed Air Corp.
Protective Packaging Systems
The Company's Protective Packaging Systems consist of Inflatable Systems and Paper Systems. Inflatable Systems are high performance machinery that deliver protective packaging materials such as air pillows and bubble-on-demand solutions at customer facilities. These systems are installed on-site for customers and offers users adjustable air-fill control, multiple pillow size selection and bubble on demand configurations. The Company's primary competitors for protective packaging systems include Pregis Corp, RanPak, Sealed Air Corp., and Storopack, Inc.
Thermal Solutions
The Company's thermal solutions product offering consists of metalized film laminated to bubble cushioning. These thermal solutions are available as metalized roll stock and as preformed metalized mailers. The Company also markets a range of thermal insulated packaging in the form of insulated mailers and packaging inserts. These products are typically used in cold chain shipments to help maintain consistent temperatures. The Company’s primary competitors for these product are Kodiak Kooler, PAC Worldwide, Pregis Corp, Sealed Air Corp. and TermperPack.
(d) Engineered Coated Products
The Company develops and manufactures innovative industrial packaging, protective covering, barrier and liner products utilizing engineered coated polyolefin fabrics, nonwovens and other laminated materials. Its products are sold through multiple channels in a wide number of industries including membrane structures, building and construction, oil and gas, lumber, and agriculture.
The Company’s engineered coated fabrics are categorized in four markets: building and construction, agro-environmental, specialty fabrics, and industrial packaging. For the years ending December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, engineered coated fabric products accounted for 12%, 13% and 13%, of the Company’s revenue, respectively.

31


Building and Construction Products
The Company’s building and construction product group includes protective wrap for kiln dried lumber, membrane barrier products such as house wrap, window and door flashing, membrane structure fabrics used in clear span buildings, synthetic roof underlayment, and insulation facing, which are used directly in residential and commercial construction. The Company also supplies packaging over-wrap sleeves for unitizing multiple bags of fiberglass insulation. The Company’s primary competitors for these products include Owens Corning, Berry Global, Dupont, and various producers from India, China and Korea.
Lumber wrap
The Company’s lumber wrap is used to package, unitize, protect and brand lumber during transportation and storage. The product is available in polyethylene or polypropylene coated fabrics and polyethylene films printed to customer specifications. The Company’s primary competitor is Owens Corning.
Membrane Structure Fabrics
NovaShield® is a lightweight, wide-width, and durable polyolefin fabric used as the outer skin layer for flexible membrane structures. The introduction and continuous improvement of the NovaShield® fabric in the membrane structure market has enabled membrane structure manufacturers to expand the use of this product beyond agricultural applications. New applications include agriculture barns, amphitheaters, recreational facilities, trade show pavilions, aircraft hangers, and casinos. Developments in the product line include NovaShield® Elite, a film laminated product with an industry leading 20-year warranty and a suite of products produced for the greenhouse market. The Company sells the Nova-Shield® fabrics to membrane structure manufacturers who design, fabricate, and install the structures. The Company’s primary competitors are Berry Global and a number of PVC (polyvinyl chloride) producers.
Roof Underlayment
The Company’s synthetic roof underlayments are installed on the roof before slate, tile or shingles for an extra layer of protection against water damage. The Company’s roofing underlayments are lighter and easier to install than standard #15 and #30 asphalt felts. To meet market needs, the Company has implemented a three-tiered (“Good, Better, Best”) approach in an attempt to reach all market segments. The Company’s primary competitors in this market are Owens Corning, GAF, a variety of roofing felt producers and a number of competitors from India, China and Korea.
Housewrap
The Company's housewrap products consist of polypropylene or polyethylene fabric coated with an advanced breathable coating. These breathable products protect the building during construction and allow vapor and condensation to escape from wall cavities. The Company's primary competitors of these products are Dupont and Berry Global.
Flashing
The Company's flashing products are comprised of polypropylene (PP) woven fabric with a highly aggressive pressure-sensitive adhesive and an easily removable split release liner. These products are designed to create a weather resistant barrier around door and window openings. The Company’s primary competitors are 3M and Dupont.
Agro-Environmental Products
The Company has developed a range of Agro-Environmental products, including bags for packaging glass-fiber insulation, fabrics designed for conversion into hay covers, grain pile covers, landfill covers, oil field membranes, and canal and pond liners. These fabrics are intended to provide protection during transit and storage and to line waterways and ponds to prevent loss of water and other liquids.
Geomembrane Fabrics
The Company’s AquaMaster® line of geomembrane fabrics is used as irrigation canal liners, golf course and aquascape pond liners, oil pad liners, hydraulic fracturing ponds and in aquaculture operations. The Company has a broad product offering in this market that includes the traditional extrusion coated woven substrates as well as manufacturing composite products composed of woven substrates laminated to other materials such as non-woven textiles and polyethylene film. . The Company’s primary

32


competitors for similar products include Berry Global, and Owens Corning. Competitive products which may be used as substitutes are manufactured by GSE Environmental, Solmax and Raven Industries Inc.
Hay Wrap
Hay cover products are specially designed fabrics that function as protective covers, haystack covers, pit and pond liners and pool covers. The proprietary coating is used to enhance abrasion resistance, flex resistance, seam strength, UV resistance and longevity. The Company’s primary competitors for this product include offshore imports, as well as Owens Corning and Berry Global.
Poultry Fabrics
Woven coated polyolefin fabrics are used in the construction of poultry houses in the southern US. Materials with high ultraviolet resistance are fabricated into side curtains that regulate ventilation and temperature in buildings. Other materials are used in ceiling construction. The Company’s primary competitor for this product is Berry Global.
Tarpaulins
The Company's tarpaulin products consist of woven coated polyolefin fabrics used in building construction and remediation projects for protection against the elements, and as protective covers in agriculture applications. The Company’s primary competitor for this product line is Berry Global.
Specialty Fabrics
Banner (Billboard and Poster Fabric)
The Company’s line of banner fabrics is comprised of polyethylene substrates engineered for large-format printing applications such as billboards, posters and banners.  Strong and light-weight making it the most environmentally responsible billboard fabric on the market.  The Company’s primary competitors in this market are Berry Global and manufacturers from China and Korea.
Other Specialty Fabric
Products and applications of specialty fabrics include fabrics designed for conversion into pool covers, field covers, disaster relief materials, protective covers and construction sheeting, brattice cloth for mine ventilation, underground marking tapes, salt pile covers and industrial packaging. Primary competitors of the Company for these products include Berry Global and producers from China and Korea.
Industrial Packaging Products
The Company has a range of industrial packaging products used as protective covers that are used before and after the manufacturing process.  These products are available in a variety of weights, widths and colors. Customers also have an option to develop brand awareness by having their logo printed on these products.
Metal Wrap
The Company’s woven and coated polyolefin metal wraps are designed to protect flat sheet and coiled metals during transit and storage.  Primary competitors of the Company for these products include Owens Corning and several producers from China.
Other Industrial Packaging Products
The Company’s printed wrap is used to brand and protect a variety of products during transit and storage. For example, the Company’s product is used to cover small recreational vehicles (ATVs) during transportation from their manufacturing location to retail dealers. Primary competitors of the Company for this product include Owens Corning and Berry Global.

33


(e) Other
FIBC / Bulk Bags
The Company also earns revenue from the distribution of Flexible Intermediate Bulk Containers ("FIBCs"). The Company’s broad range of FIBC Bags, also known as Bulk Bags or Bulk Sacks, are used for the storage and transportation of dry, granular or powder products.  Made of high-strength woven polypropylene or polyethylene, FIBC’s are used by a broad range of industries including foods, construction, agriculture, oil & gas, mining and chemicals.  Primary competitors of the Company for these products include Berry Global and producers from China.
For the years ending December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016, other products accounted for 1% of the Company’s revenue.
Research and Development and New Products
The Company’s research and development efforts continue to focus on new products, technology platform developments, new production processes and formulations. As described in the sections that follow, the Company introduced 46 new products in 2018, 38 new products in 2017, and 35 new products in 2016.
In 2016, the Company:
expanded its product offering of water-activated tape products that are designed for highly automated fulfillment operations as well as water-activated tape products designed for printability,
expanded its masking tape offering to include FineLine® masking tapes, which are low profile masking tapes using a washi tape backing,
expanded its product offering to include a range of masking tapes designed for multiple surfaces as well as technically demanding applications,
introduced a direct printable hot melt carton sealing tape, which is a key product for the fulfillment industry and
bolstered its protective packaging offering with product additions in air pillows and tandem bagging product lines.
In 2017, the Company:
focused its R&D efforts on increasing market solutions for the fulfillment and e-commerce markets. As a result, the Company increased the variety of water activated tape products for these markets,
launched a variety of utility and mid-grade acrylic carton sealing tapes to accommodate the needs of the industrial market,
expanded its engineered coated products offering to include greenhouse fabrics in translucent, clear anti-fogging and black-out variations, and
developed a number of new film laminated products to broaden the total available market opportunity for geomembrane fabric sales.
In 2018, the Company:
expanded its offering of process indicator tapes and double coated tapes,
introduced new products to bolster its stencil product offering,
further expanded its engineered coated products greenhouse fabric offering to include heavier gauge products,
introduced a complete line of paper void fill and cushioning protective packaging products, and
further expanded its thermal products protective packaging offering with the additional insulated packaging solutions to include insulated mailers and insulated package inserts.


34


(2) Customer and Sales

The Company has strong and longstanding relationships with its customer base. The Company actively engages in sales and marketing activities to increase its value to its customers through ease-of-use initiatives and customer training. The Company's customers also value its commitment to offering competitively priced solutions, as demonstrated by the greater than 15-year average relationship tenure with the top ten customers.

Sales of products to customers located in the US, Canada and Germany accounted for approximately 79%, 9% and 2% of total sales, respectively, in 2018, 80%, 9% and 2% of total sales, respectively, in 2017, 83%, 7% and 2% of total sales, respectively, in 2016.

The Company’s customer base is diverse; however, there was one customer as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 with annual sales that accounted for more than 5% of the Company’s total revenue.

(3)
Seasonality of the Company’s Main Business

The Company experiences some business seasonality that results in the Company’s efforts to effectively manage its working capital resources. Typically, a larger investment in working capital is required in quarters during which accounts receivable increase due to a higher level of sales invoiced towards the end of the quarter and inventory builds in anticipation of higher future sales, both of which typically occur in the first, second and third quarters and unwind in the fourth quarter. Furthermore, certain liabilities are accrued for throughout the year and are paid only during the first quarter of the following year.

Normal seasonality for tapes and films typically reflects a sequential improvement in sales volumes in the second half of the year. These sequential increases are usually driven by the same seasonal demand in anticipation of higher shipping volumes in line with that time of the year. This normal increase in sales volume in the third and fourth quarters is typically followed by a decline in sales in the first quarter.

Normal seasonality for protective packaging typically reflects a sequential improvement in sales volume in the fourth and first quarters of the year when sales are up for retail and fulfillment centers. This normal increase in sales volume in the fourth and first quarters is typically followed by a decline in sales in the sale second quarter.

Normal seasonality for engineered coated products typically reflects a sequential improvement in sales volumes in the second and third quarters of the year when construction activity tends to be higher. This normal increase in sales volume in the second and third quarters is typically followed by a decline in sales in the fourth quarter.
(4) Equipment and Raw Materials

The Company purchases mostly custom designed manufacturing equipment, including extruders, coaters, slitters, finishing equipment, looms, printers, bag manufacturing machines and injection molds, from manufacturers located in the US, Western Europe and Asia, and participates in the design and upgrading of such equipment. The Company is not dependent on any one manufacturer for its equipment.
The major raw materials purchased for the Company’s tape products are polypropylene resin, polyethylene resin, synthetic rubber, hydrocarbon resin, and paper (crepe and kraft). The resins and synthetic rubber are generated from petrochemicals which are by-products of crude oil and natural gas. A significant majority of these products are sourced from North American manufacturers, although due to volatility in prices the Company occasionally sources raw materials from outside of North America. Raw materials accounted for approximately 64%, 65% and 65% of reported cost of sales in 2018, 2017 and 2016.
The major raw material used in the Company’s film products is polyethylene resin. Polyethylene is a derivative of natural gas petrochemical by-products and/or crude oil.
The major raw materials used to produce the Company’s engineered coated products are polyethylene and polypropylene resins. Both of these products are petrochemical based products derived from crude oil and/or natural gas. These products are predominantly sourced from North American petrochemical manufacturers.
The major raw materials used in the production of the Company’s protective packaging products are polyethylene resin, paper and polyethylene film.  The majority of these products are sourced from North American producers. 

35


The prices of most of the major raw materials noted above can be subject to significant volatility, primarily influenced by commodity price fluctuations for crude oil and natural gas, and pulp. In addition, while the Company maintains a number of suppliers for these raw materials, the Company is dependent on such suppliers to maintain the availability of the Company’s raw materials. If any of its suppliers are unable to deliver raw materials to the Company for an extended period of time, there is no assurance that the Company’s raw material requirements would be met by other suppliers on acceptable terms, or at all, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations.
(5) Marketing Channels
The Company’s extensive product line permits the Company to offer tailored solutions to a wide range of end-markets including food processing, general manufacturing, fulfillment, transportation, building and construction, consumer, oil and gas, agriculture, aerospace, appliance, sports and entertainment, marine, composites military and medical applications.
Tape and film products are sold to the market through a network of paper, packaging and industrial distributors throughout North America.
The Company also sells complementary packaging systems and protective packaging solutions through this same network of distribution. The Company’s shrink and stretch film products are typically sold through industrial distributors. The Company's assortment of specialty tapes are primarily sold through specialty distribution. Additionally, the Company sells products through the retail channel in North America. The Company’s engineered coated products are primarily sold directly to converters and original equipment manufacturers.
(6) Trademarks and Patents
The Company markets its tape products under the trademarks Intertape™, Central®, American®, TUCK®Tape, CANTECH® and various private labels. The Company’s shrink wrap is sold under the registered trademark ExlfilmPlus® and Exlfilm®. Its stretch films are sold under the trademark SuperFlex® and StretchFlex®.
The Company markets its open mouth bags under the registered trademark NovaPac®. Other key engineered coated products, including polyolefin fabrics are sold under the registered trademarks NovaThene®, NovaShield®, NovaSeal®, NovaWrap™, and NovaFlash®.

The Company has approximately 228 active registered trademarks, 111 in the US, 76 in Canada, 11 in Mexico, and 30 in foreign jurisdictions, which include trademarks acquired from American Tape, Anchor, Rexford Paper Company, Central Products Company, The Crowell Corporation, Flexia, Better Packages, TaraTape & Design®, TARA TAPE®, and Polyair. The Company currently has 8 pending trademark applications, 3 in the US, and 5 in foreign jurisdictions.
The Company has pursued US and foreign patents in select areas where it believes that unique products offer a competitive advantage in profitable markets. The Company’s 105 granted patents and 40 pending patent applications include engineered coated products and film for which the Company has 19 patents and 2 pending applications, tape products for which it has 50 patents and 32 pending applications, adhesive products and manufacture for which it has 13 patents and 1 pending application, other products for which it has 23 patents and 5 pending applications.
The Company considers its intellectual property to be a valuable asset that is material to its short-term and long-term prospects. As summarized in the Risk Factor titled "The Company may become involved in litigation relating to its intellectual property rights, which could have an adverse impact on its business," the Company uses various methods to protect its intellectual property. Such methods may not, however, provide complete or sufficient protection, and misappropriation may still occur.
(7) Competition
The Company competes with other manufacturers of plastic packaging and pressure-sensitive adhesive products as well as manufacturers of alternative packaging products, such as paper, cardboard and paper-plastic combinations. Some of these competitors are larger companies with greater financial resources than the Company. Management believes that competition, while primarily based on price and quality, is also based on other factors, including product performance characteristics and service.

The Company believes that one of its most important differentiating factors is the strength of its product bundle. The Company believes that the diversity of its product bundle, with its many tapes, stretch and shrink films and protective packaging solutions is a key competitive advantage. The Company believes that its product bundle provides a distinctive offering to our

36


customers, enabling them to achieve advantages such as improved service levels, reductions in operating costs, pricing synergies and support for their customers. Further, this allows the Company to become even more significant to its customers, especially in the e-commerce segment, as its product bundle provides a greater breadth of protective solutions, allowing it to offer a solutions-oriented approach to selling that it believes is sought after by many end-users and distributors. The Company believes that this product bundling strategy provides it with both an offensive and defensive mechanism that will foster profitable long-term relationships with our customers.
The Company believes that significant barriers to entry exist in its addressable market. Management considers the principal barriers to be the high cost of vertical integration which it believes is necessary to operate competitively, the technical expertise in respect to various processes and equipment operation, the scale necessary to negotiate adequate terms with suppliers and distributors, and the difficulties and expense of developing a broad portfolio of products within an adequate distribution network.
Please refer to Item 4.B.1 above for a discussion of the Company’s main competitors by product.
(8) Environmental Initiatives and Regulation
(a)
Initiatives
The Company has and continues to be focused on reducing waste and minimizing any environmental impact throughout its manufacturing process, or footprint left behind by the line of products manufactured and marketed by the Company. The stewardship program is a commitment by management and employees of the Company to continually look for opportunities to lower the Company’s environmental impact to include minimizing energy intensity and greenhouse gas emissions. The Company has implemented and continues to implement activities, changes and programs that are designed to reduce waste in the manufacturing process; reduce the footprint left behind by its products, processes and employees; increase the recycling of its products; provide alternative solutions to less environmentally friendly products or applications; reduce consumption of raw materials, fuel and other energy sources; reduce pollutants released through air, water and waste; and improve the safety and health of employees.
The Company continues to focus on its environmental initiative to save energy. In August 2009, the Company became an ENERGY STAR® Industrial Partner, which is a voluntary partnership with the US Environmental Protection Agency (“EPA”) to improve energy efficiency and fight global warming. The Company as an ENERGY STAR® Industrial Partner joined the fight against global warming by improving the efficiency of its buildings and facilities. The EPA recognized the Company as a 2014 and 2015 ENERGY STAR Partner of the Year for strategically managing and improving the energy efficiency in its operating locations. In 2016, 2017, and 2018 the EPA presented the Company the ENERGY STAR Sustained Excellence Award, which is the highest level of EPA recognition. In addition, certain Company facilities have achieved the EPA’s ENERGY STAR Challenge for Industry eleven times, which is to reduce energy intensity by 10% within 5 years. Facilities that have met the EPA’s ENERGY STAR Challenge for Industry have achieved an average energy intensity reduction of 22%. The reductions have cut greenhouse gas emissions at these manufacturing facilities by 48,027 metric tons over the past 5 years, which equals the emissions from the electricity use of 5,186 homes.
The transition of manufacturing operations from the Columbia, South Carolina facility to the Blythewood, South Carolina facility has further enhanced the Company’s environmental stewardship. The Blythewood manufacturing facility uses non-solvent technologies that do not utilize volatile organic compounds in the manufacturing process and do not generate hazardous waste. Additionally, the transition of manufacturing operations to the Blythewood manufacturing facility has resulted in increased manufacturing efficiencies, lower waste and lower greenhouse gas emissions.
(b)
Regulation
The Company’s operations are subject to extensive environmental regulation in each of the countries in which it maintains facilities. For example, US (federal, state and local), Canadian (federal, provincial and municipal) and Indian (federal, state and local) environmental laws applicable to the Company include statutes and regulations intended to: (i) impose certain obligations with respect to site contamination and to allocate the cost of investigating, monitoring and remedying soil and groundwater contamination among specifically identified parties; (ii) prevent future soil and groundwater contamination; (iii) impose national ambient standards and, in some cases, emission standards, for air pollutants which present a risk to public health, welfare or the natural environment; (iv) govern the handling, management, treatment, storage and disposal of hazardous wastes and substances; and (v) regulate the discharge of pollutants into waterways.
The Company’s use of hazardous substances in its manufacturing processes and the generation of hazardous wastes not only by the Company, but by prior occupants of its facilities, suggest that hazardous substances may be present at or near

37


certain of the Company’s facilities or may come to be located there in the future. Consequently, the Company is required to monitor closely its compliance under all the various environmental laws and regulations applicable to the Company. In addition, the Company arranges for the off-site disposal of hazardous substances generated in the ordinary course of its business.
The Company obtains Phase I or similar environmental site assessments, and Phase II environmental site assessments, if necessary, for most of the manufacturing facilities it owns or leases at the time the Company either acquires or leases such facilities. These assessments typically include general inspections and may involve soil sampling and/or ground water analysis. The assessments have not revealed any material or significant environmental liability other than, or in addition to, the $1.8 million liability as of December 31, 2018, accrued in provisions in the Company’s consolidated balance sheet, that, based on current information, the Company believes will have a material adverse effect on it. Nevertheless, these assessments may not reveal all potential environmental liabilities and current assessments are not available for all facilities. Consequently, there may be material environmental liabilities of which the Company is not aware. In addition, ongoing clean up and containment operations may not be adequate for purposes of future laws and regulations. The conditions of the Company’s properties could also be affected in the future by neighboring operations or the conditions of the land in the vicinity of the Company’s properties. These developments and others, such as increasingly stringent environmental laws and regulations, increasingly strict enforcement of environmental laws and regulations, or claims for damage to property or injury to persons resulting from the environmental, health or safety impact of the Company’s operations, may cause it to incur significant costs and liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on the Company.
The Company believes that all of its facilities are in material compliance with applicable environmental laws and regulations, and that the Company has obtained, and is in material compliance with, all material permits required under environmental laws and regulations.
The Blythewood, South Carolina manufacturing facility uses low environmental impact technologies, as compared to the Columbia, South Carolina manufacturing facility. The reduced environmental impacts from Blythewood manufacturing facility operations minimize applicability of environmental laws and permit requirements. Blythewood operations only require a minor EPA air emission permit and the facility is not classified as a large quantity generator of hazardous waste as opposed to the previous Columbia manufacturing facility. The transition of manufacturing operations from the Columbia manufacturing facility to the Blythewood manufacturing facility has significantly reduced carbon emissions and hazardous air pollutants that require EPA reporting and significantly reduced carbon emissions.
In addition, although certain of the Company’s facilities emit regulated pollutants into the air, the emissions are within current permitted limits, including applicable Maximum Achievable Control Technology requirements.
The Company and its operating subsidiaries are required to maintain numerous environmental permits and governmental approvals for their operations. Some of the environmental permits and governmental approvals that have been issued to the Company or its operating subsidiaries contain conditions and restrictions, including restrictions or limits on emissions and discharges of pollutants and contaminants, or may have limited terms. If the Company or any of its operating subsidiaries fails to satisfy these conditions or to comply with these restrictions, it may become subject to enforcement actions and the operation of the relevant facilities could be adversely affected. The Company may also be subject to fines, penalties or additional costs. The Company or its operating subsidiaries may not be able to renew, maintain or obtain all environmental permits and governmental approvals required for the continued operation or further development of its facilities, as a result of which the operation of its facilities may be limited or suspended.
 

38


 
C.
ORGANIZATIONAL STRUCTURE
Intertape Polymer Group Inc. is a holding company which owns various operating companies in the US, Canada and internationally. Intertape Polymer Inc., a Canadian corporation, is the principal operating company for the Company’s Canadian operations. Intertape Polymer Corp., a Delaware corporation, is the principal operating company for the Company’s US operations.

The table below lists for each of the subsidiaries of the Company, their respective place of incorporation or constitution, as the case may be, and the percentage of voting securities beneficially owned, or over which control or direction is exercised directly or indirectly by Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Entity
Place of Incorporation
or Constitution
Proportion of Ownership
Interest and Voting Power Held as of:
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Canada
Parent
 
Parent
Better Packages, Inc.
Delaware
100%
 
100%
BP Acquisition Corporation
Connecticut
100%
 
100%
Cantech Industries, Inc.
Delaware
100%
 
100%
Capstone Polyweave Private Limited
India
55%
 
98.4%
FIBOPE Portuguesa-Filmes Biorientados, S.A.
Portugal
100%
 
100%
GPCP, Inc.
Delaware
50.1%
 
—%
Intertape Polymer Corp.
Delaware
100%
 
100%
Intertape Polymer Europe GmbH
Germany
100%
 
100%
Intertape Polymer Inc.
Canada
100%
 
100%
Intertape Polymer Japan GK
Japan
100%
 
—%
Intertape Polymer Woven USA Inc.
Delaware
100%
 
—%
Intertape Woven Products Services, S.A. de C.V.
Mexico
100%
 
100%
Intertape Woven Products, S.A. de C.V.
Mexico
100%
 
100%
IPG (US) Holdings Inc.
Delaware
100%
 
100%
IPG (US) Inc.
Delaware
100%
 
100%
IPG Luxembourg Finance S.à.r.l.
Luxembourg
100%
 
100%
IPG Mauritius Holding Company Ltd
Mauritius
100%
 
100%
IPG Mauritius II Ltd
Mauritius
100%
 
100%
IPG Mauritius Ltd
Mauritius
100%
 
100%
Polyair Canada Limited
Canada
100%
 
—%
Polyair Corporation
Delaware
100%
 
—%
Powerband Industries Private Limited
India
100%
 
74%
Spuntech Fabrics Inc.*
Canada
100%
 
100%
*
Dormant

39


 
D.
PROPERTY, PLANTS AND EQUIPMENT
Location
Status
Use
Products Manufactured
Square Feet
Property
Size (Acres)
100 Paramount Drive, Suite 300
Sarasota, Florida 34232
Leased
Office
N/A
31,942
 
2000 South Beltline Boulevard
Columbia, South Carolina 29201
Owned
Idle
N/A
7 Buildings – 
499,770
86.48
1091 Carolina Pines Drive
Blythewood, South Carolina 29016
Owned
Manufacturing
Tapes (paper, duct, stencil)
350,000
33.83
360 Ringgold Industrial Parkway
Danville, Virginia 24540
Leased
Regional
Distribution
Center
N/A
199,600
 
10101 Nordel Court
Delta, British Columbia
V4G 1J8
Leased
Manufacturing
Engineered coated products
54,274
 
317 Kendall Street (2)
Marysville, Michigan 48040
Owned
Manufacturing
Tapes (paper, specialty)
5 Buildings –
 226,016
11.53
741 4th Street
Menasha, Wisconsin 54952
Owned
Manufacturing
Tapes (water-
activated)
165,134
5.68
748 4th Street
Menasha, Wisconsin 54952
Owned
Office Building
N/A
16,251
0.80
760 West 1000 North
Tremonton, Utah 84337
Owned
Manufacturing
Films (stretch, shrink)
115,000
17.00
13722 Bill McGee Road
Midland, North Carolina 28107
Owned
Manufacturing
Tapes (water-
activated)
144,000
40.54
50 Abbey Avenue
Truro, Nova Scotia
Owned
Manufacturing
Engineered coated products
306,200
13.00
543 Willow Street
Truro, Nova Scotia
Leased
Warehouse
N/A
27,000
 
2200 North McRoy Drive
Carbondale, Illinois 62901
Owned
Manufacturing
Tapes (carton sealing, electrical, filament, specialty)
190,324
29.9
4 Kay Street
Scoudouc, New Brunswick E4P 0C8
Leased
Warehouse
N/A
50,000
 
1095 S. 4th Avenue
Brighton, Colorado 80601
Leased
Manufacturing
BOPP Film, Carton Sealing Tape
Manufacturing  & Office – 155,982
Warehouse –
27,500
 
1101 Eagle Springs Road
Danville, Virginia 24540
Owned
Manufacturing
Carton sealing 
tapes, stretch film
289,195
26.0
4-6 Hershey Drive
Ansonia, Connecticut
Leased
Manufacturing
Machinery
46,400
 
1536 Cty Rd O
Neenah, Wisconsin 54957
Leased
Distribution
N/A
114,650
 
1407 The Boulevard, Suite E
Rayne, Louisiana 70578
Leased
Offices
N/A
1,472
 
9999 Cavendish Boulevard,
Suite 200
St. Laurent, Quebec H4M 2X5
Leased
Offices
N/A
12,121
 

40


Location
Status
Use
Products Manufactured
Square Feet
Property
Size (Acres)
Philipp-Reis-Straße 5
24941 Flensburg
Germany
Leased
Office
N/A
1,448
 
Lugar de Vilares-Barqueiros
4740-676 Barqueiros BCL
Barcelos, Portugal
Owned
Manufacturing
and Distribution
Shrink film
35,500
5.40
20 Rue de Peupliers
L-2328 Luxembourg
Grand Duchy of Luxembourg
Leased
Office
N/A
108
 
Powerband
354/3,4,5 Vapi-Kachigam Road
Daman, India 396210
Owned
Manufacturing
and Distribution
Carton sealing tapes
120,000
6.79
Powerband
Plot # Z/103/B
Dahej SEZ - II
Lakhigam
Taluka: Vagra Dist, Bharuch
Leased (2)
(currently under
construction)
Manufacturing
and Distribution
Carton sealing tapes (intention once operational)
110,000
Under construction
20.28
Plot # SP4-319(A),
Karoli, Rajasthan
India
Leased (3)
(currently under
construction)
Manufacturing
Engineered coated products (intention once operational)
220,000
15.00
C 3/5, Prashant Vihar, Sector 14, Rohini, New Delhi - 110085
Leased
Office
N/A
100
 
2222 Eddie William Road
Johnson City, TN 37601-2871
Owned (4)
Idle
N/A
123,502
15.39
1400 Rosemont Ave
Cornwall, ON K6J 3E6
Owned
Manufacturing and Distribution
Tapes (carton sealing, duct, filament, masking, sheathing, specialty, sports)
206,236
39.38
455 Cote-Vertu Blvd
Montreal, Quebec H4N 1EB
Leased
Manufacturing and Distribution
Tapes (masking, specialty)
61,895
 
SP-1038, RIICO Industrial Area , Chopanki, Bhiwadi-301019, Rajasthan, India
Leased (1)
Manufacturing
Engineered coated products
150,000
5.97
495 Meadow Ln, Carlstadt, NJ 07072
Leased
Manufacturing
Mailers, Bubble
75,000
 
330 Humberline Dr, Etobicoke, ON M9W 1R5, Canada
Leased
Office and Manufacturing
Mailers, Bubble, Reflective Packaging, Solar Blankets
134,126
 
300 Spencer-Mattingly Ln, Bardstown, KY 40004
Leased
Manufacturing
Foam, Machinery
102,318
 
6035 Lagrange Blvd SW, Atlanta, GA 30336
Leased
Manufacturing and Distribution
Mailers, Bubble, Foam
105,600
 
1692 Jenks Dr # 102, Corona, CA 92880
Leased
Manufacturing
Mailers, Bubble, Reflective Packaging, Solar Blankets
129,200
 
1600 Kelly Blvd # 140, Carrollton, TX 75006
Leased
Manufacturing
Bubble
75,000
 
808 E 113th St, Chicago, IL 60628
Leased
Manufacturing
Mailers, Bubble
145,182
 

41


Location
Status
Use
Products Manufactured
Square Feet
Property
Size (Acres)
1800 Enterprise Blvd, West Sacramento, CA 95691
Leased
Warehouse
N/A
32,549
 
1800 E Pleasant St, Springfield, OH 45505
Owned
Manufacturing and Distribution
Engineered Coated Products
208,217
4.78
3725 Faith Rd, Salisbury, NC 28146
Owned
Manufacturing and Distribution
Engineered Coated Products
41,465
3.21

(1) 
The land is leased under a long lease term and the manufacturing facility is owned by the Company.
(2) 
The land is leased under a long lease term and the manufacturing facility, once completed as part of the Powerband Greenfield Project, will be owned by the Company.
(3) 
The land is leased under a long lease term and the manufacturing facility, once completed as part of the Capstone Greenfield Project, will be owned by the Company.
(4) 
As of December 31, 2018, the Johnson City manufacturing facility, which primarily produces carton sealing tape, had transferred substantially all of its production to other existing manufacturing facilities.

We consider each of the properties in the table above to be adequate for its purpose and suitably utilized according to the individual nature and requirements of the relevant operations.

The Company also owns inventory that is temporarily located at facilities owned by various third-party logistics service providers. As these facilities are not owned or leased by the Company, they have been excluded from the summary table above.

The Company continued to move forward in 2018 on several of its initiatives to improve productivity, increase capacity, and manufacture new products. Capital expenditures during 2016, 2017, and 2018 totalled $50.0 million, $85.3 million, and $75.8 million respectively.

The Company typically relies upon cash flows from operations and funds available under the 2018 Credit Facility, Senior Unsecured Notes and other available borrowings to fund capital expenditures. In 2015 through 2018, capital expenditures were also financed in part by the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and 2018 Credit Facility, the terms of which are summarized in Item 4.B. above.

For further details on capital expenditures regarding construction, expansion or improvement of above listed facilities, see Item 4.A. above.

Item 4A:
Unresolved Staff Comments

Not Applicable.

Item 5:
Operating and Financial Review and Prospects (Management's Discussion & Analysis)
This Management’s Discussion and Analysis ("MD&A") is intended to provide the reader with a better understanding of the business, strategy and performance of Intertape Polymer Group Inc. (the "Company"), as well as how it manages certain risks and capital resources. This MD&A, which has been prepared as of March 12, 2019, should be read in conjunction with the Company’s audited consolidated financial statements and notes thereto as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 and for the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 ("Financial Statements"). It should also be read together with the text below on forward-looking statements in the Section entitled "Forward-Looking Statements."
For the purposes of preparing this MD&A, the Company considers the materiality of information. Information is considered material if the Company believes at the time of preparing this MD&A that: (i) such information results in, or would reasonably be expected to result in, a significant change in the market price or value of the common shares of the Company; (ii) there is a substantial likelihood that a reasonable investor would consider it important in making an investment decision; and/or (iii) it would

42


significantly alter the total mix of information available to investors. The Company evaluates materiality with reference to all relevant circumstances, including potential market sensitivity.
Except where otherwise indicated, all financial information presented in this MD&A, including tabular amounts, is prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board ("IFRS" or "GAAP") and is expressed in US dollars. Variance, ratio and percentage changes in this MD&A are based on unrounded numbers.
Financial Highlights
(In millions of US dollars, except per share amounts, selected ratios, and trading volume information)
(Unaudited)

 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
Operations
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue
 
1,053.0

 
898.1

 
808.8

Gross margin (1)
 
20.8
%
 
22.4
%
 
23.7
%
Net earnings attributable to Company shareholders (2)
 
46.8

 
64.2

 
51.1

Adjusted net earnings (3)
 
62.2

 
63.7

 
61.6

Adjusted EBITDA (3)
 
140.9

 
129.6

 
122.0

Cash flows from operating activities
 
90.8

 
92.1

 
108.1

Free cash flows (3)
 
15.0

 
6.8

 
58.2

Capital expenditures (4)
 
75.8

 
85.3

 
50.0

Effective tax rate (5)
 
17.4
%
 
16.9
%
 
27.7
%
Per Common Share
 
 
 
 
 
 
IPG Net Earnings - diluted
 
0.79

 
1.08

 
0.85

Adjusted earnings - diluted (3)
 
1.05

 
1.07

 
1.02

Dividend paid per share (6)
 
0.56

 
0.56

 
0.53

 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
Financial Position
 
 
 
 
 
 
Working capital (7)
 
186.5

 
135.3

 
130.6

Total assets
 
1,004.8

 
715.9

 
580.6

Net debt (8)
 
481.3

 
270.4

 
158.9

Total equity attributable to Company shareholders
 
249.8

 
248.1

 
236.5

Cash and loan availability (9)
 
393.9

 
186.6

 
158.2

Selected Ratios
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current Ratio (10)
 
2.06

 
1.94

 
2.17

Secured Leverage Ratio (3) (11)
 
1.62

 
2.09

 
1.30

Total Leverage Ratio (3) (12)
 
3.30

 
2.09

 
1.30

Return on equity (13)
 
25.0
%
 
26.3
%
 
27.2
%
Stock Information
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average shares outstanding - diluted (14)
 
59,084

 
59,588

 
60,369

Shares outstanding as of December 31 (14)
 
58,650

 
58,800

 
59,060

The Toronto Stock Exchange (CDN$)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Share price as of December 31
 
16.92

 
21.49

 
25.18

High: 52 weeks
 
22.84

 
25.41

 
25.74

Low: 52 weeks
 
14.60

 
17.49

 
15.46


(1)     Gross profit divided by revenue.
(2)     Net earnings attributable to Company shareholders ("IPG Net Earnings").

43


(3) 
These are non-GAAP financial measures defined below and accompanied by a reconciliation to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure. Refer to the section below entitled "Non-GAAP Financial Measures."
(4)    Purchases of property, plant and equipment.
(5)     Refer to the section below entitled "Income Taxes" and Note 5 – Income Taxes to the Company’s Financial Statements.
(6)     Dividends paid divided by weighted average basic shares outstanding.
(7)     Current assets less current liabilities.
(8)     Borrowings, current and non-current, less cash.
(9)     Refer to the section below entitled "Liquidity and Borrowings".
(10)     Current assets divided by current liabilities.
(11)  
Secured borrowings less cash, divided by adjusted EBITDA. Secured borrowings are borrowings, current and non-current, less Senior Unsecured Notes (defined later in this document). Adjusted EBITDA for the twelve months ending December 31, 2018 used in this calculation includes pre-acquisition results for Polyair (defined later in this document) conformed to the Company's current definition of Adjusted EBITDA, which is not normalized for Polyair's expected run-rate results.
(12)  
Net debt, divided by adjusted EBITDA. Adjusted EBITDA for the twelve months ending December 31, 2018 used in this calculation includes pre-acquisition results for Polyair conformed to the Company's current definition of Adjusted EBITDA, which is not normalized for Polyair's expected run-rate results.
(13)    Adjusted net earnings divided by average total equity attributable to Company shareholders.
(14)    In thousands.
2018 Share Prices
 
 
High
 
Low
 
Close
 
ADV (1)
The Toronto Stock Exchange (CDN$)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Q1
 
22.84

 
19.71

 
20.71

 
179,475

Q2
 
20.74

 
17.61

 
18.07

 
126,106

Q3
 
19.47

 
16.63

 
19.17

 
180,097

Q4
 
19.36

 
14.60

 
16.92

 
191,524

 
(1) 
Represents average daily volume sourced from the Toronto Stock Exchange.

44


Consolidated Quarterly Statements of Earnings
(In thousands of US dollars, except share and per share amounts)
(Unaudited)
 
 
 
1st Quarter
 
2nd Quarter
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Revenue
 
237,229

 
207,120

 
190,816

 
249,072

 
210,158

 
201,517

Cost of sales
 
186,777

 
157,980

 
149,720

 
194,625

 
162,783

 
149,715

Gross profit
 
50,452

 
49,140

 
41,096

 
54,447

 
47,375

 
51,802

Gross margin
 
21.3
%
 
23.7
%
 
21.5
%
 
21.9
%
 
22.5
%
 
25.7
%
Selling, general and administrative expenses
 
29,123

 
25,974

 
23,384

 
27,653

 
28,717

 
26,282

Research expenses
 
3,221

 
2,978

 
2,542

 
3,233

 
2,643

 
2,734

 
 
32,344

 
28,952

 
25,926

 
30,886

 
31,360

 
29,016

Operating profit before manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges (recoveries)
 
18,108

 
20,188

 
15,170

 
23,561

 
16,015

 
22,786

Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges (recoveries)
 
107

 
267

 
1,733

 
(407
)
 
410

 
2,090

Operating profit
 
18,001

 
19,921

 
13,437

 
23,968

 
15,605

 
20,696

Finance costs (income)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest
 
2,462

 
1,148

 
982

 
3,945

 
1,283

 
1,022

Other expense (income), net
 
1,125

 
428

 
(91
)
 
1,328

 
274

 
411

 
 
3,587

 
1,576

 
891

 
5,273

 
1,557

 
1,433

Earnings before income tax expense
 
14,414

 
18,345

 
12,546

 
18,695

 
14,048

 
19,263

Income tax expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current
 
988

 
2,693

 
2,076

 
765

 
2,753

 
3,197

Deferred
 
2,132

 
2,219

 
940

 
2,901

 
1,222

 
2,408

 
 
3,120

 
4,912

 
3,016

 
3,666

 
3,975

 
5,605

Net earnings
 
11,294

 
13,433

 
9,530

 
15,029

 
10,073

 
13,658

Net earnings (loss) attributable to:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Company shareholders
 
11,359

 
13,462

 
9,530

 
15,097

 
10,199

 
13,658

Non-controlling interest
 
(65
)
 
(29
)
 

 
(68
)
 
(126
)
 

 
 
11,294

 
13,433

 
9,530

 
15,029

 
10,073

 
13,658

IPG Net Earnings per share
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
0.19

 
0.23

 
0.16

 
0.26

 
0.17

 
0.23

Diluted
 
0.19

 
0.22

 
0.16

 
0.26

 
0.17

 
0.22

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
58,801,327

 
59,134,017

 
58,655,667

 
58,811,586

 
59,153,920

 
58,657,691

Diluted
 
59,146,693

 
60,202,147

 
60,035,667

 
59,103,899

 
59,557,443

 
60,834,393



45


Consolidated Quarterly Statements of Earnings
(In thousands of US dollars, except share and per share amounts)
(Unaudited)
 
 
 
3rd Quarter
 
4th Quarter
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Revenue
 
279,062

 
243,444

 
206,559

 
287,656

 
237,404

 
209,909

Cost of sales
 
221,719

 
192,575

 
161,705

 
231,015

 
183,381

 
156,174

Gross profit
 
57,343

 
50,869

 
44,854

 
56,641

 
54,023

 
53,735

Gross margin
 
20.5
%
 
20.9
%
 
21.7
%
 
19.7
%
 
22.8
%
 
25.6
%
Selling, general and administrative expenses
 
34,230

 
18,776

 
27,338

 
31,460

 
34,125

 
25,576

Research expenses
 
2,926

 
3,091

 
2,287

 
2,644

 
2,889

 
3,227

 
 
37,156

 
21,867

 
29,625

 
34,104

 
37,014

 
28,803

Operating profit before manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges (recoveries)
 
20,187

 
29,002

 
15,229

 
22,537

 
17,009

 
24,932

Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges (recoveries)
 
5,777

 
216

 
6,329

 
1,583

 
466

 
(7,744
)
Operating profit
 
14,410

 
28,786

 
8,900

 
20,954

 
16,543

 
32,676

Finance costs (income)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest
 
3,952

 
2,290

 
1,158

 
6,713

 
2,525

 
1,236

Other expense (income), net
 
(1,497
)
 
593

 
270

 
2,854

 
(4,693
)
 
15

 
 
2,455

 
2,883

 
1,428

 
9,567

 
(2,168
)
 
1,251

Earnings before income tax expense (benefit)
 
11,955

 
25,903

 
7,472

 
11,387

 
18,711

 
31,425

Income tax expense (benefit)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current
 
(496
)
 
2,253

 
30

 
(323
)
 
(1,064
)
 
3,454

Deferred
 
2,742

 
4,378

 
1,192

 
1,093

 
(1,405
)
 
6,272

 
 
2,246

 
6,631

 
1,222

 
770

 
(2,469
)
 
9,726

Net earnings
 
9,709

 
19,272

 
6,250

 
10,617

 
21,180

 
21,699

Net earnings (loss) attributable to:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Company shareholders
 
9,663

 
19,244

 
6,250

 
10,634

 
21,319

 
21,682

Non-controlling interests
 
46

 
28

 

 
(17
)
 
(139
)
 
17

 
 
9,709

 
19,272

 
6,250

 
10,617

 
21,180

 
21,699

IPG Net Earnings per share
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
0.16

 
0.33

 
0.11

 
0.18

 
0.36

 
0.37

Diluted
 
0.16

 
0.32

 
0.10

 
0.18

 
0.36

 
0.36

Weighted average number of common shares outstanding
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
58,817,410

 
59,171,255

 
58,696,647

 
58,831,432

 
58,831,518

 
58,899,366

Diluted
 
59,081,293

 
59,527,823

 
60,870,914

 
59,055,824

 
59,154,509

 
60,746,886

Overview
The Company develops, manufactures and sells a variety of paper-and-film based pressure sensitive and water-activated tapes, polyethylene and specialized polyolefin films, protective packaging, engineered coated products and complementary packaging systems for industrial and retail use. The Company provides packaging and protective solutions for industrial markets in North America, Europe and other geographies.

46


The Company’s products primarily consist of carton sealing tapes, including pressure-sensitive and water-activated tapes; packaging equipment; industrial and performance specialty tapes including masking, duct, electrical, foil, process indicator, sheathing, sports and reinforced filament tapes; protective packaging solutions including inflatable systems, mailer products, bubble cushioning, paper void fill, thermal solutions and protective foam roll stock; stencil products; shrink film; stretch wrap; lumber wrap, structure fabrics, geomembrane fabrics; and non-manufactured flexible intermediate bulk containers. Most of the Company’s products are made from similar processes. A vast majority of the Company’s products, while brought to market through various distribution channels, generally have similar economic characteristics.
The Company has assembled a broad range of products by leveraging its manufacturing technologies, research and development capabilities, global sourcing expertise and strategic acquisitions. Over the years, the Company has made a number of strategic acquisitions intended to offer a broader range of products to better serve its markets. The Company’s extensive product line permits the Company to offer tailored solutions to a wide range of end-markets including food processing, general manufacturing, fulfillment, transportation, building and construction, consumer, oil and gas, agriculture, aerospace, appliance, sports and entertainment, marine, composites military and medical applications.
The Company's holistic combination of products positions it to serve the market with a broad and comprehensive range of packaging, protective and industrial product solutions. The Company believes that its broad and unique product bundle is a key competitive advantage. The portfolio of products is valuable to the Company’s customers as it contributes to the flexibility of our distributor partners by allowing them to offer a solutions-oriented approach to address specific end user needs, creates operating efficiencies and lowers operating costs. Management believes this flexibility is unique to the Company and differentiates the Company from competitors.
The Company reported a 17.2% increase in revenue for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2017 and a 21.2% increase in revenue for the fourth quarter of 2018 as compared to the fourth quarter of 2017. The increase in revenue for the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to the year ended December 31, 2017 was primarily due to additional revenue from the Cantech (1), Polyair (2), and Airtrax (3) acquisitions and an increase in average selling price, including the impact of product mix. The increase in revenue for the fourth quarter of 2018 compared to the fourth quarter of 2017 was primarily due to additional revenue from the Polyair and Airtrax acquisitions, an increase in average selling price, including the impact of product mix, and an increase in sales volume.
Gross margin decreased to 20.8% in the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to 22.4% in 2017. Gross margin decreased primarily due to the dilutive gross margins of the Cantech and Polyair acquisitions, unfavourable product mix, and an increase in medical costs. These unfavourable items were partially offset by a decrease in certain plant-related operating costs.
Gross margin decreased to 19.7% in the fourth quarter of 2018 compared to 22.8% in the fourth quarter of 2017 primarily due to an unfavourable product mix and the dilutive gross margins of the Polyair and Airtrax acquisitions. These unfavourable items were partially offset by a decrease in certain plant-related operating costs.
Net earnings attributable to Company shareholders ("IPG Net Earnings") for the year ended December 31, 2018 decreased to $46.8 million ($0.79 basic and diluted IPG Net Earnings per share) from $64.2 million ($1.09 basic IPG Net Earnings per share and $1.08 diluted IPG Net Earnings per share) for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease was primarily due to (i) an increase in selling, general and administrative expenses ("SG&A") mainly due to additional SG&A from the Polyair, Cantech and Airtrax acquisitions, (ii) an increase in interest expense resulting from higher average debt outstanding and higher average cost of debt, including the impact of the Senior Unsecured Notes (defined and discussed later in this document), (iii) foreign exchange losses in 2018 and (iv) an increase in manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges mainly related to non-cash impairment charges from the closure of the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility. These unfavourable impacts were partially offset by an increase in gross profit.
IPG Net Earnings for the fourth quarter of 2018 totalled $10.6 million ($0.18 basic and diluted IPG Net Earnings per share) compared to $21.3 million ($0.36 basic and diluted IPG Net Earnings per share) for the fourth quarter of 2017. The decrease was primarily due to (i) foreign exchange losses in the fourth quarter of 2018, (ii) an increase in interest expense and (iii) an increase in income tax expense mainly from the non-recurrence of a favourable adjustment in the fourth quarter of 2017, partially offset by the lower US corporate tax rate effective in 2018 both related to new US tax reform legislation. These unfavourable impacts were partially offset by a decrease in SG&A mainly due to the decrease in the fair value of cash-settled share-based compensation, and an increase in gross profit.
Adjusted net earnings (4) decreased to $62.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 from $63.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease was primarily due to (i) an increase in interest expense, (ii) foreign exchange losses in 2018, and (iii) an increase in SG&A mainly due to an increase in employee-related costs to support growth initiatives and variable

47


compensation expense. These unfavourable impacts were partially offset by (i) a decrease in income tax expense mainly due to the lower US corporate tax rate provided under tax reform legislation, and (ii) an increase in gross profit.
Adjusted net earnings decreased to $14.2 million for the fourth quarter of 2018 from $17.9 million for the fourth quarter of 2017. The decrease was primarily due to foreign exchange losses in the fourth quarter of 2018 and an increase in interest expense, partially offset by a decrease in income tax expense.
Adjusted EBITDA (4) increased to $140.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 from $129.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The increase was primarily due to adjusted EBITDA contributed by the Polyair and Cantech acquisitions and organic growth in gross profit. These increases were partially offset by an increase in SG&A and the non-recurrence of insurance proceeds related to the South Carolina Flood ("Insurance Proceeds") (5) of $2.1 million recorded in 2017.
Adjusted EBITDA increased to $38.5 million for the fourth quarter of 2018 from $35.7 million for the fourth quarter of 2017. The increase was primarily due to adjusted EBITDA contributed by the Polyair Acquisition and a decrease in SG&A mainly due to a decrease in employee-related costs related to discretionary employee benefit contributions, partially offset by a decrease in gross profit.
(1) 
"Cantech" refers to the acquisition by the Company of substantially all of the assets and assumption of certain liabilities of Canadian Technical Tape Ltd. (doing business as "Cantech"), which includes the shares of Cantech Industries Inc., Cantech's US subsidiary, on July 1, 2017.
(2) 
"Polyair" refers to the acquisition by the Company of 100% of the outstanding equity in Polyair Inter Pack, Inc. ("Polyair") on August 3, 2018. Refer to the section below entitled "Polyair Acquisition" for more information regarding this transaction.  
(3) 
"Airtrax" refers to the acquisition by the Company of substantially all of the assets and assumption of certain liabilities of Airtrax Polymers Private Limited (doing business as "Airtrax") on May 11, 2018 as part of a larger transaction involving Capstone Polyweave Private Limited (doing business as “Capstone”) and its minority shareholders. Refer to the section below entitled "Airtrax Acquisition Through Capstone" for more information regarding this transaction.
(4) 
Non-GAAP financial measure. For definitions and reconciliations of non-GAAP financial measures to their most directly comparable GAAP financial measures, see “Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below.
(5) 
"South Carolina Flood" refers to significant rainfall and subsequent severe flooding on October 4, 2015 that resulted in considerable damage to and the permanent closure of the Columbia, South Carolina manufacturing facility eight to nine months in advance of its planned shutdown. "Insurance Proceeds" refers to insurance claim settlement proceeds totalling $29.5 million, net of a $0.5 million deductible, covering most of the claimed losses associated with the South Carolina Flood. The Company recorded proceeds as a benefit in manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges totalling $5.0 million, $0.5 million and $9.3 million in the fourth quarter of 2015, second and fourth quarters of 2016, respectively, and as a benefit in cost of sales totalling $4.5 million, $8.1 million, and $2.1 million in the second and fourth quarters of 2016 and the first quarter of 2017, respectively.

Other Highlights
Dividend Declaration
On March 12, 2019, the Board of Directors declared a dividend of $0.14 per common share payable on March 29, 2019 to shareholders of record at the close of business on March 22, 2019.

48


Midland, North Carolina Manufacturing Facility
In February 2019, the Company successfully commissioned its second water-activated tape line at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility. The second production line is operating as planned in terms of timeline and is in line with expected capital expenditures which totalled $8.0 million in 2018 ($13.4 million since inception). This expansion doubles the water-activated tape production capacity at the facility and supports growth in the e-commerce industry. The Company completed construction of the Midland manufacturing facility in 2017 and commissioned the first production line in the third quarter of 2017 for total invested capital of approximately $48 million. The first production line is operating at capacity so the second production line provides new capacity for anticipated growth.
Cantech Integration Synergies
In the third quarter of 2018, the Company announced that it would close the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility to further expand on operational synergies gained from the Cantech Acquisition. As of December 31, 2018, the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility, which primarily produces carton sealing tape, had transferred substantially all of its production to other existing manufacturing facilities. The Company estimates these changes will generate additional annual cost savings of between $1.5 and $2.0 million by reducing its manufacturing overhead footprint while simultaneously improving machine utilization in its existing plants. As a result, total annual synergies gained from the Cantech Acquisition are expected to be between $3.5 and $6.0 million by the end of 2019.
During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company recorded closure charges of $7.2 million mainly related to non-cash impairments of property, plant and equipment and inventory as well as termination benefits and other labor related costs incurred a result of the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility closure. Total estimated cash costs of approximately $1.4 million remain and are expected to be incurred over the course of 2019 and 2020 as it relates to the closure and post-closure activities.
New Credit Facility
On June 14, 2018, the Company entered into a new five-year $600.0 million credit facility ("2018 Credit Facility") pursuant to a credit agreement with a syndicated lending group, refinancing and replacing the Company's previous $450.0 million credit facility that was due to mature in November 2019 ("2014 Revolving Credit Facility"). The 2018 Credit Facility consists of a $400.0 million revolving credit facility (“2018 Revolving Credit Facility”) and a $200.0 million term loan (“2018 Term Loan”). The 2018 Term Loan amortizes $65.0 million until March 2023 ($5.0 million in 2018, $10.0 million in 2019, $12.5 million in 2020, $15.0 million in 2021, $17.5 million in 2022, and $5.0 million in 2023), and the remaining balance of the 2018 Credit Facility is due upon maturity in June 2023. The 2018 Credit Facility also includes an incremental accordion feature of $200.0 million, which enables the Company to increase the limit of this facility (subject to the credit agreement's terms and lender approval) if needed. The 2018 Credit Facility matures on June 14, 2023 and bears an interest rate based, at the Company’s option, on the London Inter-bank Offered Rate, the Federal Funds Rate, or Bank of America’s prime rate, plus a spread varying between 25 and 250 basis points depending on the debt instrument's benchmark interest rate and the consolidated secured net leverage ratio (250 basis points as of December 31, 2018). The 2018 Credit Facility provides a more favourable covenant structure and increased flexibility to the Company as compared to the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. The 2018 Credit Facility refinanced a majority portion of the Company's existing debt and is expected to finance capital expenditures, business acquisitions, dividends, working capital, share repurchases and other general corporate activities.
Senior Unsecured Notes
On October 15, 2018, the Company completed the private placement of $250 million aggregate principal amount of 7% senior unsecured notes due October 15, 2026 ("Senior Unsecured Notes"). The net proceeds to the Company, after deducting underwriting discounts and estimated expenses, was $244.9 million. The Company used the net proceeds to repay a portion of the borrowings outstanding under the 2018 Credit Facility and to pay related fees and expenses, as well as for general corporate purposes. The Company believes the Senior Unsecured Notes provide optimal flexibility to allocate capital to the business at a historically attractive fixed interest rate.
Maiweave Acquisition
On December 17, 2018, the Company acquired substantially all of the operating assets of Maiweave LLC (“Maiweave”) for total cash consideration of $20.8 million (the "Maiweave Acquisition"). The Company funded the acquisition with funds available under the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility.

49


Maiweave is based in Springfield, Ohio and is an integrated US manufacturer of engineered coated polyolefin fabrics that employs approximately 75 team-members at two manufacturing facilities strategically located to service key US markets. Its products are used in applications such as grain and salt pile covers, pit and pond liners, shelter fabrics, outdoor media, and lumber mill packaging.
This acquisition strengthens the Company's product bundle, provides additional scale to support growing demand in woven products, and adds capacity that is in close proximity to growing markets. The Company’s woven products represent approximately 14% of the Company’s expected pro forma revenue in 2018 after adjusting for the impact of this acquisition. Maiweave is also expected to provide the Company with the ability to leverage its new woven manufacturing facility in India. Refer to the section below entitled "Airtrax Acquisition Through Capstone" for more information regarding this facility.
The Company estimates Maiweave generated approximately $25 million of revenue and approximately $2.5 million of adjusted EBITDA in the twelve months ending December 31, 2018, based on historical performance. The Company expects the acquisition will be accretive to earnings in 2019 excluding advisory fees and other costs associated with mergers and acquisitions activity, including due diligence, integration and certain non-cash purchase price accounting adjustments ("M&A Costs"). The Company expects annualized run-rate synergies of approximately $1 million in adjusted EBITDA by the second half of 2020. Based on the acquisition price and the expected synergies, the post-transaction valuation multiple is expected to be approximately five times adjusted EBITDA.
The Maiweave Acquisition had no impact on the Company's consolidated earnings during the year ended December 31, 2018.
Polyair Acquisition
On August 3, 2018, pursuant to a purchase agreement dated July 17, 2018, the Company acquired 100% of the outstanding equity in Polyair for a total net cash consideration of $145.0 million. The Company funded the acquisition with funds available under the Company’s 2018 Credit Facility.
Polyair is in the protective packaging business with seven manufacturing facilities and a distribution center in North America. Polyair's primary products consist of bubble cushioning, foam, mailers and air pillow systems, which are complementary to the Company’s product offering. The acquisition will further strengthen the Company’s product bundle and bring immediate and additional scale in protective packaging solutions. With the diverse set of customers between the Company and Polyair, this enhanced product bundle should facilitate significant cross-selling opportunities as both companies currently sell products through similar distribution and end user customer channels. Specifically, both companies have been focused on the e-commerce segment as a growth engine, which is expected to be leveraged even further with this combination. In addition to these revenue synergies, the Company expects to benefit from certain operational cost synergies.
The Company estimates that, on a pro forma basis and after making normalization adjustments, Polyair generated approximately $132 million of revenue and approximately $13 million in adjusted EBITDA in the twelve months ended December 31, 2018, and that it will be accretive to the Company's earnings in 2019, excluding M&A Costs. Integration costs are expected to be approximately $3 to $4 million in total with the majority expected to be recognized during 2019 and 2020. The Company estimates Polyair will generate approximately $20 to $22 million annually in adjusted EBITDA by 2021, which includes both revenue and cost synergies and organic growth driven primarily by the e-commerce business channel. Based on the acquisition price and the expected synergies, the post-transaction valuation multiple is expected to be approximately seven times adjusted EBITDA.
The impact of the Polyair Acquisition on the Company's consolidated earnings, including the impact of purchase accounting, was as follows (in millions of US dollars):

 
 
Three months ended
 
August 3, 2018 through
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
$
 
$
Revenue
 
35.0

 
55.5

Net earnings (loss)
 
0.3

 
(0.7
)
Airtrax Acquisition Through Capstone
On May 11, 2018, the Company acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed certain liabilities of Airtrax as part of a larger transaction involving Capstone and its minority shareholders. As part of the agreement, the minority shareholders of Capstone contributed in kind certain assets and liabilities valued at $13.4 million and formerly attributed to Airtrax’s woven product

50


manufacturing operations in exchange for newly-issued shares of Capstone. On August 10, 2018, the Company acquired additional existing and newly-issued shares of Capstone in exchange for $3.6 million in cash as part of the same overall transaction. As a result of this purchase, the Company now has a controlling 55% ownership stake in Capstone with the minority shareholders of Capstone owning 45%. This now concludes the set-up of the intended ownership structure of the Capstone partnership.
Airtrax manufactures and sells woven products used in various applications, including in the building and construction industry. Under the new arrangement, the Company now controls a fully-operative woven manufacturing facility in Chopanki, India and is continuing to partner with the minority shareholders of Capstone in serving the transferred Airtrax customers while realizing savings from a low-cost manufacturing facility that is expected to support future revenue growth in woven products.
Alongside the acquired operations of Airtrax, the new greenfield manufacturing facility in Karoli, India ("Capstone Greenfield Project") is expected to bring even further capacity to Capstone in its ability to produce woven products primarily for the Company’s global distribution. The Capstone Greenfield Project is progressing on time and on budget, with commercial operations still expected to commence in the first half of 2019. The Company continues to expect an after-tax internal rate of return of at least 15% on this project.
The impact of the Airtrax Acquisition on the Company's consolidated earnings, including the impact of purchase accounting, was as follows (in millions of US dollars):

 
 
Three months ended
 
May 11, 2018 through
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
$
 
$
Revenue
 
2.0

 
4.7

Net earnings
 
0.1

 
0.1

Powerband Acquisition
On November 16, 2018, the Company closed on its previously exercised call option to acquire the outstanding 26% interest in Powerband Industries Private Limited (doing business as "Powerband") for $9.9 million. The Company held the option under a shareholders agreement with the minority shareholders of Powerband, in which the Company acquired a 74% stake on September 16, 2016. The Company now owns all of the issued and outstanding common shares of Powerband. The Company had already transitioned all management responsibilities to a Company-appointed senior management team, so this transaction has not had any impact on day-to-day operations. In addition, the Company has continued to progress, on time and on budget, towards the completion of the Powerband Investment Project (1) which is anticipated in the first half of 2019 with expected total project expenditures of between $18 to $20 million.

(1) 
“Powerband Investment Project” refers the construction of a greenfield carton-sealing tape manufacturing facility in India.
Outlook
 
The Company's expectations for fiscal year 2019 are as follows:

Revenue in 2019 is expected to be between $1,180 and $1,220 million, excluding the impact of any merger and acquisitions activity that takes place in 2019, and any significant fluctuations in selling prices caused by unforeseen variations in raw material prices.
Adjusted EBITDA for 2019 is expected to be between $164 and $174 million. As in previous years, the Company expects adjusted EBITDA to be proportionately higher in the second, third and fourth quarters of the year relative to the first quarter due to the effects of normal seasonality. This estimate includes the expected impact of new accounting guidance for leases whereby operating lease rent expense will be classified as amortization of the right-of-use asset and interest expense on the related lease obligation, both of which are items excluded from the non-GAAP measure adjusted EBITDA, estimated to be between $6 and $7 million for the year ended December 31, 2019. For the year ended December 31, 2018, rent expense included in adjusted EBITDA was $4.6 million related to operating leases that will be accounted for as right-of-use assets as of January 1, 2019.
Total capital expenditures for 2019 are expected to be between $45 and $55 million.
Excluding the potential impact of changes in the mix of earnings between jurisdictions, the Company expects a 25% to 30% effective tax rate for 2019 and cash taxes paid in 2019 to be two thirds of the income tax expense in 2019, as a result of the anticipated changes in the tax treatment of intercompany debt.

51


Results of Operations
Revenue
Revenue for the year ended December 31, 2018 totalled $1,053.0 million, a $154.9 million or 17.2% increase from $898.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to:
Additional revenue of $91.4 million from the Cantech, Polyair, and Airtrax acquisitions;
An increase in average selling price, including the impact of product mix, of approximately 5.3% or $47.6 million primarily due to:
price increases mainly to mitigate input cost increases in certain tape, film, and woven products; and
a favourable product mix variance in the Company’s tape and film product categories; and
An increase in sales volume of approximately 1.8% or $15.9 million primarily due to an increase in demand for certain woven, film, and tape products.
Revenue for the year ended December 31, 2017 totalled $898.1 million, an $89.3 million or 11.0% increase from $808.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2016, primarily due to:
Additional revenue of $49.9 million due to the Cantech and Powerband acquisitions; and
An increase in average selling price, including the impact of product mix, of approximately 4.6% or $37.1 million primarily due to a favourable product mix variance in the Company’s tape, woven, and film product categories.
Revenue for the fourth quarter of 2018 totalled $287.7 million, a $50.3 million or 21.2% increase from $237.4 million for the fourth quarter of 2017, primarily due to:
Additional revenue of $37.0 million primarily due to the Polyair and Airtrax acquisitions;
An increase in average selling price, including the impact of product mix, of approximately 2.9% or $6.9 million primarily due to:
price increases mainly to mitigate input cost increases in certain tape and woven products; and
a favourable product mix variance in the Company’s film and tape product categories; and
An increase in sales volume of approximately 2.7% or $6.4 million primarily due to an increase in demand for certain woven, film, and tape products.

Gross Profit and Gross Margin
Gross profit totalled $218.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, a $17.5 million or 8.7% increase from $201.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. Gross margin was 20.8% in 2018 and 22.4% in 2017.
Gross profit increased primarily due to additional gross profit from the Cantech, Polyair, and Airtrax acquisitions, an increase in sales volume, a decrease in plant-related operating costs, and an increase in spread between selling prices and combined raw material and freight costs. These favourable items were partially offset by an increase in medical costs and the non-recurrence of Insurance Proceeds of $2.1 million recorded in 2017.
Gross margin decreased primarily due to the dilutive gross margins of the Cantech and Polyair acquisitions, an unfavourable product mix, and an increase in medical costs. These unfavourable items were partially offset by a decrease in certain plant-related operating costs.
Gross profit totalled $201.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, a $9.9 million or 5.2% increase from $191.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. Gross margin was 22.4% in 2017 and 23.7% in 2016.
Gross profit increased primarily due to the favourable impact of the Company’s manufacturing cost reduction programs, additional gross profit from the Cantech and Powerband acquisitions, and a favourable product mix variance. These favourable items were partially offset by a reduction in Insurance Proceeds from $12.6 million recorded in 2016 to $2.1 million recorded in 2017, certain manufacturing production inefficiencies occurring mainly in older facilities and stronger manufacturing capacity utilization in 2016.
Gross margin decreased primarily due to a reduction in Insurance Proceeds, certain manufacturing production inefficiencies occurring in 2017 mainly in older facilities and stronger manufacturing capacity utilization in 2016. These unfavourable items were partially offset by the favourable impact of the Company’s manufacturing cost reduction programs.
Gross profit totalled $56.6 million for the fourth quarter of 2018, a $2.6 million or 4.8% increase from $54.0 million for the fourth quarter of 2017. Gross margin was 19.7% in the fourth quarter of 2018 and 22.8% in the fourth quarter of 2017.
Gross profit increased primarily due to additional gross profit from the Polyair and Airtrax acquisitions, an increase in sales volume, and an increase in spread between selling prices and combined raw material and freight costs. These favourable items were partially offset by an unfavourable product mix.

52


Gross margin decreased primarily due to an unfavourable product mix and the dilutive gross margins of the Polyair and Airtrax acquisitions. These unfavourable items were partially offset by a decrease in certain plant-related operating costs.
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses
SG&A totalled $122.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, a $14.9 million or 13.8% increase from $107.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The increase was primarily due to (i) additional SG&A from the Polyair, Cantech and Airtrax acquisitions, (ii) an increase in employee-related costs to support growth initiatives in the business and (iii) an increase in variable compensation, partially offset by a decrease in share-based compensation mainly driven by a decrease in the fair value of cash-settled awards.
SG&A totalled $107.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, a $5.0 million or 4.9% increase from $102.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase was primarily due to additional SG&A from the Cantech and Powerband acquisitions and an increase in M&A Costs, partially offset by a decrease in share-based compensation primarily driven by a decrease in the fair value of cash-settled awards.
As a percentage of revenue, SG&A expenses represented 11.6%, 12.0% and 12.7% for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
SG&A for the fourth quarter of 2018 totalled $31.5 million, a $2.7 million or 7.8% decrease from $34.1 million for the fourth quarter of 2017. The decrease was primarily due to a decrease in share-based compensation mainly driven by a decrease in the fair value of cash-settled awards and a decrease in employee-related costs mainly related to discretionary employee benefit contributions, partially offset by additional SG&A from the Polyair acquisition.
The following table presents M&A Costs included in SG&A:
 
 
Three months ended
 
Twelve months ended
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
 
M&A Costs included in SG&A
 
2.2

 
1.9

 
7.5

 
5.8

 
2.4

Manufacturing Facility Closures, Restructuring and Other
Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges totalled $7.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, a $5.7 million increase from $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The increase was primarily due to non-cash impairments of property, plant and equipment and inventory as well as termination benefits and other labor related costs mainly related to the closure of the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility in 2018 as compared to charges incurred in 2017 discussed below.
Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges totalled $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, a $1.0 million decrease from $2.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The decrease was primarily due to a reduction in charges associated with the Fairless Hills, Pennsylvania manufacturing facility and the South Carolina Flood. These decreases were partially offset by the non-recurrence of the benefit from Insurance Proceeds received in 2016 and other small scale restructuring initiatives in 2017 associated with acquisition integration efforts, as well as charges related to product trials to support post-South Carolina Flood stencil production and other post-closure activities of the Columbia, South Carolina manufacturing facility. As part of its plan to realize operational synergies from the RJM Manufacturing LLC (d/b/a "TaraTape") acquisition completed in November 2015, the Company closed its Fairless Hills, Pennsylvania manufacturing facility and ceased production as of December 31, 2016. In the fourth quarter of 2017, the Company achieved a run rate of $4.0 million in annual synergies associated with the closure and integration of TaraTape.
Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges totalled $1.6 million for the fourth quarter of 2018, a $1.1 million increase from $0.5 million fourth quarter of 2017. In the fourth quarter of 2018 charges were primarily due to non-cash impairments of property, plant and equipment related to the closure of the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility and in the fourth quarter of 2017 charges were mainly related to the South Carolina Flood and other small scale restructuring efforts.



53


Finance Costs (Income)
Finance costs for the year ended December 31, 2018 totalled $20.9 million, a $17.0 million increase from $3.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to (i) an increase in interest expense resulting from higher average debt outstanding and higher average cost of debt, (ii) foreign exchange losses in 2018, compared to foreign exchange gains in 2017 (iii) the non-recurrence of the gain resulting from the Powerband non-controlling interest put options valuation remeasurement in 2017 (refer to Note 22 in the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding the options), and (iv) debt issue costs written off in the second quarter of 2018 as a result of refinancing and replacing the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility.
Finance costs for the year ended December 31, 2017 totalled $3.8 million, a $1.2 million decrease from $5.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2016, primarily due to an increase in foreign exchange gains and the Powerband non-controlling interest put options valuation remeasurement (refer to Note 22 in the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding the options). These favourable impacts were partially offset by an increase in interest expense as a result of higher average debt outstanding and higher average cost of debt.
Finance costs for the fourth quarter of 2018 totalled $9.6 million, an $11.7 million increase from finance income of $2.2 million for the fourth quarter of 2017, primarily due to (i) foreign exchange losses in the fourth quarter of 2018, compared to foreign exchange gains in the fourth quarter of 2017, (ii) an increase in interest expense resulting from higher average debt outstanding and higher average cost of debt, and (iii) the non-recurrence of the gain resulting from the Powerband non-controlling interest put options valuation remeasurement in 2017 (refer to Note 22 in the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding the options).
Income Taxes
The Company is subject to income taxation in multiple tax jurisdictions around the world. Accordingly, the Company’s effective tax rate fluctuates depending on the geographic source of its earnings. The Company’s effective tax rate is also impacted by tax planning strategies that the Company implements from time to time. Income tax expense is recognized in each interim period based on the best estimate of the weighted average annual income tax rate expected for the full financial year.
On December 22, 2017, the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act ("TCJA") was enacted into law in the US. The TCJA significantly changes the previously existing US tax laws and includes numerous provisions that have had an immediate effect on the Company’s business, and will affect certain aspects of the Company's business going forward. These changes include, but are not limited to, a reduction in the statutory corporate tax rate from 35% to 21%, an enhancement and extension through 2026 of bonus depreciation, limitations and eliminations of certain deductions, a one-time transition tax on deemed repatriation of deferred foreign income, and new tax regimes impacting how foreign-derived earnings and cross-border intercompany transactions may be subject to US tax. The Company recognized a net tax benefit of approximately $9.6 million in the fourth quarter of 2017 primarily due to the remeasurement of the US net deferred tax liability using the lower US corporate tax rate provided under the TCJA.
On September 12, 2018, the Company made an $11.3 million discretionary contribution to its US defined benefit pension plans. During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company recognized a net federal tax benefit of approximately $1.3 million primarily due to the discretionary contribution deducted on the 2017 tax return at the higher 2017 US corporate tax rate, partially offset by the reversal of the related deferred tax asset recorded using the lower US corporate tax rate provided under the TCJA.
The table below reflects the calculation of the Company’s effective tax rate (in millions of US dollars):
 
 
 
Three months ended
December 31,
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Income tax expense (benefit)
 
0.8

 
(2.5
)
 
9.8

 
13.0

 
19.6

Earnings before income tax expense (benefit)
 
11.4

 
18.7

 
56.5

 
77.0

 
70.7

Effective tax rate
 
6.8
%
 
(13.2
)%
 
17.4
%
 
16.9
%
 
27.7
%
The increase in the effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2018 compared to the same period in 2017 is primarily due to the non-recurrence of the TCJA net tax benefit in the fourth quarter of 2017, largely offset by the lower US corporate tax rate and the net tax benefit from the discretionary pension contribution.

54


The decrease in the effective tax rate for 2017 compared to 2016 is primarily due to the TCJA net tax benefit in the fourth quarter of 2017.
The increase in the effective tax rate for the three months ended December 31, 2018 compared to the same period in 2017 is primarily due to the non-recurrence of the TCJA net tax benefit in the fourth quarter of 2017, partially offset by the lower US corporate tax rate.
IPG Net Earnings
IPG Net Earnings totalled $46.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, a $17.5 million decrease from $64.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease was primarily due to (i) an increase in SG&A mainly due to additional SG&A from the Polyair, Cantech and Airtrax acquisitions, (ii) an increase in interest expense, (iii) foreign exchange losses in 2018, compared to foreign exchange gains in 2017 and (iv) an increase in manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges mainly related to non-cash impairment charges from the closure of the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility. These unfavourable impacts were partially offset by an increase in gross profit.
IPG Net Earnings totalled $64.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, a $13.1 million increase from $51.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase was primarily due to an increase in gross profit and a decrease in income tax expense, partially offset by an increase in SG&A mainly due to additional SG&A from the Cantech and Powerband acquisitions.
IPG Net Earnings for the fourth quarter of 2018 totalled $10.6 million, a $10.7 million decrease from $21.3 million for the fourth quarter of 2017. The decrease was primarily due to (i) foreign exchange losses in the fourth quarter of 2018 compared to foreign exchange gains in the fourth quarter of 2017, (ii) an increase in interest expense and (iii) an increase in income tax expense. These unfavourable impacts were partially offset by a decrease in SG&A mainly due to the decrease in the fair value of cash-settled share-based compensation, and an increase in gross profit.  
Non-GAAP Financial Measures
This MD&A contains certain non-GAAP financial measures as defined under applicable securities legislation, including adjusted net earnings (loss), adjusted earnings (loss) per share, EBITDA, adjusted EBITDA, secured leverage ratio, total leverage ratio and free cash flows (please see the "Adjusted Net Earnings (Loss) and Adjusted Net Earnings (Loss) Per Share" section below for a description and reconciliation of adjusted net earnings (loss) and adjusted earnings (loss) per share, “EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Leverage Ratios” section below for a description and reconciliation of EBITDA, adjusted EBITDA, and a description of secured leverage ratio and total leverage ratio, and the “Cash Flows” section below for a description and reconciliation of free cash flows). In determining these measures, the Company excludes certain items which are otherwise included in determining the comparable GAAP financial measures. The Company believes such non-GAAP financial measures improve the period-to-period comparability of the Company’s results and provide investors with more insight into, and an additional tool to understand and assess, the performance of the Company's ongoing core business operations. As required by applicable securities legislation, the Company has provided definitions of those measures and reconciliations of those measures to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures. Investors and other readers are encouraged to review the related GAAP financial measures and the reconciliation of non-GAAP financial measures to their most directly comparable GAAP financial measures set forth below and should consider non-GAAP financial measures only as a supplement to, and not as a substitute for or as a superior measure to, measures of financial performance prepared in accordance with GAAP.

55


Adjusted Net Earnings (Loss) and Adjusted Earnings (Loss) Per Share
A reconciliation of the Company’s adjusted net earnings (loss), a non-GAAP financial measure, to IPG Net Earnings, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, is set out in the adjusted net earnings (loss) reconciliation table below. Adjusted net earnings (loss) should not be construed as IPG Net Earnings as determined by GAAP. The Company defines adjusted net earnings (loss) as IPG Net Earnings before (i) manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges (recoveries); (ii) advisory fees and other costs associated with mergers and acquisitions activity, including due diligence, integration and certain non-cash purchase price accounting adjustments ("M&A Costs"); (iii) share-based compensation expense (benefit); (iv) impairment of goodwill; (v) impairment (reversal of impairment) of long-lived assets and other assets; (vi) write-down on assets classified as held-for-sale; (vii) (gain) loss on disposal of property, plant, and equipment; (viii) other discrete items as shown in the table below; and (ix) the income tax effect of these items. The term “adjusted net earnings (loss)” does not have any standardized meaning prescribed by GAAP and is therefore unlikely to be comparable to similar measures presented by other issuers. Adjusted net earnings (loss) is not a measurement of financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered as an alternative to IPG Net Earnings as an indicator of the Company’s operating performance or any other measures of performance derived in accordance with GAAP. The Company has included this non-GAAP financial measure because it believes that it permits investors to make a more meaningful comparison of the Company’s performance between periods presented by excluding certain non-cash expenses and non-recurring expenses. In addition, adjusted net earnings (loss) is used by management in evaluating the Company’s performance because it believes it provides an indicator of the Company’s performance that is often more meaningful than GAAP financial measures for the reasons stated in the previous sentence.
Adjusted earnings (loss) per share is also presented in the following table and is a non-GAAP financial measure. Adjusted earnings (loss) per share should not be construed as IPG Net Earnings per share as determined by GAAP. The Company defines adjusted earnings (loss) per share as adjusted net earnings (loss) divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding, both basic and diluted. The term “adjusted earnings (loss) per share” does not have any standardized meaning prescribed by GAAP and is therefore unlikely to be comparable to similar measures presented by other issuers. Adjusted earnings (loss) per share is not a measurement of financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered as an alternative to IPG Net Earnings per share as an indicator of the Company’s operating performance or any other measures of performance derived in accordance with GAAP. The Company has included this non-GAAP financial measure because it believes that it permits investors to make a more meaningful comparison of the Company’s performance between periods presented by excluding certain non-cash expenses and non-recurring expenses. In addition, adjusted earnings (loss) per share is used by management in evaluating the Company’s performance because it believes it provides an indicator of the Company’s performance that is often more meaningful than GAAP financial measures for the reasons stated in the previous sentence.

56


Adjusted Net Earnings Reconciliation to IPG Net Earnings
(In millions of US dollars, except per share amounts and share numbers)
(Unaudited)
 
Three months ended
December 31,
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
IPG Net Earnings
10.6

 
21.3

 
46.8

 
64.2

 
51.1

Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges
1.6

 
0.5

 
7.1

 
1.4

 
2.4

M&A Costs
2.5

 
2.2

 
9.5

 
7.5

 
2.4

Share-based compensation expense
0.4

 
6.4

 
1.9

 
3.3

 
8.2

Impairment of long-lived assets and other assets
0.0

 
0.2

 
0.1

 
0.2

 
0.2

Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment
0.0

 
0.0

 
0.2

 
0.3

 
0.1

Other item: Litigation Settlement

 

 

 

 
1.9

Income tax effect of these items
(0.9
)
 
(3.1
)
 
(3.3
)
 
(3.5
)
 
(4.8
)
Other item: special income tax events (1) 

 
(9.6
)
 

 
(9.6
)
 

Adjusted net earnings
14.2

 
17.9

 
62.2

 
63.7

 
61.6

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
IPG Net Earnings per share
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
0.18

 
0.36

 
0.79

 
1.09

 
0.87

Diluted
0.18

 
0.36

 
0.79

 
1.08

 
0.85

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Adjusted earnings per share
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
0.24

 
0.30

 
1.06

 
1.08

 
1.05

Diluted
0.24

 
0.30

 
1.05

 
1.07

 
1.02

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average number of common shares outstanding
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
58,831,432

 
58,831,518

 
58,815,526

 
59,072,119

 
58,727,751

Diluted
59,055,824

 
59,154,509

 
59,084,175

 
59,587,769

 
60,369,227

(1) 
Represents the impact of the net tax benefit in the fourth quarter of 2017 resulting mainly from the remeasurement of the US net deferred tax liability using the lower US corporate tax rate provided under the TCJA.
Adjusted net earnings totalled $62.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, a $1.5 million or 2.3% decrease from $63.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to (i) an increase in interest expense, (ii) foreign exchange losses in 2018, and (iii) an increase in SG&A mainly due to an increase in employee-related costs to support growth initiatives and variable compensation expense. These unfavourable impacts were partially offset by a decrease in income tax expense and an increase in gross profit.
Adjusted net earnings totalled $63.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, a $2.1 million or 3.0% increase from $61.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase was primarily due to organic growth in gross profit, partially offset by an increase in SG&A mainly due to employee-related costs to support growth initiatives.
Adjusted net earnings totalled $14.2 million for the fourth quarter of 2018, a $3.7 million or 20.5% decrease from $17.9 million for the fourth quarter of 2017. The decrease was primarily due to foreign exchange losses in the fourth quarter of 2018 and an increase in interest expense, partially offset by a decrease in income tax expense.

57


EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Leverage Ratios
A reconciliation of the Company’s EBITDA, a non-GAAP financial measure, to net earnings, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, is set out in the EBITDA reconciliation table below. EBITDA should not be construed as earnings before income taxes, net earnings or cash flows from operating activities as determined by GAAP. The Company defines EBITDA as net earnings before (i) interest and other finance costs (income); (ii) income tax expense (benefit); (iii) amortization of intangible assets; and (iv) depreciation of property, plant and equipment. The Company defines adjusted EBITDA as EBITDA before (i) manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges (recoveries); (ii) advisory fees and other costs associated with mergers and acquisitions activity, including due diligence, integration and certain non-cash purchase price accounting adjustments ("M&A Costs"); (iii) share-based compensation expense (benefit); (iv) impairment of goodwill; (v) impairment (reversal of impairment) of long-lived assets and other assets; (vi) write-down on assets classified as held-for-sale; (vii) (gain) loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment; and (viii) other discrete items as shown in the table below. The terms "EBITDA" and "adjusted EBITDA" do not have any standardized meanings prescribed by GAAP and are therefore unlikely to be comparable to similar measures presented by other issuers. EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA are not measurements of financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered as alternatives to cash flows from operating activities or as alternatives to net earnings as indicators of the Company’s operating performance or any other measures of performance derived in accordance with GAAP. The Company has included these non-GAAP financial measures because it believes that they allow investors to make a more meaningful comparison between periods of the Company’s performance, underlying business trends and the Company’s ongoing operations. The Company further believes these measures may be useful in comparing its operating performance with the performance of other companies that may have different financing and capital structures, and tax rates. Adjusted EBITDA excludes costs that are not considered by management to be representative of the Company’s underlying core operating performance, including certain non-operating expenses, non-cash expenses and non-recurring expenses. In addition, EBITDA and adjusted EBITDA are used by management to set targets and are metrics that, among others, can be used by the Company’s Human Resources and Compensation Committee to establish performance bonus metrics and payout, and by the Company’s lenders and investors to evaluate the Company’s performance and ability to service its debt, finance capital expenditures and acquisitions, and provide for the payment of dividends to shareholders. The Company experiences normal business seasonality that typically results in adjusted EBITDA that is proportionately higher in the second, third and fourth quarters of the year relative to the first quarter.
The Company defines total leverage ratio as borrowings less cash divided by adjusted EBITDA and secured leverage ratio as secured borrowings less cash divided by adjusted EBITDA. Secured borrowings are defined as borrowings less Senior Unsecured Notes. The terms "total leverage ratio" and "secured leverage ratio" do not have any standardized meaning prescribed by GAAP and are therefore unlikely to be comparable to similar measures presented by other issuers with diversified sources of capital. Total leverage ratio and secured leverage ratio are not measurements of financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered as alternatives to any GAAP measure as an indicator of the Company’s liquidity level or any other measures of performance derived in accordance with GAAP. Total leverage ratio and secured leverage ratio are not presented as defined by applicable indentures and should not be considered as alternatives to the respective debt covenants described in the section below entitled "Liquidity and Borrowings." The Company has included these non-GAAP financial measures because it believes that they allow investors to make a meaningful comparison of the Company’s liquidity level and borrowing flexibility. In addition, total leverage ratio and secured leverage ratio are used by management in evaluating the Company’s performance because it believes that they allow management to monitor the Company's liquidity level and borrowing flexibility as well as evaluate its capacity to deploy capital to meet its strategic objectives.

58


EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA Reconciliation to Net Earnings
(In millions of US dollars)
(Unaudited)
 
 
Three months ended
December 31,
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Net earnings
 
10.6

 
21.2

 
46.6

 
64.0

 
51.1

Interest and other finance costs (income)
 
9.6

 
(2.2
)
 
20.9

 
3.8

 
5.0

Income tax expense (benefit)
 
0.8

 
(2.5
)
 
9.8

 
13.0

 
19.6

Depreciation and amortization
 
13.1

 
9.9

 
44.8

 
36.1

 
31.0

EBITDA
 
34.0

 
26.4

 
122.2

 
117.0

 
106.7

Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges
 
1.6

 
0.5

 
7.1

 
1.4

 
2.4

M&A Costs
 
2.5

 
2.2

 
9.5

 
7.5

 
2.4

Share-based compensation expense
 
0.4

 
6.4

 
1.9

 
3.3

 
8.2

Impairment of long-lived assets and other assets
 
0.0

 
0.2

 
0.1

 
0.2

 
0.2

Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment
 
0.0

 
0.0

 
0.2

 
0.3

 
0.1

Other Item: Litigation Settlement
 

 

 

 

 
1.9

Adjusted EBITDA
 
38.5

 
35.7

 
140.9

 
129.6

 
122.0


Adjusted EBITDA totalled $140.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, an $11.3 million or 8.7% increase from $129.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to adjusted EBITDA contributed by Polyair and Cantech and organic growth in gross profit. These favourable impacts were partially offset by an increase in SG&A and the non-recurrence of Insurance Proceeds of $2.1 million recorded in 2017.
 
Adjusted EBITDA totalled $129.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, a $7.6 million or 6.2% increase from $122.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase was primarily due to organic growth in gross profit and adjusted EBITDA contributed by Cantech, partially offset by a $10.5 million reduction in Insurance Proceeds and an increase in SG&A mainly due to employee-related costs to support growth initiatives in the business.
Adjusted EBITDA totalled $38.5 million for the fourth quarter of 2018, a $2.8 million or 8% increase from $35.7 million for the fourth quarter of 2017, primarily due to adjusted EBITDA contributed by the Polyair Acquisition and a decrease in SG&A mainly due to a decrease in employee-related costs related to discretionary employee benefit contributions, partially offset by a decrease in gross profit.
Comprehensive Income Attributable to Company Shareholders ("IPG Comprehensive Income")
IPG Comprehensive Income is comprised of IPG Net Earnings and other comprehensive income (loss) attributable to Company shareholders. IPG Comprehensive Income totalled $40.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, a $28.9 million or 41.5% decrease from $69.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017. The decrease was primarily due to (i) lower IPG Net Earnings in 2018, (ii) an increase in losses arising on hedging instruments designated as hedges of the net assets in foreign operations in 2018 and (iii) less of a favourable foreign exchange impact from cumulative translation adjustments ("CTA") in 2018 compared to 2017. These unfavourable impacts were partially offset by gains from the remeasurement of the defined benefit liability.
IPG Comprehensive Income totalled $69.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, a $17.4 million or 33.3% increase from $52.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The increase was primarily due to higher IPG Net Earnings in 2017 as well as an increase in favourable CTA in 2017.
IPG Comprehensive Income totalled $9.2 million for the fourth quarter of 2018, a $10.4 million decrease from $19.6 million for the fourth quarter of 2017. The decrease was primarily due to (i) lower IPG Net Earnings in the fourth quarter of 2018, (ii) an increase in losses arising on hedging instruments designated as hedges of the net assets in foreign operations in the fourth quarter of 2018, and (iii) a decrease in the change in fair value of interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges. These unfavourable impacts were partially offset by favourable foreign exchange impacts from CTA in the fourth quarter of 2018 compared to unfavourable foreign exchange impacts from CTA in the fourth quarter of 2017 and gains from the remeasurement of the defined benefit liability in the fourth quarter of 2018.

59


Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
Letters of Credit
The Company had standby letters of credit issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2018 that could result in payments by the Company up to an aggregate of $7.4 million upon the occurrence of certain events. All of the letters of credit have expiry dates in 2019.
Capital Commitments
The Company had commitments to suppliers to purchase machinery and equipment totalling approximately $16.3 million as of December 31, 2018. It is expected that such amounts will be paid out in the next twelve months. In the event of cancellation, the penalties that would apply may be equal to the purchase price depending on the timing of the cancellation.
Raw Material Commitments
The Company obtains certain raw materials from suppliers under consignment agreements. The suppliers retain ownership of raw materials until the earlier of when the materials are consumed in production or auto billings are triggered based upon maturity. The consignment agreements involve short-term commitments that typically mature within 30 to 60 days of inventory receipt and are typically renewed on an ongoing basis. The Company may be subject to fees in the event the Company requires storage in excess of 30 to 60 days. As of December 31, 2018, the Company had on hand $9.2 million of raw material owned by its suppliers.
The Company has entered into agreements with various raw material suppliers to purchase minimum quantities of certain raw materials at fixed rates through August 2020 totalling approximately $15.0 million as of December 31, 2018. The Company is also required by the agreements to pay any storage costs incurred by the applicable supplier in the event the Company delays shipment in excess of 30 days. In the event the Company defaults under the terms of an agreement, an arbitrator will determine fees and penalties due to the applicable supplier. Neither party will be liable for failure to perform for reasons of "force majeure" as defined in the agreements.
Utilities Commitments
The Company entered into a five-year electricity service contract for one of its manufacturing facilities on May 1, 2016, under which the Company has and expects to continue to reduce the overall cost of electricity consumed by the facility. In the event of early termination, the Company is required to pay for unrecovered power supply costs incurred by the supplier which are estimated to be approximately $5.8 million as of December 31, 2018 and would decline monthly based on actual service billings to date.
The Company entered into a ten-year electricity service contract for one of its manufacturing facilities on November 12, 2013. The service date of the contract commenced in August 2014. The Company is committed to monthly minimum usage requirements over the term of the contract. The Company was provided installation at no cost and is receiving economic development incentive credits and maintenance of the required energy infrastructure at the manufacturing facility as part of the contract. The credits are expected to reduce the overall cost of electricity consumed by the facility over the term of the contract. Effective August 1, 2015, the Company entered into an amendment lowering the minimum usage requirements over the term of the contract. In addition, a new monthly facility charge has been incurred by the Company over the term of the contract. The Company estimates that service billings will total approximately $9.5 million over the remaining term of the contract. Certain penalty clauses exist within the electricity service contract related to early cancellation after the service date of the contract. The costs related to early cancellation penalties include termination fees based on anticipated service billings over the term of the contract and capital expense recovery charges. While the Company does not expect to cancel the contract prior to the end of its term, the penalties that would apply to early cancellation could total as much as $3.9 million as of December 31, 2018. This amount declines annually until the expiration of the contract.
The Company has entered into agreements with various utility suppliers to fix certain energy costs, including natural gas, through December 2022 for minimum amounts of consumption at several of its manufacturing facilities. The Company estimates that utility billings will total approximately $6.4 million over the term of the contracts based on the contracted fixed terms and current market rate assumptions. The Company is also required by the agreements to pay any difference between the fixed price agreed to with the utility and the sales amount received by the utility for resale to a third party if the Company fails to meet the minimum consumption required by the agreements. In the event of early termination, the Company is required to pay the utility suppliers the difference between the contracted amount and the current market value of the energy, adjusted for present value, of any future agreed upon minimum usage. Neither party will be liable for failure to perform for reasons of "force majeure" as defined in the agreements.

60


The Company currently knows of no event, trend or uncertainty that may affect the availability or benefits of these arrangements now or in the future or that would trigger any such penalty described above. The Company maintains no other off-balance sheet arrangements.
Related Party Transactions
The Company’s key personnel include all members of the Board of Directors and five members of senior management in 2018. Key personnel remuneration includes short-term benefits including base and variable compensation, deferred compensation, director retainer and committee fees, post-employment benefits and share-based compensation. Total key personnel remuneration included in the statement of consolidated earnings totalled $5.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, a decrease of $0.1 million from $6.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2017.
Total key personnel remuneration included in the statement of consolidated earnings totalled $6.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, a decrease of $4.3 million from $10.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2016. The decrease was primarily due to a decrease in share-based compensation mainly driven by a decrease in fair value of cash-settled awards.
Working Capital
The Company experiences some business seasonality that results in the Company’s efforts to effectively manage its working capital resources. Typically, a larger investment in working capital is required in quarters during which accounts receivable increase due to a higher level of sales invoiced towards the end of the quarter and inventory builds in anticipation of higher future sales, both of which typically occur in the first, second and third quarters and unwind in the fourth quarter. Furthermore, certain liabilities are accrued for throughout the year and are paid only during the first quarter of the following year.
The Company uses Days Inventory to measure inventory performance. Days Inventory increased to 65 for the year ended December 31, 2018 from 61 for the year ended December 31, 2017. Days Inventory increased to 66 for the fourth quarter of 2018 from 65 in the fourth quarter of 2017. Inventories totalled $190.7 million as of December 31, 2018, a $43.9 million increase from $146.8 million as of December 31, 2017. The increase was primarily due to (i) additional inventory resulting from the Polyair, Maiweave and Airtrax acquisitions, (ii) an increase in production, including the utilization of completed capacity expansion projects and in preparation for the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility closure, and (iii) an increase in raw material costs and purchases. The calculations are shown in the following table:

 
 
Three months ended
 
Year ended
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
Cost of sales (1)
 
$
231.0

 
$
183.4

 
$
834.1

 
$
696.7

Days in period
 
92

 
92

 
365

 
365

Cost of sales per day (1)
 
$
2.5

 
$
2.0

 
$
2.3

 
$
1.9

Average inventory (1)
 
$
166.0

 
$
129.1

 
$
149.4

 
$
115.9

Days inventory
 
66

 
65

 
65

 
61

Days inventory is calculated as follows:
 
 
Cost of sales ÷ Days in period = Cost of sales per day
 
 
(Beginning inventory + Ending inventory) ÷ 2 = Average inventory
 
 
Average inventory ÷ Cost of goods sold per day = Days inventory
 
 
For purposes of this calculation inventory excludes items considered parts and supplies.
 
 

(1) 
In millions of US dollars
The Company uses Days Sales Outstanding (“DSO”) to measure trade receivables. DSO increased to 45 for the year ended December 31, 2018 from 43 for the year ended December 31, 2017. DSO was 41 in the fourth quarters of 2018 and 2017. Trade receivables totalled $129.3 million as of December 31, 2018, a $22.7 million increase from $106.6 million as of December 31, 2017. The increase was primarily due to an increase in the amount of revenue invoiced in the fourth quarter of 2018 as compared to the fourth quarter of 2017, including the impact of the Polyair, Maiweave, and Airtrax acquisitions.

61


The calculations are shown in the following table:
 
 
 
Three months ended
 
Year ended
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
Revenue (1)
 
$
287.7

 
$
237.4

 
$
1,053.0

 
$
898.1

Days in period
 
92

 
92

 
365

 
365

Revenue per day (1)
 
$
3.1

 
$
2.6

 
$
2.9

 
$
2.5

Trade receivables (1)
 
$
129.3

 
$
106.6

 
$
129.3

 
$
106.6

DSO
 
41

 
41

 
45

 
43

DSO is calculated as follows:
 
 
Revenue ÷ Days in period = Revenue per day
 
 
Ending trade receivables ÷ Revenue per day = DSO
 
 

(1) 
In millions of US dollars
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities totalled $154.8 million as of December 31, 2018, an increase of 50.0 million from $104.8 million as of December 31, 2017. The increase was primarily due to the timing of payments for inventory and SG&A and the impact of the Polyair, Maiweave, and Airtrax acquisitions.
Liquidity and Borrowings
Senior Unsecured Notes
On October 15, 2018, the Company completed the private placement of $250 million aggregate principal amount of Senior Unsecured Notes due October 15, 2026 with certain guarantors and Regions Bank, as Trustee. The Company incurred debt issue costs of $5.1 million which were capitalized and are being amortized using the straight-line method over the eight-year term. The Company used the net proceeds to partially repay borrowings under the 2018 Credit Facility and to pay related fees and expenses, as well as for general corporate purposes. The Senior Unsecured Notes bear interest at a rate of 7.00% per annum, payable semi-annually, in cash, in arrears on April 15 and October 15 of each year, beginning on April 15, 2019.
As of December 31, 2018, the Senior Unsecured Notes outstanding balance amounted to $250.0 million ($245.3 million, net of $4.7 million in unamortized debt issue costs).
2018 Credit Facility
On June 14, 2018, the Company refinanced and replaced the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility with the 2018 Credit Facility. On the same date, the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility's outstanding balance of $304.7 million was repaid in full resulting in satisfaction and discharge of the first priority lien.
The 2018 Credit Facility consists of the $400.0 million 2018 Revolving Credit Facility and the $200.0 million 2018 Term Loan. The 2018 Term Loan amortizes $65.0 million until March 2023 ($5.0 million in 2018, $10.0 million in 2019, $12.5 million in 2020, $15.0 million in 2021, $17.5 million in 2022, and $5.0 million in 2023), and the remaining balance of the 2018 Credit Facility is due upon maturity in June 2023. The 2018 Credit Facility also includes an incremental accordion feature of $200.0 million, which enables the Company to increase the limit of this facility (subject to the credit agreement's terms and lender approval) if needed. The 2018 Credit Facility matures on June 14, 2023 and bears an interest rate based, at the Company’s option, on the London Inter-bank Offered Rate ("LIBOR"), the Federal Funds Rate, or Bank of America’s prime rate, plus a spread varying between 25 and 250 basis points (250 basis points as of December 31, 2018) depending on the debt instrument's benchmark interest rate and the consolidated secured net leverage ratio.
The 2018 Credit Facility provides a more favourable covenant structure and increased flexibility to the Company as compared to the previous credit facility.

62


The 2018 Credit Facility has two financial covenants, a consolidated secured net leverage ratio not to be more than 3.50 to 1.00, with an allowable temporary increase to 4.00 to 1.00 for the quarter in which the Company consummates an acquisition with a price not less than $50 million and the following three quarters, and a consolidated interest coverage ratio not to be less than 3.00 to 1.00. The Company was in compliance with the consolidated secured net leverage ratio and consolidated interest coverage ratio, which were 1.42 and 7.17, respectively, as of December 31, 2018. In addition, the 2018 Credit Facility has certain non-financial covenants, such as covenants regarding indebtedness, investments, and asset dispositions. The Company was in compliance with all covenants as of and for the year ended December 31, 2018.
As of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Term Loan's outstanding principal balance amounted to $195.0 million and the 2018 Revolving Credit Facility’s outstanding principal balance amounted to $26.4 million, for a total gross outstanding principal balance under the 2018 Credit Facility of $221.4 million (net outstanding principal balance of $219.1 million, net of $2.3 million in unamortized debt issue costs). Standby letters of credit totalled $7.4 million resulting in total utilization under the 2018 Credit Facility of $228.8 million. Accordingly, the unused availability under the 2018 Credit Facility as of December 31, 2018 amounted to $366.2 million.
Other Borrowings
On February 6, 2018, Capstone entered into an Indian Rupee ("INR") 975.0 million ($15.0 million) credit facility ("2018 Capstone Credit Facility"). The 2018 Capstone Credit Facility consists of an INR 585.0 million ($9.0 million) term loan facility ("Capstone Term Loan Facility") with committed funding and INR 390.0 million ($6.0 million) working capital facility ("Capstone Working Capital Facility") with uncommitted funding. Borrowings under the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility mature in June 2023, are guaranteed by the Company, and are otherwise unsecured.
As of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility credit limit was INR 975.0 million ($13.9 million), and the total gross outstanding balance was INR 530.4 million ($7.6 million). Including INR 44.5 million ($0.6 million) in standby letters of credit, total utilization under the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility amounted to INR 574.9 million ($8.2 million). Accordingly, as of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility's unused availability was INR 400.1 million ($5.7 million), comprised of committed availability under the Capstone Term Loan Facility equalling INR 162.6 million ($2.3 million) and uncommitted availability under the Capstone Working Capital Facility amounting to INR 237.5 million ($3.4 million).
On July 4, 2018, Powerband entered into an INR 1,300.0 million ($19.0 million) credit facility (“2018 Powerband Credit Facility”). In December 2018, Powerband amended the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility to reallocate and increase its credit limit by INR 100 million ($1.4 million), bringing the total 2018 Powerband Credit Facility limit to INR 1,400.0 million ($19.3 million). The 2018 Powerband Credit Facility is guaranteed by the Company, and local assets (carrying amount of $30.2 million as of December 31, 2018) are required to be pledged. Powerband is prohibited from granting liens on its assets without the consent of the lender under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility. Funding under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility is not committed and could be withdrawn by the lender with 10 days' notice. Additionally, under the terms of the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility, Powerband's debt to net worth ratio (as defined by the credit agreement) must be maintained below 3.00. Powerband was in compliance with the debt to net worth ratio (2.07 as of December 31, 2018) as of and for the year ended December 31, 2018.
As of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility credit limit was INR 1,400.0 million ($20.0 million) and the total gross outstanding balance was INR 1,147.9 million ($16.4 million). Net of INR 5.5 million ($0.1 million) unamortized debt issue costs, the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility outstanding balance was INR 1,142.4 million ($16.3 million). Including INR 30.2 million ($0.4 million) in standby letters of credit, total utilization under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility amounted to INR 1,178.1 million ($16.8 million). Accordingly, unused availability under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility as of December 31, 2018 amounted to INR 221.9 million ($3.2 million).
Liquidity
The Company relies upon cash flows from operations and borrowings to meet working capital requirements, as well as to fund capital expenditures, mergers & acquisitions, dividends, share repurchases, obligations under its other debt instruments, and other general corporate purposes.
The Company’s liquidity risk management processes attempt to (i) maintain a sufficient amount of cash, and (ii) ensure that the Company has financing sources for a sufficient authorized amount. The Company establishes budgets, cash estimates and cash management policies with a goal of ensuring it has the necessary funds to fulfill its obligations for the foreseeable future.
The Company believes it has sufficient cash on hand, and that it will generate sufficient funds from cash flows from operating activities, to meet its ongoing expected capital expenditures, working capital and discretionary dividend payment funding needs

63


for at least the next twelve months. In addition, funds available under the 2018 Credit Facility may be used, as needed, to fund more significant strategic initiatives.
As of December 31, 2018, the Company had $18.7 million of cash and $375.1 million of loan availability (comprised of committed funding of $368.5 million and uncommitted funding of $6.6 million), yielding total cash and loan availability of $393.9 million compared to total cash and loan availability of $186.6 million as of December 31, 2017. The increase in cash and loan availability is primarily due to increased capacity under the 2018 Credit Facility and the issuance of the $250 million Senior Unsecured Notes in October, 2018.
Cash Flows
The Company’s net working capital on the balance sheets increased during 2018 and 2017 due to the effects of business acquisitions. However, working capital amounts acquired are not included in cash flows from operating activities under IFRS. As such, the discussions below regarding 2018 and 2017 working capital items appropriately exclude these effects.
Cash flows from operating activities decreased in the year ended December 31, 2018 by $1.3 million to $90.8 million from $92.1 million in the year ended December 31, 2017. Factors that decreased operating cash flows included an $11.3 million discretionary contribution to US defined benefit pension plans in 2018, plus year over year increases in working capital. The combination of accounts receivable, inventories, other current assets and accounts payable increased working capital by $27.4 million in 2018, compared to working capital increases of $18.2 million in 2017. These items were largely offset by an increase in gross profit and decreases in income taxes paid mainly as a result of the TCJA in 2018. Additional discussion on working capital changes is provided in the section entitled "Working Capital” above.
Cash flows from operating activities decreased in the year ended December 31, 2017 by $16.0 million to $92.1 million from $108.1 million in the year ended December 31, 2016, primarily due to cash flows from working capital items. Cash flows from working capital items decreased primarily due to (i) a decrease in accounts payable and accrued liabilities resulting from the timing of payments near the end of 2017 compared to the end of 2016 and the cash-settlement of share-based compensation awards in 2017, (ii) a greater increase in inventory mainly due to an increase in raw material costs in the fourth quarter of 2017 compared to the fourth quarter of 2016, and (iii) a decrease in provisions resulting primarily from settlements for restoration obligations and termination benefits associated with manufacturing facility closures in 2017.
Cash flows from operating activities increased in the fourth quarter of 2018 by $10.9 million to $70.2 million from $59.3 million in the fourth quarter of 2017 primarily due to a greater increase in accounts payable and accrued liabilities resulting from the timing of payments near the end of the fourth quarter of 2018 compared to 2017, partially offset by an increase in inventories as discussed in the section entitled "Working Capital" above.
Cash flows used for investing activities increased in the year ended December 31, 2018 by $90.4 million to $243.3 million from $152.9 million in the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to a greater investment in strategic acquisitions, consisting of Polyair and Maiweave in 2018 for a total of $165.8 million, compared to Cantech and the Capstone partnership in 2017 for a total of $67.0 million.
Cash flows used for investing activities increased in the year ended December 31, 2017 by $61.1 million to $152.9 million from $91.8 million in the year ended December 31, 2016, primarily due to higher capital expenditures as well as the Cantech Acquisition and Capstone partnership in 2017 for a total of $67.0 million, compared to the Powerband Acquisition in 2016 for $41.9 million.
Cash flows used for investing activities increased by $24.5 million to $40.1 million in the fourth quarter of 2018 from $15.5 million in the fourth quarter of 2017 primarily due to the Maiweave Acquisition.
Cash flows from financing activities increased in the year ended December 31, 2018 by $116.4 million to an inflow of $164.2 million from an inflow of $47.7 million in the year ended December 31, 2017 and increased by $31.3 million to an outflow of $23.9 million in the fourth quarter of 2018 from an outflow of $55.2 million in the fourth quarter of 2017. The change in both periods is primarily due to an increase in net borrowings, partially offset by the settlement of the Company's call options to acquire the outstanding 26% interest in Powerband in 2018 and an increase in debt issuance costs primarily associated with the Senior Unsecured Notes and the 2018 Credit Facility. The increase in borrowings was primarily to fund strategic and growth acquisitions and other working capital requirements.
Cash flows from financing activities increased in the year ended December 31, 2017 by $59.3 million to an inflow of $47.7 million from an outflow of $11.5 million in the year ended December 31, 2016, primarily due to an increase in net borrowings, partially offset by an increase in repurchases of common shares.

64


The Company is including free cash flows, a non-GAAP financial measure, because it is used by management and investors in evaluating the Company’s performance and liquidity. Free cash flows does not have any standardized meaning prescribed by GAAP and is therefore unlikely to be comparable to similar measures presented by other issuers. Free cash flows should not be interpreted to represent the total cash movement for the period as described in the Company's Financial Statements, or to represent residual cash flow available for discretionary purposes, as it excludes other mandatory expenditures such as debt service.
Free cash flows is defined by the Company as cash flows from operating activities less purchases of property, plant and equipment.
Free cash flows increased in the year ended December 31, 2018 by $8.2 million to $15.0 million from $6.8 million in the year ended December 31, 2017 primarily due to a decrease in capital expenditures.
Free cash flows decreased in the year ended December 31, 2017 by $51.3 million to $6.8 million from $58.2 million in the year ended December 31, 2016 due to an increase in capital expenditures and a decrease in cash flows from operating activities.
Free cash flows increased in the fourth quarter of 2018 by $6.7 million to $52.0 million from $45.3 million in the fourth quarter of 2017, primarily due to an increase in cash flows from operating activities, partially offset by an increase in capital expenditures.
A reconciliation of free cash flows to cash flows from operating activities, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, is set forth below.
Free Cash Flows Reconciliation to Cash Flows from Operating Activities
(In millions of US dollars)
(Unaudited)
 
 
Three months ended
December 31,
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Cash flows from operating activities
 
70.2

 
59.3

 
90.8

 
92.1

 
108.1

Less purchases of property, plant and equipment
 
(18.2
)
 
(14.0
)
 
(75.8
)
 
(85.3
)
 
(50.0
)
Free cash flows
 
52.0

 
45.3

 
15.0

 
6.8

 
58.2

Capital Resources
Capital expenditures totalled $18.2 million and $75.8 million in the three months and year ended December 31, 2018, respectively, as funded by the Company's borrowings and cash flows from operating activities. Capital expenditures for the year ended December 31, 2018 were primarily for property, plant and equipment to support the greenfield manufacturing facilities in India as well as capacity expansion at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility ("Midland Expansion Project") and various other growth initiatives and maintenance needs. All of the Company's strategic and growth initiatives are currently expected to yield an after-tax internal rate of return greater than 15%.
In February 2019, the Company successfully commissioned its second water-activated tape line at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility. The second production line is operating as planned in terms of timeline and is in line with expected capital expenditures. This expansion doubles the water-activated tape production capacity at the facility and supports growth in the e-commerce industry. The Company completed construction of the Midland manufacturing facility in 2017 and commissioned the first production line in the third quarter of 2017 for total invested capital of approximately $48 million. The first production line is operating at capacity so the second production line provides new capacity for anticipated growth. Another major initiative completed in 2018 was the expansion of the Company's specialty tape product offering ("Specialty Tape Project"). In all of these projects, the Company achieved or surpassed the related timeline and budgeted project spending goals.
The Company made significant progress on the both the carton-sealing tape and woven greenfield manufacturing facilities in India where facility construction has been completed and equipment installation and product trials have begun. Both projects are proceeding on time and on budget.

65


Estimates of completion and future expenditure levels, as well as capital expenditures to date, for selected strategic and growth initiatives are summarized in the table below (in millions of US dollars):

 
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
Approximate amounts
based on current estimates
 
 
2018
 
2019
 
Total Project
 
Completion Date
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
 
Ongoing Initiatives:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capstone Greenfield Project (1) (2)
 
16.9

 
3-7

 
28-32

 
First half of 2019
Midland Expansion Project
 
8.0

 
1-2

 
14-16

 
Early 2019
Powerband Investment Project (1)
 
6.9

 
3-6

 
18-20

 
First half of 2019
Utah Shrink Film Project
 
4.8

 
1-2

 
9-10

 
Early 2019 (3)
Initiative Completed in 2018:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Specialty Tape Project
 
1.0

 

 
6.2

 
 
 
(1) 
Subject to FX impact.
(2) 
Excluding any government subsidies.
(3) 
Extension from previous completion estimate of end of 2018 primarily due to a supplier installation delay.
Capital expenditures to support maintenance needs are approximately $20 million annually. This amount has increased from previous years mainly due to the business acquisitions made in 2018 and 2017. The Company regards maintenance needs as those expenditures required to keep its equipment and premises in acceptable working order. However, the Company plans for on-going annual capital investments in excess of maintenance needs in order to ensure that it is supporting efficiency and effectiveness in its operations to keep it competitive with its peers. This additional investment is generally expected to result in total annual capital expenditures (including maintenance needs) that range between $40 to $60 million excluding any larger-scale strategic projects.
The Company had commitments to suppliers to purchase machinery and equipment totalling approximately $16.3 million as of December 31, 2018, primarily to support the initiatives discussed above. It is expected that such amounts will be paid out in the next twelve months and will be funded by the Company's borrowings and cash flows from operating activities.
Contractual Obligations
The Company’s principal contractual obligations and commercial commitments as of December 31, 2018 are summarized in the following table (in millions of US dollars):
 
 
 
Payments Due by Period (1)
 
 
Total
 
Less
than
1 year
 
1-3
years
 
4-5
years
 
After
5 years
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Debt principal obligations (2)
 
501.4

 
12.9

 
30.6

 
207.0

 
250.8

Standby letters of credit (2)
 
7.4

 
7.4

 

 

 

Finance lease obligations (3)
 
6.2

 
1.6

 
1.5

 
3.1

 

Pensions, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefit plans (4)
 
3.7

 
3.7

 

 

 

Operating lease obligations
 
35.5

 
8.5

 
11.5

 
9.4

 
6.1

Equipment purchase commitments
 
16.3

 
16.3

 

 

 

Utilities contract obligations (5)
 
21.7

 
6.7

 
9.0

 
5.1

 
1.0

Raw material purchase commitments (6)
 
24.2

 
22.0

 
2.2

 

 

Other obligations (7)
 
6.5

 
2.3

 
2.4

 

 
1.8

Total
 
622.9

 
81.4

 
57.2

 
224.6

 
259.8

 

66


(1) 
"Less than 1 year" represents those payments due in 2019, "1-3 years" represents those payments due in 2020 and 2021, "3-5 years" represents those payments due in 2022 and 2023, while "After 5 years" includes those payments due in later years.

(2) 
Refer to the previous section entitled "Liquidity and Borrowings" and Note 13 in the Company’s Financial Statements for a complete discussion of borrowings.

(3) 
The figures in the table above include interest expense included in minimum lease payments of $0.5 million.

(4) 
Pension, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefit plans includes contributions associated with defined benefit and defined contribution plans. Defined benefit plan contributions represent the minimum required amount the Company expects to contribute in 2019, including benefit payments associated with the health & welfare and other post-retirement plans. Defined benefit plan contributions beyond 2019 are not determinable since the amount of any contributions is heavily dependent on the future economic environment and investment returns on pension plan assets. Volatility in the global financial markets could have an unfavourable impact on the Company’s future pension and other post-retirement benefits funding obligations as well as net periodic benefit cost.
Defined contribution plan contributions represent the obligation recorded as of December 31, 2018 to be paid in 2019. Certain defined contribution plan contributions beyond 2019 are not determinable since contribution to the plan is at the discretion of the Company.
Obligations under deferred compensation plans represent participant compensation deferrals and earnings and losses thereon. Amounts due to participants are payable based on participant elections. The amount and timing of a potential cash payment to settle these obligations is not determinable since the decision to settle is not within the Company’s control and, therefore, is not included in the table above. As of December 31, 2018, obligations under the deferred compensation plan totalled $2.6 million.
Refer to Note 18 in the Company’s Financial Statements for a complete discussion of pension, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefit plans.

(5) 
Utilities contract obligations include agreements with various utility suppliers to fix certain energy costs, including natural gas and electricity, for minimum amounts of consumption at several of the Company’s manufacturing facilities, as discussed in the previous section entitled "Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements". The figures included in the table above are estimates of utility billings over the term of the contracts based on the contracted fixed terms and current market rate assumptions. The Company currently knows of no event, trend or uncertainty that may affect the availability or benefits of the agreements now or in the future.

(6) 
Raw material purchase commitments include certain raw materials from suppliers under consignment agreements, as discussed in the previous section entitled "Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements". The figures included in the table above represent raw material inventory on hand or in transit, owned by the Company’s suppliers, that the Company expects to consume.
Raw material purchase commitments also include agreements with various raw material suppliers to purchase minimum quantities of certain raw materials at fixed rates, as discussed in the previous section entitled "Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements". The figures included in the table above do not include estimates for storage costs, fees or penalties. The Company currently knows of no event, trend or uncertainty that may affect the availability or benefits of these agreements now or in the future.
 
(7) 
Other obligations include provisions for (i) environmental obligations primarily related to the Columbia, South Carolina manufacturing facility, (ii) restoration obligations associated with leased facilities, (iii) termination benefits primarily related to the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility closure and (iv) litigation provisions. Refer to Note 14 in the Company’s Financial Statements for a complete discussion of provisions and contingent liabilities.
The amount and timing of a potential cash payment to settle a deferred share unit ("DSU") is not determinable since the decision to settle is not within the Company’s control after the award vests and, therefore, is not included in the table above. As of December 31, 2018, the aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding vested DSUs was $2.4 million. Refer to the section below entitled "Capital Stock" for a discussion of share-based compensation plans.
Purchase orders outside the scope of the raw material purchase commitments as defined in this section are not included in the table above. The Company is not able to determine the aggregate amount of such purchase orders that represent contractual obligations, as these purchase orders typically represent authorizations to purchase rather than binding agreements. For the purposes of this

67


table, contractual obligations for purchase of goods or services are defined as agreements that are enforceable and legally binding on the Company and that specify all significant terms, including: fixed or minimum quantities to be purchased; fixed, minimum or variable price provisions; and the approximate timing of the transaction. The Company’s purchase orders are based on current demand expectations and are fulfilled by the Company’s vendors within short time horizons. The Company also enters into contracts for outsourced services; however, the obligations under these contracts are not significant and the contracts generally contain clauses allowing for cancellation without significant penalty.
Capital Stock and Dividends
Common Shares
As of December 31, 2018, there were 58,650,310 common shares of the Company outstanding.
Dividends
During the year ended December 31, 2018, cash dividends were paid as follows:
 
Declared Date
 
Paid date
 
Per common
share
amount
 
Shareholder
record date
 
Common
shares issued
and
outstanding
 
Aggregate
payment
March 7, 2018
 
March 30, 2018
 
$
0.14

 
March 20, 2018
 
58,807,410

 
$
8.3

May 9, 2018
 
June 29, 2018
 
$
0.14

 
June 15, 2018
 
58,817,410

 
$
8.1

August 10, 2018
 
September 28, 2018
 
$
0.14

 
September 14, 2018
 
58,817,410

 
$
8.2

November 7, 2018
 
December 28, 2018
 
$
0.14

 
December 14, 2018
 
58,867,410

 
$
8.1


On March 12, 2019, the Board of Directors declared a dividend of $0.14 per common share payable on March 29, 2019 to shareholders of record at the close of business on March 22, 2019.
Since the dividend policy was reinstated in August 2012, the Company has paid $170.5 million in cumulative dividends, of which $32.8 million was paid in 2018.
The dividends paid in 2018 and payable in 2019 by the Company are "eligible dividends" as defined in subsection 89(1) of the Income Tax Act (Canada).
Share Repurchases
On July 23, 2018, the Company renewed the normal course issuer bid ("NCIB") under which it is permitted to repurchase for cancellation up to 4,000,000 common shares of the Company at prevailing market prices during the twelve-month period ending July 22, 2019. As of December 31, 2018 and March 12, 2019, 3,782,900 shares remained available for repurchase under the NCIB.
The Company's three previous NCIBs, which each allowed repurchases for cancellation of up to 4,000,000 common shares, expired on July 16, 2018, July 13, 2017 and July 9, 2016, respectively.
The table below summarizes the NCIB activity that occurred during the three months and year ended December 31:
 
 
 
Three months ended
December 31,
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
Common shares repurchased
 
217,100

 
71,800

 
217,100

 
487,300

Average price per common share including commissions
 
CDN$
16.02

 
CDN$
17.85

 
CDN$
16.02

 
CDN$
18.88

Total purchase price including commissions (1)
 
$
2.6

 
$
1.0

 
$
2.6

 
$
7.5


(1) 
In millions of US dollars


68


Share-based Compensation
The Company's share-based compensation plans include: stock options, Stock Appreciation Rights ("SAR"), Performance Share Units ("PSU"), Restricted Share Units ("RSU") and Deferred Share Units ("DSU").
On March 7, 2018, the Board of Directors approved the addition of RSUs as an available cash-settled award type. An RSU, as defined by the Amended and Restated Performance and Restricted Share Unit Plan, is a right to receive a cash payment equal to the five trading days volume weighted average price ("VWAP") of a common share of the Company on the Toronto Stock Exchange ("TSX") upon completion of time-based vesting conditions. Grants of RSUs to employees of the Company are on a discretionary basis and subject to the Board of Directors’ approval. The fair value of RSUs is based on the five trading days VWAP of the Company’s common shares on the TSX at the end of each reporting period. The RSUs are expensed over the vesting period beginning from the date of grant through February 15th of the fourth calendar year following the date of grant, unless vesting is accelerated based on retirement eligibility, death or disability.
The table below summarizes share-based compensation activity that occurred during the following periods:
 
 
Three months ended
December 31,
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
Equity-settled
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock options granted
 

 

 
242,918

(1) 

Stock options exercised
 
50,000

 

 
67,500

 
226,875

Cash proceeds (in millions of US dollars)
 
$0.5
 

 
$0.6
 
$1.5
Cash-settled
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
DSUs granted
 
26,031

 

 
69,234

 
48,179

DSUs settled
 

 

 
37,668

 

PSUs granted
 

 

 
284,571

 
358,386

PSUs (cancelled)/added by performance factor (2)
 

 

 
(2,125
)
 
69,600

PSUs settled (2)
 

 

 
335,465

 
208,800

PSUs forfeited/cancelled
 

 

 
16,053

 

RSUs granted
 

 

 
113,047

 

RSUs forfeited/cancelled
 

 

 
1,228

 

SARs exercised
 

 

 
147,500

 
13,250

Cash settlements (in millions of US dollars)
 

 

 
$7.9
 
$4.3
Share-based compensation expense (in millions of US dollars)
 
$0.4
 
$6.4
 
$1.9
 
$3.3

(1) 
In accordance with the TSX rules, no further grants of stock options have been made under the Company's Executive Stock Option Plan ("ESOP") since June 4, 2018, the date on which the ESOP elapsed.
(2) 
The table below provides further information regarding the PSUs settled included in the table above. The number of "Target Shares" reflects 100% of the PSUs granted and the number of PSUs settled reflects the performance adjustments to the Target Shares:
Grant Date
 
Date Settled
 
Target Shares
 
Performance
 
PSUs settled
June 11, 2014
 
June 22, 2017
 
139,200

 
150
%
 
208,800

March 14, 2015
 
March 21, 2018
 
217,860

 
100
%
 
217,860

May 14, 2015
 
May 22, 2018
 
115,480

 
100
%
 
115,480

May 20, 2015
 
May 28, 2018
 
4,250

 
50
%
 
2,125

As of December 31, 2018, $5.1 million was recorded in share-based compensation liabilities, current, and $4.1 million was recorded in share-based compensation liabilities, non-current.


69


The table below presents the share-based compensation expense recorded in earnings in SG&A by award type (in millions of US dollars):
 
 
Three months ended
December 31,
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2018
 
2017
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Equity-settled
 
0.1

 
0.0

 
0.5

 
0.2

Cash-settled
 
0.2

 
6.3

 
1.4

 
3.1

Total
 
0.4

 
6.4

 
1.9

 
3.3

Pension and Other Post-Retirement Benefit Plans
On September 12, 2018, the Company made an $11.3 million discretionary contribution to its US defined benefit pension plans. These plans are near wholly funded on an accounting basis and as a result, the Company expects to reduce future contribution requirements and certain plan administration expenses.
The Company’s pension and other post-retirement benefit plans had an unfunded deficit of $14.9 million as of December 31, 2018 as compared to $29.3 million as of December 31, 2017. The decrease was primarily due to an increase in the fair value of plan assets resulting from the $11.3 million discretionary contribution, partially offset by unfavourable investment performance. In addition to the favourable change in plan assets, the net present value of the liability decreased mainly due to gains arising from changes in actuarial assumptions including an increase in the weighted average discount rate at year-end from 3.55% and 3.50% for US and Canadian plans, respectively, as of December 31, 2017 to 4.05% and 3.95% for US and Canadian plans, respectively, as of December 31, 2018.
Adverse market conditions could require the Company to make additional cash payments to fund the plans which could reduce cash available for other business needs; however, the Company expects to meet its minimum required pension benefit plan funding obligations for 2019. None of the defined benefit plan assets were invested in any of the Company’s own equity or financial instruments or in any property or other assets used by the Company.
Financial Risk, Objectives and Policies
Interest Rate Risk
The Company is exposed to a risk of change in cash flows due to the fluctuations in interest rates on its variable rate borrowings.
To minimize the potential long-term cost of floating rate borrowings, the Company entered into interest rate swap agreements. The interest rate swap agreements involve the exchange of periodic payments excluding the notional principal amount upon which the payments are based. If the underlying interest rate swap agreement is a qualifying cash flow hedge, these payments are recorded as an adjustment of interest expense on the hedged debt instruments and the related amount payable to or receivable from counterparties is included as an adjustment to accrued interest. Cash payments related to non-qualifying cash flow hedges are recorded as a reduction of the fair value of the corresponding interest rate swap agreement recognized in the balance sheet, which indirectly impacts the change in fair value recorded in earnings. The fair value of the derivative assets totalled $2.6 million as of December 31, 2018.
The terms of the interest rate swap agreements are as follows (in millions of US dollars, except as noted):
 
Effective Date
 
Maturity
 
Notional amount
 
Settlement
 
Fixed interest rate paid
Qualifying cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
$
 
 
 
%
 
June 8, 2017
 
June 20, 2022
 
40.0

 
Monthly
 
1.7900
 
July 21, 2017
 
July 18, 2022
 
CDN 36.0 (1)

 
Monthly
 
1.6825
 
August 20, 2018
 
August 18, 2023
 
60.0

 
Monthly
 
2.0450
Non-qualifying cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
March 18, 2015
 
November 18, 2019
 
40.0

 
Monthly
 
1.6100
(1) 
The notional amount will decrease by CDN$18.0 million on July 18, 2021 and 2022.

70


On August 20, 2018, an interest rate swap agreement with a notional amount of $60.0 million and fixed interest rate of 1.1970% matured and was settled in full.
Exchange Risk
The Company’s Financial Statements are expressed in US dollars while a portion of its business is conducted in other currencies. Changes in the exchange rates for such currencies into US dollars can increase or decrease revenues, operating profit, earnings and the carrying values of assets and liabilities.
The Company's risk strategy with respect to its foreign currency exposure is that the Financial Risk Management Committee (i) monitors the Company's exposures and cash flows, taking into account the large extent of naturally offsetting exposures, (ii) considers the Company's ability to adjust its selling prices due to foreign currency movements and other market conditions, and (iii) considers borrowing under available debt facilities in the most advantageous manner, after considering interest rates, foreign currency exposures, expected cash flows and other factors.
Hedge of net investment in foreign operations
A foreign currency exposure arises from Intertape Polymer Group Inc.'s (the “Parent Company”) net investment in its USD functional currency subsidiary, IPG (US) Holdings Inc. The risk arises from the fluctuations in the USD and CDN current exchange rate, which causes the amount of the net investment to vary.
In 2018, the Parent Company completed the private placement of its USD denominated Senior Unsecured Notes which resulted in additional equity investments in IPG (US) Holdings Inc. The Senior Unsecured Notes are being used to hedge the Company’s exposure to the USD foreign exchange risk on this investment. Gains or losses on the retranslation of this borrowing are transferred to other comprehensive income ("OCI") to offset any gains or losses on translation of the net investment in the subsidiary.
There is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument as the net investment creates a translation risk that will match the foreign exchange risk on the USD borrowing designated as the hedging instrument. Hedge ineffectiveness will arise when the amount of the investment in the foreign subsidiary becomes lower than the amount of the fixed rate borrowing and is recorded in finance costs in other expense (income), net.
The amount related to items designated as hedging instruments in the hedge of a net investment are as follows for the year ended December 31, 2018:
 
Notional Amount
 
Carrying Amount
 
Change in value used for calculating hedge ineffectiveness
 
Change in value of hedging instrument recognized in OCI
 
Hedge ineffectiveness recognized in earnings
 
Foreign exchange impact recognized in CTA
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Senior Unsecured Notes denominated in USD
250.0

 
245.3

 
(10.9
)
 
(9.4
)
 
(1.5
)
 


The amounts related to items designated as hedged items are as follows for the year ended December 31, 2018:
 
Change in value used for calculating hedge ineffectiveness
 
Foreign currency translation reserve
 
$
 
$
Net investment in IPG (US) Holdings, Inc.
9.4

 
(9.4
)

71


Litigation
The Company is engaged from time-to-time in various legal proceedings and claims that have arisen in the ordinary course of business. The outcome of all of the proceedings and claims against the Company is subject to future resolution, including the uncertainties of litigation. Based on information currently known to the Company and after consultation with outside legal counsel, management believes that the probable ultimate resolution of any such proceedings and claims, individually or in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the financial condition of the Company, taken as a whole, and accordingly, no material amounts have been recorded as of December 31, 2018.
Critical Accounting Judgments, Estimates and Assumptions
The preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires management to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies and the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. Significant changes in the underlying assumptions could result in significant changes to these estimates. Consequently, management reviews these estimates on a regular basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognized in the period in which the estimates are revised and in any future periods affected. Information about these significant judgments, assumptions and estimates that have the most significant effect on the recognition and measurement of assets, liabilities, income and expenses are summarized below:
Significant Management Judgments
Deferred income taxes
Deferred tax assets are recognized for unused tax losses and tax credits to the extent that it is probable that future taxable income will be available against which the losses can be utilized. These estimates are reviewed at every reporting date. Significant management judgment is required to determine the amount of deferred tax assets that can be recognized, based upon the likely timing and the level of the reversal of existing timing differences, future taxable income and future tax planning strategies. Refer to Note 5 of the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding income taxes.
Estimation Uncertainty
Impairments
At the end of each reporting period, the Company performs a test of impairment on assets subject to amortization if there are indicators of impairment. Goodwill allocated to CGUs and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are tested annually. An impairment loss is recognized when the carrying value of an asset or CGU exceeds its recoverable amount, which in turn is the higher of its fair value less costs to sell and its value in use. The value in use is based on discounted estimated future cash flows. The cash flows are derived from the budget or forecasts for the estimated remaining useful lives of the CGUs and do not include restructuring activities that the Company is not yet committed to or significant future investments that will enhance the performance of the asset or CGU being tested. The value in use will vary depending on the discount rate applied to the discounted cash flows, the estimated future cash inflows, and the growth rate used for extrapolation purposes.
Refer to Note 12 of the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding impairment testing.
Pension, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefits
The cost of defined benefit pension plans and other post-retirement benefit plans and the present value of the related obligations are determined using actuarial valuations. The determination of benefits expense and related obligations requires assumptions such as the discount rate to measure obligations, expected mortality and the expected health care cost trend. Actual results will differ from estimated results, which are based on assumptions. Refer to Note 18 of the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding the assumptions related to the pension and other post-retirement benefit plans.
Uncertain tax positions
The Company is subject to taxation in numerous jurisdictions. There are many transactions and calculations during the course of business for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain. The Company maintains provisions for uncertain tax positions that it believes appropriately reflect its risk. These provisions are made using the best estimate of the amount expected to be paid based on a qualitative assessment of all relevant factors. The Company reviews the adequacy of these provisions at the end of the reporting period. However, it is possible that at some future date, liabilities in excess of the Company’s provisions could result from audits

72


by, or litigation with, the relevant taxing authorities. Refer to Note 5 of the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding income taxes.
Useful lives of depreciable assets
The Company depreciates property, plant and equipment over the estimated useful lives of the assets. In determining the estimated useful life of these assets, significant judgment is required. Judgment is required to determine whether events or circumstances warrant a revision to the remaining periods of depreciation and amortization. The Company considers expectations of the in-service period of these assets in determining these estimates. The Company assesses the estimated useful life of these assets at each reporting date. If the Company determines that the useful life of an asset is different from the original assessment, changes to depreciation and amortization will be applied prospectively. The estimates of cash flows used to assess the potential impairment of these assets are also subject to measurement uncertainty. Actual results may vary due to technical or commercial obsolescence, particularly with respect to information technology and manufacturing equipment.
Net realizable value of inventories and parts and supplies
Inventories and parts and supplies are measured at the lower of cost or net realizable value. In estimating net realizable values of inventories and parts and supplies, management takes into account the most reliable evidence available at the time the estimate is made.
Provisions for slow-moving and obsolete inventories are made based on the age and estimated net realizable value of inventories. The assessment of the provision involves management judgment and estimates associated with expected disposition of the inventory. Refer to Note 7 of the Company’s Financial Statements for information regarding inventories and write-downs of inventories.
Allowance for doubtful accounts and revenue adjustments
During each reporting period, the Company makes an assessment of whether trade accounts receivable are collectible from customers. Accordingly, management establishes an allowance for estimated losses arising from non-payment and other revenue adjustments. The Company’s allowance for expected credit loss reflects expected credit losses using a provision matrix model, supplemented by an allowance for individually impaired trade receivables. The provision matrix is based on the Company’s historic credit loss experience, adjusted for any change in risk of the trade receivable population based on credit monitoring indicators, and expectations of general economic conditions that might affect the collection of trade receivables. The provision matrix applies fixed provision rates depending on the number of days that a trade receivable is past due, with higher rates applied the longer a balance is past due. The Company also records reductions to revenue for estimated returns, claims, customer rebates, and other incentives. These incentives are recorded as a reduction to revenue at the time of the initial sale using the most-likely amount estimation method. The most-likely amount method is based on the single most likely outcome from a range of possible consideration outcomes. The range of possible outcomes are primarily derived from the following inputs: sales terms, historical experience, trend analysis, and projected market conditions in the various markets served. If future collections and trends differ from estimates, future earnings will be affected. Refer to Note 22 of the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding the allowance for doubtful accounts and the related credit risks.
Provisions
Provisions are recognized when the Company has a present obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event, it is probable that the Company will be required to settle the obligation, and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.
The amount recognized as a provision is the best estimate of the consideration required to settle the present obligation at the end of the reporting period, taking into account the risks and uncertainties surrounding the obligation. When a provision is measured using the cash flows estimated to settle the present obligation, its carrying amount is the present value of those cash flows, when the effect of the time value of money is material.
The Company's provisions include environmental and restoration obligations, termination benefits and other and litigation provisions. Refer to Note 14 of the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding provisions.

73


Share-based payments
The estimation of share-based payment fair value and expense requires the selection of an appropriate pricing model.
The model used by the Company for stock options and SAR awards is the Black-Scholes pricing model. The Black-Scholes model requires the Company to make significant judgments regarding the assumptions used within the model, the most significant of which are the expected volatility of the Company’s own common shares, the probable life of awards granted, the time of exercise, the risk-free interest rate commensurate with the term of the awards, and the expected dividend yield.
The model used by the Company for PSU awards subject to a market performance condition is the Monte Carlo simulation model. The Monte Carlo model requires the Company to make significant judgments regarding the assumptions used within the model, the most significant of which are the volatility of the Company’s own common shares as well as those of a peer group, the performance measurement period, and the risk-free interest rate commensurate with the term of the awards. For PSU awards subject to a non-market performance condition, management estimates the expected achievement of performance criteria using long range forecasting models.
Refer to Note 16 of the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding share-based payments.
Business acquisitions
Management uses various valuation techniques when determining the fair values of certain assets and liabilities acquired in a business combination. Refer to Note 17 of the Company’s Financial Statements for more information regarding business acquisitions.
New Standards adopted as of January 1, 2018
IFRS 15 – Revenue from Contracts with Customers replaces IAS 18 – Revenue, IAS 11 – Construction Contracts and some revenue related interpretations. IFRS 15 established a new control-based revenue recognition model, changed the basis for deciding when revenue is recognized at a point in time or over time, provided new and more detailed guidance on specific topics and expanded and improved disclosures about revenue. IFRS 15 is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2018 and the Company adopted it as of this date. Management chose the modified retrospective method of adoption, and as a result, the 2017 comparative period has not been restated to conform to the new IFRS 15 requirements. There was no material impact to the Company’s financial statements as a result of adopting IFRS 15. The Company's accounting policy with respect to revenue recognition and additional disclosure relative to IFRS 15 are explained in the accounting policies below.
The Company adopted IFRS 9 (2013) - Financial Instruments effective January 1, 2015. IFRS 9 (2014) - Financial Instruments differs in some regards from IFRS 9 (2013). IFRS 9 (2014) includes updated guidance on the classification and measurement of financial assets. The final standard also amended the impairment model by introducing a new expected credit loss model for calculating impairment. The mandatory effective date of IFRS 9 (2014) is for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2018 and must be applied retrospectively with some exceptions. The Company adopted IFRS 9 (2014) on January 1, 2018 and the new guidance resulted in enhancements to the Company's model that calculates the allowance for doubtful accounts on trade receivables for expected credit losses. There was no material impact to the Company’s financial statements as a result of adopting IFRS 9 (2014) and the 2017 comparative period has not been restated. The Company's accounting policy with respect to the allowance for doubtful accounts on trade receivables for expected credit losses are explained in the accounting policies below.
In the current year, the Company has applied a number of other amendments to IFRS Standards and Interpretations issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) that are effective for an annual period that begins on or after January 1, 2018. Their adoption has not had any material impact on the disclosures or on the amounts reported in these financial statements.
New Standards and Interpretations Issued but Not Yet Effective
As of the date of authorization of the Company’s Financial Statements, certain new standards, amendments and interpretations, and improvements to existing standards have been published by the IASB but are not yet effective and have not been adopted early by the Company. Management anticipates that all the relevant pronouncements will be adopted in the first reporting period following the date of application. Information on new standards, amendments and interpretations, and improvements to existing standards, which could potentially impact the Company’s Financial Statements, are detailed as follows:

74


IFRS 16 - Leases, which will replace IAS 17 - Leases, introduces a comprehensive model for the identification of lease arrangements and accounting treatments for both lessors and lessees, as well as new disclosure requirements. It will result in most leases being recognized on the balance sheet by lessees as lease liabilities with a corresponding right-of-use asset. IFRS 16 is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2019. The Company will adopt IFRS 16 effective January 1, 2019 (hereafter "the initial application date"). The Company is acting as a lessee for its leases. Management has performed a review of the new guidance as compared to the Company's current accounting policies, including a review of the various practical expedients and other elections available under the new guidance, an analysis of the Company's significant existing leases for treatment under the new guidance and an analysis estimating the potential impact on the financial statements. The Company is using the modified retrospective approach for transition and as a result, the Company's 2018 financial statements will not be restated. Accordingly, the Company will make use of the practical expedient available on transition to IFRS 16 not to reassess whether a contract is or contains a lease and the definition of a lease in accordance with IAS 17 and IFRIC 4 will continue to apply to those leases entered or modified before January 1, 2019. The Company will apply recognition exemptions across its complete portfolio of leased assets for short-term leases and leases of low value items. Furthermore, the Company will use certain relevant practical expedients available under the modified retrospective approach. Specifically, these include (i) applying a single discount rate to a portfolio of leases with reasonably similar characteristics, (ii) relying on the assessment of whether leases are onerous applying IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets immediately before the date of initial application as an alternative to performing an impairment review, (iii) excluding leases for which the lease term ends within 12 months of the date of initial application, (iv) excluding initial direct costs from the measurement of the right-of-use asset at the date of initial application, and (v) using hindsight, such as in determining the lease term if the contract contains options to extend or terminate the lease.
The discount rates are based on market rates as of January 1, 2019 for a BB- rated industrial company issuing debt for maturities ranging from 3 months to 10 years. As of December 31, 2018, the Company has non-cancellable operating lease commitments of $35.5 million. Of these commitments, approximately $2.3 million relate to short-term and low value leases which will be recognized on a straight-line basis as expense in earnings. The adoption of this new guidance will result in changes to the balance sheet, including (i) the recognition of approximately $31.1 million in right-of-use assets included in property, plant and equipment, (ii) the recognition of approximately $31.5 million in lease liabilities included in borrowings, current and non-current, (iii) decrease of approximately $0.1 million in accounts payable and accrued liabilities and (iv) decrease of approximately $0.3 million in other liabilities.

Based on the Company's current portfolio of leases, management expects:

an increase in cash flows from operating activities and a decrease in cash flows from financing activities, as operating lease payments will be reclassified to financing cash flows as components of interest and lease obligations;
an insignificant change to net earnings and adjusted net earnings, but with reclassification of amounts between costs within operating profit and finance costs as operating lease costs are reclassified into amortization of the right-of-use asset and interest expense on the related lease obligation and
an increase in adjusted EBITDA, as operating lease rent expense will be classified as amortization of the right-of-use asset and interest expense on the related lease obligation, both of which are items excluded from the non-GAAP measure. For the year ended December 31, 2018, rent expense included in adjusted EBITDA was $4.6 million related to operating leases that will be accounted for as right-of-use assets as of January 1, 2019.
On March 29, 2018, the IASB issued its revised Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting ("Conceptual Framework"). This replaces the previous version of the Conceptual Framework issued in 2010. The revised Conceptual Framework will be effective on January 1, 2020. Management is currently assessing but has not yet determined the impact of this new standard on the Company’s financial statements.
Certain other new standards and interpretations have been issued but are not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
In accordance with the Canadian Securities Administrators National Instrument 52-109, "Certification of Disclosure in Issuers’ Annual and Interim Filings" ("NI 52-109"), the Company has filed interim certificates signed by the Chief Executive Officer ("CEO") and the CFO that, among other things, report on the design of disclosure controls and procedures and design of internal control over financial reporting. With regards to the annual certification requirements of NI 52-109, the Company relies on the statutory exemption contained in section 8.1 of NI 52-109, which allows it to file with the Canadian securities regulatory authorities the certificates required under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 at the same time such certificates are required to be filed in the United States of America.

75


Internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of the Company’s financial reporting and its compliance with GAAP (as derived in accordance with IFRS) in its consolidated financial statements. The CEO and CFO of the Company have evaluated whether there were changes to the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the Company’s most recent interim period that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. As a result of the Polyair Acquisition on August 3, 2018, the internal control over financial reporting utilized by the Company prior to the acquisition became the internal control over financial reporting of Polyair, and the Company is currently in the process of evaluating and integrating Polyair's historical internal controls over financial reporting with the Company's. During the three months ended December 31, 2018, other than continuing changes to internal control processes resulting from the Polyair Acquisition, there have been no material changes to the Company's internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Management’s assessment of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 did not include the Polyair Acquisition consummated during fiscal year 2018. Polyair is included in the Company’s Financial Statements and represents 18% of total assets as of December 31, 2018 and 5% of revenues for the year then ended. Subject to the foregoing, the CEO and CFO have concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 was effective.
All internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations. Therefore, even those systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to financial statement preparation and presentation. Because of its inherent limitation, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.


76


Item 6:
Directors, Senior Management and Employees
 
 
A.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
Directors
The following table sets forth the name, residence, position, and principal occupations for the last five (5) years of each Director of the Company as of the date hereof, as well as the year during which each Director was first elected. Each Director is elected for a term of one year and may be nominated for re-election at the Company’s following annual shareholders’ meeting. The next annual shareholders’ meeting is scheduled to be held on June 6, 2019, at which time the current term of each Director will expire.
Name and
City of Residence
Position and Occupation
First Year as
Director
Robert M. Beil
Phoenix, Arizona
Director
 
Retired, September 2006
 
Sales, Marketing, Business and Executive Management, The Dow Chemical Company, 1975 to 2006
2007
Frank Di Tomaso, FCPA, FCA, ICD.D
Montreal, Quebec, Canada
Director
 
Director, Birks Group Inc.
(1) (designer, manufacturer and retailer of jewelry, timepieces, silverware and gifts), 2014 to present
 
Director, National Bank Trust (asset management and trust services firm), 2012 to present
 
Director, National Bank Life Assurance Company, 2012 to present
 
Director, Yorbeau Resources Inc. (gold exploration company), 2011 to 2016
 
Director, ADF Group Inc.
(1) (complex structural steel and heavy built-up steel components for the non-residential construction industry), 2015 to present
 
Director, Laurentian Pilotage Authority (regulates operations of pilotage services on the St. Lawrence River), 2011 to present
 
Director, Redline Communications Group Inc. (wireless communications network designer and manufacturer), 2010 to 2013
2014
Robert J. Foster
Toronto, Ontario, Canada
Director
 
Chief Executive Officer and President, Capital Canada Limited (investment banking firm), 1977 to present
2010
James Pantelidis
Toronto, Ontario, Canada
Chairman of the Board of Directors (2)
 
Director and Chairman of the Board of Parkland Fuel Corporation (1) (distributor and marketer of fuels and lubricants), 1999 to present

Chairman of the Supply and Development Committee of Parkland Fuel Corporation, 2009 to present
 
Director and Chairman of the Board of EnerCare Inc. (1) (home services company), 2002 to 2018
 
Director and Chairman of Human Resources Committee of RONA Inc. (retailer and distributor of hardware, building materials and home renovation products), 2004 to 2016
 
Director, Chairman of the Investment Committee, and Member of the Human Resources and Compensation Committee, Industrial Alliance Insurance and Financial Services Inc. (insurance company), 2002 to 2016
2012

77


Name and
City of Residence
Position and Occupation
First Year as
Director
Jorge N. Quintas
Porto, Portugal
Director
 
President, Nelson Quintas SGPS, SA (manufacturer of electrical and telecommunication cables), 2009 to present
2009
Mary Pat Salomone
Naples, Florida
Director
 
Director, Herc Holdings Inc. (1) (rental company), 2016 to present
 
Director, TransCanada Corporation (1) (energy infrastructure company), 2013 to present
 
Director, TransCanada Pipelines Limited (1) (energy infrastructure company), 2013 to present
 
Senior Vice President and COO, The Babcock & Wilcox Company (power generation systems and specialty manufacturer of nuclear components company), 2010 to 2013
2015
Gregory A.C. Yull
Sarasota, Florida
Director
 
CEO and President of the Company, 2010 to present
 
President Tapes and Films Division of the Company, 2008 to 2010
 
Executive Vice President, Industrial Business Unit for Tapes and Films, 2004 to 2008
2010
Melbourne F. Yull
Sarasota, Florida
Director
 
Executive Director through June 8, 2010
 
Retired, 2006 to 2007
 
Prior thereto he was Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer of the Company, 1981 to 2006
 
Father of Gregory A.C. Yull
1989-2006
2007
(1) 
A publicly traded company.
(2) 
On June 7, 2018, the Board of Directors appointed Mr. James Pantelidis as the new Chairman of the Board following the retirement of the former Chairman, Mr. George J. Bunze.
Senior Management
The following table sets forth the name, residence and position of each member of senior management of the Company as of the date hereof, as well as the year during which each was first elected.
 
Name and City of
Residence
Position and Occupation
First Elected
To Office
Gregory A.C. Yull
Sarasota, Florida
Chief Executive Officer & President
2010
Jeffrey Crystal, CPA, CA
Sarasota, Florida
Chief Financial Officer
2014
Douglas Nalette (1)
Longboat Key, Florida
Senior Vice President, Operations
2006
Shawn Nelson (1)
Bradenton, Florida
Senior Vice President, Sales
2010
Joseph Tocci (1)
Bradenton, Florida
Senior Vice President, Global Sourcing and Supply Chain
2013
 
(1) 
Officer of Intertape Polymer Corp., a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company

78


The principal occupation of each member of senior management for the last five (5) years is as follows:
Gregory A.C. Yull was appointed Chief Executive Officer and President on June 8, 2010. He was President, Tapes & Films, from 2008 to June 2010. Gregory A.C. Yull is a son of Melbourne F. Yull.
Jeffrey Crystal was appointed Chief Financial Officer on May 9, 2014. Prior to that, he served as Vice President of Finance of Primo International since December 2013. Prior to that, he served as Chief Financial Officer of American Iron & Metal from June 2008 to February 2013.
Douglas Nalette was appointed Senior Vice President Operations in 2006.
Shawn Nelson was appointed Senior Vice President Sales in 2010. Prior to that, he served as Senior Vice President Industrial Channel since 2006.
Joseph Tocci was appointed Senior Vice President of Global Sourcing and Supply Chain in 2013. Prior to that, he served as Senior Vice President of Corporate Marketing, Research & Development, and Supply Chain since 2012. Prior to that, he served as Senior Vice President of Corporate Marketing and Supply Chain since 2011. Prior to that, he served as Senior Vice President of Consumer and Supply Chain since 2008.
 
B.
COMPENSATION

Director Compensation
The following table sets forth the compensation paid, and benefits in kind granted, to directors for the last fiscal year for serving as directors of the Company, with the exception of Gregory A. C. Yull, who does not receive any compensation for serving as director being that he is an executive of the Company.
 
Annual Board and Committee Fees Earned
$
Allocation of Annual Fees(1)
 
 
Share-Based Awards
Name
DSUs(2)
$
Cash
$
Other
$
 
DSUs(3)
$
Robert M. Beil
65,000
65,000
 
112,061
George J. Bunze (4)
49,400
49,400
5,000
(5) 
Frank Di Tomaso
70,000
70,000
 
101,739
Robert J. Foster
70,000
70,000
 
128,407
James Pantelidis (6)
89,759
89,759
 
102,167
Jorge N. Quintas
57,000
57,000
 
122,147
Mary Pat Salomone
65,000
65,000
 
90,660
Melbourne F. Yull
59,000
59,000
260,935
(7) 
116,638

(1) 
Under the DSU Plan, directors are able to elect to receive 0%, 50% or 100% of their annual retainer in the form of DSUs.
(2) 
Amounts represent the grant date fair value of DSUs elected in lieu of cash for Board and Committee fees earned (see "Deferred Share Unit Plan" below for further details including number of shares issued).
(3) 
Amounts represent the grant date fair value of DSUs granted. Amounts presented include quarterly dividend grant. Amounts presented do not include DSUs elected in lieu of cash for semi-annual directors’ fees (see "Deferred Share Unit Plan" below for further details including number of shares issued).
(4) 
Mr. Bunze retired from the Board in June, 2018.
(5) 
Represents amounts paid with respect to a service award.
(6) 
On June 7, 2018, the Board of Directors appointed Mr. James Pantelidis as the new Chairman of the Board following the retirement of the former Chairman, Mr. George J. Bunze.
(7) 
Mr. Yull receives a pension from the Company (see “Pension and Other Post-Retirement Benefit Plans” below).    


79


Senior Management Compensation
The following table sets forth the compensation paid, and benefits in kind granted, to senior management for the last fiscal year for services in all capacities to the Company, including contingent and deferred compensation (also see "US Deferred Compensation" below for additional details).
 
 
Annual Compensation
 
Share-based Awards
 
Option-based Awards (5)
$
Name 
 
Salary (1)
$
 
Bonus
$
 
Other
$
 
Performance
Share Units
(2)
$
PSU Dividend Equivalent Settled (3) 
$
Restricted Share Units (4)
$
 
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
799,575
 
757,417
 
36,513
(6) 
1,012,937
116,736

462,473
 
462,916
Jeffrey Crystal
 
445,678
 
316,082
 
8,824
(7) 
232,705
32,880

106,243
 
106,237
Douglas Nalette
 
379,561
 
175,987
 
 
123,203
24,000

56,249
 
56,243
Shawn Nelson
 
361,396
 
167,534
 
 
123,203
24,000

56,249
 
56,243
Joseph Tocci
 
338,154
 
156,550
 
 
123,203
16,656

56,249
 
56,243
 
(1) 
Represents amounts included in each executive’s W-2, rather than the base salary amount.
(2) 
Amounts represent the grant date fair value of PSUs granted (see "Performance and Restricted Share Unit Plan" below for further details including number of awards issued).
(3) 
Amounts represent the lump-sum cash payment equal to the product that results from multiplying the number of settled PSUs by the amount of cash dividends per common share declared and paid by the Company from the date of grant of the PSUs to the settlement date (see "Performance and Restricted Share Unit Plan" below for further details including number of awards issued).
(4) 
Amounts represent the grant date fair value of RSUs granted (see "Performance and Restricted Share Unit Plan" below for further details including number of awards issued).
(5) 
Amounts represent the grant date fair value of stock options granted. In accordance with the TSX rules, no further grants of stock options have been made under the ESOP since June 4, 2018, the date on which the ESOP has elapsed. (see "Executive Stock Option Plan" below for further details including number of awards issued).
(6) 
Represents amounts paid related to an auto allowance and club membership pursuant to the terms of Mr. Yull’s employment agreement.
(7) 
Represents amounts paid related to a club membership, pursuant to the terms of Mr. Crystal's employment agreement.

US Deferred Compensation

In the US, the Company provides a deferred compensation plan to certain employees, including the members of senior management. Earnings and losses on the deferral and amounts due to the participants are payable based on participant elections. Assets are held in a Rabbi trust and are composed of corporate owned life insurance policies. Participant investment selections are used to direct the allocation of funds underlying the corporate owned life insurance policies. The following table sets out the eligible compensation deferred in 2018 and the accumulated value as of December 31, 2018 for each member of senior management.
Name
 
Compensation Deferred in 2018
$
 
Accumulated Value at Year End
$
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
476,406

 
513,841

Jeffrey Crystal
 
296,166

 
331,550

Douglas Nalette
 

 

Shawn Nelson
 

 

Joseph Tocci
 
157,653

 
229,350

2018 Senior Management Bonus Plan
Each of the members of senior management received a performance bonus for 2018. Bonuses were paid based on the level of achievement of financial objectives of the Company. The Company attributes to each executive, depending on his or her management level, a bonus target level set as a percentage of his or her salary, representing the amount that will be paid if all objectives are achieved according to the targets set. Actual bonuses may vary between zero and 200% of the target bonus, based on the level of achievement of the predetermined objectives set out at the beginning of the fiscal year. The objectives and weight attached thereto are re-evaluated on an annual basis by the Human Resources and Compensation Committee of the Board of

80


Directors and communicated to the relevant individuals. The Human Resources and Compensation Committee has discretion to adjust bonus payments upwards or downwards to ensure that payouts are aligned with the Company's performance and reflect the level of risk undertaken to achieve results.

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018, the bonuses were based on the Company achieving certain target amounts for:
(i)     Compensation Adjusted EBITDA, which the Human Resources and Compensation Committee defines as Adjusted EBITDA excluding: (i) performance bonus expense; and (ii) the positive or negative impact on Adjusted EBITDA of the Polyair and Maiweave acquisitions in the current year. The Company defines Adjusted EBITDA as net earnings (loss) before: (i) interest and other finance costs (income); (ii) income tax expense (benefit); (iii) amortization of intangible assets; (iv) depreciation of property, plant and equipment; (v) manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges (recoveries); (vi) advisory fees and other costs associated with mergers and acquisitions activity, including due diligence, integration and certain non-cash purchase price accounting adjustments ("M&A Costs"); (vii) share-based compensation expense (benefit); (viii) impairment of goodwill; (ix) impairment (reversal of impairment) of long-lived assets and other assets; (x) write-down on assets classified as held-for-sale; (xi) (gain) loss on disposal of property, plant, and equipment; and (xii) other discrete items as disclosed; and
(ii)    Compensation Cash Flows, which the Human Resources and Compensation Committee defines as cash flows from operating activities excluding: (i) the cash flows from operating activities of the Polyair and Maiweave acquisitions in the current year; (ii) M&A Costs paid in the current year excluding certain costs associated with planned acquisition integration activities; (iii) discretionary contribution to US defined benefit pension plans made in the current year and (iv) the income tax effect of these items.
At the Human Resources and Compensation Committee’s recommendation, the Board of Directors elected to use Compensation Adjusted EBITDA and Compensation Cash Flows in determining bonuses for 2018 because certain expenses and charges expected (at the time of the Board’s election) to be incurred by the Company during the year (e.g., M&A Costs and manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges) were viewed to be in the long term interest of the Company and that such amounts should not impact the ability of senior management to achieve the performance bonus targets.
The target amount for Compensation Adjusted EBITDA for 2018 was set at $144,400,000 (the “Compensation Adjusted EBITDA Target”) and the target amount for Compensation Cash Flows for 2018 was set at $101,000,000 (the “Compensation Cash Flows Target”). The Company’s actual Compensation Adjusted EBITDA for 2018 was $140,859,000 which was 97.5% of the Compensation Adjusted EBITDA Target. The Company’s actual Compensation Cash Flows for 2018 was $105,501,000 which was 104.5% of the Compensation Cash Flows Target.
The following table presents the target incentive compensation as a percentage of salary, the indicators used in 2018 to measure the Company’s performance for purposes of the short-term incentive compensation program and their relative weight.
 
 
Gregory
A.C. Yull
 
Jeffrey
Crystal
 
Douglas
Nalette
 
Shawn Nelson
 
Joseph
Tocci
2018 Annual Eligible Base Salary
 
$
810,000

 
$
448,050

 
$
382,561

 
$
364,186

 
$
340,305

Incentive compensation as a percentage of salary:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Minimum
 
0
%
 
0
%
 
0
%
 
0
%
 
0
%
Target
 
100
%
 
75
%
 
50
%
 
50
%
 
50
%
Maximum
 
200
%
 
150
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
Relative weight of financial indicators:
Compensation Adjusted EBITDA
 
75
%
 
75
%
 
75
%
 
75
%
 
75
%
Compensation Cash Flows
 
25
%
 
25
%
 
25
%
 
25
%
 
25
%
Total
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%

81


The bonus is calculated using, for each of the Compensation Adjusted EBITDA and Compensation Cash Flows objectives, the following formula and is equal to the sum of all results:
Annual Eligible Base salary at target
  
X
  
Bonus percentage (as determined based on the Company's performance relative to the applicable objective’s target and as capped by the applicable maximum)
  
X
  
Weight of financial indicator
For purposes of the above calculation, bonus percentage is between 50% and 100% if between approximately 90% and 100% of the target objectives were achieved by the Company, respectively. For achievement between 90% and 100%, the bonus percentage is interpolated between 50% and 100%. The Company's actual Compensation Adjusted EBITDA for 2018 yielded a bonus percentage of 86.4%. For achievement above 100%, the bonus percentage is capped at 100% for purposes of calculating the bonuses for each of the Compensation Adjusted EBITDA and Compensation Cash Flows objectives but such achievement triggers respective additional “reach” bonuses described below.
The members of senior management were also eligible for an additional bonus calculated using a Compensation Adjusted EBITDA target amount of $157,400,000 (the “Reach Adjusted EBITDA Target”). This additional bonus is calculated using the following formula (note that the fraction below is capped by the applicable maximum (i.e., it cannot exceed 1)): 
Actual Compensation Adjusted EBITDA – Compensation Adjusted EBITDA Target
  
X
  
Maximum bonus amount –
Target bonus amount
  
X
  
Weight of financial indicator
Reach Adjusted EBITDA Target – Compensation Adjusted EBITDA Target
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
The members of senior management were also eligible for an additional bonus calculated using a Compensation Cash Flows target amount of $110,000,000 (the “Reach Cash Flows Target”). This additional bonus is calculated using the following formula (note that the fraction below is capped by the applicable maximum (i.e., it cannot exceed 1)):
Actual Compensation Cash Flows – Compensation Cash Flows Target
  
X
  
Maximum bonus amount –
Target bonus amount
  
X
  
Weight of financial indicator
Reach Cash Flows Target – Compensation Cash Flows Target
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
The following table presents the target objectives for 2018 approved by the Board of Directors and the results achieved by the Company.
 
 
Target
 
Actual
 
Evaluation of
Performance
 
 
$
 
$
 
%
Compensation Adjusted EBITDA
 
144,400,000

 
140,859,000

 
97.5
Compensation Cash Flows
 
101,000,000

 
105,501,000

 
104.5
Reach Adjusted EBITDA
 
157,400,000

 
140,859,000

 
89.5
Reach Cash Flows
 
110,000,000

 
105,501,000

 
95.9
The following table presents, for each target objective, the bonus amount earned by each member of senior management for 2018.
 
 
Gregory
A.C. Yull
 
Jeffrey
Crystal
 
Douglas
Nalette
 
Shawn Nelson
 
Joseph
Tocci
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Compensation Adjusted EBITDA
 
524,769

 
217,706

 
123,923

 
117,971

 
110,236

Compensation Cash Flows
 
202,500

 
84,009

 
47,820

 
45,523

 
42,538

Reach Adjusted EBITDA
 

 

 

 

 

Reach Cash Flows
 
101,262

 
42,010

 
23,913

 
22,764

 
21,272

Bonus Correction (1)
 
(71,114
)
 
(27,643
)
 
(19,669
)
 
(18,724
)
 
(17,496
)
Total
 
757,417

 
316,082

 
175,987

 
167,534

 
156,550

(1)    Represents correction of the computation of Compensation Cash Flows for 2017.

82


Incentive Plan Awards    
Performance and Restricted Share Unit Plan (formerly known as the Performance Share Unit Plan)
On March 7th, 2018, the Board of Directors approved the addition of RSUs as an available award type under the PSU and RSU Plan.
The purpose of the PSU and RSU Plan is to provide participants with a proprietary interest in the Company to: (a) increase the incentives of those participants who share primary responsibility for the management, growth and protection of the business of the Company; (b) furnish an incentive to such participants to continue their services for the Company; and (c) provide a means through which the Company may attract potential employees. The PSU and RSU Plan is administered by the Human Resources and Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of the Company and authorizes the Company to award PSUs and RSUs to eligible persons.
A PSU, as defined by the PSU and RSU Plan, represents the right of a participant, once such PSU is earned and has vested in accordance with the PSU and RSU Plan, to receive a cash payment equal to the VWAP of the Company's shares on the TSX for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding the day of settlement.
The number of PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017 which will be eligible to vest can range from 0% to 150% of the Target Shares ("Target Shares" reflects 100% of the PSUs granted) based on the Company's total shareholder return ("TSR") ranking relative to a self-selected peer group of companies ("Peer Group") over the measurement period as outlined in the following table. Further, first quartile means the top performing quartile and fourth quartile means the bottom performing quartile.
TSR Ranking Relative to the Peer Group
Percent of Target Shares Vested
First Quartile TSR ranking
150
%
Second Quartile TSR ranking
100
%
Third Quartile TSR ranking
50
%
Fourth Quartile TSR ranking
0
%
The number of PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017 which will be eligible to vest can range from 0% to 175% of the Target Shares as determined by multiplying the number of PSUs awarded by the adjustment factors as follows:
50% based on the Company's TSR relative to the Peer Group over the measurement period as set out in the table below.
50% based on the average return on invested capital over the measurement period (the “ROIC Performance”) as set out in the table below.

The relative TSR performance adjustment factor is determined as follows:
TSR Ranking Relative to the Peer Group
Percent of Target Shares Vested
Less than the 25th percentile
0
%
25th percentile
50
%
50th percentile
100
%
75th percentile
150
%
90th percentile or higher
200
%

83



The ROIC Performance adjustment factor is determined as follows:
ROIC Performance
Percent of Target Shares Vested
1st Tier
0
%
2nd Tier
50
%
3rd Tier
100
%
4th Tier
150
%
A RSU, as defined by the PSU and RSU Plan, represents the right of a participant, once such RSU is earned and has vested in accordance with the PSU and RSU Plan, to receive a cash payment equal to the VWAP of the Company's shares on the TSX for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding the day of settlement. The fair value of RSUs is calculated based on the VWAP of the Company's shares on the TSX for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding the reporting period end date. Changes in the fair value of the liability will be reflected in SG&A.
On February 17, 2017, the Board of Directors approved amendments to the PSU and RSU Plan to provide for only cash settlement of PSU awards. As a result of the amendment, prospectively and until award settlement, the Company will remeasure the fair value of the awards at each reporting period end date and present the cash-settled awards as a liability within the Company’s consolidated balance sheet under the caption share-based compensation liabilities, current, for amounts expected to settle in the next twelve months and share-based compensation liabilities, non-current, for amounts expected to settle in more than twelve months. PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017 are subject to a market performance condition as well as a time-based vesting condition. Accordingly, the fair value of PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017 is based on the Monte Carlo valuation model at each reporting period end date. PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017 are subject to a market (50 percent) and non-market performance condition (50 percent) as well as a time-based vesting condition. Accordingly, the fair value of PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017 is based 50 percent on the Monte Carlo valuation model at each reporting period end date and 50 percent on the Company's VWAP of common shares on the TSX for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding the reporting period end multiplied by the number of PSUs expected to vest based on estimated achievement of non-market performance criteria at the reporting period end. Expense is recognized over the vesting period. Changes in the fair value of the liability will be reflected in SG&A. Prior to the amendment, PSUs were to be settled in common shares of the Company. The expense was based on the grant date fair value of the awards expected to vest over the vesting period with a corresponding adjustment through contributed surplus.
Additionally, the PSU and RSU Plan provides that, as soon as reasonably practicable following the settlement date, the Company or a subsidiary will make a lump-sum cash payment to an executive officer or employee, net of any withholdings, in an amount equal to the product that results from multiplying the number of settled PSUs and RSUs by the amount of cash dividends per common share declared and paid by the Company from the date of grant of the PSUs and RSUs to such executive officer or employee to the settlement date.
The performance and vesting period for PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017, is the period from the date of grant through the third anniversary of the date of grant. The PSUs are expensed over the vesting period, unless vesting is accelerated based on retirement eligibility, death or disability.
For PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017, the performance period is the period from January 1st in the year of grant through December 31st of the third calendar year following the date of grant. The PSUs are expensed over the vesting period beginning from the date of grant through February 15th of the fourth calendar year following the date of grant, unless vesting is accelerated based on retirement eligibility, death or disability.
RSUs are expensed over the vesting period beginning from the date of grant through February 15th of the fourth calendar year following the date of grant, unless vesting is accelerated based on retirement eligibility, death or disability. No RSUs were granted or outstanding as of December 31, 2017.
    

84


PSU Grants During the Most Recently Completed Fiscal Year
The following table sets out the details of all PSU grants to the members of senior management during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018. 
Name
 
PSU Awards
granted
 
% of total PSU
awards granted in
fiscal year
 
Market value on
date of grant
CDN$(1)
 
Expiration date
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
56,779
 
20%
 
$23.29
 
12/31/2021
Jeffrey Crystal
 
13,044
 
5%
 
$23.29
 
12/31/2021
Douglas Nalette
 
6,906
 
2%
 
$23.29
 
12/31/2021
Shawn Nelson
 
6,906
 
2%
 
$23.29
 
12/31/2021
Joseph Tocci
 
6,906
 
2%
 
$23.29
 
12/31/2021
(1) 
The base value (or grant date fair value) of a PSU is based 50% on the VWAP of the common shares of the Company on the TSX for the five trading days preceding the grant date (CDN$21.22, USD$16.29) and 50% on an estimated value derived using the Monte Carlo simulation model implemented in a risk-neutral framework considering the following assumptions:
PSU Grant Date
 
March 21, 2018
Grant recipient
 
All NEOs above
Performance period starting price
 
CDN$21.13
Valuation date stock price
 
CDN$20.59
Estimated dividend yield
 
0%
US risk-free interest rate
 
2.43%
Canadian risk-free interest rate
 
1.96%
Estimated volatility
 
30%
Term
 
3 years
Result
 
CDN$25.36
 
 
(USD$19.39)
Year-End Unvested PSU Awards and Values
The following table sets out for each of the members of senior management the total number of unvested PSU awards held as of December 31, 2018 and the value of such unvested awards at that date.
Name
Number of PSUs at fiscal
year-end
 
Number of PSUs adjusted for TSR at fiscal year end(1)
 
Value of PSUs at fiscal year-end CDN$ (2)
 
Unvested
 
Unvested
 
Unvested
Gregory A.C. Yull
255,979
 
148,680
 
2,462,137
Jeffrey Crystal
62,440
 
39,438
 
653,089
Douglas Nalette
33,142
 
20,922
 
346,465
Shawn Nelson
33,142
 
20,922
 
346,465
Joseph Tocci
30,934
 
19,818
 
328,182
 

85


(1) 
The final number of PSUs that vest will range from 0% to 175% of the initial number awarded based on predetermined performance criteria. Based on the Company’s performance as of December 31, 2018, the number of PSUs earned if all of the outstanding awards were to be settled at December 31, 2018, would be as follows:
Grant Date
% of Target Shares
March 21, 2016
50
%
December 20, 2016
%
March 20, 2017
50
%
March 21, 2018
113
%
(2) 
The fair value of the PSUs is based on the five-day VWAP of the common shares of the Company on the TSX on December 31, 2018 (CDN$ 16.56).

RSU Grants During the Most Recently Completed Fiscal Year
The following table sets out the details of all RSU grants to the members of senior management during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018. 
Name
 
RSU Awards
granted
 
% of total RSU
awards granted in
fiscal year
 
Market value on
date of grant
CDN$
(1)
 
Expiration date
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
28,390
 
25%
 
$21.22
 
12/31/2021
Jeffrey Crystal
 
6,522
 
6%
 
$21.22
 
12/31/2021
Douglas Nalette
 
3,453
 
3%
 
$21.22
 
12/31/2021
Shawn Nelson
 
3,453
 
3%
 
$21.22
 
12/31/2021
Joseph Tocci
 
3,453
 
3%
 
$21.22
 
12/31/2021
(1) 
The grant date fair value of a RSU is based on the VWAP of the common shares of the Company on the TSX for the five trading days preceding the grant date, March 21, 2018 (CDN$21.22, USD$16.29).
Year-End Unvested RSU Awards and Values
The following table sets out for each of the members of senior management the total number of unvested RSU awards held as of December 31, 2018 and the value of such unvested awards at that date. No RSUs were vested as of December 31, 2018.
Name
Number of RSUs at fiscal
year-end
 
Value of RSUs at fiscal year-end CDN$ (1)
Gregory A.C. Yull
28,390
 
470,138
Jeffrey Crystal
6,522
 
108,004
Douglas Nalette
3,453
 
57,182
Shawn Nelson
3,453
 
57,182
Joseph Tocci
3,453
 
57,182
(1) 
The fair value of the RSUs is based on the five-day VWAP of the common shares of the Company on the TSX on December 31, 2018 (CDN$ 16.56).
Deferred Share Unit Plan
The purpose of the DSU Plan is to provide participants with a form of compensation which promotes greater alignment of the interests of the participants and the shareholders of the Company in creating long-term shareholder value. The DSU Plan is administered by the Human Resources and Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of the Company and authorizes the Company to award DSUs to any member of the Board of Directors of the Company that is not an executive officer or employee of the Company. Under the DSU plan, each director may receive DSUs as a result of a grant and/or in lieu of cash for semi-annual directors’ fees. DSUs are settled when the director ceases to be a member of the Board of Directors of the Company.
A DSU, as defined by the Company’s DSU Plan, is a right that has a value equal to the VWAP of the shares on the TSX for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding the day of settlement.

86


On February 17, 2017, the Board of Directors approved amendments to the DSU Plan to provide for only cash settlement of DSU awards. As a result of the amendment, prospectively and until award settlement, the Company will remeasure the fair value of the awards on the amendment date and at each reporting period end date and present the cash-settled awards as a liability on the Company's consolidated balance sheet under the caption share-based compensation liabilities-current. Changes in the fair value of the liability are reflected in SG&A. Prior to the amendment, DSUs were to be settled in common shares of the Company and the expense was based on the grant date fair value of the awards with a corresponding adjustment through contributed surplus.
DSUs received in lieu of cash for directors’ fees are expensed as earned over the service period. DSUs received as a result of a grant are expensed immediately.
On September 10, 2018, the Board of Directors approved amendments to the DSU Plan in order to provide that the participants in the DSU Plan be also entitled to a dividend equivalent payment, payable in additional DSUs equal to the amount of dividends paid on Shares to which the DSUs held by them relate.
DSU Grants During the Most Recently Completed Fiscal Year
The following table sets out the details for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018 of all DSU grants to directors, including dividend equivalents and DSUs elected in lieu of cash by the directors for semi-annual director fees granted as of December 31, 2018.
Name
 
Grant date
 
DSU Awards
granted
 
% of total DSU
awards granted in
fiscal year
 
Market value on
date of grant
CDN$
 
Expiration 
date
Robert M. Beil
 
6/15/2018
 
5,172
 
7%
 
$18.81
 
n/a
 
 
10/11/2018
 
2,182
 
3%
 
$19.35
 
n/a
 
 
12/31/2018
 
310
 
—%
 
$16.48
 
n/a
George J. Bunze
 
3/16/2018
 
3,311
(1) 
5%
 
$21.76
 
n/a
Frank Di Tomaso
 
6/15/2018
 
5,172
 
7%
 
$18.81
 
n/a
 
 
10/11/2018
 
1,559
 
2%
 
$19.35
 
n/a
 
 
12/31/2018
 
243
 
—%
 
$16.48
 
n/a
Robert J. Foster
 
3/16/2018
 
2,033
(1) 
3%
 
$21.76
 
n/a
 
 
6/15/2018
 
5,172
 
7%
 
$18.81
 
n/a
 
 
10/11/2018
 
3,097
 
4%
 
$19.35
 
n/a
 
 
11/19/2018
 
2,448
(2) 
4%
 
$18.18
 
n/a
 
 
12/10/2018
 
2,657
(2) 
4%
 
$17.27
 
n/a
 
 
12/31/2018
 
506
 
1%
 
$16.48
 
n/a
James Pantelidis
 
6/15/2018
 
5,172
 
7%
 
$18.81
 
n/a
 
 
10/11/2018
 
1,587
 
2%
 
$19.35
 
n/a
 
 
12/31/2018
 
243
 
—%
 
$16.48
 
n/a
Jorge N. Quintas
 
3/16/2018
 
1,655
(1) 
2%
 
$21.76
 
n/a
 
 
6/15/2018
 
5,172
 
7%
 
$18.81
 
n/a
 
 
10/11/2018
 
2,733
 
4%
 
$19.35
 
n/a
 
 
11/19/2018
 
1,993
(2) 
3%
 
$18.18
 
n/a
 
 
12/10/2018
 
2,164
(2) 
3%
 
$17.27
 
n/a
 
 
12/31/2018
 
448
 
1%
 
$16.48
 
n/a
Mary Pat Salomone
 
6/15/2018
 
5,172
 
7%
 
$18.81
 
n/a
 
 
10/11/2018
 
876
 
1%
 
$19.35
 
n/a
 
 
12/31/2018
 
189
 
—%
 
$16.48
 
n/a
Melbourne F. Yull
 
6/15/2018
 
5,172
 
7%
 
$18.81
 
n/a
 
 
10/11/2018
 
2,466
 
4%
 
$19.35
 
n/a
 
 
12/31/2018
 
330
 
—%
 
$16.48
 
n/a

(1)    Represents grant of DSUs elected in lieu of cash for semi-annual directors’ fees earned in 2017.
(2)    Represents grant of DSUs elected in lieu of cash for semi-annual directors’ fees earned in 2018.


87


Year-End Vested DSU Awards

The following table sets out for each of the directors the total number of vested DSUs as of December 31, 2018 and the value of such vested DSUs at that date.
Name
 
Number of vested DSUs outstanding
at fiscal year-end
 
Value of vested DSUs outstanding
 CDN$
(1)
Robert M. Beil
 
27,201
 
450,449
George J. Bunze (2)
 
 
Frank Di Tomaso
 
21,285
 
352,480
Robert J. Foster
 
44,372
 
734,800
James Pantelidis
 
21,313
 
352,943
Jorge N. Quintas
 
39,315
 
651,056
Mary Pat Salomone
 
16,548
 
274,035
Melbourne F. Yull
 
28,959
 
479,561
 
(1) 
The value of vested DSUs is based on the five-day VWAP of the common shares of the Company on the TSX on December 31, 2018 (CDN$ 16.56).
(2) 
Mr. Bunze retired from the Board in June, 2018. Upon retirement, 37,668 DSUs were settled in cash for a total payment of $546,186.
Executive Stock Option Plan
The purpose of the Executive Stock Option Plan ("ESOP") is to promote a proprietary interest in the Company among the executives, key employees and consultants of the Company and its subsidiaries, in order to both encourage such persons to further the development of the Company and assist the Company in attracting and retaining key personnel necessary for the Company’s long-term success. The Board of Directors designates from time-to-time those persons to whom options are to be granted and determines the number of common shares subject to such options. Generally, participation is limited to persons holding positions that can have an impact on the Company’s long-term results.
The ESOP provides that the total number of common shares reserved for issuance thereunder is equal to 10% of the issued and outstanding common shares of the Company from time to time. The ESOP is considered to be an “evergreen” plan, because the number of common shares covered by options which have been exercised will be available for subsequent grants under the ESOP and the number of options available for grants increases as the number of issued and outstanding common shares of the Company increases. As such, under the rules of the TSX, a security-based arrangement such as the ESOP must, when initially put in place, receive shareholder approval at a duly-called meeting of shareholders and the unallocated options are subject to ratification by shareholders every three years thereafter. Shareholders last ratified unallocated options under the ESOP at an annual and special meeting of shareholders of the Company held on June 4, 2015. In accordance with the TSX rules, no further grants of stock options have been made under the ESOP since June 4, 2018, the date at on which the ESOP has elapsed (see "2019 ESOP" below for further details.)
The number of common shares to which the options relate is determined by taking into account, inter alia, the market value of the common shares and each optionee’s base salary.
The following is a description of certain features of the ESOP (for further details regarding the ESOP, please see Exhibit 4.1 to this Form 20-F):
 
options expire not later than ten years after the date of grant and, unless otherwise determined by the Board of Directors, all vested options under a particular grant expire 24 months after the vesting date of the last tranche of such grant;
options that are granted to directors who are not executive officers of the Corporation vest 25% on the date of grant, with another 25% vesting on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of the grant. Under the current amended plan, all other options granted vest as to one-third on each of the first, second and third anniversaries of the date of grant. Previously, the ESOP provided that such stock options granted, other than to directors who are not executives, vest 25% per year over four years;
the exercise price of the options is determined by the Board of Directors, but cannot be less than the “Market Value” of the common shares of the Company, defined in the ESOP as the closing price of the common shares on the TSX for the day immediately preceding the effective date of the grant; and

88


certain limitations exist on the number of options, common shares reserved for issuance, number of common shares issuable and the number of common shares issued to certain individuals over certain time periods.
As of December 31, 2018, there were options outstanding under the ESOP to purchase an aggregate of 1,009,793 common shares, representing 1.7% of the issued and outstanding common shares of the Company, and a total of 766,875 options exercisable.
Option Grants During the Most Recently Completed Fiscal Year
The following table sets out the details of all options granted to the members of senior management during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018. During 2018, there were no options granted to directors.
Name
 
Options granted
 
% of total options granted in fiscal year
 
Exercise Price CDN$
 
Market value on
date of grant
CDN$
(1)
 
Expiration date
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
117,194
 
48%
 
$21.76
 
$5.06
 
3/13/2028
Jeffrey Crystal
 
31,431
 
13%
 
$21.76
 
$4.33
 
3/13/2023
Douglas Nalette
 
16,640
 
7%
 
$21.76
 
$4.33
 
3/13/2023
Shawn Nelson
 
16,640
 
7%
 
$21.76
 
$4.33
 
3/13/2023
Joseph Tocci
 
16,640
 
7%
 
$21.76
 
$4.33
 
3/13/2023
(1) 
The grant date fair value of awards is estimated at the date of the grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions:
Option Grant Date
March 13, 2018
March 13, 2018
Grant recipient
All NEOs above except Gregory A.C. Yull
Gregory A. C. Yull
Stock price at grant date
CDN$21.76
CDN$21.76
Exercise price of awards
CDN$21.76
CDN$21.76
Expected dividends
3.3%
3.3%
Canadian risk-free interest rate
2.01%
2.10%
Estimated volatility
31%
33%
Expected life
4 years
5.6 years

89


Year-End Unexercised Options and Option Values
The following table sets out for each of the directors and members of senior management the total number of unexercised options held as of December 31, 2018 and the value of such unexercised options at that date.
Name
 
Number of unexercised options
at fiscal year-end
Exercisable / Unexercisable
 
Value of unexercised “in the money”
options
at fiscal year-end
Exercisable / Unexercisable CDN$ (1)
Robert M. Beil
 
10,000
 
 
48,800
 
George J. Bunze (2)
 
 
 
 
Frank Di Tomaso
 
 
 
 
Robert J. Foster
 
10,000
 
 
48,800
 
James Pantelidis
 
10,000
 
 
48,800
 
Jorge N. Quintas
 
 
 
 
Mary Pat Salomone
 
 
 
 
Melbourne F. Yull
 
 
 
 
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
320,000
 
117,194
 
1,480,000
 
Jeffrey Crystal
 
32,500
 
31,431
 
155,350
 
Douglas Nalette
 
32,500
 
16,640
 
142,025
 
Shawn Nelson
 
82,500
 
16,640
 
386,025
 
Joseph Tocci
 
70,000
 
16,640
 
331,400
 

(1) 
The value of unexercised “in-the-money” options is calculated using the closing price of the common shares of the Company on the TSX on December 31, 2018 (CDN$ 16.92) less the respective exercise prices of the options.
(2) 
Mr. Bunze retired from the Board in June, 2018. Upon retirement, 10,000 stock options with an exercise price of CDN$12.04 were exercised.

2019 ESOP

On March 12, 2019, the Board of Directors adopted the 2019 ESOP. Accordingly, at the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on June 6, 2019 (the “Meeting”), shareholders will be asked to consider and if deemed advisable, to approve with or without variation, an ordinary resolution (the “2019 ESOP Resolution”) approving the 2019 ESOP, as required by the TSX. The text of the 2019 ESOP Resolution will be annexed as Schedule B to the Circular for the Meeting.

In accordance with the rules of the TSX, in order to be adopted, the 2019 ESOP Resolution must be approved by a majority of the votes cast by the shareholders of the Company, either present in person or represented by proxy at the Meeting. If the 2019 ESOP Resolution is not passed at the Meeting, any stock options granted will be cancelled and no further grants of stock options will be made under the 2019 ESOP.

The purpose of the 2019 ESOP is to promote a proprietary interest in the Company among the executives, key employees and consultants of the Company and its subsidiaries, in order to both encourage such persons to further the development of the Company and assist the Company in attracting and retaining key personnel necessary for the Company’s long-term success. The Board of Directors designates from time-to-time those persons to whom options are to be granted and determines the number of common shares subject to such options. Generally, participation is limited to persons holding positions that can have an impact on the Company’s long-term results. The number of common shares to which the options relate is determined by taking into account, inter alia, the market value of the common shares and each optionee’s base salary.

The following is a description of certain features of the 2019 ESOP (for further details regarding the 2019 ESOP, please see Exhibit 4.10 to this Form 20-F):

the Board of Directors has the discretion to determine the vesting schedule of the options and the Board of Directors shall have the full power and authority to accelerate the vesting or exercisability of all or any portion of any option;
the exercise price of the option is determined by the Board of Directors, but shall not be less than the closing price of the common shares of the Company on the TSX for the day immediately preceding the effective date of the grant; and
certain limitations exist on the number of options, common shares reserved for issuance, number of common shares issuable and the number of common shares issued to certain individuals over certain time periods.

90


As of March 27, 2019, no stock options had been granted under the 2019 ESOP.

Stock Appreciation Rights Plan
The purpose of the Stock Appreciation Rights Plan is to: (a) promote a proprietary interest in the Company among its executives and directors; (b) encourage the Company’s executives and directors to further the Company’s development; and (c) attract and retain the key employees necessary for the Company’s long-term success. The Stock Appreciation Rights Plan is administered by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of the Company and authorizes the Company to award stock appreciation rights (“SARs”) to eligible persons. A SAR, as defined by the Company’s plan, is a right to receive a cash payment equal to the difference between the base price of the SAR and the market value of a common share of the Company on the date of exercise. These SARs can only be settled in cash and expire no later than 10 years after the date of the grant. The award agreements provide that these SARs granted to employees and executives will vest and may be exercisable 25% per year over four years. The SARs granted to directors, who are not officers of the Company, will vest and may be exercisable 25% on the grant date, and a further 25% will vest and may be exercisable per year over three years. No SARs were granted in 2018. No SARs were outstanding as of December 31, 2018.
Clawback Policy
In April 2014, the Board of Directors adopted a “clawback” policy, pursuant to which the Company may recoup from executive officers or employees of the Company and its subsidiaries, as the case may be, annual incentive bonuses, special bonuses, other incentive compensation and equity-based awards, whether vested or unvested, paid, issued or granted to them, in the event of fraud, restatement of the Company’s financial results, material errors or omissions in the Company’s financial statements, or other events as may be determined from time to time by the Board of Directors in its discretion. To-date, the Company has not been required to apply the "clawback" policy.
Pension and Other Post Retirement Benefit Plans
Melbourne F. Yull was Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer of the Company from January 11, 1995 to June 14, 2006. Prior thereto, Mr. Yull was the President and a Director of the Company or a predecessor thereof, from 1981. The former employment agreement entered into between the Company and Mr. Yull provides that Mr. Yull receive from the Company a defined benefit supplementary pension annually for life in an amount equal to 2% of the average of Mr. Yull’s annual gross salary for the final five years of his employment with the Company, multiplied by his years of service with the Company to retirement. Accordingly, Mr. Yull receives a pension from the Company in an amount of $260,935 per year. This pension was earned by Mr. Yull in his capacity as an executive of the Company, not as a Director of the Company.
Defined Contribution Pension Plans
The Company maintains defined contribution pension plans in the US and Canada. Each member of senior management participates in the “US Plan”. The US Plan is a defined contribution pension plan and qualifies as a deferred salary arrangement under section 401(k) of the US Internal Revenue Code. Under the US Plan, employees who have been employed for at least 90 days may defer a portion of their pre-tax earnings subject to statutory limitations. The Company may make discretionary contributions for the benefit of eligible employees. The US Plan permits eligible employees to choose how their account balances are invested on their behalf within a range of investment options provided by third-party fund managers. The following table sets out the Company’s contributions to the pension plan payable for 2018 for each member of senior management.
Name
 
Company
Contributions
$
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
9,900

Jeffrey Crystal
 
9,900

Douglas Nalette
 
9,900

Shawn Nelson
 
9,900

Joseph Tocci
 
9,900

Total Cash Payments
Total cash payments for employee future benefits for 2018, consisting of cash contributed by the Company to its defined benefit pension plans, cash payments directly to beneficiaries for its unfunded other benefit plans, cash contributed to its defined contribution plans and cash contributed to its multi-employer defined benefit plans, were $19.0 million ($8.4 million in 2017).

91


Executive Employment Contracts and Change of Control Agreements
The following agreements between the Company and members of senior management were in effect at the end of 2018.
The Company entered into “change of control, non-interference and confidentiality” agreements as of January 28, 2001 with Shawn Nelson, as of October 28, 2004 with Douglas Nalette, and as of September 8, 2006 with Joseph Tocci. These agreements include provisions regarding confidentiality, non-interference and non-solicitation covenants, and ownership of intellectual property, among other things. The non-interference and non-solicitation covenants survive for 12 months following the employee's voluntary termination of employment, provided however that if the employee resigns within six months after a Change of Control (as defined in such agreements), such covenants shall be null and void.
The “change of control, non-interference and confidentiality” agreements provide also that if, within a period of six months after a Change of Control of the Company: (a) the executive voluntarily terminates his employment with the Company; or (b) the Company terminates the executive’s employment without cause, such executive will be entitled to (i) severance equal to 12 months of such executive’s base salary at the effective date of such resignation or termination and 12 months of car allowance, if applicable, (ii) 12 months of continued health insurance coverage then in effect if permitted by its carrier and, if applicable, 12 months' use of the company car, and (iii) accelerated vesting of any unvested stock options.
Furthermore, without regard to whether the executive has terminated employment, these agreements also provide that if during the term of the executive’s employment a bona fide offer is made to all shareholders of the Company which, if accepted, would result in a change of control of the Company, then, subject to any applicable law, all of the executive’s stock options which have not yet become vested and exercisable shall become vested and exercisable immediately. Upon expiry of such bona fide offer, if it does not result in a change of control of the Company, all of the executive’s unexercised stock options which were not vested prior to such offer, shall immediately revert to their unvested status and to their former provisions with respect to the time of their vesting.
On August 2, 2010, the Company entered into an Executive Employment Agreement with Gregory A.C. Yull, as supplemented to date (the "Yull Agreement"). Pursuant to the terms of the Yull Agreement, Mr. Yull received an annual base salary of $450,000 which increased to $475,000 commencing June 1, 2011 and to $500,000 commencing on June 1, 2012. Also pursuant to the terms of the Yull Agreement, as of June 1, 2013 and thereafter, annual base salary adjustment has been and will be determined by the Board. Mr. Yull shall also be entitled to a performance bonus for each fiscal year ranging from zero to 100% of his then current annual base salary (zero to 150% effective beginning with the 2013 Senior Management Bonus Plan and zero to 200% effective beginning with the 2018 Senior Management Bonus Plan as resolved by the Board of Directors) based on the achievement of specific goals that are mutually agreed to between Mr. Yull and the Board. For 2018, Mr. Yull’s bonus was based on the Company achieving certain target amounts for Compensation Adjusted EBITDA Targets, Compensation Cash Flow Targets, Reach Adjusted EBITDA Targets and Reach Cash Flow Targets, as further described above in the Section entitled2018 Senior Management Bonus Plan”.
The Yull Agreement includes provisions regarding confidentiality, non-solicitation and non-compete covenants, and ownership of intellectual property, among other things. The non-compete and non-solicitation covenants survive for 12 months following termination of employment, provided however that in the event of a termination of employment resulting in severance being payable following termination other than for cause or resignation for Good Reason (as defined in the Yull Agreement) more than 24 months after a Change of Control (as defined in the Yull Agreement) as described below, the covenants survive for 24 months following termination of employment.
In the event the Company terminates Mr. Yull’s employment without Cause, or Mr. Yull terminates his employment for Good Reason (except as otherwise summarized in the next paragraph), Mr. Yull shall be entitled to receive a pro-rated performance bonus that he would have received in respect of the fiscal year in which the termination occurred, based upon the average performance bonus paid to Mr. Yull in the last two fiscal years and severance pay in an amount equal to two times the sum of his annual base salary and the average performance bonus paid to Mr. Yull in the last two fiscal years ending on the date prior to his date of termination. In addition, all unvested options that would otherwise vest during the 24 months following the date of termination shall be immediately vested and remain exercisable for a period of 12 months. Mr. Yull shall also be entitled to participate, at active employee rates, in the benefits under the Company's medical and dental benefit program for 24 months and will receive disability and life insurance benefits pursuant to any benefit plans and programs then provided by the Company generally to its executives for a period of 18 months following the date of termination. Lastly, the defined benefit supplemental pension summarized below shall vest.

92


In the event that the Company terminates Mr. Yull’s employment without Cause or Mr. Yull terminates his employment for Good Reason within two years of a Change of Control, then he shall be entitled to receive a pro-rated performance bonus that he would have received in respect of the fiscal year in which the termination occurred, based upon the average performance bonus paid to Mr. Yull in the last two fiscal years and severance pay in an amount equal to three times the sum of his annual base salary and the average performance bonus paid in the last two fiscal years immediately preceding the date of termination. In addition, all unvested stock options held by Mr. Yull that would otherwise vest during the 36 months following the date of termination shall immediately vest and remain exercisable for a period of 36 months following the date of termination. Mr. Yull shall also be entitled to participate, at active employee rates, in the benefits under the Company’s medical and dental benefit program for 36 months (or, if earlier, until such time as he reaches the age of eligibility for coverage under Medicare) and will receive disability and life insurance benefits pursuant to any benefit plans and programs then provided by the Company generally to its executives and continue for a period of 36 months following the date of termination. Lastly, the defined benefit supplemental pension summarized below shall vest.
Under the Yull Agreement, in the event that Mr. Yull’s employment is terminated as a result of his Permanent Disability, as defined in the Yull Agreement, or death, he shall be entitled to receive a pro-rated performance bonus that he would have received in respect of the fiscal year in which the termination occurred and all unvested stock options held by Mr. Yull shall immediately vest and remain exercisable for a period of nine months following the date of termination for Permanent Disability or death.
Pursuant to a retirement agreement, dated August 10, 2017 amending and restating certain retirement benefit provisions in the Yull Agreement, unless terminated by the Company for Cause (as defined in the Yull Agreement), he shall receive a defined benefit supplemental pension annually for life equal to the lesser of: (i) $600,000 if he separates from service at age 65 or older, $570,000 at age 64, $540,000 at age 63, $510,000 at age 62, $480,000 at age 61, or $450,000 at age 60 or younger; and (ii) two percent of the average of his total cash compensation (base salary and performance bonus) for the highest five years of his employment during the prior ten years as of the time of separation, multiplied by his years of service with the Company, with such payments to begin at age 60. In the event of Mr. Yull’s death, his surviving spouse would receive 50% of the annual supplemental pension benefit that was being paid to Mr. Yull at the time of his death or that would have been paid to Mr. Yull if he had retired on the date of his death. The retirement benefits set forth above were vested upon the completion of five years of service.
On May 5, 2017, the Company entered into an Executive Employment Agreement with Jeffrey Crystal (the "Crystal Agreement"), which supersedes the previous terms of employment mutually agreed upon by the Company and Mr. Crystal on March 21, 2014. Pursuant to the terms of the Agreement, Mr. Crystal receives an annual base salary of $435,000 which will be reviewed annually by the Board. Mr. Crystal shall also be entitled to a performance bonus for each fiscal year ranging from zero to 120% of his then-current annual base salary based on the achievement of specific goals that are mutually agreed to between Mr. Crystal and the Board. For 2018, Mr. Crystal's bonus maximum was increased to 150% of his annual base salary and was based on the Company achieving certain target amounts for Compensation Adjusted EBITDA Targets and Compensation Cash Flow Targets, as further described above in the Section entitled2018 Senior Management Bonus Plan”. In addition, the Company agreed to cover certain of Mr. Crystal’s relocation costs.
The Crystal Agreement includes provisions regarding confidentiality, non-solicitation and non-competition covenants, and ownership of intellectual property, among other things. The non-competition and non-solicitation covenants survive for 24 months following termination of employment.
In the event that Mr. Crystal’s employment is terminated by the Company other than for cause or in connection with a Change of Control (as defined in the Crystal Agreement), then he shall be entitled to receive a pro-rated performance bonus that he would have received in respect of the fiscal year in which the termination occurred, based upon the average performance bonus paid to Mr. Crystal in the last two fiscal years and severance pay in an amount equal to one and a half times the sum of his annual base salary and the average performance bonus paid in the last two fiscal years immediately preceding the date of termination.
Alternatively, if Mr. Crystal is involuntarily terminated or terminates his employment for Good Reason (as defined in the Crystal Agreement) within six months of a Change of Control, then he shall be entitled to receive a pro-rated performance bonus that he would have received in respect of the fiscal year in which the termination occurred, based upon the average performance bonus paid to Mr. Crystal in the last two fiscal years and severance pay in an amount equal to two times the sum of his annual base salary and the average performance bonus paid in the last two fiscal years immediately preceding the date of termination.
If Mr. Crystal is entitled to severance payments and elects continuation coverage of any Company medical insurance benefits, the Company will pay to the plan(s) on Mr. Crystal's behalf for the duration of the period in which he is receiving severance payments.

93


Under the Crystal Agreement, in the event that Mr. Crystal’s employment is terminated as a result of his death or disability, he shall be entitled to receive a pro-rated performance bonus that he would have received in respect of the fiscal year in which the termination occurred, based upon the average performance bonus paid to Mr. Crystal in the last two fiscal years.
The PRSU Plan, subject to conditions contained therein, includes certain accelerated vesting provisions that would be triggered in the event of the participant’s termination, retirement, death or disability.
Estimated Termination Payments
The table below reflects incremental amounts or values, in addition to salary and bonuses that have already been earned, that would have been payable to or received by each member of senior management if his employment had been terminated on December 31, 2018 based on the terms described above:
 
 
Severance
RSUs (1)
PSUs (1)
Other Payments (2)
Total
Name
Event
$
$
$
$
$
Gregory A.C. Yull
Termination other than for cause or Resignation for good reason
3,200,785



49,408

3,250,193

 
Termination other than for cause or resignation for good reason within 24 months from a Change of Control (3)
4,801,178

361,689

3,419,051

81,741

8,663,659

 
Retirement





 
Permanent disability

361,689

3,419,051


3,780,740

 
Death

361,689

3,419,051


3,780,740

Jeffrey Crystal
Termination other than for cause
1,132,427



34,613

1,167,040

 
Termination other than for cause or resignation for good reason within 6 months from a Change of Control (3)
1,509,902

83,090

837,923

46,151

2,477,066

 
Retirement





 
Permanent disability

83,090

837,923


921,013

 
Death

83,090

837,923


921,013

Douglas Nalette
Termination other than for cause





 
Termination other than for cause or resignation within 6 months from a Change of Control (3)
382,561

43,991

444,743

14,709

886,004

 
Retirement


356,760


356,760

 
Permanent disability

43,991

444,743


488,734

 
Death

43,991

444,743


488,734

Shawn Nelson
Termination other than for cause





 
Termination other than for cause or resignation within 6 months from a Change of Control (3)
364,186

43,991

444,743

24,427

877,347

 
Retirement





 
Permanent disability

43,991

444,743


488,734

 
Death

43,991

444,743


488,734

Joseph Tocci
Termination other than for cause





 
Termination other than for cause or resignation within 6 months from a Change of Control (3)
340,305

43,991

414,660

24,107

823,063

 
Retirement





 
Permanent disability

43,991

414,660


458,651

 
Death

43,991

414,660


458,651

(1) 
The value of the PSUs and RSUs is based on the five-day VWAP of Shares on the TSX on December 31, 2018 (being CDN$ 16.56, USD$ 12.18). Includes dividend equivalent amounts.
(2) 
Represents continuation of benefits, including medical, dental and other insurance benefits.
(3) 
Change of Control as defined by the applicable employment agreement and plan documents. The same amount would be payable if PSUs and RSUs were not assumed in the event of Change of Control. For PSUs and RSUs the amounts above apply only to terminations other than for cause by the Company (and not resignations) within 12 months of a Change of Control.

As of December 31, 2018, unvested stock options were not in-the-money and as such would have resulted in nil incremental value to each member of senior management if his employment had been terminated on December 31, 2018. There would be nil incremental amounts payable to each member of senior management if his employment had been terminated for cause on December 31, 2018.

94


C.
BOARD PRACTICES
Term
The Company has eight Directors. Each Director is elected for a term of one year and may be nominated for re-election at the Company’s following annual shareholders’ meeting. The next annual shareholders’ meeting is scheduled to be held on June 6, 2019, at which time the current term of each Director will expire.
Human Resources and Compensation Committee
The Human Resources and Compensation Committee is appointed by the Board and is currently composed of four directors, Robert M. Beil (Chairman), Robert J. Foster, Jorge N. Quintas and Mary Pat Salomone, none of whom is or has been at any previous time an employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries. Each of the Human Resources and Compensation Committee members is independent as that term is defined by the TSX and Sarbanes-Oxley Act.
Mr. Beil joined the Dow Chemical Company in 1975 after graduating from Youngstown State University with a BA Degree in Industrial Marketing. During a thirty-two-year career with Dow, Mr. Beil held numerous sales and marketing executive positions, where he had responsibility for the implementation of company compensation schemes for large organizations. In addition, he spent a portion of his career working in Dow’s Human Resources function, which was responsible for compensation design for Dow, a Fortune 500 company.
Mr. Foster graduated from Queen’s University with an MA in Economics, earning his CFA, then managed the research department and worked in corporate finance at one of the major investment dealers in Canada. He founded and serves as President and Chief Executive Officer of Capital Canada Limited, a boutique investment banking firm. He serves on a number of not-for-profit boards and was on the board and audit committee of CHC Helicopters Corporation and Golf Town Income Trust.
Mr. Quintas graduated in Management at INP-Lisbon and initialized his professional career in ALCAN (England). Later he became a Board Member in several industrial companies from power and telecommunication cable production to optic fibers. He was a Board Member at Portgás, a city gas distributor in Portugal. Presently Mr. Quintas is the Chairman of Nelson Quintas Group in Portugal and Board Member of: ECODEAL- dangerous waste recycling plant, NQT- Telecommunication Network in Rio de Janeiro (Brasil) and Audit Committee of Serralves Foundation.
Ms. Salomone graduated from Baldwin Wallace College with a Masters of Business Administration and from Youngstown State University with a Bachelor of Engineering in Civil Engineering. Ms. Salomone is a Director of TransCanada Corporation and TransCanada Pipelines Limited since 2013 where she serves on the Human Resources Committee and the Health, Safety, Sustainability and Environment Committee. Ms. Salomone is also a Director of Herc Holdings, Inc. (equipment rental company) since 2016. She is the chairperson of the Compensation Committee, as well as a member of the Nominating and Governance Committee at Herc Holdings. Ms. Salomone was the Senior Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of The Babcock & Wilcox Company (“B&W”) (power generation company) from January 2010 to June 2013. Ms. Salomone serves as a trustee of the Youngstown State University Foundation.
The mandate of the Human Resources and Compensation Committee consists of ensuring the direction and implementation of the Company’s wage and compensation plans, policies, and programs.
The Human Resources and Compensation Committee Charter is included as Exhibit 15.2 to this Form 20-F.
Audit Committee
The Audit Committee is appointed by the Board and is currently composed of three Directors, Frank Di Tomaso (Chairman), Robert J. Foster, and Mary Pat Salomone. Each of the Audit Committee members is independent and financially literate as such terms are defined by Canadian Multilateral Instrument 52-110-Audit Committees.
Mr. Di Tomaso graduated from Concordia University with a Bachelor of Commerce in Accounting and is a Chartered Professional Accountant, a Fellow CPA, FCA and an ICD.D. Mr. Di Tomaso has over 45 years of experience in accounting and auditing. Mr. Di Tomaso was a Partner and Advisory Partner from 1981 until 2012 and served as Director and Member of the Management Committee from 2000 to 2009, of Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton, and previously served as a Director and Chair of the Audit Committee at Yorbeau Resources, Inc. Mr. Di Tomaso currently serves as Director and Chair of the Audit Committee

95


of ADF Group Inc., and Birks Group Inc. He is also a Director of National Bank Trust, National Bank Life Assurance Company and Laurentian Pilotage Authority.
For Mr. Foster’s professional experience, please see above under “Human Resources and Compensation Committee.”
For Ms. Salomone’s professional experience, please see above under “Human Resources and Compensation Committee.”
The Audit Committee fulfills applicable public corporation obligations required of audit committees and assists the Board in fulfilling its oversight responsibilities. The Audit Committee examines the financial reporting processes, internal controls, financial risk management and the audit process and procedures applied by the Company and makes recommendations to the Board in connection with the nomination of the external auditor.
The Audit Committee’s Charter is included as Exhibit 15.3 to this Form 20-F. 
 
D.
EMPLOYEES
As of December 31, 2018, the Company had 3,472 total employees; 2,119 in the US, 745 in Canada, 514 in India, 80 in Portugal, 11 in the rest of Europe and 3 in Mexico. As of December 31, 2018, 766 held either sales-related, administrative, information technology or research and development positions and 2,706 were employed in operations. The Company does not employ a significant number of temporary employees. The Company's total employees increased from 2,585 as of December 31, 2017 mainly as a result of the Polyair and Airtrax acquisitions in 2018.
The table below presents details of the hourly employees that are unionized and subject to a collective bargaining agreement at the Company's manufacturing facilities:
Manufacturing facility
Hourly employees
Collective bargaining agreement expiration date
Delta, British Columbia
14

March 31, 2019
Carbondale, Illinois
100

March 4, 2021
Chicago, Illinois
89

June 6, 2021
Marysville, Michigan
145

April 30, 2021
Carlstadt, New Jersey
33

June 30, 2020
Cornwall, Ontario
121

March 6, 2021
Toronto, Ontario
49

October 31, 2019
Montreal, Quebec
25

April 15, 2021
Menasha, Wisconsin
184

July 31, 2022
Other than the strike at its Brantford, Ontario manufacturing facility in 2008, which is now closed, the Company has never experienced a work stoppage and it considers its employee relations to be satisfactory.
 

96


 
E.
SHARE OWNERSHIP
The following table sets out for each of the Directors and members of senior management the number of common shares of the Company owned or controlled by each, as of March 13, 2019.
 
Name
 
Number of
Shares Owned
 
% of Shares
Outstanding
Robert M. Beil
 
42,133
 
0.07%
George J. Bunze (1)
 
N/A
 
N/A
Frank Di Tomaso
 
10,000
 
0.02%
Robert J. Foster
 
50,100
 
0.09%
James Pantelidis
 
31,560
 
0.05%
Jorge N. Quintas
 
50,508
 
0.09%
Mary Pat Salomone
 
 
Melbourne F. Yull
 
1,734,629
 
2.96%
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
708,619
 
1.21%
Jeffrey Crystal
 
20,820
 
0.04%
Douglas Nalette
 
127,803
 
0.22%
Shawn Nelson
 
139,670
 
0.24%
Joseph Tocci
 
62,752
 
0.11%

(1)    Mr. Bunze retired from the Board in June, 2018.
Directors who are not executive officers of the Company are required to own a minimum of 10,000 shares within five years of joining the Board of Directors in order to remain eligible for future grants of DSUs. On February 3, 2016, the Board determined that DSUs will be included in determining whether the minimum share ownership requirements have been satisfied, on the basis that each DSU is equivalent to one common share for purposes of such determination. As of March 13, 2019, all of the seven directors who are not executive officers of the Company are in compliance with the share ownership requirement.
The Board of Directors has determined that the Company’s minimum share ownership requirement shall apply to the CEO, CFO and all the Company’s other NEOs as identified in the Company’s management information circular. The three NEOs are currently Douglas Nalette, Shawn Nelson and Joseph Tocci. The Board of Directors has further determined that, for the CEO, the minimum share ownership requirement is shares having a value equal to at least two times his annual salary, and for the CFO and the three other NEOs, the minimum share ownership requirement is shares having a value equal to at least one time their respective annual salaries. As of March 13, 2019, the CEO, CFO and the NEOs are in compliance with the minimum share ownership requirement.
The Board of Directors has also adopted a policy of “once met always met” and a review process every three years. Specifically, if an executive satisfies the minimum share ownership requirement, he or she will continue to satisfy the minimum requirement notwithstanding a subsequent decrease in the value of shares held due to market conditions. Further, the Human Resources and Compensation Committee will review every three years whether an executive will be required to purchase additional shares to satisfy the minimum share ownership requirement, including as a result of an increase in compensation. If the Human Resources and Compensation Committee determines that an additional purchase of shares is required, the executive will have one year in which to do so.
As of March 13, 2019, the Directors and senior management owned an aggregate of 2,978,594 common shares of the Company, being 5.1% of the issued and outstanding common shares of the Company. The common shares held by the Directors and senior management do not have different voting rights from those held by the other shareholders of the Company.
Please see the heading “Executive Stock Option Plan” above in this section for a description of the Company’s Amended Executive Stock Option Plan.

97


The following table sets forth all vested and unvested outstanding options granted to the Company’s Directors and senior management through March 13, 2019:
Name
 
Number of options
outstanding
 
Exercise price of
options
CDN$
 
Expiration date of
options
Robert M. Beil
 
10,000
 
12.04
 
6/5/2019
George J. Bunze (1)
 
 
 
Frank Di Tomaso
 
 
 
Robert J. Foster
 
10,000
 
12.04
 
6/5/2019
James Pantelidis
 
10,000
 
12.04
 
6/5/2019
Jorge N. Quintas
 
 
 
Mary Pat Salomone
 
 
 
Melbourne F. Yull
 
 
 
Gregory A.C. Yull
 
160,000
 
12.04
 
6/5/2023
 
 
160,000
 
12.55
 
3/17/2024
 
 
117,194
 
21.76
 
3/13/2028
Jeffrey Crystal
 
32,500
 
12.14
 
5/13/2020
 
 
31,431
 
21.76
 
3/13/2023
Douglas Nalette
 
32,500
 
12.55
 
3/17/2020
 
 
16,640
 
21.76
 
3/13/2023
Shawn Nelson
 
50,000
 
12.04
 
6/5/2019
 
 
32,500
 
12.55
 
3/17/2020
 
 
16,640
 
21.76
 
3/13/2023
Joseph Tocci
 
50,000
 
12.04
 
6/5/2019
 
 
20,000
 
12.55
 
3/17/2020
 
 
16,640
 
21.76
 
3/13/2023
 (1)    Mr. Bunze retired from the Board in June, 2018.

Item 7:
Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions
 
 
A.
MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS
As of March 13, 2019, to the knowledge of the Company, there were no shareholders who beneficially own, or exercise control or direction over, more than 5% of the issued and outstanding common shares of the Company.
As of December 31, 2018, the number of record holders is estimated to be as follows: 29,599 in Canada, 772 in the US and 324 elsewhere. Of the 58,650,310 common shares issued and outstanding on December 31, 2018, such record holders are estimated to hold 35,624,293 shares in Canada, 18,072,873 shares in the US, and 4,953,144 shares elsewhere, equaling 60.74%, 30.81% and 8.45%, respectively.
The Company is not directly or indirectly owned or controlled by another corporation, by any foreign government or by any natural or legal person. There are no arrangements known to the Company that could result at a subsequent date in a change of control of the Company.


98


 
B.
RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
To the knowledge of the Company, for the period from the beginning of 2018, none of its directors or officers or any person who beneficially owns or exercises control or direction over shares carrying more than ten percent of the voting rights attached to the Company’s shares, any associate or affiliate of any such person, or any close member of any such person’s family, has any material interest in any transaction since the beginning of the last completed financial year or in any proposed transactions that has materially affected or will materially affect the Company or any of its affiliates.
 
C.
INTERESTS OF EXPERTS AND COUNSEL
Not Applicable.

Item 8:
Financial Information

The Company's consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards.

 
A.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS AND OTHER FINANCIAL INFORMATION
The Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017, and 2016 include the following:
 
Management’s Responsibility for Consolidated Financial Statements

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Consolidated Financial Statements

Consolidated Earnings

Consolidated Comprehensive Income

Consolidated Changes in Equity

Consolidated Cash Flows

Consolidated Balance Sheets

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements



99


Legal or Arbitration Proceedings
The Company is engaged from time-to-time in various legal proceedings and claims that have arisen in the ordinary course of business. The outcome of all of the proceedings and claims against the Company is subject to future resolution, including the uncertainties of litigation. Based on information currently known to the Company and after consultation with outside legal counsel, management believes that the probable ultimate resolution of any such proceedings and claims, individually, or in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the financial condition of the Company, taken as a whole, and accordingly, no amounts have been recorded as of December 31, 2018.
Dividends
The Board of Directors of the Company adopted a Dividend Policy on August 14, 2012 providing for semi-annual dividend payments. On August 14, 2013, the Board of Directors modified the Company’s dividend policy to provide for quarterly dividend payments.
The following table sets forth the changes in the amount of the annualized dividend in the Company's Dividend Policy:
Date Approved by Board of Directors
 
Annualized Dividend Per Share Before Modifications
 
Annualized Dividend Per Share After Modification
 
Change in Annualized Dividend Per Share
July 7, 2014
 
USD$ 0.32
 
USD$ 0.48
 
50%
August 12, 2015
 
USD$ 0.48
 
USD$ 0.52
 
8.3%
August 10, 2016
 
USD$ 0.52
 
USD$ 0.56
 
7.7%
So long as the payments do not result in a violation of the Company’s covenants with its lenders, and subject to the provisions of the Canada Business Corporations Act relating to the declaration and payment of dividends, there are no other restrictions that would prevent the Company from paying dividends.
The following table sets forth the dividends paid for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
Date Declared
 
Record Date
 
Date Paid
 
Amount per Share
March 9, 2016
 
March 21, 2016
 
March 31, 2016
 
USD$ 0.13
May 9, 2016
 
June 15, 2016
 
June 30, 2016
 
USD$ 0.13
August 10, 2016
 
September 15, 2016
 
September 30, 2016
 
USD$ 0.14
November 10, 2016
 
December 15, 2016
 
December 30, 2016
 
USD$ 0.14
March 8, 2017
 
March 21, 2017
 
March 31, 2017
 
USD$ 0.14
May 8, 2017
 
June 15, 2017
 
June 30, 2017
 
USD$ 0.14
August 10, 2017
 
September 15, 2017
 
September 29, 2017
 
USD$ 0.14
November 10, 2017
 
December 15, 2017
 
December 29, 2017
 
USD$ 0.14
March 7, 2018
 
March 20, 2018
 
March 30, 2018
 
USD$ 0.14
May 9, 2018
 
June 15, 2018
 
June 29, 2018
 
USD$ 0.14
August 10, 2018
 
September 14, 2018
 
September 28, 2018
 
USD$ 0.14
November 7, 2018
 
December 14, 2018
 
December 28, 2018
 
USD$ 0.14

The Company has determined it is appropriate to declare its dividend in US dollars because most of its cash flows are in US dollars. The Company has paid no other dividend in the past three years other than as set forth above. For details regarding the Company’s covenants with its lenders please refer to the 2018 Credit Facility Agreement, filed as Exhibit 4.7, the 2014 Credit Facility Agreement, as amended, filed as Exhibit 4.6 and the Senior Unsecured Notes indenture, filed as Exhibit 2.2, to this Form 20-F.
 
B.
SIGNIFICANT CHANGES
No significant changes have occurred since the date of the annual financial statements.

100


Item 9:
The Offer and Listing
 
 
A.
OFFER AND LISTING DETAILS
The Company sells its shares in Canada on the TSX under the trading symbol “ITP” and in the US on the OTC Pink Marketplace under the trading symbol “ITPOF”.

The Company has authorized an unlimited number of voting common shares without par value. The Company also has authorized an unlimited number of non-voting Class A preferred shares issuable in a series, ranking in priority to the common shares with respect to dividends and return of capital on dissolution. The Board of Directors is authorized to fix, before issuance, the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to the shares of each series of Class A preferred shares. As of December 31, 2018, there were 58,650,310 issued and outstanding common shares and no issued and outstanding preferred shares of the Company.

 
B.
PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
Not Applicable.

 
C.
MARKETS
The Company sells its shares in Canada on the TSX under the trading symbol “ITP” and in the US on the OTC Pink Marketplace under the trading symbol “ITPOF”.

 
D.
SELLING SHAREHOLDERS
Not Applicable.

 
E.
DILUTION
Not Applicable.

 
F.
EXPENSES OF THE ISSUE
Not Applicable.

Item 10:
Additional Information

 
A.
SHARE CAPITAL
Not Applicable.

 
B.
MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION
1.The business of the Company was established when Intertape Systems Inc., a predecessor of the Company, established a pressure-sensitive tape manufacturing facility in Montreal. The Company was incorporated under the Canada Business Corporations Act (the “Act”) on December 22, 1989 under the name “171695 Canada Inc.” On October 8, 1991, the Company filed a Certificate of Amendment changing its name to “Intertape Polymer Group Inc.” A Certificate of Amalgamation was filed by the Company on August 31, 1993, at which time the Company was amalgamated with EBAC Holdings Inc.
On November 11, 2015, the Board of Directors adopted By-Law 2015-1, requiring advance notice for the nomination of directors.

101


2.The Directors of the Company may, when deemed expedient:
 
(a)
borrow money upon the credit of the Company;

(b)
issue debentures or other securities of the Company, and pledge or sell the same for such sums and at such prices as may be deemed expedient;

(c)
notwithstanding the provisions of the Civil Code, hypothecate, mortgage or pledge the moveable or immoveable property, present or future, of the Company, to secure any such debentures, or other securities, or give part only of such guarantee for such purposes; and constitute the hypothec, mortgage or pledge above mentioned, by trust deed, or on any other manner; and

(d)
mortgage, hypothecate, pledge or otherwise create a security interest in all or any moveable or personal, immoveable or real or other property of the Company, owned or subsequently acquired, to secure any obligation of the Company.
The directors may, by resolution or by-law, delegate the above listed powers to such officers or directors of the Company as set out in such resolution or by-law.
Section 13 of the By-laws allows the Board of Directors to determine the remuneration paid to directors and such remuneration shall be in addition to the salary paid to any officer of the Company who is also a member of the Board of Directors (in the Board’s discretion, it does not currently pay any director remuneration to Gregory A.C. Yull in addition to the compensation paid to him as an officer of the Company). The Directors may also by resolution award special remuneration to any Director undertaking any special services on the Company’s behalf other than the routine work ordinarily required of a Director by the Company. The confirmation of any such resolution or resolutions by the shareholders is not required.
3.Description of Share Capital
The authorized capital of the Company consists of an unlimited number of common shares and non-voting Class A preferred shares, issuable in series. The following is a summary of the material provisions which attach to the common shares and Class A preferred shares and is qualified by reference to the full text of the rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions of such shares.
Common Shares
Voting Rights – Each common share entitles the holder thereof to one vote at all meetings of the shareholders of the Company.
Payment of Dividends – The holders of the Company’s common shares are entitled to receive during each year, as and when declared by the Board of Directors, dividends payable in money, property or by issue of fully-paid shares of the capital of the Company.
Distribution of Assets Upon Winding-Up – In the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding-up of the Company, whether voluntary or involuntary, or other distribution of assets of the Company among shareholders for the purpose of winding-up its affairs, the holders of the Company’s common shares are entitled to receive the remaining property of the Company.
Class A Preferred Shares
The Board of Directors may at any time and from time to time issue non-voting Class A preferred shares in one or more series, each series to consist of such number of shares, designation, rights, restrictions, conditions and limitations (including any sinking fund provisions) as may, before the issuance thereof, be determined by the Board of Directors. The Class A preferred shares are entitled to preference over the common shares with respect to the payment of dividends. In the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding-up of the Company or other distribution of assets of the Company among shareholders for the purpose of winding-up its affairs, the holders of the Class A preferred shares will, before any amount is paid to, or any property or assets of the Company distributed among, the holders of the common shares, be entitled to receive: (i) an amount equal to the amount paid-up on such shares together with, in the case of cumulative Class A preferred shares, all unpaid cumulative dividends and, in the case of non-cumulative Class A preferred shares, all declared and unpaid non-cumulative dividends; and (ii) if such liquidation, dissolution, winding-up or distribution is voluntary, an additional amount equal to the premium, if any, which would have been payable on the redemption of the Class A preferred shares if they had been called for redemption by the Company on the date of distribution.

102


4.The rights of the holders of the Class A preferred shares may be amended only with the prior approval of two-thirds of the holders of the Class A preferred shares in addition to any other approvals required by the Act. There are no preferred shares currently issued and outstanding.
5.Subject to compliance with the Act, the annual shareholders' meeting shall be convened on such day each year and at such time as the Board of Directors may by resolution determine. Special meetings of the shareholders may be convened by order of the Chairman of the Board, the President or a Vice President who is a director or by the Board of Directors to be held at such time and place as may be specified in such order. Special meetings of the shareholders may also be called by written request to the Board of Directors signed by shareholders holding between them not less than five percent (5%) of the outstanding shares of the Company entitled to vote at such meeting. Such request shall state the business to be transacted at the meeting and sent to the registered office of the Company. In the event the Board of Directors does not call the meeting within twenty-one (21) days after receiving the request, then any shareholder who signed the request may call the meeting.
6.The Articles of Amalgamation of the Company do not contain limitations on the rights of non-resident or foreign shareholders to hold or exercise voting rights on the Company’s shares.
7.   The Articles of Amalgamation and the Bylaws contain no provision that would have an effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of the Company and that would operate only with respect to a merger, acquisition or corporate restructuring involving the Company or any of its subsidiaries.
 
C.
MATERIAL CONTRACTS
The following is a description of the material contracts the Company was a party to during the last two fiscal years ended December 31, 2018, regardless of when they were initially entered into by the Company, either directly or through one of its subsidiaries, and that are not in the ordinary course of the Company’s business:
 
an Amended Executive Stock Option Plan. For a summary of this Plan, please see Item 6.B in this 20-F. For a copy of the Amended Executive Stock Option Plan, see Exhibit 4.1 to this Form 20-F.

an Amended Stock Appreciation Rights Plan. For a summary of this Plan, please see Item 6.B in this 20-F. For a copy of the Amended Stock Appreciation Rights Plan, as amended, see Exhibit 4.2 to this Form 20-F.

an Amended and Restated Deferred Share Unit Plan. For a summary of this Plan, please see Item 6.B in this 20-F. For a copy of the Amended and Restated Deferred Shared Unit Plan, see Exhibit 4.3 to this Form 20-F.

an Amended and Restated Performance and Restricted Share Unit Plan. For a summary of this Plan, please see Item 6.B in this 20-F. For a copy of the Amended and Restated Performance and Restricted Shared Unit Plan, see Exhibit 4.4 to this Form 20-F.

an Equipment Finance Agreement dated August 14, 2012 in the amount of up to $24.0 million (which was later increased to $25.7 million as of March 26, 2014) for qualifying US capital expenditures during the period May 2012 through March 31, 2014. The Equipment Finance Agreement allowed for periodic scheduling of amounts with each schedule having a term of sixty months and a fixed interest rate for leases scheduled prior to March 31, 2014. For a copy of the Equipment Finance Agreement, see Exhibit 4.5 to this Form 20-F. The Company has entered into the five schedules as listed below.
Date Entered
 
Amount
 
Interest
Rate
 
Payments
 
Last Payment due
September 27, 2012
 
2.7 million
 
2.74%
 
$48,577
 
October 1, 2017
December 28, 2012
 
2.6 million
 
2.74%
 
$46,258
 
January 1, 2018
June 28, 2013
 
2.2 million
 
2.90%
 
$39,329
 
July 1, 2018
December 31, 2013
 
14.7 million
 
2.90%
 
$263,450
 
January 1, 2019
April 1, 2014
 
3.5 million
 
2.95%
 
$62,263
 
April 1, 2019

a 2014 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement dated November 18, 2014 (and since amended on January 28, 2016, September 2, 2016, January 27, 2017, June 9, 2017 and June 14, 2017), among the Company and certain of its subsidiaries, the Lenders referred to therein, Wells Fargo Bank, National Association as Administrative Agent, Swingline Lender and Issuing Lender, Bank of America, N.A. as Syndication Agent, and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC

103


and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated as Joint Lead Arrangers and Joint Bookrunners. The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement, as amended, provided for a five-year $450.0 million Revolving Credit Facility and included an incremental accordion feature of $150.0 million, which enabled the Company to increase the limit of this facility (subject to the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement’s terms and lender approval) if needed. The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility had a maturity date of November 18, 2019 and bore an interest rate based primarily on the LIBOR for US dollar loans and CDOR for Canadian dollar loans plus a spread varying between 100 and 225 basis points depending on the consolidated total leverage ratio (1.75 basis points as of December 31, 2017). The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement included certain financial covenant obligations. The amount of capital expenditures in any fiscal year was limited to $100 million (prior to the January 2017 amendment, this limit was $50 million and any portion of the allowable $50 million not expended in the year could have been carried over for expenditure in the following year but not carried over to any additional subsequent year thereafter). The consolidated total leverage ratio was limited to a maximum of 3.25 to 1.00 (subject to increase to 3.75 to 1.00 for the first four quarters following an acquisition with a price not less than $50 million), and the consolidated debt service coverage ratio required a minimum of not less than 1.50 to 1.00. The consolidated total leverage ratio compares consolidated total indebtedness to consolidated EBITDA (as defined in the Revolving Credit Facility Agreement). The consolidated debt service coverage ratio compares consolidated EBITDA (less certain taxes and dividends), to the sum of consolidated interest expense plus scheduled principal payments. The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement also included certain other affirmative and negative covenants, subject to certain exceptions and limitations, including restrictions on indebtedness, liens, investments, and distributions. Reference is made to the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement for more detailed information regarding specific covenants, defined terms and conditions. This 2014 Revolving Credit Facility has been refinanced and replaced by the 2018 Credit Facility, discussed below. For a copy of the Revolving Credit Facility Agreement, see Exhibit 4.6 to this Form 20-F.

a 2018 Credit Facility Agreement dated June 14, 2018 with a syndicated lending group, led by Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, refinancing and replacing the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility that was due to mature in November 2019. The 2018 Credit Facility consists of a $400.0 million revolving credit facility and a $200.0 million term loan. The term loan amortizes $65.0 million until March 2023 ($5.0 million in 2018, $10.0 million in 2019, $12.5 million in 2020, $15.0 million in 2021, $17.5 million in 2022, and $5.0 million in 2023), and the remaining balance of the 2018 Credit Facility is due upon maturity in June 2023. The 2018 Credit Facility also includes an incremental accordion feature of $200.0 million, which enables the Company to increase the limit of this facility (subject to the credit agreement's terms and lender approval) if needed. The 2018 Credit Facility matures on June 14, 2023 and bears an interest rate based, at the Company’s option, on the London Inter-bank Offered Rate ("LIBOR"), the Federal Funds Rate, or Bank of America’s prime rate, plus a spread varying between 25 and 250 basis points depending on the debt instrument's benchmark interest rate and the consolidated secured net leverage ratio. The 2018 Credit Facility is secured by a first priority lien on all personal property of the Company and all current and future material subsidiaries. The 2018 Credit Facility has two financial covenants, a consolidated secured net leverage ratio not to be more than 3.50 to 1.00, with an allowable temporary increase to 4.00 to 1.00 for the quarter in which the Company consummates an acquisition with a price not less than $50 million and the following three quarters, and a consolidated interest coverage ratio not to be less than 3.00 to 1.00. In addition, the 2018 Credit Facility has certain non-financial covenants, such as covenants regarding indebtedness, investments, and asset dispositions. For a copy of the 2018 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement, see Exhibit 4.7 to this Form 20-F.

the Senior Unsecured Notes issued under the indenture dated October 15, 2018 among certain guarantors and Regions Bank, as Trustee. On October 15, 2018, the Company completed its offering of $250.0 million 7.00% senior unsecured notes due in 2026 (the "Senior Unsecured Notes"). The offering of the Senior Unsecured Notes was effected by way of private placement sales in the United States and Canada pursuant to exemptions from the Securities Act of 1933 registration and prospectus requirements. The Senior Unsecured Notes bear interest at a rate of 7.00% per annum, payable semi-annually in cash in arrears on April 15 and October 15 of each year, beginning on April 15, 2019. The Senior Unsecured Notes will mature on October 15, 2026. On or after October 15, 2021, the Company may redeem the Senior Unsecured Notes at its option, in whole or in part, on certain redemption dates and at certain redemption prices specified in the indenture, plus any accrued and unpaid interest. If the Company experiences a change of control, it may be required to offer to repurchase the Senior Unsecured Notes at a purchase price equal to 101% of their aggregate principal amount plus any accrued and unpaid interest up to, but excluding, the date of such repurchase. The indenture contains customary covenants that, among other things, limit the Company's ability to incur additional debt; pay dividends, redeem stock or make other distributions; enter into certain types of transactions with affiliates; incur liens on assets; make certain restricted payments and investments; engage in certain asset sales, including sale and leaseback transactions; agree to certain restrictions on the ability of restricted subsidiaries to make payments to the Company; and merge, consolidate, transfer or dispose of substantially all assets. Certain of these covenants will be suspended if the Senior Unsecured Notes are assigned an investment grade rating by Standard & Poor's Rating

104


Services and Moody's Investors Services, Inc. For a copy of the Senior Unsecured Notes indenture, see Exhibit 2.2 to this Form 20-F.

the Rights Plan dated December 14, 2015 with CST Trust Company. The purpose of the Shareholder Rights Plan is to provide the Company’s Board of Directors with additional time, in the event of an unsolicited takeover bid, to develop and propose alternatives to the bid and negotiate with the bidder, as well as to ensure equal treatment of shareholders in the context of an acquisition of control made other than by way of an offer to all shareholders, and lessen the pressure on shareholders to tender a bid.

The Company’s Board of Directors has implemented the Rights Plan by authorizing the issuance of one right (a “Right”) in respect of each common share outstanding at the close of business on December 14, 2015 (the “Record Time”) and in respect of each voting share issued by the Company after the Record Time. The Rights trade with, and are represented by, the common shares. Until such time as the Rights separate, when they become exercisable, Rights certificates will not be distributed to shareholders and no further action is required by shareholders. If a person, or a group acting jointly or in concert (each, an “Offeror”), acquires beneficial ownership of 20% or more of the then outstanding voting shares (other than pursuant to an exemption available under the Rights Plan), Rights (other than those held by such Offeror, which will become void) will separate and permit the holders thereof to purchase additional shares at a substantial discount to the market price of the shares at that time. Pursuant to the Rights Plan, any bid that meets certain criteria intended to protect the interests of all shareholders will be deemed to be a “permitted bid” and will not trigger a separation under the Rights Plan. These criteria require, among other things, that the bid be made by way of a takeover bid circular to all holders of voting shares other than the Offeror, that all shareholders be treated equally and that the bid remain open for acceptance by shareholders for at least 60 days or such longer period as may be prescribed by law as the minimum deposit period.

Prior to separation, the Rights Plan is not dilutive and will not affect reported earnings per share or change the way in which shareholders would otherwise trade shares. Upon separation, reported earnings per share, on a fully diluted or non-diluted basis, may be affected. Shareholders who do not exercise their Rights upon separation may suffer substantial dilution along with the Offeror.

Under the policies of the TSX, the Rights Plan was required to be ratified by the shareholders of the Company at a meeting held within six months following the adoption of the Rights Plan, or otherwise the Company would have been required to immediately cancel the Rights Plan and any rights issued thereunder would have been immediately redeemed or cancelled. On June 9, 2016, shareholders approved a resolution ratifying and approving the Rights Plan. At the Annual Meeting of Shareholders of the Company on June 6, 2019, the shareholders will be asked to consider and if deemed advisable to approve a resolution of the Board of Directors to ratify the continued existence of the Rights Plan. For a copy of the Rights Plan, see Exhibit 2.1 to this Form 20-F.

the Asset Purchase Agreement dated June 9, 2017 among the Company and Cantech, Lenalco Holdings (Canada) Ltd., 169892 Canada Inc., 169893 Canada Inc., Howard Cohen, Paul Joseph Cohen, Intertape Polymer Inc. and Intertape Polymer Corp. Under this agreement, the Company acquired, on July 1, 2017, substantially all of the assets of Cantech, a privately-owned North American supplier of industrial and specialty tapes based in Montreal, Quebec, for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $67.0 million, net of cash acquired. The assets included the shares of Cantech Industries Inc., Cantech’s US subsidiary. The agreement also includes certain other affirmative and negative covenants, subject to certain exceptions and limitations, including restrictions on other transactions and competition, the ability to enter into certain material contracts, and material changes to the nature of the Company's business. For a copy of the Asset Purchase Agreement, see Exhibit 4.8 to this Form 20-F.

the Stock Purchase Agreement dated July 17, 2018 among the Company, Glencoe Skydome Holdings L.P. and Polyair. Under this agreement, the Company acquired 100% of the outstanding equity in Polyair, a North American supplier of protective packaging with headquarters in Toronto, Ontario and Chicago, Illinois. The aggregate purchase price of the transaction was approximately $145.0 million. The agreement also includes certain other limited affirmative and negative covenants. For a copy of the Polyair Stock Purchase Agreement, see Exhibit 4.9 to this Form 20-F.

A copy of each of the foregoing contracts, except as otherwise noted, are available as Exhibits to this Form 20-F.


105


 
D.
EXCHANGE CONTROLS
As of the date hereof, there are no governmental laws, decrees or regulations in Canada on the export or import of capital, or which impose foreign exchange controls or affect the remittance of interest, dividends or other payments to non-resident holders of the Company’s common stock, except as described under Item 10E “Taxation” below.
Except as provided in the Investment Canada Act (Canada), the Competition Act (Canada), and/or the Canada Transportation Act (Canada), which have provisions that may potentially restrict the holding of voting shares by non-Canadians, there are no limitations specific to the rights of non-Canadians to hold or vote the Company’s common shares under the laws of Canada or in its charter documents. The following summarizes the principal features of the Investment Canada Act, the Competition Act and the Canada Transportation Act for non-Canadian residents proposing to acquire the Company’s common shares.
This summary is of a general nature only and is not intended to be, and should not be construed to be, legal advice to any holder or prospective holder of the Company’s common shares, and no opinion or representation to any holder or prospective holder of the Company’s common shares is hereby made. Accordingly, holders and prospective holders of the Company’s common shares should consult with their own legal advisors with respect to the consequences of purchasing and owning the Company’s common shares. 
1.
Investment Canada Act
The Investment Canada Act governs acquisitions of control of Canadian businesses by non-Canadians. Under the Investment Canada Act, non-Canadian individuals or entities acquiring “control” (as defined in the Investment Canada Act) of a corporation carrying on business in Canada are required to either notify, or file an application for review with, Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada (or in the case of “cultural businesses”, Heritage Canada), subject to certain statutory exemptions. The relevant Minister may review any transaction which constitutes an acquisition of control of a Canadian business, where certain thresholds are exceeded (which are higher for investors from World Trade Organization member countries or investors from countries with which Canada has a trade agreement, including the US and the European Union) or where the activity of the business is a “cultural business” (as defined in the legislation and its regulations), or where the investment could be injurious to Canada’s national security. For acquisitions of control of businesses which do not involve a cultural business or present national security issues, no change of voting control will be deemed to have occurred, for purposes of the Investment Canada Act, if less than one-third of the voting control of a Canadian corporation is acquired by an investor. Different rules apply to acquisitions of control of businesses related to Canada’s cultural heritage or national identity, or present national security concerns.
If an investment is reviewable under the Investment Canada Act, an application for review in the form prescribed is normally required to be filed with Innovation, Science and Economic Development Canada or Heritage Canada prior to implementation of the investment. An investment subject to review may not be implemented until the review has been completed and the Minister responsible is satisfied that the investment is likely to be of “net benefit” to Canada. If the Minister is not satisfied that the investment is likely to be of net benefit to Canada, the non-Canadian cannot implement the investment, or if the investment has been implemented, may be required to divest itself of control of the Canadian business that is the subject of the investment. Different rules apply if the Minister determines that the investment may be injurious to Canada’s national security.

Certain transactions relating to the Company’s common stock would be exempt from the Investment Canada Act, unless they are found to be potentially injurious to Canada’s national security by the Minister responsible, including:
 
(a)
the acquisition of the Company’s common stock by a person in the ordinary course of that person’s business as a trader or dealer in securities;
(b)
the acquisition of control of the Company in connection with the realization of security granted for a loan or other financial assistance and not for a purpose related to the provisions of the Investment Canada Act; and
(c)
the acquisition of control of the Company by reason of an amalgamation, merger, consolidation or corporate reorganization following which the ultimate direct or indirect control in fact of the Company, through ownership of the Company’s common stock, remains unchanged.
These exemptions do not apply to an acquisition of control of a Canadian business that is deemed to be potentially injurious to Canada’s national security.

106


2.
Competition Act
The Competition Act requires notification to the Commissioner of Competition of specified merger transactions that exceed certain monetary and share thresholds prior to their completion.
If a proposed merger is subject to pre-merger notification, each party to the proposed merger must file a notification with the Commissioner of Competition.
Proposed mergers that are subject to pre-merger notification under the Competition Act are prohibited from being completed before the end of 30 days following the receipt of a complete notification by the Commissioner of Competition, unless a waiver of the waiting period is obtained from the Commissioner of Competition. The waiting period may be extended by the issuance of a supplementary information request by the Commissioner of Competition within the initial 30 day waiting period. In the event that a supplementary information request is issued by the Commissioner of Competition, the parties may not complete the proposed merger until the end of a further 30 day waiting period that commences on the date on which the information requested pursuant to the supplementary information request has been provided to the Commissioner of Competition.
Whether or not a merger is subject to pre-merger notification to the Commissioner of Competition, the Commissioner of Competition may commence an application for relief in the Competition Tribunal on the basis that the merger prevents or lessens, or is likely to prevent or lessen, competition substantially in a relevant market. Such applications for relief are subject to a one-year limitation period from the merger’s substantial completion.
3.
Canada Transportation Act
If a proposed transaction involves a transportation undertaking and is subject to pre-merger notification to the Commissioner of Competition pursuant to the Competition Act, the parties to the proposed transaction must also provide pre-closing notification to the Minister of Transportation under the Canada Transportation Act. Such transactions require a 42-day waiting period which may be extended.
The parties to a proposed transaction subject to pre-merger notification to the Minister of Transportation may not complete the proposed transaction unless the Minister of Transportation issues a notice of his opinion that the proposed transaction does not raise issues with respect to the public interest as it relates to national transportation, or unless the transaction is approved by the Governor in Council.
 
E.
TAXATION
Material Canadian Federal Income Tax Consequences
The following general summary describes the principal Canadian federal income tax consequences applicable to a holder of the Company’s common stock who is a resident of the US, who is not, will not be and will not be deemed to
be a resident of Canada for purposes of the Income Tax Act (Canada) (the “Income Tax Act”) and any applicable tax treaty and who does not use or hold, and is not deemed to use or hold, his common stock in the capital of the Company in connection with carrying on a business in Canada (a “non-resident holder”). This summary applies only to non-resident holders who hold their Company common stock as capital property. This summary does not apply to non-resident holders who are financial institutions (within the meaning of the Income Tax Act) or insurers.
This summary is based upon the current provisions of the Income Tax Act, the regulations thereunder (the “Regulations”), the current publicly announced administrative and assessing policies of the Canada Revenue Agency and the Canada-United States Tax Convention (1980), as amended (the “Treaty”). This summary also takes into account the amendments to the Income Tax Act and the Regulations publicly announced by the Minister of Finance (Canada) prior to the date hereof (the “Tax Proposals”) and assumes that all such Tax Proposals will be enacted in their present form. However, no assurances can be given that the Tax Proposals will be enacted in the form proposed, or at all. This summary is not exhaustive of all possible Canadian federal income tax consequences applicable to a non-resident holder of the Company’s common stock and, except for the foregoing, this summary does not take into account or anticipate any changes in law, whether by legislative, administrative or judicial decision or action, nor does it take into account provincial, territorial or foreign income tax legislation or considerations, which may differ from the Canadian federal income tax consequences described herein.
This summary is of a general nature only and is not intended to be, and should not be construed to be, legal, business or tax advice to any particular holder or prospective holder of the Company’s common stock, and no opinion or

107


representation with respect to the Canadian tax consequences to any holder or prospective holder of the Company’s common stock is made. Accordingly, holders and prospective holders of the Company’s common stock should consult their own tax advisors with respect to the income tax consequences of purchasing, owning and disposing of the Company’s common stock in their particular circumstances.
Dividends
Dividends paid on the Company’s common stock to a non-resident holder will be subject under the Income Tax Act to withholding tax which tax is deducted at source by the Company. The withholding tax rate for dividends prescribed by the Income Tax Act is 25% but this rate may be reduced under the provisions of an applicable tax treaty. Under the Treaty, the withholding tax rate is reduced to 15% on dividends paid by the Company to a resident of the US who is the beneficial owner of such dividend and is eligible to benefits under the Treaty. The rate is further reduced to 5% where the beneficial owner of the dividend is a corporation resident in the US that is eligible for benefits under the Treaty and that owns at least 10% of the voting stock of the Company.
Capital Gains
A non-resident holder is not subject to tax under the Income Tax Act in respect of a capital gain realized upon the disposition of a common share of the Company unless such share is (or is deemed to be) “taxable Canadian property” (as defined in the Income Tax Act) of the non-resident holder. As long as the Company's common stock are listed on a designated stock exchange (which includes the TSX) at the time they are disposed of, the Company’s common stock will generally not be considered taxable Canadian property of a non-resident holder unless at any time during the 60-month period immediately preceding the disposition of the stock: (i) the non-resident holder, persons with whom the non-resident holder does not deal at arm’s length, partnerships in which the non-resident holder or any person with whom the non-resident holder does not deal at arm’s length holds a membership interest directly or indirectly through one or more partnerships, or the non-resident holder together with such non-arm’s length persons or partnerships owned, or had an interest in an option in respect of, 25% or more of the issued stock of any class or series of the Company’s capital stock; and (ii) more than 50% of the fair market value of the shares of the Company was derived directly or indirectly from one or any combination of real or immovable property situated in Canada, Canadian resource properties (as defined in the Income Tax Act), timber resource properties (as defined in the Income Tax Act), or an option, an interest or right in such property.
Material US Federal Income Tax Consequences
The following is a general discussion of the material US federal income tax consequences, under current law, generally applicable to a US Holder (as hereinafter defined) of common shares of the Company. This discussion does not address individual consequences to persons subject to special provisions of federal income tax law, such as those described below as excluded from the definition of a US. Holder. In addition, this discussion does not cover any state, local or foreign tax consequences. (See “Canadian Federal Tax Consequences”).

The following discussion is based upon the sections of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), Treasury Regulations, published Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) rulings, published administrative positions of the IRS and court decisions that are currently applicable, any or all of which could be materially and adversely changed, possibly on a retroactive basis, at any time. This discussion does not consider the potential effects, both adverse and beneficial, of any recently proposed legislation which, if enacted, could be applied, possibly on a retroactive basis, at any time.

This discussion is for general information only and it is not intended to be, nor should it be construed to be, legal or tax advice to any holder or prospective holder of common shares of the Company and no opinion or representation with respect to the US federal income tax consequences to any such holder or prospective holder is made. Accordingly, holders and prospective holders of common shares of the Company are urged to consult their own tax advisors about the federal, state, local, and foreign tax consequences of purchasing, owning and disposing of common shares of the Company.
US Holders
As used herein, a “US Holder” means a holder of common shares of the Company who is a citizen or individual resident of the US, a corporation or partnership created or organized in or under the laws of the US or of any political subdivision thereof or a trust whose income is taxable in the US irrespective of source.
This summary does not address the tax consequences to, and US Holder does not include, persons subject to specific provisions of federal income tax law, such as tax-exempt organizations, qualified retirement plans, individual retirement accounts and other tax-deferred accounts, financial institutions, insurance companies, real estate investment trusts, regulated investment

108


companies, broker-dealers, non-resident alien individuals, persons or entities that have a “functional currency” other than the US dollar, shareholders who hold common shares as part of a straddle, hedging or a conversion transaction, persons that actually or constructively own 10 percent or more of the Company by vote or value, and shareholders who acquired their common shares through the exercise of employee stock options or otherwise as compensation for services. This summary is limited to US Holders who own common shares as capital assets. This summary does not address the consequences to a person or entity holding an interest in a shareholder or the consequences to a person of the ownership, exercise or disposition of any options, warrants or other rights to acquire common shares.
Distribution on Common Shares of the Company
US Holders receiving dividend distributions (including constructive dividends) with respect to common shares of the Company are required to include in gross income for US federal income tax purposes the gross amount of such distributions equal to the US dollar value of such dividends on the date of receipt (based on the exchange rate on such date) to the extent that the Company has current or accumulated earnings and profits, without reduction for any Canadian income tax withheld from such distributions. Such Canadian tax withheld may be credited, subject to certain limitations, against the US Holder’s federal income tax liability or, alternatively, may be deducted in computing the US Holder’s federal taxable income by those who itemize deductions. (See more detailed discussion at “Foreign Tax Credit” below). Dividends received by non-corporate US investors may be subject to US federal income tax at preferential tax rates if certain conditions are met. Dividends received by non-corporate US Holders with respect to the common shares of the Company are expected to be eligible for these preferential tax rates. US Holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding the eligibility of such dividends for a reduced rate of tax. To the extent that distributions exceed current or accumulated earnings and profits of the Company, they will be treated first as a return of capital up to the US Holder’s adjusted basis in the common shares and thereafter as gain from the sale or exchange of the common shares. Preferential tax rates for long-term capital gains are applicable to a US Holder which is an individual, estate or trust. There are currently no preferential tax rates for long-term capital gains for a US Holder which is a corporation. Section 1411 of the Internal Revenue Code imposes a 3.8% Medicare surtax on net investment income of certain individuals, estates and trusts. In general, income with respect to Company distributions will be considered investment income for purposes of the surtax.
Foreign Tax Credit
A US Holder who pays (or has withheld from distributions) Canadian income tax with respect to the ownership of common shares of the Company may be entitled, at the option of the US Holder, to either receive a deduction or a tax credit for such foreign tax paid or withheld. Generally, it will be more advantageous to claim a credit because a credit reduces US federal income taxes on a dollar-for-dollar basis, while a deduction merely reduces the taxpayer’s income subject to tax. This election is made on a year-by-year basis and applies to all foreign taxes paid by (or withheld from) the US Holder during that year. There are significant and complex limitations which apply to the credit, among which is the general limitation that the credit cannot exceed the proportionate share of the US Holder’s US income tax liability that the US Holder’s foreign sources income bears to his or its worldwide taxable income. In the determination of the application of this limitation, the various items of income and deduction must be classified into foreign and domestic sources. Complex rules govern this classification process. In addition, this limitation is calculated separately with respect to specific classes of income such as “passive income,” “high withholding tax interest,” “financial services income,” “shipping income,” and certain other classifications of income. Dividends distributed by the Company will generally constitute “passive income” or, in the case of certain US Holders, “financial services income” for these purposes. The availability of the foreign tax credit and the application of the limitations on the credit are fact specific, and US Holders of common shares of the Company should consult their own tax advisors regarding their individual circumstances.
Disposition of Common Shares of the Company
A US Holder will recognize gain or loss upon the sale of common shares of the Company equal to the difference, if any, between: (i) the amount of cash plus the fair market value of any property received; and (ii) the shareholder’s tax basis in the common shares of the Company. This gain or loss will be capital gain or loss if the common shares are a capital asset in the hands of the US Holder, which will be long-term capital gain or loss if the common shares of the Company are held for more than one year. Preferential tax rates apply to long-term capital gains of US Holders who are individuals, estates or trusts. Section 1411 of the Internal Revenue Code imposes a 3.8% Medicare surtax on net investment income of certain individuals, estates and trusts. In general, capital gain or loss recognized upon the sale of common shares of the Company will be considered investment income for purposes of the surtax.

109


Other Considerations
In the following circumstances, the above sections of this discussion may not describe the US federal income tax consequences resulting from the holding and disposition of common shares:
Passive Foreign Investment Company
Certain US income tax legislation contains rules governing “passive foreign investment companies” (“PFIC”) which can have significant tax effects on US Holders of foreign corporations. These rules do not apply to non-US Holders.
Section 1297 of the Code defines a PFIC as a corporation that is not formed in the US and, for any taxable year, either (i) 75% or more of its gross income is “passive income”, which includes interest, dividends and certain rents and royalties or (ii) the average percentage, by fair market value (or, if the Company is a controlled foreign corporation or makes an election, adjusted tax basis) of its assets that produce or are held for the production of “passive income” is 50% or more. The Company does not believe that it is a PFIC. If the Company is determined to be a PFIC, US Holders could be subject to additional US federal income taxes on gain recognized with respect to the common shares and on certain distributions. In addition, an interest charge may apply to the portion of the US federal income tax liability on such gains or distributions treated under the PFIC rules as having been deferred by the US Holder. Moreover, dividends that a non-corporate US Holder receives from the Company will not be eligible for the reduced US federal income tax rates on dividends described above if the Company is a PFIC in the taxable year of the dividend or the preceding taxable year. Each US Holder of the Company is urged to consult a tax advisor with respect to how the PFIC rules affect their tax situation and whether any related reporting is required.
 
F.
DIVIDENDS AND PAYING AGENTS
Not Applicable.

 
G.
STATEMENT BY EXPERTS
Not Applicable.

 
H.
DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY
The documents referred to in this Form 20-F may be viewed at the Company’s office located at 100 Paramount Drive, Suite 300, Sarasota, Florida 34232.

 
I.
SUBSIDIARY INFORMATION
Not Applicable.

Item 11:
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
Information for this Item is set forth in Note 22 to the 2018 audited consolidated financial statements under Item 18.

Item 12:
Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities
 
 
A.
Debt Securities
Not Applicable.
 

110


 
B.
Warrants and Rights
Not Applicable.
 
 
C.
Other Securities
Not Applicable.
 
 
D.
American Depositary Shares
None.

PART II
 
Item 13:
Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies
None.
 
Item 14:
Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds
None.
 
Item 15:
Controls and Procedures
(a)    Disclosure Controls and Procedures. the Company maintains disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) designed to ensure not only that information required to be disclosed in its reports filed under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, but also that information required to be disclosed by the Company is accumulated and communicated to management, including its principal executive officer and principal financial officer, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. The Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of the Company conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures as of December 31, 2018. They concluded based on such evaluation that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective.
(b)    Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of the Company’s financial reporting as well as the preparation of consolidated financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.
Internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit the preparation of consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements and, even when determined to be effective, can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to consolidated financial statements preparation and presentation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with policies or procedures may deteriorate.

111


Management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 based on the criteria established in the “2013 Internal Control – Integrated Framework” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Management’s assessment of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 did not include the acquisition of 100% of the outstanding equity value in Polyair Inter Pak Inc. (“Polyair”) consummated during fiscal year 2018. Polyair is included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements and represents 18% of total assets as of December 31, 2018 and 5% of revenues for the year then ended.
Subject to the foregoing, management has concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2018 based on those criteria.
The Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 has been audited by Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton LLP, the Company’s external independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in its report which follows.
(c)    Attestation Report of Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton LLP. The Company’s independent auditors, Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton LLP, audited the annual consolidated financial statements included in this annual report and audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 and included in the consolidated financial statements referenced in Item 18 of this Form 20-F its report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
(d)    Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. On August 3, 2018, the Company completed its acquisition of Polyair. Management’s assessment of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 did not include the acquisition of Polyair consummated during fiscal year 2018. We are in the process of integrating the historical internal controls over financial reporting of Polyair with the rest of the Company. Polyair is included in the Company’s 2018 consolidated financial statements and represents 18% of total assets as of December 31, 2018 and 5% of revenues for the year then ended.
Other than the foregoing, there have been no changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during 2018 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
Item 16:
[RESERVED]
 
 
Item 16A:
Audit Committee Financial Expert
The Board of Directors of the Company has determined that it has at least one audit committee financial expert serving on its audit committee. Mr. Frank Di Tomaso, having over 45 years of experience in accounting and auditing, and having the attributes set forth in Paragraph 16A(b) of the General Instructions to Form 20-F, has been determined to be an audit committee financial expert. Further, Mr. Di Tomaso is “independent” as that term is defined by the TSX and Sarbanes-Oxley Act.
 
Item 16B:
Code of Ethics
The Company has adopted a code of ethics entitled “Intertape Polymer Group Inc. Code of Business Conduct and Ethics”, which is applicable to all of its employees, including its principal executive officer, principal financial officer, principal accounting officer or controller, and all persons performing similar functions. A copy of the Company’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics has been posted on the Company’s website at http://www.itape.com under “Investor Relations”, “Corporate Governance”, “Governance Documents”. Any amendments to, or waiver from, any provision of the Code of Business Conduct and Ethics will be posted on the Company’s website at the above address within 5 business days following the date of such amendment or waiver and such information will remain available on the Company’s website for at least a 12-month period.


112


 
Item 16C:
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
The following table sets forth the fees billed (in Canadian dollars) for professional services rendered by Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton LLP, Chartered Professional Accountants, the Company’s independent auditors, for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2018, and December 31, 2017:
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
 
$CDN
 
$CDN
Audit Fees
 
803,000
 
837,500
Audit-Related Fees
 
273,800
 
213,000
Tax Fees
 
201,365
 
187,152
All Other Fees
 
 
136,000
Total Fees
 
1,278,165
 
1,373,652
(a) Audit Fees. Audit fees were for professional services rendered for the integrated audit of the Company’s consolidated financial statements and internal control over financial reporting, assisting its Audit Committee in discharging its responsibilities for the review of the Company’s interim unaudited consolidated financial statements and services that generally only the independent auditor can reasonably provide, such as consent letters and assistance and review of documents filed with the SEC and Canadian securities regulatory authorities.
(b) Audit-Related Fees. Audit-related fees were for assurance and related services that are reasonably related to the performance of the audit or review of the Company’s consolidated interim unaudited financial statements and are not reported under the caption “Audit Fees” above. These services included consultations concerning financial accounting and reporting standards as well as services related to the business acquisitions and notes offering made in 2018.
(c) Tax Fees. Tax fees were for tax compliance, tax advice and tax planning. These services included the preparation of the Canadian subsidiaries’ income tax returns, assistance with questions regarding tax audits from the various taxation authorities in Canada and tax planning relating to common forms of domestic and international taxation, including tax planning related to the business acquisitions made in 2018.
(d) All Other Fees. All other fees are defined as services provided other than the audit fees, audit-related fees and tax fees described above. In 2017 other fees related to acquisition due diligence services that were provided.
(e) The Audit Committee charter provides for the required pre-approvals of services to be rendered by the external auditors. The pre-approval process takes place annually and is presented by the Company’s internal accountants and the external auditors for planned activity including audit, tax and non-audit services and includes reasonable detail with respect to the services covered. The pre-approval of all non-audit services allows the Audit Committee to consider the effect of such services on the independence of the external auditor. Any such services that may arise in addition to the pre-approved plan must be presented separately to the Audit Committee for pre-approval. The charter states that this responsibility cannot be delegated to management of the Company in any way whatsoever.

 
Item 16D:
Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committee
Not Applicable.
 

113


 
Item 16E:
Purchase of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers
 
Period (1)
 
(a) Total number of
subordinate voting
shares purchased (*)
 
(b) Average price paid
per subordinate voting
share
 
(c) Total number of
subordinate voting
shares purchased as
part of publicly
announced plans or
programs
 
(d) Maximum number
(or approximate dollar
value) of subordinate
voting shares that may
yet be purchased
under the plans or
programs
January 1, 2018 – January 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
3,512,700
February 1, 2018 – February 28, 2018
 
 
 
 
3,512,700
March 1, 2018 – March 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
3,512,700
April 1, 2018– April 30, 2018
 
 
 
 
3,512,700
May 1, 2018 – May 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
3,512,700
June 1, 2018 – June 30, 2018
 
 
 
 
3,512,700
July 1, 2018 – July 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
4,000,000
August 1, 2018 – August 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
4,000,000
September 1, 2018 – September 30, 2018
 
 
 
 
4,000,000
October 1, 2018 – October 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
4,000,000
November 1, 2018 – November 30, 2018
 
 
 
 
4,000,000
December 1, 2018 – December 31, 2018
 
217,100
 
11.79
 
 
3,782,900

(1) 
On July 18, 2018, the Company renewed the NCIB under which it is permitted to repurchase for cancellation up to 4,000,000 common shares of the Company at prevailing market prices during the twelve-month period ending July 22, 2019. As of December 31, 2018, the Company has repurchased 217,100 common shares under its NCIB at an average price of CDN$ 16.02 per share, including commissions, for a total purchase price of $2.6 million. The Company's previous NCIBs, which allowed repurchases for cancellation up to 4,000,000 common shares, expired on July 18, 2018.

 
Item 16F:
Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant
Not Applicable.

 
Item 16G:
Corporate Governance
Not Applicable.

 
Item 16H:
Mine Safety Disclosure
Not Applicable.
PART III
 
Item 17:
Financial Statements
Not Applicable.
 
Item 18:
Financial Statements
The consolidated financial statements required under Item 18 of this Form 20-F are attached hereto as Exhibit “A”.

114


 
Item 19:
Exhibits
The Consolidated Financial Statements and the following exhibits are filed as part of this Annual Report on Form 20-F and are incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
A.
Consolidated Financial Statements
 
Management’s Responsibility for Consolidated Financial Statements

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Consolidated Financial Statements for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016

Consolidated Earnings

Consolidated Comprehensive Income

Consolidated Changes in Equity

Consolidated Cash Flows

Consolidated Balance Sheets

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

115


B.
Exhibits:
1.1
 
 
1.2
 
 
1.3
 
 
2.1
 
 
2.2
 
 
4.1
 
 
4.2
 
 
4.3
 
 
4.4
 
 
4.5
 
 
4.6
 
 
4.7
 
 
4.8
 
 
4.9
 
 
4.10
 
 
8.1
 
 
10.1
During 2018, the Company was not required to send its directors and executive officers notices pursuant to Rule 104 of Regulation BTR concerning any equity security subject to a blackout period under Rule 101 of Regulation BTR. The Company’s blackout periods are regularly scheduled and a description of such periods, including their frequency and duration and plan transactions to be suspended or affected are included in the documents under which the Company’s plans operate and is disclosed to employees before enrollment or within thirty (30) days thereafter.
 
 
12.1
 
 
12.2
 
 
13.1
13.2
 
 

116


15.1
 
 
15.2
 
 
15.3



117


SIGNATURES
The Registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on its behalf.

Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
                            
By: /s/ Gregory A.C. Yull
Gregory A.C. Yull, Chief Executive Officer

Dated March 28, 2019





118


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
 
 
 
 
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
4 to 5
 
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
6 to 7
 
 
Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10 to 12
 
 
 
 
 
 
15 to 89




Management’s Responsibility for Consolidated Financial Statements

The consolidated financial statements of Intertape Polymer Group Inc. (the “Company”) and other financial information are the responsibility of the Company’s management and have been examined and approved by its Board of Directors. These consolidated financial statements have been prepared by management in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board and include some amounts that are based on management’s best estimates and judgments. The selection of accounting principles and methods is management’s responsibility.
Management is responsible for the design, establishment and maintenance of appropriate internal control and procedures over financial reporting, to ensure that financial statements for external purposes are fairly presented in conformity with IFRS. Pursuant to these internal controls and procedures, processes have been designed to ensure that the Company’s transactions are properly authorized, the Company’s assets are safeguarded against unauthorized or improper use, and the Company’s transactions are properly recorded and reported to permit the preparation of the Company’s consolidated financial statements in conformity with IFRS.
Management recognizes its responsibility for conducting the Company’s affairs in a manner to comply with the requirements of applicable laws and for maintaining proper standards of conduct in its activities.
The Audit Committee, all of whose members are independent directors, is involved in the review of the consolidated financial statements and other financial information.
The Audit Committee’s role is to examine the consolidated financial statements and annual report and once approved, recommend that the Board of Directors approve them, examine internal control over financial reporting and information protection systems and all other matters relating to the Company’s accounting and finances. In order to do so, the Audit Committee meets periodically with the external auditor to review its audit plan and discuss the results of its examinations. The Audit Committee is also responsible for recommending the nomination of the external auditor.
The Company’s external independent registered public accounting firm, Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton LLP, was appointed by the Shareholders at the Annual Meeting of Shareholders on June 7, 2018 to conduct the integrated audit of the Company’s consolidated financial statements, and the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Its reports indicating the scope of its audits and its opinions on the consolidated financial statements and the Company’s internal control over financial reporting follow.
/s/ Gregory A.C. Yull
Gregory A.C. Yull
President and Chief Executive Officer
/s/ Jeffrey Crystal
Jeffrey Crystal
Chief Financial Officer
Sarasota, Florida and Montreal, Quebec
March 12, 2019



2


Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of the Company’s financial reporting as well as the preparation of consolidated financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.
Internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit the preparation of consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements and, even when determined to be effective, can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to consolidated financial statements preparation and presentation. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 based on the criteria established in the “2013 Internal Control – Integrated Framework” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Management’s assessment of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 did not include the acquisition of 100% of the outstanding equity value in Polyair Inter Pak Inc. (“Polyair”) consummated during fiscal year 2018. Polyair is included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements and represents 18% of total assets as of December 31, 2018 and 5% of revenues for the year then ended.
Subject to the foregoing, management has concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2018 based on those criteria.
The Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 has been audited by Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton LLP, the Company’s external independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in its report which follows.
/s/ Gregory A.C. Yull
Gregory A.C. Yull
President and Chief Executive Officer
/s/ Jeffrey Crystal
Jeffrey Crystal
Chief Financial Officer
Sarasota, Florida and Montreal, Quebec
March 12, 2019


3



rcgtlogo.jpg
 
Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton LLP
 
Suite 2000
Report of Independent Registered
National Bank Tower
Public Accounting Firm
600 De La Gauchetière Street West
 
Montréal, Quebec H3B 4L8
 
 
To the Shareholders and Directors of
Telephone: 514-878-2691
Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Fax: 514-878-2127
 
www.rcgt.com

Opinion on the Consolidated Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Intertape Polymer Group Inc. (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the related consolidated statements of earnings, comprehensive income, changes in equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the results of its consolidated operations and its consolidated cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on the criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated March 12, 2019 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
Basis for Opinion
These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s consolidated financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.


4


We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

rcgtsignature.jpg

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 1981.


Montreal, Canada
March 12, 2019
________________________________________________
1 CPA auditor, CA, public accountancy permit No. A121855

 



5


rcgtlogo.jpg
 
Raymond Chabot Grant Thornton LLP
Report of Independent Registered
Suite 2000
Public Accounting Firm on Internal
National Bank Tower
Control over Financial Reporting
600 De La Gauchetière Street West
 
Montréal, Quebec H3B 4L8
 
 
To the Shareholders and Directors of
Telephone: 514-878-2691
Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Fax: 514-878-2127
 
www.rcgt.com


Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Intertape Polymer Group Inc. (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by COSO.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018 and our report dated March 12, 2019 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.
Basis for Opinion
The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting ("Management's Report"). Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the US federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
Our audit of, and opinion on, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting does not include the internal control over financial reporting of Polyair Inter Pak Inc. (“Polyair”), a wholly owned subsidiary, whose financial statements reflect total assets and revenues constituting 18% and 5%, respectively, of the related consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended December 31, 2018. As indicated in in the accompanying Management’s Report, Polyair was acquired during 2018.


6


Management’s assertion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting excluded internal control over financial reporting of Polyair.
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of consolidated financial statements for external purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of consolidated financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

rcgtsignature.jpg

Montreal, Canada
March 12, 2019
________________________________________________
1 CPA auditor, CA, public accountancy permit No. A121855
 



7


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Consolidated Earnings
Years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
(In thousands of US dollars, except per share amounts)
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Revenue
1,053,019

 
898,126

 
808,801

Cost of sales
834,136

 
696,719

 
617,314

Gross profit
218,883

 
201,407

 
191,487

Selling, general and administrative expenses
122,466

 
107,592

 
102,580

Research expenses
12,024

 
11,601

 
10,790

 
134,490

 
119,193

 
113,370

Operating profit before manufacturing facility closures,
restructuring and other related charges
84,393

 
82,214

 
78,117

Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other
related charges (Note 4)
7,060

 
1,359

 
2,408

Operating profit
77,333

 
80,855

 
75,709

Finance costs (income) (Note 3)
 
 
 
 
 
Interest
17,072

 
7,246

 
4,398

Other expense (income), net
3,810

 
(3,398
)
 
605

 
20,882

 
3,848

 
5,003

Earnings before income tax expense
56,451

 
77,007

 
70,706

Income tax expense (Note 5)
 
 
 
 
 
Current
934

 
6,635

 
8,757

Deferred
8,868

 
6,414

 
10,812

 
9,802

 
13,049

 
19,569

Net earnings
46,649

 
63,958

 
51,137

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net earnings (loss) attributable to:
 
 
 
 
 
Company shareholders
46,753

 
64,224

 
51,120

Non-controlling interests
(104
)
 
(266
)
 
17

 
46,649

 
63,958

 
51,137

 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings per share attributable to Company shareholders (Note 6)
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
0.79

 
1.09

 
0.87

Diluted
0.79

 
1.08

 
0.85

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements and Note 3 presents additional information on consolidated earnings.


8


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Consolidated Comprehensive Income
Years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
(In thousands of US dollars)
 
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Net earnings
46,649

 
63,958

 
51,137

Other comprehensive income (loss)
 
 
 
 
 
Change in fair value of interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges (1) (Note 22)
1,433

 
1,608

 
136

Reclassification adjustments for amounts recognized in earnings related to interest rate swap agreements (Note 22)
(531
)
 

 

Deferred tax benefit due to enactment of US tax reform legislation (Note 5)

 
116

 

Change in cumulative translation adjustments
(153
)
 
4,734

 
789

Net loss arising from hedge of a net investment in foreign operations (Note 22)
(9,421
)
 

 

Items that will be reclassified subsequently to net earnings
(8,672
)
 
6,458

 
925

Remeasurement of defined benefit liability (2) (Note 18)
2,286

 
89

 
201

Deferred tax expense due to enactment of US tax reform legislation (Note 5)

 
(714
)
 

Items that will not be reclassified subsequently to net earnings
2,286

 
(625
)
 
201

Other comprehensive (loss) income
(6,386
)
 
5,833

 
1,126

Comprehensive income for the year
40,263

 
69,791

 
52,263

Comprehensive income (loss) for the year attributable to:
 
 
 
 
 
Company shareholders
40,828

 
69,777

 
52,353

Non-controlling interests
(565
)
 
14

 
(90
)
 
40,263

 
69,791

 
52,263


(1) 
Presented net of deferred income tax (benefit) expense of ($463) in 2018, $750 in 2017 and $83 in 2016.
(2) 
Presented net of deferred income tax expense of $730 in 2018, $213 in 2017, and $66 in 2016.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.


9


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Consolidated Changes in Equity
Year ended December 31, 2016

(In thousands of US dollars, except for number of common shares)
 
Capital stock
 
 
 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Number
 
Amount
 
Contributed
surplus
 
Cumulative
translation
adjustment
account
 
Reserve for
cash flow
hedges
 
Total
 
Deficit
 
Total equity
attributable
to Company
shareholders
 
Non-
controlling
interest
 
Total
equity
 
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Balance as of December 31, 2015
58,667,535
 
347,325

 
23,298

 
(20,407
)
 
(272
)
 
(20,679
)
 
(133,216
)
 
216,728

 

 
216,728

Transactions with owners
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exercise of stock options (Note 16)
540,000
 
1,452

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,452

 
 
 
1,452

Change in excess tax benefit on exercised share-based awards (Note 5)
 
 
2,693

 
(2,693
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

Change in excess tax benefit on outstanding share-based awards (Note 5)
 
 
 
 
4,302

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,302

 
 
 
4,302

Share-based compensation (Note 16)
 
 
 
 
5,273

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5,273

 
 
 
5,273

Share-based compensation expense credited to capital on options exercised (Note 16)
 
 
595

 
(595
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

Repurchases of common shares (Note 16)
(147,200)
 
(862
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(835
)
 
(1,697
)
 
 
 
(1,697
)
Dividends on common shares (Note 16)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(31,694
)
 
(31,694
)
 
 
 
(31,694
)
 
392,800
 
3,878

 
6,287

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(32,529
)
 
(22,364
)
 
 
 
(22,364
)
Net earnings
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
51,120

 
51,120

 
17

 
51,137

Other comprehensive income (loss)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Change in fair value of interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges (1) (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
136

 
136

 
 
 
136

 
 
 
136

Remeasurement of defined benefit liability (2) (Note 18)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
201

 
201

 
 
 
201

Change in cumulative translation adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
896

 
 
 
896

 
 
 
896

 
(107
)
 
789

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
896

 
136

 
1,032

 
201

 
1,233

 
(107
)
 
1,126

Comprehensive income (loss) for the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
896

 
136

 
1,032

 
51,321

 
52,353

 
(90
)
 
52,263

Recognition of non-controlling interest put options arising from the acquisition of Powerband (3) (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(10,181
)
 
(10,181
)
 
 
 
(10,181
)
Non-controlling interest arising from the Powerband Acquisition (Note 17)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6,497

 
6,497

Balance as of December 31, 2016
59,060,335
 
351,203

 
29,585

 
(19,511
)
 
(136
)
 
(19,647
)
 
(124,605
)
 
236,536

 
6,407

 
242,943


(1) 
Presented net of deferred income tax expense of $83 for the year ended December 31, 2016.
(2) 
Presented net of deferred income tax expense of $66 for the year ended December 31, 2016.
(3) 
Refers to the acquisition by the Company of 74% of Powerband Industries Private Limited (doing business as "Powerband") on September 16, 2016. On November 16, 2018, the Company acquired the remaining 26% interest in Powerband, such that as of December 31, 2018, the Company owns all of the issued and outstanding common shares of Powerband. Refer to Note 22 for additional information.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.


10


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Consolidated Changes in Equity
Year ended December 31, 2017
(In thousands of US dollars, except for number of common shares)
 
Capital stock
 
 
 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Number
 
Amount
 
Contributed
surplus
 
Cumulative
translation
adjustment
account
 
Reserve for
cash flow
hedges
 
Total
 
Deficit
 
Total equity
attributable
to Company
shareholders
 
Non-
controlling
interests
 
Total
equity
 
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Balance as of December 31, 2016
59,060,335
 
351,203

 
29,585

 
(19,511
)
 
(136
)
 
(19,647
)
 
(124,605
)
 
236,536

 
6,407

 
242,943

Transactions with owners
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exercise of stock options (Note 16)
226,875
 
1,362

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,362

 
 
 
1,362

Change in excess tax benefit on exercised share-based awards (Note 5)
 
 
597

 
(597
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

Change in excess tax benefit on outstanding share-based awards (Note 5)
 
 
 
 
(3,135
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(3,135
)
 
 
 
(3,135
)
Share-based compensation (Note 16)
 
 
 
 
(7,828
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(4,183
)
(4 
) 
(12,011
)
 
 
 
(12,011
)
Share-based compensation expense credited to capital on options exercised (Note 16)
 
 
495

 
(495
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

Repurchases of common shares (Note 16)
(487,300)
 
(2,898
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(4,553
)
 
(7,451
)
 
 
 
(7,451
)
Dividends on common shares (Note 16)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(33,030
)
 
(33,030
)
 
 
 
(33,030
)
 
(260,425)
 
(444
)
 
(12,055
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(41,766
)
 
(54,265
)
 
 
 
(54,265
)
Net earnings (loss)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
64,224

 
64,224

 
(266
)
 
63,958

Other comprehensive income (loss)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Change in fair value of interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges (1) (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,608

 
1,608

 
 
 
1,608

 
 
 
1,608

Remeasurement of defined benefit liability (2) (Note 18)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
89

 
89

 
 
 
89

Deferred tax benefit (expense) due to enactment of US tax reform legislation (Note 5)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
116

 
116

 
(714
)
 
(598
)
 
 
 
(598
)
Change in cumulative translation adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,454

 
 
 
4,454

 
 
 
4,454

 
280

 
4,734

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,454

 
1,724

 
6,178

 
(625
)
 
5,553

 
280

 
5,833

Comprehensive income for the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,454

 
1,724

 
6,178

 
63,599

 
69,777

 
14

 
69,791

Derecognition of non-controlling interest put options arising from the Powerband Acquisition (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8,810

 
8,810

 
 
 
8,810

Recognition of the call option redemption liability arising from the Powerband Acquisition (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(12,725
)
 
(12,725
)
 
 
 
(12,725
)
Non-controlling interest arising from investment in Capstone (3) (Note 17)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 


 
15

 
15

Capital transactions with non-controlling shareholders of Capstone (Note 17)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
153

 
153

Balance as of December 31, 2017
58,799,910
 
350,759

 
17,530

 
(15,057
)
 
1,588

 
(13,469
)
 
(106,687
)
 
248,133

 
6,589

 
254,722


(1) 
Presented net of deferred income tax expense of $750 for the year ended December 31, 2017.
(2) 
Presented net of deferred income tax expense of $213 for the year ended December 31, 2017.
(3) 
Refers to the purchase by the Company of 99.7% of the shares in Capstone Polyweave Private Limited, a newly-formed enterprise in India (d/b/a "Capstone"), on June 23, 2017. As of December 31, 2018, the Company held a 55% controlling ownership stake in Capstone while the minority shareholders held a 45% non-controlling interest in Capstone. Refer to Note 17 for additional information.
(4) 
Presented net of income tax benefit of $1,620 for the year ended December 31, 2017.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.


11


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Consolidated Changes in Equity
Year ended December 31, 2018
(In thousands of US dollars, except for number of common shares)
 
Capital stock
 
 
 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Number
 
Amount
 
Contributed
surplus
 
Cumulative
translation
adjustment
account
 
Reserve for
cash flow
hedges
 
Total
 
Deficit
 
Total equity
attributable
to Company
shareholders
 
Non-
controlling
interests
 
Total
equity
 
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Balance as of December 31, 2017
58,799,910
 
350,759

 
17,530

 
(15,057
)
 
1,588

 
(13,469
)
 
(106,687
)
 
248,133

 
6,589

 
254,722

Transactions with owners
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exercise of stock options (Note 16)
67,500
 
618

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
618

 
 
 
618

Change in excess tax benefit on exercised share-based awards (Note 5)
 
 
7

 
(7
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

Change in excess tax benefit on outstanding share-based awards (Note 5)
 
 
 
 
(737
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(737
)
 
 
 
(737
)
Share-based compensation (Note 16)
 
 
 
 
467

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(472
)
(4 
) 
(5
)
 
 
 
(5
)
Share-based compensation expense credited to capital on options exercised (Note 16)
 
 
179

 
(179
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

Repurchases of common shares (Note 16)
(217,100)
 
(1,296
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,263
)
 
(2,559
)
 
 
 
(2,559
)
Dividends on common shares (Note 16)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(32,943
)
 
(32,943
)
 
 
 
(32,943
)
 
(149,600)
 
(492
)
 
(456
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(34,678
)
 
(35,626
)
 
 
 
(35,626
)
Net earnings (loss)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
46,753

 
46,753

 
(104
)
 
46,649

Other comprehensive income (loss)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Change in fair value of interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges (1) (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,433

 
1,433

 
 
 
1,433

 
 
 
1,433

Reclassification adjustments for amounts recognized in earnings (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(531
)
 
(531
)
 
 
 
(531
)
 
 
 
(531
)
Remeasurement of defined benefit liability (2) (Note 18)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,286

 
2,286

 
 
 
2,286

Change in cumulative translation adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
308

 
 
 
308

 
 
 
308

 
(461
)
 
(153
)
Net loss arising from hedge of a net investment in foreign operations (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
(9,421
)
 
 
 
(9,421
)
 
 
 
(9,421
)
 

 
(9,421
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(9,113
)
 
902

 
(8,211
)
 
2,286

 
(5,925
)
 
(461
)
 
(6,386
)
Comprehensive income (loss) for the period
 
 
 
 
 
 
(9,113
)
 
902

 
(8,211
)
 
49,039

 
40,828

 
(565
)
 
40,263

Non-controlling interest arising from investment in Polyair (3)
(Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
421

 
421

Capital transactions with non-controlling shareholders of Capstone (Note 17)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
11,102

 
11,102

Recognition of non-controlling interest put options arising from the Capstone Acquisition (Note 22)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(10,888
)
 
(10,888
)
 
 
 
(10,888
)
Derecognition of call option redemption liability arising from the Powerband Acquisition (Note 22)

















1,434



1,434





1,434

Acquisition of the non-controlling interest of Powerband (Note 22)

















5,966



5,966


(5,966
)


Balance as of December 31, 2018
58,650,310
 
350,267

 
17,074

 
(24,170
)
 
2,490

 
(21,680
)
 
(95,814
)
 
249,847

 
11,581

 
261,428


(1) 
Presented net of deferred income tax benefit of $463 for the year ended December 31, 2018.
(2) 
Presented net of deferred income tax expense of $730 for the year ended December 31, 2018.
(3) 
As part of the acquisition of Polyair Inter Pack Inc. (“Polyair”), on August 3, 2018, the Company indirectly obtained a controlling 50.1% interest in the Polyair subsidiary GPCP Inc. Refer to Note 17 for additional information.
(4) 
Presented net of income tax benefit of $126 for the year ended December 31, 2018.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.


12


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Consolidated Cash Flows
Years ended December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
(In thousands of US dollars)
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
 
 
 
 
 
Net earnings
46,649

 
63,958

 
51,137

Adjustments to net earnings
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation and amortization
44,829

 
36,138

 
30,978

Income tax expense
9,802

 
13,049

 
19,569

Interest expense
17,072

 
7,246

 
4,398

Non-cash charges in connection with manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges
6,136

 
133

 
5,204

Impairment of inventories
716

 
801

 
1,997

Share-based compensation expense
1,914

 
3,291

 
8,201

Pension and other post-retirement expense related to defined benefit plans
2,695

 
2,730

 
2,913

Loss (gain) on foreign exchange
1,933

 
(2,578
)
 
(510
)
Other adjustments for non-cash items
928

 
(1,958
)
 
276

Income taxes paid, net
(1,577
)
 
(6,452
)
 
(7,193
)
Contributions to defined benefit plans
(13,802
)
 
(4,143
)
 
(1,268
)
Cash flows from operating activities before changes in working capital items
117,295

 
112,215

 
115,702

Changes in working capital items
 
 
 
 
 
Trade receivables
(9,660
)
 
(6,847
)
 
(8,920
)
Inventories
(30,388
)
 
(9,969
)
 
(5,127
)
Other current assets
(6,523
)
 
89

 
451

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities and share-based compensation liabilities, current
19,215

 
(1,493
)
 
5,304

Provisions
859

 
(1,863
)
 
725

 
(26,497
)
 
(20,083
)
 
(7,567
)
Cash flows from operating activities
90,798

 
92,132

 
108,135

INVESTING ACTIVITIES
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition of subsidiaries, net of cash acquired
(165,763
)
 
(67,027
)
 
(41,855
)
Purchases of property, plant and equipment
(75,781
)
 
(85,312
)
 
(49,972
)
Purchase of intangible assets
(1,558
)
 
(1,914
)
 
(88
)
Other investing activities
(173
)
 
1,338

 
66

Cash flows from investing activities
(243,275
)
 
(152,915
)
 
(91,849
)
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from borrowings
991,917

 
257,021

 
180,604

Repayment of borrowings
(762,622
)
 
(162,107
)
 
(155,630
)
Payments of debt issue costs
(7,862
)
 
(683
)
 
(160
)
Interest paid
(10,901
)
 
(7,360
)
 
(4,739
)
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
618

 
1,362

 
1,452

Repurchases of common shares
(2,160
)
 
(7,451
)
 
(1,697
)
Dividends paid
(32,776
)
 
(33,199
)
 
(31,365
)
Acquisition of non-controlling interest in Powerband through settlement of call option
(9,869
)
 

 

Cash outflow from capital transactions with non-controlling interest in Capstone
(2,630
)
 

 

Other financing activities
452

 
154

 

Cash flows from financing activities
164,167

 
47,737

 
(11,535
)
Net increase (decrease) in cash
11,690

 
(13,046
)
 
4,751

Effect of foreign exchange differences on cash
(2,132
)
 
1,183

 
(1,410
)
Cash, beginning of year
9,093

 
20,956

 
17,615

Cash, end of year
18,651

 
9,093

 
20,956


The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.


13


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Consolidated Balance Sheets
As of
(In thousands of US dollars)
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
ASSETS
 
 
 
Current assets
 
 
 
Cash
18,651

 
9,093

Trade receivables (Note 22)
129,285

 
106,634

Inventories (Note 7)
190,675

 
146,804

Other current assets (Note 8)
24,395

 
16,188

 
363,006

 
278,719

Property, plant and equipment (Note 9)
377,076

 
313,520

Goodwill (Note 17)
107,714

 
41,690

Intangible assets (Note 11)
122,389

 
47,318

Deferred tax assets (Note 5)
25,069

 
27,627

Other assets (Note 10)
9,586

 
6,998

Total assets
1,004,840

 
715,872

 
 
 
 
LIABILITIES
 
 
 
Current liabilities
 
 
 
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
154,838

 
104,812

Share-based compensation liabilities, current (Note 16)
5,066

 
10,265

Call option redemption liability (Note 22)

 
12,725

Provisions, current (Note 14)
2,262

 
657

Borrowings, current (Note 13)
14,389

 
14,979

 
176,555

 
143,438

Borrowings, non-current (Note 13)
485,596

 
264,484

Pension, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefits (Note 18)
14,898

 
29,298

Share-based compensation liabilities, non-current (Note 16)
4,125

 
4,984

Non-controlling interest put options (Note 22)
10,499

 

Deferred tax liabilities (Note 5)
42,321

 
13,769

Provisions, non-current (Note 14)
4,194

 
3,221

Other liabilities (Note 15)
5,224

 
1,956

Total liabilities
743,412

 
461,150

EQUITY
 
 
 
Capital stock (Note 16)
350,267

 
350,759

Contributed surplus (Note 16)
17,074

 
17,530

Deficit
(95,814
)
 
(106,687
)
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
(21,680
)
 
(13,469
)
Total equity attributable to Company shareholders
249,847

 
248,133

Non-controlling interests
11,581

 
6,589

Total equity
261,428

 
254,722

Total liabilities and equity
1,004,840

 
715,872

           
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.


14


Intertape Polymer Group Inc.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2018
(In US dollars, tabular amounts in thousands, except shares, per share data and as otherwise noted)
1 - GENERAL BUSINESS DESCRIPTION
Intertape Polymer Group Inc. (the “Parent Company”), incorporated under the Canada Business Corporations Act, has its principal administrative offices in Montreal, Québec, Canada and in Sarasota, Florida, USA. The address of the Parent Company’s registered office is 800 Place Victoria, Suite 3700, Montreal, Québec H4Z 1E9, c/o Fasken Martineau DuMoulin LLP. The Parent Company’s common shares are listed on the Toronto Stock Exchange (“TSX”) in Canada. The principal activities of the Parent Company and its subsidiaries (together referred to as the “Company”) are set out in Note 2.
The Company develops, manufactures and sells a variety of paper-and-film based pressure sensitive and water-activated tapes, polyethylene and specialized polyolefin films, protective packaging, engineered coated products and complementary packaging systems for industrial and retail use.
Intertape Polymer Group Inc. is the Company’s ultimate parent.
2 - ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Basis of Presentation and Statement of Compliance
The consolidated financial statements present the Company’s consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, as well as its consolidated earnings, comprehensive income, cash flows, and changes in equity for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018. These consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”) and are expressed in United States (“US”) dollars.
The consolidated financial statements were authorized for issuance by the Company’s Board of Directors on March 12, 2019.
New Standards adopted as of January 1, 2018
IFRS 15 – Revenue from Contracts with Customers replaces IAS 18 – Revenue, IAS 11 – Construction Contracts and some revenue related interpretations. IFRS 15 established a new control-based revenue recognition model, changed the basis for deciding when revenue is recognized at a point in time or over time, provided new and more detailed guidance on specific topics and expanded and improved disclosures about revenue. IFRS 15 is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2018 and the Company adopted it as of this date. Management chose the modified retrospective method of adoption, and as a result, the 2017 comparative period has not been restated to conform to the new IFRS 15 requirements. There was no material impact to the Company’s financial statements as a result of adopting IFRS 15. The Company's accounting policy with respect to revenue recognition and additional disclosure relative to IFRS 15 are explained in the accounting policies below.
The Company adopted IFRS 9 (2013) - Financial Instruments effective January 1, 2015. IFRS 9 (2014) - Financial Instruments differs in some regards from IFRS 9 (2013). IFRS 9 (2014) includes updated guidance on the classification and measurement of financial assets. The final standard also amended the impairment model by introducing a new expected credit loss model for calculating impairment. The mandatory effective date of IFRS 9 (2014) is for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2018 and must be applied retrospectively with some exceptions. The Company adopted IFRS 9 (2014) on January 1, 2018 and the new guidance resulted in enhancements to the Company's model that calculates the allowance for doubtful accounts on trade receivables for expected credit losses. There was no material impact to the Company’s financial statements as a result of adopting IFRS 9 (2014) and the 2017 comparative period has not been restated. The Company's accounting policy with respect to the allowance for doubtful accounts on trade receivables for expected credit losses are explained in the accounting policies below.
In the current year, the Company has applied a number of other amendments to IFRS Standards and Interpretations issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) that are effective for an annual period that begins on or after January 1, 2018. Their adoption has not had any material impact on the disclosures or on the amounts reported in these financial statements.


15


New Standards and Interpretations Issued but Not Yet Effective
As of the date of authorization of the Company's financial statements, certain new standards, amendments and interpretations, and improvements to existing standards have been published by the IASB but are not yet effective and have not been adopted early by the Company. Management anticipates that all of the relevant pronouncements will be adopted in the first reporting period following the date of application. Information on new standards, amendments and interpretations, and improvements to existing standards, which could potentially impact the Company’s financial statements, are detailed as follows:
IFRS 16 - Leases, which will replace IAS 17 - Leases, introduces a comprehensive model for the identification of lease arrangements and accounting treatments for both lessors and lessees, as well as new disclosure requirements. It will result in most leases being recognized on the balance sheet by lessees as lease liabilities with a corresponding right-of-use asset. IFRS 16 is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2019. The Company will adopt IFRS 16 effective January 1, 2019 (hereafter "the initial application date"). The Company is acting as a lessee for its leases. Management has performed a review of the new guidance as compared to the Company's current accounting policies, including a review of the various practical expedients and other elections available under the new guidance, an analysis of the Company's significant existing leases for treatment under the new guidance and an analysis estimating the potential impact on the financial statements. The Company is using the modified retrospective approach for transition and as a result, the Company's 2018 financial statements will not be restated. Accordingly, the Company will make use of the practical expedient available on transition to IFRS 16 not to reassess whether a contract is or contains a lease and the definition of a lease in accordance with IAS 17 and IFRIC 4 will continue to apply to those leases entered or modified before January 1, 2019. The Company will apply recognition exemptions across its complete portfolio of leased assets for short-term leases and leases of low value items. Furthermore, the Company will use certain relevant practical expedients available under the modified retrospective approach. Specifically, these include (i) applying a single discount rate to a portfolio of leases with reasonably similar characteristics, (ii) relying on the assessment of whether leases are onerous applying IAS 37 Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets immediately before the date of initial application as an alternative to performing an impairment review, (iii) excluding leases for which the lease term ends within 12 months of the date of initial application, (iv) excluding initial direct costs from the measurement of the right-of-use asset at the date of initial application, and (v) using hindsight, such as in determining the lease term if the contract contains options to extend or terminate the lease.
The discount rates are based on market rates as of January 1, 2019 for a BB- rated industrial company issuing debt for maturities ranging from 3 months to 10 years. As of December 31, 2018, the Company has non-cancellable operating lease commitments of $35.5 million. Of these commitments, approximately $2.3 million relate to short-term and low value leases which will be recognized on a straight-line basis as expense in earnings. The adoption of this new guidance will result in changes to the balance sheet, including (i) the recognition of approximately $31.1 million in right-of-use assets included in property, plant and equipment, (ii) the recognition of approximately $31.5 million in lease liabilities included in borrowings, current and non-current, (iii) decrease of approximately $0.1 million in accounts payable and accrued liabilities and (iv) decrease of approximately $0.3 million in other liabilities.
Refer to Note 21 for more information on the Company's operating lease commitments.
Based on the Company's current portfolio of leases, management expects:
an increase in cash flows from operating activities and a decrease in cash flows from financing activities, as operating lease payments will be reclassified to financing cash flows as components of interest and lease obligations; and
an insignificant change to net earnings, but with reclassification of amounts between costs within operating profit and finance costs as operating lease costs are reclassified into amortization of the right-of-use asset and interest expense on the related lease obligation.
On March 29, 2018, the IASB issued its revised Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting ("Conceptual Framework"). This replaces the previous version of the Conceptual Framework issued in 2010. The revised Conceptual Framework will be effective on January 1, 2020. Management is currently assessing but has not yet determined the impact of this new standard on the Company’s financial statements.
Certain other new standards and interpretations have been issued but are not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.


16


Basis of Measurement
The consolidated financial statements have been prepared on the historical cost basis, except for certain financial instruments that are measured at revalued amounts or fair values at the end of each reporting period and the Company’s pension plans, post-retirement plans and other long-term employee benefit plans, as explained in the accounting policies below.
Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date, regardless of whether that price is directly observable or estimated using another valuation technique. In estimating the fair value of an asset or a liability, the Company takes into account the characteristics of the asset or liability if market participants would take those characteristics into account when pricing the asset or liability at the measurement date.
Basis of Consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Parent Company and all of its subsidiaries. The Parent Company controls a subsidiary if it has power over the investee, is exposed, or has rights, to variable return, from its involvement with the subsidiary and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the subsidiary. Consolidation of a subsidiary begins when the Company obtains control over the subsidiary and ceases when the Company loses control of the subsidiary. Specifically, subsidiaries acquired or disposed of during the year are reflected in the Company's earnings from the date the Company gains control until the date when the Company ceases to control the subsidiary. Changes in the Company's interests in subsidiaries that do not result in a loss of control are accounted for as equity transactions. The carrying amount of the Company's interests and the non‑controlling interests are adjusted to reflect the changes in their relative interests in the subsidiaries.
Earnings and each component of other comprehensive income are attributed to the owners of the Company and to the non‑controlling interests. Total comprehensive income of the subsidiaries is attributed to the owners of the Company and to the non‑controlling interests based on their respective ownership interests, even if this results in the non‑controlling interests having a deficit balance.
Non-controlling interest in subsidiaries is presented in the consolidated balance sheets as a separate component of equity that is distinct from shareholders' equity.
All intercompany balances and transactions are eliminated on consolidation, including unrealized gains and losses on transactions between the consolidated entities.
Powerband and Capstone have a fiscal year end of March 31 due to Indian legislation. However, for consolidation purposes, the financial information for Powerband and Capstone is presented as of the same date as the Parent Company. All other subsidiaries have a reporting date identical to that of the Parent Company. Amounts reported in the financial statements of subsidiaries have been adjusted where necessary to ensure consistency with the accounting policies adopted by the Parent Company.


17


Details of the Parent Company’s subsidiaries are as follows:
 
Name of Subsidiary
 
Principal
Activity
 
Country of Incorporation
and Residence
 
Proportion of Ownership
Interest and Voting Power Held as of:
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
Better Packages, Inc.
 
Manufacturing
 
United States
 
100%
 
100%
BP Acquisition Corporation
 
Holding
 
United States
 
100%
 
100%
Cantech Industries, Inc.
 
Manufacturing
 
United States
 
100%
 
100%
Capstone Polyweave Private Limited
 
Manufacturing
 
India
 
55%
 
98.4%
FIBOPE Portuguesa-Filmes Biorientados, S.A.
 
Manufacturing
 
Portugal
 
100%
 
100%
GPCP, Inc.
 
Manufacturing
 
United States
 
50.1%
 
Intertape Polymer Corp.
 
Manufacturing
 
United States
 
100%
 
100%
Intertape Polymer Europe GmbH
 
Distribution
 
Germany
 
100%
 
100%
Intertape Polymer Inc.
 
Manufacturing
 
Canada
 
100%
 
100%
Intertape Polymer Japan GK
 
Distribution
 
Japan
 
100%
 
Intertape Polymer Woven USA Inc.
 
Manufacturing
 
United States
 
100%
 
Intertape Woven Products Services, S.A. de C.V.
 
Non-operating
 
Mexico
 
100%
 
100%
Intertape Woven Products, S.A. de C.V.
 
Non-operating
 
Mexico
 
100%
 
100%
IPG (US) Holdings Inc.
 
Holding
 
United States
 
100%
 
100%
IPG (US) Inc.
 
Holding
 
United States
 
100%
 
100%
IPG Luxembourg Finance S.à.r.l.
 
Financing
 
Luxembourg
 
100%
 
100%
IPG Mauritius Holding Company Ltd
 
Holding
 
Mauritius
 
100%
 
100%
IPG Mauritius II Ltd
 
Holding
 
Mauritius
 
100%
 
100%
IPG Mauritius Ltd
 
Holding
 
Mauritius
 
100%
 
100%
Polyair Canada Limited
 
Manufacturing
 
Canada
 
100%
 
Polyair Corporation
 
Manufacturing
 
United States
 
100%
 
Powerband Industries Private Limited
 
Manufacturing
 
India
 
100%
 
74%
Spuntech Fabrics Inc.
 
Holding
 
Canada
 
100%
 
100%
Business Acquisitions
The Company applies the acquisition method of accounting for business acquisitions. The consideration transferred by the Company to obtain control of a subsidiary is calculated as the sum of the acquisition-date fair values of assets transferred, liabilities incurred, and the equity interests issued by the Company. Acquisition costs are expensed as incurred. Assets acquired and liabilities assumed are generally measured at their acquisition-date fair values. Refer to Note 17 for more information regarding business acquisitions.
Non-controlling Interests
Non-controlling interests represent the equity in subsidiaries that are not attributable, directly or indirectly, to the Parent Company. A non-controlling interest is initially recognized as the proportionate share of the identifiable net assets of the subsidiary on the date of its acquisition and is subsequently adjusted for the non-controlling interest’s share in changes of the acquired subsidiary’s earnings and capital, as well as changes in foreign currency exchange rates where applicable.
Foreign Currency Translation
Functional and presentation currency
The consolidated financial statements are presented in US dollars, which is the Company’s presentation currency. Items included in the financial statements of each of the consolidated entities are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment


18


in which such entity operates (the “functional currency”). The significant functional currencies of the different consolidated entities include the US dollar, Canadian dollar ("CDN"), Indian rupee and Euro.
Transactions and balances

Transactions denominated in currencies other than the functional currency of a consolidated entity are translated into the functional currency of that entity using the exchange rates prevailing at the date of each transaction.
Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated into the functional currencies using the current rate at each period-end.
Foreign exchange gains or losses arising on settlement or translation of monetary items are recognized in earnings in finance costs in the period in which they arise, except when deferred in other comprehensive income (loss) ("OCI") as a qualifying hedge (refer to Note 22). Tax charges and credits attributable to exchange differences on qualifying hedges are also recognized in OCI.
Non-monetary items are not retranslated at year-end and are measured at historical cost (translated using the exchange rates at the transaction date), except for non-monetary items measured at fair value which are translated using the exchange rates at the date when fair value was determined.
Foreign Operations
Assets and liabilities of entities with a functional currency other than the US dollar are translated to the presentation currency using the closing exchange rate in effect at the balance sheet date, and revenues and expenses are translated at each month-end’s average exchange rate. The resulting translation adjustments are charged or credited to OCI and recognized in the cumulative translation adjustment account within accumulated OCI in equity. The functional currencies of entities within the Company have remained unchanged during the reporting period.
When a foreign operation is partially disposed of or sold, exchange differences that were recorded in equity are recognized in earnings as part of the gain or loss on sale.
Foreign exchange gains or losses recognized in earnings are presented in finance costs - other expense (income), net.
Segment Reporting
The Company operates in various geographic locations and develops, manufactures and sells a variety of products to a diverse customer base. Most of the Company’s products are made from similar processes. A vast majority of the Company’s products, while brought to market through various distribution channels, generally have similar economic characteristics. The Company’s decisions about resources to be allocated are predominantly determined as a whole based on the Company’s operational, management and reporting structure. The chief operating decision maker primarily assesses the Company’s performance as a single reporting segment.
Revenue Recognition
The Company recognizes revenues from the sale of goods classified within five product categories: Tape, Film, Engineered Coated Products, Protective Packaging and Other. Refer to Note 19 for additional information on revenue by product category and geographical location.
The vast majority of the Company's customer arrangements contain a single performance obligation to transfer manufactured goods. Revenue is recognized when control of goods has transferred to customers. Control is considered transferred in accordance with the terms of sale, generally when goods are shipped to external customers as that is generally when legal title, physical possession and risks and rewards of goods/services transfers to the customer. The normal credit term is 30 days upon delivery.
Revenue is recognized at the transaction price which the Company expects to be entitled. In determining the transaction price, the Company considers the effects of variable consideration. The main sources of variable consideration for the Company are customer rebates and cash discounts. These incentives are recorded as a reduction to revenue at the time of the initial sale using the most-likely amount estimation method. The most-likely amount method is based on the single most likely outcome from a range of possible consideration outcomes. The range of possible consideration outcomes are primarily derived from the following inputs: sales terms, historical experience, trend analysis, and projected market conditions in the various markets served. Because the Company serves numerous markets, the sales incentive programs offered vary across businesses, but the most common incentive


19


relates to amounts paid or credited to customers for achieving defined volume levels or growth objectives. There are no material instances where variable consideration is constrained and not recorded at the initial time of sale.
Certain contracts provide a customer with a right to return goods if certain conditions are met. Product returns are recorded as a reduction to revenue based on anticipated sales returns that occur in the normal course of business. At this time, the Company believes it is highly unlikely that a significant reversal in the cumulative revenue recognized will occur given the consistent level of claims over previous years. Sales, use, value-added, and other excise taxes are not recognized in revenue. The Company has elected to present revenue net of sales taxes and other similar taxes.
Borrowing Costs
Borrowing costs directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of an asset that necessarily takes a substantial period of time to get ready for its intended use are capitalized during the period of time that is necessary to complete and prepare the asset for its intended use. All other borrowing costs are recognized in earnings within interest in finance costs in the period in which they are incurred. Borrowing costs consist of interest and other costs incurred in connection with the borrowing of funds.
Research Expenses
Research expenses are expensed as they are incurred, net of any related investment tax credits, unless the criteria for capitalization of development expenses are met.
Share-Based Compensation Expense
Stock Options
Stock option expense is based on the grant date fair value of the awards expected to vest over the vesting period. Forfeitures are estimated at the time of the grant and are included in the measurement of the expense and are subsequently adjusted to reflect actual events. For awards with graded vesting, the fair value of each tranche is recognized on a straight-line basis over its vesting period.
Any consideration paid by participants on exercise of stock options is credited to capital stock together with any related share-based compensation expense originally recorded in contributed surplus. If the amount of the tax deduction (or estimated future tax deduction) exceeds the amount of the related cumulative remuneration expense for stock options, this indicates that the tax deduction relates not only to remuneration expense but also to an equity item. In this situation, the Company recognizes the excess of the associated current or deferred tax to contributed surplus prior to an award being exercised, and any such amounts are transferred to capital stock upon exercise of the award.
Stock Appreciation Rights
The Stock Appreciation Rights ("SARs") expense is determined based on the fair value of the liability at the end of the reporting period. The expense is recognized over the vesting period. At the end of each reporting period, the Company re-assesses its estimates of the number of awards that are expected to vest and recognizes the impact of the revisions in the consolidated earnings statement. The total amount of expense recognized over the life of the awards will equal the amount of the cash outflow, if any, as a result of exercises. At the end of each reporting period, the lifetime amount of expense recognized will equal the current period value of the SARs using the Black-Scholes pricing model, multiplied by the percentage vested. As a result, the amount of expense recognized can vary due to changes in the model variables from period to period until the SARs are exercised, expire, or are otherwise cancelled.


20


Deferred Share Units
On February 17, 2017, the Board of Directors approved an amendment to the Deferred Share Unit ("DSU") plan to provide for only cash settlement of DSUs. As a result of the amendment, the Company remeasured the fair value of the DSU awards on the amendment date and continues to do so prospectively at each reporting period end date and at settlement. There was no incremental fair value granted as a result of those modifications. The fair value of DSUs is based on the volume weighted average trading price ("VWAP") of the Company’s common shares on the TSX for the five trading days immediately preceding the end of each reporting period. As a result, the amount of expense recognized can vary due to changes in the stock price from period to period until the DSUs are settled, expire, or are otherwise cancelled. The corresponding liability is recorded on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet under the caption share-based compensation liabilities, current, as the Company does not have an unconditional right to defer settlement of the liabilities for at least twelve months after the reporting period end date. DSUs received as a result of a grant are expensed immediately. DSUs received in lieu of cash for directors’ fees are expensed as earned over the service period.
Prior to the amendment, DSUs were to be settled in common shares of the Company and the expense was based on the grant date fair value of the awards with a corresponding adjustment through contributed surplus.
Performance Share Units
On February 17, 2017, the Board of Directors approved an amendment to the Performance Share Unit ("PSU") plan to provide for only cash settlement of PSU awards. As a result of the amendment, the Company remeasured the fair value of the PSU awards on the amendment date and continues to do so prospectively at each reporting period end date and at settlement. There was no incremental fair value granted as a result of these modifications.
Prior to the amendment, PSUs were to be settled in common shares of the Company. The expense was based on the grant date fair value of the awards expected to vest over the vesting period with a corresponding adjustment through contributed surplus. Forfeitures were estimated at the time of the grant and included in the measurement of the expense and are subsequently adjusted to reflect actual events.
PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017 are subject to a market performance condition as well as a time-based vesting condition. Accordingly, the fair value of PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017 is based on the Monte Carlo valuation model at each reporting period end date. PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017 are subject to a market (50 percent) and non-market performance condition (50 percent) as well as a time-based vesting condition. Accordingly, the fair value of PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017 is based 50 percent on the Monte Carlo valuation model at each reporting period end date and 50 percent on the Company's VWAP of common shares on the TSX for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding the reporting period end multiplied by the number of PSUs expected to vest based on estimated achievement of non-market performance criteria at the reporting period end. Expense is recognized over the vesting period. As a result, the amount of expense recognized can vary due to changes in the model variables and estimated achievement of non-market performance criteria, from period to period, until the PSUs are settled, expire or are otherwise cancelled. The corresponding liability is recorded on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet under the caption share-based compensation liabilities, current for amounts expected to settle in the next twelve months and share-based compensation liabilities, non-current for amounts expected to settle in more than twelve months. The cash payment at settlement is calculated based on the number of settled PSUs held by the participant, multiplied by the VWAP of the Company’s common shares on the TSX for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding the day of settlement.
Restricted Share Units
The Restricted Share Unit ("RSU") expense is determined based on the fair value of the liability at the end of the reporting period. The fair value of RSUs is based on the five trading days VWAP of the Company’s common shares on the TSX at the end of each reporting period. The RSUs are expensed over the vesting period beginning from the date of grant through February 15th of the fourth calendar year following the date of grant, unless vesting is accelerated based on retirement eligibility, death or disability.
Refer to Note 16 for more information regarding share-based payments.


21


Income Taxes
Income tax expense (benefit) comprises both current and deferred tax. Current and deferred tax is recognized in earnings except to the extent it relates to items recognized in OCI or directly in equity. When it relates to the latter items, the income tax is recognized in OCI or directly in equity, respectively.
Current tax is based on the results for the period as adjusted for items that are not taxable or deductible. Current tax is calculated using tax rates and laws enacted or substantially enacted at the reporting date in the countries in which the Company operates and generates taxable income.
Management periodically evaluates positions taken in tax returns with respect to situations in which applicable tax regulations are subject to interpretation. Provisions are established where appropriate on the basis of amounts expected to be paid to the taxing authorities.
Deferred tax is recognized in respect of temporary differences arising between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts in the balance sheet. A deferred tax asset is recognized for unused tax losses, tax credits and deductible temporary differences to the extent that it is probable that future taxable income will be available against which they can be utilized. Deferred tax is calculated using tax rates and laws enacted or substantially enacted at the reporting date in the countries where the Company operates, and which are expected to apply when the related deferred income tax asset is realized, or the deferred tax liability is settled.
The carrying amounts of deferred tax assets are reviewed at each reporting period and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable income will be available to allow all or part of the deferred tax asset to be utilized. Unrecognized deferred tax assets are reassessed at each reporting period and are recognized to the extent that it has become probable that future taxable income will allow the deferred tax asset to be recovered.
Deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities are offset only if a legally enforceable right exists to set off the recognized amounts and the deferred taxes relate to the same taxable entity and the same taxation authority.
Earnings Per Share
As discussed above in Share-Based Compensation Expense, the DSU and PSU plans were amended on February 17, 2017 to provide for only cash settlement of awards. Prior to the amendment, PSU and DSUs were to be settled in common shares of the Company.
The impact on the calculation of earnings per share is as follows:
Prior to February 17, 2017
Basic earnings per share was calculated by dividing the net earnings attributable to Company shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period, including the effect of stock options exercised, common shares repurchased under the normal course issuer bid (“NCIB”) and DSUs outstanding.
Diluted earnings per share was calculated by dividing the net earnings attributable to Company shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period, including the effect of stock options exercised, common shares repurchased under the NCIB and DSUs outstanding and for the effects of all dilutive potential outstanding stock options and contingently issuable shares.
Dilutive potential outstanding stock options included the total number of additional common shares that would have been issued by the Company assuming stock options with exercise prices below the average market price for the year were exercised and reduced by the number of shares that the Company could have repurchased if it had used the assumed proceeds from the exercise of stock options to repurchase them on the open market at the average share price for the period.
DSUs were not considered contingently issuable shares since the shares were issuable solely after the passage of time. As such, DSUs were treated as outstanding and included in the calculation of weighted average basic common shares.
PSUs were considered contingently issuable shares since the shares were issuable only after certain service and market-based performance conditions were satisfied. PSUs were treated as outstanding and included in the calculation of weighted average basic common shares only after the date when these conditions were satisfied at the end of the vesting period. PSUs were treated as


22


outstanding and included in the calculation of weighted average diluted common shares, to the extent they are dilutive, when the applicable performance conditions had been satisfied as of the reporting period end date.
Subsequent to February 17, 2017
Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the net earnings attributable to Company shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period, including the effect of stock options exercised and common shares repurchased under the NCIB.
Diluted earnings per share is calculated by dividing the net earnings attributable to Company shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period, including the effect of stock options exercised and common shares repurchased under the NCIB and for the effects of all dilutive potential outstanding stock options.
Dilutive potential outstanding stock options includes the total number of additional common shares that would have been issued by the Company assuming stock options with exercise prices below the average market price for the year were exercised and reduced by the number of shares that the Company could have repurchased if it had used the assumed proceeds from the exercise of stock options to repurchase them on the open market at the average share price for the period.
Refer to Note 6 for more information regarding earnings per share.
Financial Instruments
A financial instrument is any contract that gives rise to a financial asset of one entity and a financial liability or equity instrument of another entity. Financial assets and liabilities are recognized when the Company becomes party to the contractual provisions of the financial instrument. Financial assets are derecognized when the contractual rights to the cash flows from the financial asset expire, or when the financial asset and all substantial risks and rewards are transferred. A financial liability is derecognized when it is extinguished, discharged, cancelled or when it expires.
Classification and initial measurement of financial assets
Financial assets, other than those designated and effective as hedging instruments, are classified, at initial recognition, as subsequently measured at amortized cost, fair value through earnings, and fair value through OCI.
The classification of financial assets at initial recognition depends on the financial asset's contractual cash flow characteristics and the Company's business model for managing them. With the exception of trade receivables that do not contain a significant financing component, the Company initially measures a financial asset at its fair value plus, in the case of financial assets not a fair value through earnings, transaction costs. Transaction costs directly attributable to the acquisition of financial assets or financial liabilities at fair value through earnings are recognized immediately in earnings. Trade receivables that do not contain a significant financing component or for which the Company has applied the practical expedient are measured at the transaction price determined under IFRS 15. Refer to the accounting polices discussed above in Revenue Recognition.
Subsequent measurement
In subsequent periods, the measurement of financial instruments depends on their classification.
The Company measures financial assets at amortized cost if the assets meet the following conditions:
they are held within a business model whose objective is to hold the financial assets and collect its contractual cash flows
the contractual terms of the financial assets give rise to cash flows that are solely payments of principal and interest on the principal amount outstanding.
After initial recognition, these are measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method. Discounting is omitted where the effect of discounting is immaterial. The Company's cash, trade receivables, supplier rebates and other receivables fall into this category of financial instruments. The expense relating to the allowance for expected credit loss is recognized in earnings in selling, general and administrative expense ("SG&A").
Financial assets that are held within a different business model other than ‘hold to collect’ or ‘hold to collect and sell’ are categorized at fair value through earnings. Financial assets with cash flows that are not solely payments of principal and interest are classified and measured at fair value through earnings, irrespective of the business model. All derivative financial instruments fall into this


23


category, except for those designated and effective as hedging instruments, for which the hedge accounting requirements apply (see below). Assets in this category are measured at fair value with gains or losses recognized in earnings. The fair values of financial assets in this category are determined by reference to active market transactions or using a valuation technique where no active market exists.
Impairment of financial assets
The Company recognizes a loss allowance for expected credit losses arising from financial assets. The amount of expected credit losses is updated at each reporting date to reflect changes in credit risk since initial recognition of the respective financial instrument.
The Company applies a simplified approach for calculating expected credit losses for trade and other receivables. The Company recognizes a loss allowance based on lifetime expected credit losses at each reporting date. These are the expected shortfalls in contractual cash flows, considering the potential for default at any point during the life of the financial instrument. In calculating, the Company uses its historical experience, external indicators and forward-looking information to calculate the expected credit losses using a provision matrix. Refer to Note 22 for a detailed analysis of how the impairment requirements of IFRS 9 are applied.
Classification and measurement of financial liabilities
The Company’s financial liabilities include accounts payable and accrued liabilities (excluding employee benefits), borrowings (excluding finance lease liabilities), amounts due to the former shareholders of Polyair (refer to Note 18) and its call option redemption liability. Financial liabilities are initially measured at fair value, and, where applicable, adjusted for transaction costs unless the Company designated a financial liability at fair value through earnings. Subsequently, financial liabilities are measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method except for derivatives and financial liabilities designated at fair value through earnings, which are carried subsequently at fair value with gains or losses recognized in earnings (other than derivative financial instruments that are designated and effective as hedging instruments). The call option redemption liability relating to Powerband is measured at amortized cost, with any changes to the recorded value being recorded in deficit.
The Company's financial liabilities also include the non-controlling interest put options that are associated with the acquisitions of Powerband and Capstone are measured at fair value through earnings. Changes in the fair value of the non-controlling interest put options are recognized in earnings in finance costs. Refer to Note 22 for more information regarding the fair value measurement and classification of put options relating to the Powerband and Capstone non-controlling interests.
All interest related charges for financial liabilities measured at amortized cost are recognized in earnings in finance costs. Discounting is omitted where the effect of discounting is immaterial.
Derivative instruments and hedging
The Company applies hedge accounting to arrangements that qualify and are designated for hedge accounting treatment.
For the purpose of hedge accounting, hedges are classified as:
fair value hedges when hedging the exposure to changes in the fair value of a recognized asset or liability or an unrecognized firm commitment
cash flow hedges when hedging the exposure to variability in cash flows that is either attributable to a particular risk associated with a recognized asset or liability or a highly probable forecast transaction or the foreign currency risk in an unrecognized firm commitment
hedges of a net investment in foreign operations
When the requirements for hedge accounting are met at inception, the Company may designate a certain financial instrument as a hedging instrument in a hedge relationship. Upon designation, the Company documents the relationships between the hedging instrument and the hedged item, including the risk management objectives and strategy in undertaking the hedge transaction, and the methods that will be used to assess the effectiveness of the hedging relationship.
At inception of a hedge relationship and at each subsequent reporting date, the Company evaluates if the hedging relationship qualifies for hedge accounting under IFRS 9, which includes the following conditions to be met:
There is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument;
The effect of credit risk does not dominate the value changes that result from that economic relationship; and


24


The hedge ratio of the hedging relationship is the same as that resulting from the quantity of the hedged item that the entity actually hedges and the quantity of the hedging instrument that the entity actually uses to hedge that quantity of hedged item.

Cash flow hedges

The Company has certain interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges. These arrangements have been entered into to mitigate the risk of change in cash flows due to the fluctuations in interest rates applicable on the Company's floating rate borrowings. Such derivative financial instruments used for hedge accounting are recognized initially at fair value on the date on which the derivative contract is entered into and are subsequently reported at fair value in the consolidated balance sheets.

To the extent that the hedge is effective, changes in the fair value of the derivatives designated as hedging instruments in cash flow hedges are recognized in OCI and are included within the reserve for cash flow hedges in equity. Any ineffectiveness in the hedge relationship is recognized immediately in earnings. Derivatives are carried as financial assets when the fair value is positive and as financial liabilities when the fair value is negative.

Hedge accounting is discontinued prospectively when a derivative instrument ceases to satisfy the conditions for hedge accounting or is sold or liquidated. If the hedging relationship ceases to meet the effectiveness conditions, hedge accounting is discontinued, and the related gain or loss is held in the equity reserve until reclassified to the consolidated statement of earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged future cash flows affect earnings. If the hedged item ceases to exist before the end of the original hedge term, the unrealized hedge gain or loss in OCI is reclassified immediately in the consolidated statement of earnings.

Interest rate swap agreements that economically hedge the risk of changes in cash flows due to the fluctuations in interest rates applicable on the Company's variable rate borrowings, but for which hedge accounting is not applied, are measured at fair value through earnings.
Refer to Note 22 for more information regarding interest rate swap agreements.
Hedge of a net investment
Hedges of a net investment in foreign operations, including a hedge of a monetary item that is accounted for as part of the net investment, are accounted for similar to cash flow hedges. Gains or losses on the hedging instrument relating to the effective portion of the hedge are recognized in OCI while any gains or losses relating to the ineffective portion are recognized in the statement of earnings. On disposal of a foreign operation, the cumulative value of any such gains or losses recorded in equity is transferred to the statement of earnings.
The Company uses some of its borrowings as a hedge of its exposure to foreign exchange risk on its investments in foreign operations.
Refer to Note 22 for more information regarding net investment hedging.
Cash

Cash comprises cash at banks and on hand.
Inventories and Parts and Supplies
Raw materials, work in process, parts and supplies and finished goods are measured at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Cost is assigned by using the first in, first out cost formula, and includes all costs of purchases, costs of conversion and other costs incurred in bringing the inventories to their present location and condition. Trade discounts, rebates and other similar items are deducted in determining the costs of purchases. The cost of work in process and finished goods includes the cost of raw materials, direct labor and a systematic allocation of fixed and variable production overhead incurred in converting materials into finished goods. The allocation of fixed production overheads to the cost of conversion is based on the normal capacity of the manufacturing facilities.
Net realizable value of inventories, excluding parts and supplies, is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less the estimated costs of completion and the estimated selling expenses. Parts and supplies are valued at the lower of cost, which is equivalent to its purchase price, or net realizable value based on replacement cost.


25


Property, Plant and Equipment
Property, plant and equipment are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation, accumulated impairment losses and the applicable investment tax credits earned. The cost of an item of property, plant and equipment comprises its purchase price, any costs directly attributable to bringing the asset to the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by management and, where applicable, borrowing costs and the initial estimate of the costs of dismantling and removing the item and restoring the site on which it is located.
Depreciation is recognized using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of like assets as outlined below or, if lower, over the terms of the related leases:
 
Years
Land
Indefinite
Buildings and related major components
3 to 40
Manufacturing equipment and related major components
4 to 30
Computer equipment and software
3 to 15
Furniture, office equipment and other
3 to 10
Assets related to restoration provisions
Expected remaining term of the lease
The depreciation methods, useful lives and residual values related to property, plant and equipment are reviewed at each reporting date and adjusted if necessary.
When parts of an item of property, plant and equipment have different useful lives, they are accounted for as separate items (major components) of property, plant and equipment, and are depreciated over their respective useful lives. Depreciation of an asset begins when it is available for use in the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by management. Manufacturing equipment under construction is not depreciated. Depreciation of an asset ceases at the earlier of the date on which the asset is classified as held for sale or is included in a disposal group that is classified as held for sale, and the date on which the asset is derecognized.
The cost of replacing a part of an item of property, plant and equipment is recognized in the carrying amount of the asset if it is probable that the future economic benefits embodied within the part will flow to the Company, and its cost can be measured reliably. At the same time, the carrying amount of the replaced part is derecognized. The costs of the day-to-day servicing of property, plant and equipment, and repairs and maintenance are recognized in earnings as incurred.
Gains or losses arising on the disposal of property, plant and equipment are determined as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the assets and are recognized in earnings in the category consistent with the function of the property, plant and equipment.
Depreciation expense is recognized in earnings in the expense category consistent with the function of the property, plant and equipment.
Intangible Assets and Goodwill
The Company has a trademark and trade names which are identifiable intangible assets for which the expected useful life is indefinite. The trademark and trade names represent the value of brand names acquired in business acquisitions which management expects will provide benefit to the Company for an indefinite period. Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired in business acquisitions. Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives that are acquired separately, and goodwill are carried at cost less accumulated impairment losses.
When intangible assets are purchased with a group of assets, the cost of the group of assets is allocated to the individual identifiable assets and liabilities on the basis of their relative fair values at the date of purchase. When intangible assets are purchased separately, the cost comprises its purchase price and any directly attributable cost of preparing the asset for its intended use. For capitalized internally developed software, directly attributable costs include employee costs incurred on solution development and implementation along with an appropriate portion of borrowing costs.


26


Intangible assets are carried at cost less accumulated amortization and are amortized using the straight-line method over their estimated useful lives as follows:
 
Years
Distribution rights and customer contracts
6 to 15
Customer lists, license agreements and software
5 to 20
Patents and trademarks being amortized
2 to 5
Non-compete agreements
3 to 10
The amortization methods, useful lives and residual values related to intangible assets are reviewed and adjusted if necessary, at each financial year-end. Amortization begins when the asset is available for use, i.e. when it is in the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by management. Amortization expense is recognized in earnings in the expense category consistent with the function of the intangible asset.
Impairment Testing of Intangible Assets, Goodwill and Property, Plant and Equipment
The Company assesses, at least at each reporting date, whether or not there is an indication that a cash-generating unit ("CGU") may be impaired. If such an indication exists, or when annual impairment testing is required for intangible assets, such as applications software not yet available for use and the trademark and trade names with indefinite useful lives, the Company estimates the recoverable amount of the asset. The recoverable amount is determined for an individual asset, unless the asset does not generate cash inflows that are largely independent of other assets or groups of assets. In the latter case, the recoverable amount is determined for a CGU which is the smallest identifiable group of assets that generates cash inflows that are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets or group of assets. Goodwill is allocated to those CGUs that are expected to benefit from synergies of related business acquisitions and represent the lowest level within the group at which management monitors goodwill.
The recoverable amount is the higher of its value in use and its fair value less costs to sell. Value in use is the present value of the future cash flows expected to be derived from an asset or CGU. Fair value less costs to sell is the price that would be received to sell an asset or CGU in an orderly transaction between market participants, less the cost of disposal. The Company determines the recoverable amount and compares it with the carrying amount. If the carrying amount exceeds the recoverable amount, an impairment loss is recognized for the difference. Impairment losses are recognized in earnings in the expense category consistent with the function of the corresponding property, plant and equipment or intangible asset. Impairment losses recognized in respect of CGUs are allocated to reduce the carrying amounts of the assets of the unit or group of units pro rata based on the carrying amount of each asset in the unit or group of units.
With the exception of goodwill, an assessment is made at each reporting date as to whether there is any indication that previously recognized impairment losses may no longer exist or may have decreased. In this case, the Company will estimate the recoverable amount of that asset, and if appropriate, record a partial or an entire reversal of the impairment. The increased carrying amount of an asset attributable to a reversal of an impairment loss would not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined (net of amortization or depreciation) had no impairment loss been recognized for the asset in prior years.
Goodwill is subject to impairment testing at least once a year, or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount may be impaired. Goodwill is considered to be impaired when the carrying amount of the CGU or group of CGUs to which the goodwill has been allocated exceeds its fair value. An impairment loss, if any, would be recognized in the statement of earnings.


27


Provisions
Provisions represent liabilities to the Company for which the amount or timing is uncertain. Provisions are recognized if, as a result of a past event, the Company has a present legal or constructive obligation that can be estimated reliably, and it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation. The amount recognized as a provision is the best estimate of the expenditure required to settle the present obligation at the end of the reporting period. Provisions are measured at the present value of the expected expenditures to settle the obligation which, when the effect of the time value of money is material, is determined using a discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the obligation. The increase in the provision during the period to reflect the passage of time is recognized in earnings as a finance cost.
A provision is recorded in connection with environmental expenditures relating to existing conditions caused by past operations that do not contribute to current or future cash flows. Provisions for liabilities related to anticipated remediation costs are recorded on a discounted basis, if the effects of discounting are material, when they are probable and reasonably estimable, and when a present obligation exists as a result of a past event. Environmental expenditures for capital projects that contribute to current or future operations generally are capitalized and depreciated over their estimated useful lives.
A provision is recorded in connection with the estimated future costs to restore leased property to their original condition at the inception of the lease agreement. The liability and a corresponding asset are recorded on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet under the captions provisions, and property, plant and equipment (buildings), respectively. The provision is reviewed at the end of each reporting period to reflect the passage of time, changes in the discount rate and changes in the estimated future restoration costs. The Company amortizes the amount capitalized to property, plant and equipment on a straight-line basis over the expected lease term and recognizes a financial cost in connection with the discounted liability over the same period. Changes in the liability are added to, or deducted from, the cost of the related asset in the current period. These changes to the capitalized cost result in an adjustment to depreciation and interest.
A provision is recorded in connection with termination benefits at the earlier of the date on which the Company can no longer withdraw the offer of those benefits and the date on which the Company recognizes costs related to restructuring activities. In the case of an offer made to encourage voluntary redundancy, the termination benefits are measured based on the number of employees expected to accept the offer. If benefits are not expected to be settled wholly within 12 months of the end of the reporting period, they are presented on a discounted basis, if the effects of discounting are material.
The Company is engaged from time-to-time in various legal proceedings and claims that have arisen in the ordinary course of business. The Company records liabilities for legal proceedings in those instances where it can reasonably estimate the amount of the loss and where liability is probable.
Pension, Post-Retirement and Other Long-term Employee Benefits
The Company has defined contribution plans, defined benefit pension plans, other post-retirement benefit plans, and other long-term employee benefit plans for certain of its employees in Canada and the US.
A defined contribution plan is a post-retirement benefit plan under which the Company pays fixed contributions into a separate entity and to which it will have no legal or constructive obligation to pay future amounts. The Company contributes to several state plans, multi-employer plans and insurance funds for individual employees that are considered defined contribution plans. Contributions to defined contribution pension plans are recognized as an employee benefit expense in earnings in the periods during which services are rendered by employees.
A defined benefit plan is a post-retirement benefit plan other than a defined contribution plan. For defined benefit pension plans, other post-retirement benefit plans and other long-term employee benefit plans, the benefits expense and the related obligations are actuarially determined on an annual basis by independent qualified actuaries using the projected unit credit method when the effects of discounting are material. Past service costs are recognized as an expense in earnings immediately following the introduction of, or changes to, a pension plan. Remeasurements, comprising actuarial gains and losses, the effect of the asset ceiling, the effect of minimum funding requirements and the return on plan assets (excluding amounts included in net interest expense) are recognized immediately in OCI, net of income taxes, and in deficit.
The asset or liability related to a defined benefit plan recognized in the balance sheet is the present value of the defined benefit obligation at the end of the reporting period, less the fair value of plan assets, together with adjustments for the asset ceiling and minimum funding liabilities. The present value of the defined benefit obligation is determined by discounting the estimated future


28


cash outflows using interest rates of high-quality corporate bonds that are denominated in the currency in which the benefits will be paid and that have terms to maturity approximating the terms of the related pension liability.
For funded plans, surpluses are recognized only to the extent that the surplus is considered recoverable. Recoverability is primarily based on the extent to which the Company can unilaterally reduce future contributions to the plan. Any reduction in the recognized asset is recognized in OCI, net of income taxes, and in deficit.
An additional liability is recognized based on the minimum funding requirement of a plan when the Company does not have an unconditional right to the plan surplus. The liability and any subsequent remeasurement of that liability is recognized in OCI, net of income taxes, and in deficit.
Leases
Leases are classified as either operating or finance, based on the substance of the transaction at inception of the lease. Classification is re-assessed if the terms of the lease are changed other than by renewing the lease.
Leases in which a significant portion of the risks and rewards of ownership are retained by the lessor are classified as operating leases. Expenses under an operating lease are recognized in earnings on a straight-line basis over the period of the lease.
Leases in which substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are transferred to the Company are classified as finance leases. Assets meeting finance lease criteria are capitalized at the lower of the present value of the related lease payments or the fair value of the leased asset at the inception of the lease. Minimum lease payments are apportioned between the finance cost and the liability. The finance charge is recognized in earnings in finance costs and is allocated to each period during the lease term so as to produce a constant periodic rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability.
Equity
Capital stock represents the amount received on issuance of shares (less any issuance costs and net of taxes), share-based compensation expense credited to capital on stock options exercised less common shares repurchased equal to the carrying value.
Contributed surplus includes amounts related to equity-settled share-based compensation until such equity instruments are exercised or settled, in which case the amounts are transferred to capital stock or reversed upon forfeiture if not vested.
The cumulative translation adjustment account comprises all foreign currency translation differences arising on the translation of the consolidated entities that use a functional currency different from the presentation currency, as well as the effective portion of the foreign currency differences arising from the Company's hedge of its net investment in foreign operations.
Gains and losses on certain derivative financial instruments designated as hedging instruments are included in reserves for cash flow hedges until such time as the hedged forecasted cash flows affect earnings.
Deficit includes all current and prior period earnings or losses, the excess of the purchase price paid over the carrying value of common share repurchases, dividends on common shares, the remeasurement of the defined benefit liability net of income tax expense (benefit), and the impacts of the derecognition and recognition of non-controlling interest put and call options (discussed in Note 22).
Share Repurchases
The purchase price of the common shares repurchased equal to its carrying value is recorded in capital stock in the consolidated balance sheet and in the statement of consolidated changes in equity. The excess of the purchase price paid over the carrying value of the common shares repurchased is recorded in deficit in the consolidated balance sheet and in the statement of consolidated changes in equity as a share repurchase premium. Refer to Note 16 for additional information on share repurchases.
Dividends
Dividend distributions to the Company’s shareholders are recognized as a liability in the consolidated balance sheets if not paid in the period in which dividends are approved by the Company’s Board of Directors.


29


Critical Accounting Judgments, Estimates and Assumptions
The preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires management to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies and the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. Significant changes in the underlying assumptions could result in significant changes to these estimates. Consequently, management reviews these estimates on a regular basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are recognized in the period in which the estimates are revised and in any future periods affected. Information about these significant judgments, assumptions and estimates that have the most significant effect on the recognition and measurement of assets, liabilities, income and expenses are summarized below:
Significant Management Judgments
Deferred income taxes
Deferred tax assets are recognized for unused tax losses and tax credits to the extent that it is probable that future taxable income will be available against which the losses can be utilized. These estimates are reviewed at every reporting date. Significant management judgment is required to determine the amount of deferred tax assets that can be recognized, based upon the likely timing and the level of the reversal of existing timing differences, future taxable income and future tax planning strategies. Refer to Note 5 for more information regarding income taxes.
Estimation Uncertainty
Impairments
At the end of each reporting period, the Company performs a test of impairment on assets subject to amortization if there are indicators of impairment. Goodwill allocated to CGUs and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are tested annually. An impairment loss is recognized when the carrying value of an asset or CGU exceeds its recoverable amount, which in turn is the higher of its fair value less costs to sell and its value in use. The value in use is based on discounted estimated future cash flows. The cash flows are derived from the budget or forecasts for the estimated remaining useful lives of the CGUs and do not include restructuring activities that the Company is not yet committed to or significant future investments that will enhance the performance of the asset or CGU being tested. The value in use will vary depending on the discount rate applied to the discounted cash flows, the estimated future cash inflows, and the growth rate used for extrapolation purposes.
Refer to Note 12 for more information regarding impairment testing.
Pension, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefits
The cost of defined benefit pension plans and other post-retirement benefit plans and the present value of the related obligations are determined using actuarial valuations. The determination of benefits expense and related obligations requires assumptions such as the discount rate to measure obligations, expected mortality and the expected health care cost trend. Actual results will differ from estimated results, which are based on assumptions. Refer to Note 18 for more information regarding the assumptions related to the pension, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefit plans.
Uncertain tax positions
The Company is subject to taxation in numerous jurisdictions. There are many transactions and calculations during the course of business for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain. The Company maintains provisions for uncertain tax positions that it believes appropriately reflect its risk. These provisions are made using the best estimate of the amount expected to be paid based on a qualitative assessment of all relevant factors. The Company reviews the adequacy of these provisions at the end of the reporting period. However, it is possible that at some future date, liabilities in excess of the Company’s provisions could result from audits by, or litigation with, the relevant taxing authorities. Refer to Note 5 for more information regarding income taxes.
Useful lives of depreciable assets
The Company depreciates property, plant and equipment over the estimated useful lives of the assets. In determining the estimated useful life of these assets, significant judgment is required. Judgment is required to determine whether events or circumstances warrant a revision to the remaining periods of depreciation and amortization. The Company considers expectations of the in-service period of these assets in determining these estimates. The Company assesses the estimated useful life of these assets at each reporting date. If the Company determines that the useful life of an asset is different from the original assessment, changes


30


to depreciation and amortization will be applied prospectively. The estimates of cash flows used to assess the potential impairment of these assets are also subject to measurement uncertainty. Actual results may vary due to technical or commercial obsolescence, particularly with respect to information technology and manufacturing equipment.
Net realizable value of inventories and parts and supplies
Inventories and parts and supplies are measured at the lower of cost or net realizable value. In estimating net realizable values of inventories and parts and supplies, management takes into account the most reliable evidence available at the time the estimate is made. Provisions for slow-moving and obsolete inventories are made based on the age and estimated net realizable value of inventories. The assessment of the provision involves management judgment and estimates associated with expected disposition of the inventory. Refer to Note 7 for information regarding inventories and write-downs of inventories.
Allowance for expected credit loss and revenue adjustments
During each reporting period, the Company makes an assessment of whether trade accounts receivable are collectible from customers. Accordingly, management establishes an allowance for estimated losses arising from non-payment and other revenue adjustments. The Company’s allowance for expected credit loss reflects expected credit losses using a provision matrix model, supplemented by an allowance for individually impaired trade receivables. The provision matrix is based on the Company’s historic credit loss experience, adjusted for any change in risk of the trade receivable population based on credit monitoring indicators, and expectations of general economic conditions that might affect the collection of trade receivables. The provision matrix applies fixed provision rates depending on the number of days that a trade receivable is past due, with higher rates applied the longer a balance is past due. The Company also records reductions to revenue for estimated returns, claims, customer rebates, and other incentives. These incentives are recorded as a reduction to revenue at the time of the initial sale using the most-likely amount estimation method. The most-likely amount method is based on the single most likely outcome from a range of possible consideration outcomes. The range of possible outcomes are primarily derived from the following inputs: sales terms, historical experience, trend analysis, and projected market conditions in the various markets served. If future collections and trends differ from estimates, future earnings will be affected. Refer to Note 22 for more information regarding the allowance for doubtful accounts and the related credit risks.
Provisions
Provisions are recognized when the Company has a present obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event, it is probable that the Company will be required to settle the obligation, and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.
The amount recognized as a provision is the best estimate of the consideration required to settle the present obligation at the end of the reporting period, taking into account the risks and uncertainties surrounding the obligation. When a provision is measured using the cash flows estimated to settle the present obligation, its carrying amount is the present value of those cash flows, when the effect of the time value of money is material.
The Company's provisions include environmental and restoration obligations, termination benefits and other and litigation provisions. Refer to Note 14 for more information regarding provisions.    
Share-based payments
The estimation of share-based payment fair value and expense requires the selection of an appropriate pricing model.
The model used by the Company for stock options and SAR awards is the Black-Scholes pricing model. The Black-Scholes model requires the Company to make significant judgments regarding the assumptions used within the model, the most significant of which are the expected volatility of the Company’s own common shares, the probable life of awards granted, the time of exercise, the risk-free interest rate commensurate with the term of the awards, and the expected dividend yield.
The model used by the Company for PSU awards subject to a market performance condition is the Monte Carlo simulation model. The Monte Carlo model requires the Company to make significant judgments regarding the assumptions used within the model, the most significant of which are the volatility of the Company’s own common shares as well as those of a peer group, the performance measurement period, and the risk-free interest rate commensurate with the term of the awards. For PSU awards subject to a non-market performance condition, management estimates the expected achievement of performance criteria using long range forecasting models.


31


Refer to Note 16 for more information regarding share-based payments.
Business acquisitions
Management uses various valuation techniques when determining the fair values of certain assets and liabilities acquired in a business combination. Refer to Note 17 for more information regarding business acquisitions.
3 - INFORMATION INCLUDED IN CONSOLIDATED EARNINGS
The following table describes the charges incurred by the Company which are included in the Company’s consolidated earnings for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Employee benefit expense
 
 
 
 
 
Wages, salaries and other short-term benefits
197,155

 
170,657

 
161,661

Termination benefits (Note 14)
1,861

 
204

 
1,733

Share-based compensation expense (Note 16)
1,914

 
3,291

 
8,201

Pension, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefit plans (Note 18):
 
 
 
 
 
Defined benefit plans
2,768

 
2,811

 
3,002

Defined contributions plans
3,471

 
4,699

 
4,631

 
207,169

 
181,662

 
179,228

Finance costs - Interest
 
 
 
 
 
Interest on borrowings
17,443

 
7,973

 
4,770

Amortization and write-off of debt issue costs on borrowings
1,906

 
651

 
445

Interest capitalized to property, plant and equipment
(2,277
)
 
(1,378
)
 
(817
)
 
17,072

 
7,246

 
4,398

Finance costs - other expense (income), net
 
 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange loss (gain)
1,945

 
(2,663
)
 
(518
)
Other costs (income), net
1,865

 
(735
)
 
1,123

 
3,810

 
(3,398
)
 
605

Additional information
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment (Note 9)
38,548

 
32,409

 
29,402

Amortization of intangible assets (Note 11)
6,281

 
3,729

 
1,890

Impairment of assets (Note 12)
6,936

 
1,433

 
7,062



32


4 - MANUFACTURING FACILITY CLOSURES, RESTRUCTURING AND OTHER RELATED CHARGES
The following table describes the charges incurred by the Company which are included in the Company’s consolidated earnings for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 under the caption manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Impairment of property, plant and equipment
4,839

 
289

 
3,018

Impairment of intangibles

 

 
379

Equipment relocation

 
147

 
711

Revaluation and impairment of inventories
1,297

 
163

 
1,420

Termination benefits and other labor related costs
1,043

 
2

 
1,765

Restoration and idle facility costs
268

 
308

 
3,787

Insurance proceeds

 

 
(9,793
)
Professional fees
31

 
87

 
942

Other (recoveries) costs
(418
)
 
363

 
179

 
7,060

 
1,359

 
2,408

Charges incurred during the year ended December 31, 2018 were primarily due to non-cash impairments of property, plant and equipment and inventory as well as termination benefits and other labor related costs related to the closure of the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility. The closure further expands on operational synergies gained from the Canadian Technical Tape Ltd. acquisition (Refer to Note 17), which was completed in July 2017. As of December 31, 2018, the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility, which primarily produces carton sealing tape, has transferred substantially all of its production to other existing manufacturing facilities.
Charges incurred during the year ended December 31, 2017 were primarily related to small scale restructuring initiatives associated with acquisition integration efforts, as well as charges related to product trials to support post-South Carolina Flood (defined below) stencil production and other post-closure activities of the Columbia, South Carolina manufacturing facility.
On October 4, 2015, the Columbia, South Carolina manufacturing facility was damaged by significant rainfall and subsequent severe flooding (“South Carolina Flood”). The damages sustained were considerable and resulted in the facility being shut down permanently. Charges incurred during the year ended December 31, 2016 totalled $4.9 million, before insurance recoveries and were primarily related to site clean-up and idle facility costs as well as asset impairments resulting from real and personal property damage. On October 19, 2016, the Company and its insurers reached a settlement for the related property and business interruption claims in the amount of $30.0 million, subject to a $0.5 million deductible, covering substantially all of the claimed losses. As of December 31, 2016, the Company received a total of $29.5 million in insurance claim settlement proceeds of which $5.0 million was recorded in manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges in 2015 and $12.6 million and $9.8 million were recorded in cost of sales and manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges (presented in the table above under insurance proceeds), respectively, in 2016. The remaining $2.1 million was recognized as a reduction of cost of sales in the first quarter of 2017.
As of part of its plan to realize operational synergies from the RJM Manufacturing LLC acquisition completed in November 2015, the Company closed its Fairless Hills, Pennsylvania manufacturing facility and ceased production as of December 31, 2016. Charges incurred as a result of the closure of this facility totalled $6.0 million during the year ended December 31, 2016 and were primarily related to asset impairments, termination benefits, and facility lease obligations including restoration.
Charges incurred with respect to other restructuring initiatives during the year ended December 31, 2016 totalled $1.3 million and were primarily related to termination benefits and equipment relocation.
As of December 31, 2018, restructuring provisions of $2.6 million are included in provisions ($2.6 million in 2017) and $0.1 million in accounts payable and accrued liabilities ($0.2 million in 2017). Refer to Note 14 for more information on provisions.

33


5 - INCOME TAXES
On December 22, 2017, the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (“TCJA”) was enacted into law in the US. The TCJA significantly changed the previously existing US tax laws and includes numerous provisions that had an immediate effect on the Company’s business and affects certain aspects of the Company's business going forward. These changes include, but are not limited to, (i) a reduction in the statutory corporate tax rate from 35% to 21%, (ii) an enhancement and extension through 2026 of bonus depreciation, (iii) limitations and eliminations of certain deductions, (iv) a one-time transition tax on deemed repatriation of deferred foreign income, and (v) new tax regimes impacting how foreign-derived earnings and cross-border intercompany transactions may be subject to US tax. During the year ended December 31, 2017, the Company recognized a net tax benefit of approximately $9.6 million primarily due to the remeasurement of the US net deferred tax liability using the lower US corporate tax rate provided under the TCJA.
The reconciliation of the combined Canadian federal and provincial statutory income tax rate to the Company’s effective income tax rate is detailed as follows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
%
 
%
 
%
Combined Canadian federal and provincial income tax rate
28.4

 
28.8

 
29.5

Foreign earnings/losses taxed at higher income tax rates
0.4

 
6.8

 
6.6

Foreign earnings/losses taxed at lower income tax rates
(5.1
)
 
(0.6
)
 
(0.7
)
Impact of TCJA enactment

 
(12.4
)
 

Prior period adjustments
(3.4
)




Nondeductible expenses
3.9

 
0.4

 
0.7

Impact of other differences
(0.7
)
 
(2.3
)
 
(2.3
)
Nontaxable dividend
(8.6
)
 
(6.6
)
 
(6.9
)
Canadian deferred tax assets not recognized
2.5





Change in derecognition of deferred tax assets

 
2.8

 
0.8

Effective income tax rate
17.4

 
16.9

 
27.7

The major components of income tax expense (benefit) are outlined below for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Current income tax expense
934

 
6,635

 
8,757

Deferred tax expense (benefit)
 
 
 
 
 
TCJA reduction in US corporate statutory rate

 
(10,122
)
 

(Recognition) derecognition of US deferred tax assets
(182
)
 
885

 
175

US temporary differences
10,427

 
15,668

 
10,818

Canadian deferred tax assets not recognized
1,297





Derecognition of Canadian deferred tax assets

 
412

 
330

Canadian temporary differences
(1,548
)
 
1,202

 
(352
)
Temporary differences in other jurisdictions
(1,126
)
 
(1,631
)
 
(159
)
Total deferred income tax expense
8,868

 
6,414

 
10,812

Total tax expense for the year
9,802

 
13,049

 
19,569



34


The amount of income taxes relating to components of OCI for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 is outlined below:
 
Amount before
income tax
 
Deferred
income taxes
 
Amount net of
income taxes
 
$
 
$
 
$
For the year ended December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Deferred tax expense on remeasurement of defined benefit liability
3,016

 
(730
)
 
2,286

Deferred tax benefit on change in fair value of interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges
970

 
463

 
1,433

 
3,986

 
(267
)
 
3,719

 
 
 
 
 
 
For the year ended December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Deferred tax expense on remeasurement of defined benefit liability
302

 
(213
)
 
89

Deferred tax expense on change in fair value of interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges
2,358

 
(750
)
 
1,608

 
2,660

 
(963
)
 
1,697

 
 
 
 
 
 
Deferred tax expense due to TCJA reduction in US statutory rate
 
 
 
 
(598
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
For the year ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
Deferred tax expense on remeasurement of defined benefit liability
267

 
(66
)
 
201

Deferred tax expense on change in fair value of interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges
219

 
(83
)
 
136

 
486

 
(149
)
 
337

The amount of recognized deferred tax assets and liabilities is outlined below:
 
Deferred tax
assets
 
Deferred tax
liabilities
 
Net
 
$
 
$
 
$
As of December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Tax credits, losses, carryforwards and other tax deductions
11,147

 

 
11,147

Property, plant and equipment
13,910

 
(38,290
)
 
(24,380
)
Pension and other post-retirement benefits
3,798

 

 
3,798

Share-based payments
2,508

 

 
2,508

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
5,659

 

 
5,659

Goodwill and other intangibles
6,998

 
(25,343
)
 
(18,345
)
Trade and other receivables
633

 

 
633

Inventories
2,262

 

 
2,262

Other
5

 
(539
)
 
(534
)
Deferred tax assets and liabilities
46,920

 
(64,172
)
 
(17,252
)
Presented in the consolidated balance sheets as:
 
December 31,
2018
 
$
Deferred tax assets
25,069

Deferred tax liabilities
(42,321
)
 
(17,252
)


35


 
Deferred tax
assets
 
Deferred tax
liabilities
 
Net
 
$
 
$
 
$
As of December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Tax credits, losses, carryforwards and other tax deductions
11,387

 

 
11,387

Property, plant and equipment
15,661

 
(28,208
)
 
(12,547
)
Pension and other post-retirement benefits
7,175

 

 
7,175

Share-based payments
4,532

 

 
4,532

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
3,894

 

 
3,894

Goodwill and other intangibles
7,950

 
(9,692
)
 
(1,742
)
Trade and other receivables
344

 

 
344

Inventories
1,939

 

 
1,939

Other
466

 
(1,590
)
 
(1,124
)
Deferred tax assets and liabilities
53,348

 
(39,490
)
 
13,858

Presented in the consolidated balance sheets as:
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
Deferred tax assets
27,627

Deferred tax liabilities
(13,769
)
 
13,858

Nature of evidence supporting recognition of deferred tax assets
In assessing the recoverability of deferred tax assets, management determines, at each balance sheet date, whether it is more likely than not that a portion or all of its deferred tax assets will be realized. This determination is based on quantitative and qualitative assessments by management and the weighing of all available evidence, both positive and negative. Such evidence includes the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities, projected future taxable income and the implementation of tax planning strategies.
As of December 31, 2018, management analyzed all available evidence and determined it is more likely than not that substantially all of the Company’s deferred tax assets in the US and Canadian operating entities will be realized. Accordingly, the Company continues to recognize the majority of its deferred tax assets in the US and Canadian operating entities. With respect to the deferred tax assets at the Canadian corporate holding entity, the Parent Company, management determined it appropriate that the Parent Company's deferred tax assets should continue not to be recognized as of December 31, 2018. The Canadian deferred tax assets remain available to the Company in order to reduce its taxable income in future periods.    
As of December 31, 2017, management analyzed all available evidence and determined it is more likely than not that substantially all of the Company’s deferred tax assets in the US and Canadian operating entities will be realized. Accordingly, the Company continues to recognize the majority of its deferred tax assets in the US and Canadian operating entities. With respect to the deferred tax assets at the Parent Company, management determined it is appropriate to derecognize $0.4 million of remaining deferred tax assets as of December 31, 2017. The Canadian deferred tax assets remain available to the Company in order to reduce its taxable income in future periods.    


36


The following table outlines the changes in the deferred tax assets and liabilities during the year ended December 31, 2017:
 
Balance January 1, 2017
 
Recognized in
earnings (with
translation
adjustments)
 
Recognized in
contributed
surplus
 
Recognized in
OCI
 
Recognized in deficit
 
Business
acquisitions
 
Balance reclassified from accrued liabilities
 
Balance December 31, 2017
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Deferred tax assets    
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax credits, losses, carryforwards and other tax deductions
15,689

 
(4,302
)
 

 

 

 

 

 
11,387

Property, plant and equipment
18,125

 
(2,464
)
 

 

 

 

 

 
15,661

Pension and other post-retirement benefits
11,467

 
(3,418
)
 

 
(874
)
 

 

 

 
7,175

Share-based payments
8,749

 
(1,309
)
 
(3,732
)
 

 
824

 

 

 
4,532

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
6,893

 
(3,081
)
 

 

 

 
82

 

 
3,894

Goodwill and other intangibles
3,658

 
4,292

 

 

 

 

 

 
7,950

Trade and other receivables
353

 
(64
)
 

 

 

 
55

 

 
344

Inventories
2,871

 
(953
)
 

 

 

 
21

 

 
1,939

Other
539

 
231

 

 
(304
)
 

 

 

 
466

 
68,344

 
(11,068
)
 
(3,732
)
 
(1,178
)
 
824

 
158

 

 
53,348

Deferred tax liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
(30,078
)
 
5,050

 

 

 

 
(2,405
)
 
(775
)
 
(28,208
)
Other
(1,102
)
 
(161
)
 

 
(327
)
 

 

 

 
(1,590
)
Goodwill and other intangibles
(9,885
)
 
889

 

 

 

 
(696
)
 

 
(9,692
)
 
(41,065
)
 
5,778

 

 
(327
)
 

 
(3,101
)
 
(775
)
 
(39,490
)
Deferred tax assets and liabilities
27,279

 
(5,290
)
 
(3,732
)
 
(1,505
)
 
824

 
(2,943
)
 
(775
)
 
13,858

Impact due to foreign exchange rates
 
 
(1,124
)
 

 
(56
)
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Total recognized
 
 
(6,414
)
 
(3,732
)
 
(1,561
)
 
824

 
 
 
 
 
 


37


The following table outlines the changes in the deferred tax assets and liabilities during the year ended December 31, 2018:
 
Balance January 1, 2018
 
Recognized in
earnings (with
translation
adjustments)
 
Recognized in
contributed
surplus
 
Recognized in
OCI
 
Recognized in deficit
 
Business
acquisitions
 
Balance December 31, 2018
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Deferred tax assets    
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax credits, losses, carryforwards and other tax deductions
11,387

 
(3,051
)
 

 

 

 
2,811

 
11,147

Property, plant and equipment
15,661

 
(1,751
)
 

 

 

 

 
13,910

Pension and other post-retirement benefits
7,175

 
(2,604
)
 

 
(773
)
 

 

 
3,798

Share-based payments
4,532

 
(867
)
 
(744
)
 

 
(413
)
 

 
2,508

Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
3,894

 
740

 

 

 

 
1,025

 
5,659

Goodwill and other intangibles
7,950

 
(952
)
 

 

 

 

 
6,998

Trade and other receivables
344

 
277

 

 

 

 
12

 
633

Inventories
1,939

 
478

 

 

 

 
(155
)
 
2,262

Other
466

 
190

 

 

 

 
(651
)
 
5

 
53,348

 
(7,540
)
 
(744
)
 
(773
)
 
(413
)
 
3,042

 
46,920

Deferred tax liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Property, plant and equipment
(28,208
)
 
(6,462
)
 

 

 

 
(3,620
)
 
(38,290
)
Other
(1,590
)
 
588

 

 
463

 

 

 
(539
)
Goodwill and other intangibles
(9,692
)
 
3,262

 

 

 

 
(18,913
)
 
(25,343
)
 
(39,490
)
 
(2,612
)
 

 
463

 

 
(22,533
)
 
(64,172
)
Deferred tax assets and liabilities
13,858

 
(10,152
)
 
(744
)
 
(310
)
 
(413
)
 
(19,491
)
 
(17,252
)
Impact due to foreign exchange rates
 
 
1,284

 

 
43

 

 
 
 
 
Total recognized
 
 
(8,868
)
 
(744
)
 
(267
)
 
(413
)
 
 
 
 
Deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses for which no deferred tax asset is recognized in the consolidated balance sheets are as follows:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Tax losses, carryforwards and other tax deductions
39,787

 
25,004

Share-based payments
2,417

 
2,972

 
42,204

 
27,976



38


The following table presents the amounts and expiration dates relating to unused tax credits in Canada for which no asset is recognized in the consolidated balance sheets as of December 31:
 
2018
 
2017
 
$
 
$
2018

 
676

2019
1,172

 
1,271

2020
518

 
561

2021
196

 
212

2022
446

 
483

2023
221

 
239

2024
208

 
225

2025
352

 
381

2026
269

 
292

2027
245

 
266

2028
285

 
309

2029
227

 
247

2030
207

 
224

2031
303

 
328

2032
182

 
197

2033
223

 
242

2034
197

 
214

2035
525

 
569

2036
344

 
373

2037
249

 
207

2038
581

 

Total tax credits derecognized
6,950

 
7,516

The following table presents the year of expiration of the Company’s operating losses carried forward in Canada as of December 31, 2018:
 
 
Deferred tax assets not recognized
 
 
Federal
 
Provincial
 
 
$
 
$
2028
 
8,803

 
8,803

2029
 
873

 
873

2030
 
2,913

 
2,913

2031
 
1,622

 
1,622

2037
 
1,118

 
1,118

2038
 
2,407

 
2,407

 
 
17,736

 
17,736

In addition, the Company has (i) state losses of $58.5 million (with expiration dates ranging from 2019 to 2030) for which a tax benefit of $2.5 million has been recognized; (ii) state losses of $93.2 million (with expiration dates ranging from 2019 to 2028) for which a tax benefit of $3.2 million has not been recognized; (iii) US. state credits of $0.1 million for which no tax benefit has been recognized; and (iv) $14.8 million of capital loss carryforwards with indefinite lives available to offset future capital gains in Canada for which no tax benefit has been recognized.    


39


6 - EARNINGS PER SHARE
The weighted average number of common shares outstanding is as follows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
Basic
58,815,526

 
59,072,119
 
58,727,751
Effect of stock options
268,649

 
371,933
 
473,446
Effect of PSUs

 
143,717
 
1,168,030
Diluted
59,084,175

 
59,587,769
 
60,369,227
There were 242,918 stock options that were anti-dilutive and excluded from the calculation of weighted average diluted common shares for the year ended December 31, 2018. There were no stock options that were anti-dilutive and excluded from the calculation of weighted average diluted common shares for the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016.
One of the Company's share-based compensation plans, the PSU plan, was amended on February 17, 2017 to provide for only cash settlement of awards. Prior to the amendment, PSUs were to be settled in common shares of the Company and were included in the calculation of weighted average diluted common shares, to the extent they were dilutive, when the applicable performance conditions had been satisfied. Subsequent to amendment, there is no impact of PSUs in the calculation of weighted average diluted common shares. Refer to Note 2 for a discussion of the impact on the calculation of earnings per share prior to February 17, 2017 and subsequent to February 17, 2017.
The effect of PSUs included in the calculation of weighted average diluted shares outstanding includes the following for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2017:
 
2017
 
2016
PSUs which met the performance criteria
885,879
 
892,077
7 - INVENTORIES
Inventory is composed of the following for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Raw materials
52,157

 
36,396

Work in process
30,017

 
20,207

Finished goods
88,307

 
71,630

Parts and supplies
20,194

 
18,571

 
190,675

 
146,804

The Company recorded impairments of inventories to net realizable value in the Company’s consolidated earnings as an expense for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 as follows:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Recorded in manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges
1,297

 
163

 
1,420

Recorded in cost of sales
716

 
801

 
2,019

 
2,013

 
964

 
3,439



40


There were no reversals of impairments of inventories to net realizable value in the Company’s consolidated earnings during the year ended December 31, 2018 ($0.2 million and nil during the years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, respectively). Refer to Note 12 for information regarding impairments of inventories.
The amount of inventories included in the Company’s consolidated earnings as an expense for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 is as follows:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Inventories recognized in earnings as an expense
761,051

 
642,586

 
575,473

8 - OTHER CURRENT ASSETS
Other current assets are comprised of the following for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Income taxes receivable and prepaid
6,202

 
4,279

Sales and other taxes receivable and credits
4,873

 
2,717

Prepaid expenses
8,424

 
6,697

Supplier rebates receivable
2,006

 
1,858

Reserve for inventory returns
1,227

 

Other
1,663

 
637

 
24,395

 
16,188



41


9 - PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
The following table outlines the changes to property, plant and equipment during the year ended December 31, 2017:
 
Land
 
Buildings
 
Manufacturing
equipment
 
Computer
equipment
and software
 
Furniture,
office equipment
and other
 
Construction in
progress
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Gross carrying amount
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance as of December 31, 2016
6,130

 
92,945

 
557,317

 
41,643

 
2,467

 
43,993

 
744,495

Additions – separately acquired

 

 

 

 

 
82,510

 
82,510

Additions through business acquisitions
1,268

 
6,617

 
17,427

 
407

 
55

 
1,501

 
27,275

Assets placed into service
4,638

 
25,353

 
59,125

 
1,415

 
236

 
(90,767
)
 

Disposals
(229
)
 
(116
)
 
(15,260
)
 
(1,139
)
 
(140
)
 

 
(16,884
)
Foreign exchange and other
303

 
2,274

 
8,791

 
176

 
87

 
598

 
12,229

Balance as of December 31, 2017
12,110

 
127,073

 
627,400

 
42,502

 
2,705

 
37,835

 
849,625

Accumulated depreciation and impairments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance as of December 31, 2016
609

 
61,072

 
411,924

 
35,460

 
1,866

 
86

 
511,017

Depreciation

 
4,341

 
25,717

 
2,172

 
179

 

 
32,409

Impairments

 

 
208

 

 
2

 
274

 
484

Impairment reversals

 

 
(3
)
 

 

 

 
(3
)
Disposals

 
(82
)
 
(14,501
)
 
(1,138
)
 
(13
)
 

 
(15,734
)
Foreign exchange and other

 
963

 
6,823

 
158

 
74

 
(86
)
 
7,932

Balance as of December 31, 2017
609

 
66,294

 
430,168

 
36,652

 
2,108

 
274

 
536,105

Net carrying amount as of December 31, 2017
11,501

 
60,779

 
197,232

 
5,850

 
597

 
37,561

 
313,520

The following table outlines the changes to property, plant and equipment during the year ended December 31, 2018:
 
Land
 
Buildings
 
Manufacturing
equipment
 
Computer
equipment
and software
 
Furniture,
office equipment
and other
 
Construction in
progress
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Gross carrying amount
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance as of December 31, 2017
12,110

 
127,073

 
627,400

 
42,502

 
2,705

 
37,835

 
849,625

Additions – separately acquired

 

 

 

 

 
74,712

 
74,712

Additions through business acquisitions
2,400

 
5,720

 
28,619

 
146

 
163

 
1,334

 
38,382

Assets placed into service

 
10,330

 
42,114

 
1,876

 
785

 
(55,105
)
 

Disposals

 
(180
)
 
(4,667
)
 
(230
)
 
(137
)
 


 
(5,214
)
Category reclassifications
(1,641
)
 
4,229

 
(2,588
)
 

 

 


 

Foreign exchange and other
(793
)
 
(1,755
)
 
(8,632
)
 
(243
)
 
(58
)
 
(1,107
)
 
(12,588
)
Balance as of December 31, 2018
12,076

 
145,417

 
682,246

 
44,051

 
3,458

 
57,669

 
944,917

Accumulated depreciation and impairments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance as of December 31, 2017
609

 
66,294

 
430,168

 
36,652

 
2,108

 
274

 
536,105

Depreciation

 
5,615

 
30,154

 
2,245

 
534

 

 
38,548

Impairments
370

 
820

 
3,649

 

 

 
84

 
4,923

Disposals

 
(118
)
 
(4,305
)
 
(229
)
 
(128
)
 

 
(4,780
)
Foreign exchange and other

 
(1,035
)
 
(5,662
)
 
(208
)
 
(48
)
 
(2
)
 
(6,955
)
Balance as of December 31, 2018
979

 
71,576

 
454,004

 
38,460

 
2,466

 
356

 
567,841

Net carrying amount as of December 31, 2018
11,097

 
73,841

 
228,242

 
5,591

 
992

 
57,313

 
377,076

Capital expenditures incurred in the year ended December 31, 2018 were primarily to support the greenfield manufacturing facilities in India as well as capacity expansion at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility and other growth initiatives. As of December 31, 2018, the Company had commitments to suppliers to purchase machinery and equipment totalling $16.3 million primarily to support the greenfield manufacturing facilities in India and other growth initiatives. It is expected that such amounts


42


will be paid out in the next twelve months and will be funded by the Company's borrowings and cash flows from operating activities.
Capital expenditures incurred in the year ended December 31, 2017 were primarily to support the construction of the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility, the construction of the greenfield manufacturing facilities in India, the capacity expansion of stretch film production at the Danville, Virginia manufacturing facility and other growth initiatives and maintenance needs. As of December 31, 2017, the Company had commitments to suppliers to purchase machinery and equipment totalling $29.3 million primarily to support the construction of the greenfield manufacturing facilities in India, shrink film capacity expansion at the Tremonton, Utah manufacturing facility, capacity expansion at the Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility and other growth initiatives.
During the year ended December 31, 2018, the loss on disposals amounted to 0.2 million ($0.3 million and 0.1 million loss on disposals in 2017 and 2016, respectively).
Supplemental information regarding property, plant and equipment is as follows for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
Interest capitalized to property, plant and equipment
$2,277
 
$1,378
Weighted average capitalization rates
7.64
%
 
3.02
%
10 - OTHER ASSETS
Other assets are comprised of the following for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Corporate owned life insurance held in grantor trust
4,210

 
2,738

Interest rate swap agreements (1)
2,605

 
2,139

Prepaid software licensing
1,173

 
1,402

Deposits
1,194

 
272

Cash surrender value of officers’ life insurance
358

 
375

Other
46

 
72

 
9,586

 
6,998

(1)Refer to Note 22 for additional information regarding the fair value of interest rate swap agreements.


43


11 - INTANGIBLE ASSETS
The following tables outline the changes in intangible assets during the period:
 
Distribution
rights
 
Customer
contracts
 
License
agreements
 
Customer
lists
 
Software (1)
 
Patents/
Trademark/Trade names
(2)
 
Non-compete
agreements
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Gross carrying amount
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance as of December 31, 2016
2,697

 
1,037

 
302

 
26,206

 
1,783

 
2,216

 
7,896

 
42,137

Additions – separately acquired

 

 

 

 
3,108

 
452

 

 
3,560

Additions through business acquisitions

 

 

 
5,284

 

 
6,088

 
328

 
11,700

Net foreign exchange differences
182

 
70

 

 
1,151

 

 
179

 
496

 
2,078

Balance as of December 31, 2017
2,879

 
1,107

 
302

 
32,641

 
4,891

 
8,935

 
8,720

 
59,475

Accumulated amortization and impairments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance as of December 31, 2016
2,678

 
1,037

 
210

 
2,296

 
1,016

 
509

 
341

 
8,087

Amortization
20

 

 
7

 
2,504

 
283

 
(4
)
 
919

 
3,729

Net foreign exchange differences
181

 
70

 

 
77

 

 

 
13

 
341

Balance as of December 31, 2017
2,879

 
1,107

 
217

 
4,877

 
1,299

 
505

 
1,273

 
12,157

Net carrying amount as of December 31, 2017

 

 
85

 
27,764

 
3,592

 
8,430

 
7,447

 
47,318

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross carrying amount
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance as of December 31, 2017
2,879

 
1,107

 
302

 
32,641

 
4,891

 
8,935

 
8,720

 
59,475

Additions – separately acquired

 

 

 

 
1,617

 
16

 

 
1,633

Additions through business acquisitions

 

 

 
75,683

 

 
6,810

 
380

 
82,873

Net foreign exchange differences
(224
)
 
(86
)
 

 
(2,075
)
 
19

 
(723
)
 
(733
)
 
(3,822
)
Balance as of December 31, 2018
2,655

 
1,021

 
302

 
106,249

 
6,527

 
15,038

 
8,367

 
140,159

Accumulated amortization and impairments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance as of December 31, 2017
2,879

 
1,107

 
217

 
4,877

 
1,299

 
505

 
1,273

 
12,157

Amortization

 

 
7

 
4,698

 
557

 
101

 
918

 
6,281

Net foreign exchange differences
(224
)
 
(86
)
 

 
(265
)
 
19

 
2

 
(114
)
 
(668
)
Balance as of December 31, 2018
2,655

 
1,021

 
224

 
9,310

 
1,875

 
608

 
2,077

 
17,770

Net carrying amount as of December 31, 2018

 

 
78

 
96,939

 
4,652

 
14,430

 
6,290

 
122,389

(1) 
Includes $0.2 million and $0.9 million of acquired software licenses during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.
(2) 
Includes a trademark and trade names not subject to amortization totalling $13.8 million and $8.0 million as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.


44


12 - IMPAIRMENT OF ASSETS
CGU Determination and Indicators of Impairment
In updating its determination of CGUs and applying any related indicators of impairment, the Company took into consideration the manufacturing facility closures and other related activities that have taken place over the course of the year; the expected costs, timeline, and future benefits expected from its major capital expenditure projects; the impact of acquisitions; as well as changes in the interdependencies of cash flows among the Company’s manufacturing sites. As a result of this analysis, the Company’s CGUs consist of the following:
The tapes and films CGU (the "T&F CGU") includes the Company’s tape and film manufacturing locations in the United States, Canada and India that it owned prior to 2018.
As discussed in Note 17, the Company acquired 100% of the equity value of Polyair in 2018. Polyair is a separate CGU at this time, but integration efforts continue to merge this CGU's cash flows into the network of the T&F CGU. Management monitors the goodwill balance of Polyair combined with the T&F CGU assets as it remains focused on achieving its strategic plan of developing significant acquisition synergies, and as a result of those synergies, having interdependencies of cash flows. Accordingly, the assets of Polyair are included in the tapes and film impairment test discussed further below (the “T&F Group”).
The engineered coated products (“ECP CGU") remains the Company’s ECP manufacturing facilities in the United States and Canada that it owned prior to 2018, as well as the newly-acquired Capstone facility discussed in Note 17. Capstone is part of the ECP CGU as it will support and expand the Company's operations in this area.
As discussed in Note 17, the Company acquired substantially all of the operating assets of Maiweave in 2018. Management monitors the goodwill balance of Maiweave combined with the ECP CGU assets as it remains focused on achieving its strategic plan of developing significant synergies, and as a result of those synergies, having interdependencies of cash flows. Accordingly, the assets of Maiweave are included in the ECP impairment test discussed below (the “ECP Group”).
The Company’s other CGU, Fibope, consists of the Company’s operating site in Portugal.
There were no indicators of impairment for any of the CGUs previously described. Due to the significant amount of recorded goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets associated with the T&F Group and the ECP Group, the Company conducted an impairment test as discussed further below. The test did not result in any impairment being recognized as of December 31, 2018 and 2017. Unrelated to the impairment tests performed at the CGU level, there were impairments of certain individual assets as disclosed in the impairments table below, which primarily relate to manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges.
The Company also considers indicators for the reversal of prior impairment charges recorded, which is based on the recent and projected results of CGUs and specific asset groups that were previously impaired. For the year ended December 31, 2018, this analysis did not result in any impairment reversals.
Impairment Testing
All of the Company’s carrying amounts of goodwill, intangible assets with indefinite useful lives and software not yet available for use as of December 31, 2018 relate to the T&F Group and the ECP Group. The Company performed the required annual impairment test for these asset groups in the fourth quarter of 2018. The impairment test for the asset groups was determined based on value in use. The key assumptions used in each discounted cash flow projection, management’s approach to determine the value assigned to each key assumption, and other information as required for the asset groups are outlined in the table below. Reasonably possible changes in the key assumptions below would not be expected to cause the carrying amount of the asset groups to exceed its recoverable amount, in which case an impairment would otherwise be recognized.
Revenue and other future assumptions used in these models were prepared in accordance with IAS 36 – Impairment of Assets and, as such, do not include the benefit from obtaining or the incremental costs to obtain growth initiatives or cost reduction programs that the Company may be planning but has not yet undertaken within its current asset base.


45


Details of the key assumptions used in impairment tests performed as of December 31, 2018 are outlined below:
 
T&F Group

ECP Group

Carrying amount allocated to the asset group:
 
 
Goodwill
$101,769
$5,945
Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives
$13,841
$0
Results of test performed as of December 31, 2018:
 
 
Recoverable amount
$1,428,909
$188,736
Annual revenue growth rates (1)
13.0% in 2019, 2.5%-3.3% thereafter

32.8% in 2019, 7.6% in 2020, tapering down to 2.5% thereafter

Discount rate (2)
8.8
%
11.6
%
Cash flows beyond 2019 have been extrapolated using a steady growth rate of (3)
2.5
%
2.5
%
Income tax rate (4)
25.0
%
27.0
%

(1) 
For both models, the annual revenue growth rate for 2019 is based on projections presented to management and the Board of Directors. The projected revenue growth rates for the period are consistent with the Company's recent history of sales volumes within the asset group, as well as the Company’s expectation that its sales will at least match gross domestic product growth.

For the T&F Group, the 2019 projections reflect a full year of benefit from owning Polyair. Beyond 2019, the projections assume that the Company’s revenue will grow consistent with United States gross domestic product average projections, and from anticipated synergies realized from Polyair cross-selling opportunities.

For the ECP Group, the 2019 projection reflects a full year of benefit from Capstone's operations as well as the acquisition of Maiweave. The Company expects additional ramping up of revenue from the group due to integration and capital expenditure efforts in 2020, and then tapering down to sustained growth levels consistent with United States gross domestic product.
(2) 
The discount rate used is the estimated weighted average cost of capital for the asset group, using observable market rates and data based on a set of publicly traded industry peers.
(3) 
Cash flows beyond 2019 have been primarily extrapolated using declining growth rates through 2028 and then a per annum growth rate which is at or below the projected long-term average growth rate for the asset group. Cash flows resulting from expected business combination synergies and new production capacity currently under construction are included discretely in the projection period through 2023 consistent with anticipated ramp-up periods for each project.
(4) 
The income tax rate represents an estimated effective tax rate based on enacted or substantively enacted rates.
Sensitivity analysis performed as of December 31, 2018 using reasonably possible changes in key assumptions above are outlined below:
 
T&F Group
ECP Group
Revenue growth rates
10.1% in 2019, 0% thereafter

30.5% in 2019, 3.6% in 2020, tapering down to 1% thereafter

Discount rate
11.0
%
13.1
%
Cash flows beyond 2019 have been extrapolated using a steady growth rate of
1.0
%
1.0
%
Income tax rate
35.0
%
37.0
%
There was no impairment indication resulting from changing the individual assumptions above.


46


Details of the key assumptions used in impairment tests performed as of December 31, 2017 are outlined below:
Carrying amount allocated to the asset group
 
Goodwill
$41,690
Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives
$7,964
Results of test performed as of December 31, 2017:
 
Recoverable amount
$971,752
Annual revenue growth rates (1)
10.2% in 2018,
2.5% thereafter

Discount rate (2)
10.6
%
Cash flows beyond 2018 have been extrapolated using a steady growth rate of (3)
2.5
%
Income tax rate (4)
23.0
%
(1) 
The annual revenue growth rate for 2018 is based on projections presented to management and the Board of Directors. This projection reflects a full year of benefit from owning Cantech, as well as the expected benefits from recently completed capital expenditure projects, such as the new Midland, North Carolina manufacturing facility. Beyond 2018, the projections assume that the Company’s revenue will grow consistent with United States gross domestic product projections. The revenue growth rates for the period are consistent with recent history of sales volumes within the asset group, as well as the Company’s expectations for its sales to at least match gross domestic product growth.
(2) 
The discount rate used is the estimated weighted average cost of capital for the asset group, using observable market rates and data based on a set of publicly traded industry peers.
(3) 
Cash flows beyond 2018 have been extrapolated using a per annum growth rate which is at or below the projected long-term average growth rate for the asset group.
(4) 
The income tax rate represents an estimated effective tax rate based on enacted or substantively enacted rates.
Sensitivity analysis performed as of December 31, 2017 using reasonably possible changes in key assumptions above are outlined below:

Revenue growth rates
6.6% in 2018, 0% thereafter

Discount rate
12.0
%
Cash flows beyond 2018 have been extrapolated using a steady growth rate of
1.0
%
Income tax rate
39.0
%
There was no impairment resulting from changing the individual assumptions above.


47


Impairments
Impairments recognized during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 and reversals of impairments recognized during the year ended December 31, 2017 are presented in the table below. There were no reversals of impairments recognized during the year ended December 31, 2018.
 
2018
 
2017
 
Impairment
recognized
 
Impairment
recognized
 
Impairment
reversed
 
$
 
$
 
$
Classes of assets impaired
 
 
 
 
 
Manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges
 
 
 
 
 
Inventories
1,297

 
338

 
(175
)
Parts and supplies

 

 
(12
)
Property, plant and equipment
 
 
 
 
 
Land
370

 

 

Buildings
820

 

 

Manufacturing equipment
3,649

 
208

 
(1
)
       Construction in progress

 
82

 

 
6,136

 
628

 
(188
)
Cost of sales
 
 
 
 
 
Inventories
716

 
801

 

Property, plant and equipment
 
 
 
 
 
Manufacturing equipment

 

 
(2
)
Furniture, office equipment and other

 
2

 

Construction in progress
84

 
192

 

 
800

 
995

 
(2
)
Total
6,936

 
1,623

 
(190
)
The assets impaired during the year ended December 31, 2018 were primarily the result of the closure of the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility as discussed in Note 4. The assets impaired during the year ended December 31, 2017 were primarily the result of provisions for slow-moving and obsolete inventory and small-scale restructuring initiatives as discussed in Note 4.
The Company used its best estimate in assessing the likely outcome for each of the assets. The recoverable amount of the assets in all cases was fair value less costs to sell.


48


13 - BORROWINGS

Borrowings are comprised of the following for the years ended: 
 
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
Maturity
 
Weighted average
effective interest  rate
$
 
Weighted average
effective interest  rate
$
Senior Unsecured Notes (a)
October 2026
 
7.00
%
245,252

 


2018 Credit Facility (b)
June 2023
 
4.26
%
219,084

 


2014 Revolving Credit Facility (c)
Repaid in 2018
 
4.91
%

 
3.39
%
254,773

2018 Powerband Credit Facility (d)
Various until August 2023
 
9.91
%
16,338

 


Powerband Revolving Line of Credit (e)
Repaid in 2018
 
9.15
%

 
8.75
%
9,563

2018 Capstone Credit Facility (f)
June 2023
 
7.63
%
7,585

 


Forgivable government loans (g)
January 2024 and 2026
 
1.25
%
6,014

 
1.25
%
4,660

Finance lease liabilities (h)
Various until June 2022
 
3.82
%
5,712

 
3.11
%
8,817

Term and other loans (i)
Repaid in 2018
 


 
9.05
%
1,650

Total borrowings
 
 
 
499,985

 
 
279,463

Less: current borrowings
 
 
 
14,389

 
 
14,979

Total long-term borrowings
 
 
 
485,596

 
 
264,484

The aggregate principal amounts of the related borrowings in the table above are presented net of debt issuance costs of $7.1 million and $1.4 million as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, and imputed interest of $0.4 million and $0.3 million December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, totalling $6.7 million and $1.1 million as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.
Repayments of borrowings are due as follows:
 
Finance
lease
liabilities
 
Other
borrowings
 
$
 
$
2019
1,627

 
12,948

2020
839

 
13,631

2021
688

 
17,006

2022
2,914

 
18,780

2023
136

 
188,223

Thereafter
34

 
250,826

Total payments
6,238

 
501,414

Interest expense included in minimum lease payments
526

 

Total
5,712

 
501,414

(a)
Senior Unsecured Notes
On October 15, 2018, the Company completed the private placement of $250 million aggregate principal amount of senior unsecured notes due October 15, 2026 ("Senior Unsecured Notes") with certain guarantors and Regions Bank, as Trustee. The Company incurred debt issue costs of $5.1 million which were capitalized and are being amortized using the straight-line method over the eight-year term. The Company used the net proceeds to partially repay borrowings under the 2018 Credit Facility (defined below) and to pay related fees and expenses, as well as for general corporate purposes. The Senior Unsecured Notes bear interest at a rate of 7.00% per annum, payable semi-annually, in cash, in arrears on April 15 and October 15 of each year, beginning on April 15, 2019.
As of December 31, 2018, the Senior Unsecured Notes outstanding balance amounted to $250.0 million ($245.3 million, net of $4.7 million in unamortized debt issue costs).


49


On or after October 15, 2021, the Company may redeem the Senior Unsecured Notes at its option, in whole or in part, on certain redemption dates and at certain redemption prices specified in the indenture, plus any accrued and unpaid interest. If the Company experiences a change of control, it may be required to offer to repurchase the Senior Unsecured Notes at a purchase price equal to 101% of their aggregate principal amount plus any accrued and unpaid interest up to, but excluding, the date of such repurchase.
The indenture contains usual and customary incurrence based covenants which are generally less restrictive than covenants under the 2018 Credit Facility and, among other things, limit the Company's ability to incur additional debt; pay dividends, redeem stock or make other distributions; enter into certain types of transactions with affiliates; incur liens on assets; make certain restricted payments and investments; engage in certain asset sales, including sale and leaseback transactions; agree to certain restrictions on the ability of restricted subsidiaries to make payments to the Company; and merge, consolidate, transfer or dispose of substantially all assets. Certain of these covenants will be suspended if the Senior Unsecured Notes are assigned an investment grade rating by Standard & Poor's Rating Services and Moody's Investors Services, Inc. None of these covenants are considered restrictive to the Company’s operations and as of December 31, 2018, the Company was in compliance with all of these debt covenants. The Senior Unsecured Notes are guaranteed by all direct and indirect subsidiaries of the Parent Company that are borrowers or guarantors under the 2018 Credit Agreement. Under the terms of the indenture, any direct or indirect subsidiaries that in the future become borrowers or guarantors under the 2018 Credit Agreement shall also be guarantors of the Senior Unsecured Notes.
(b)
2018 Credit Facility
On June 14, 2018, the Company entered into a five-year, $600.0 million credit facility (“2018 Credit Facility”) with a syndicated lending group, refinancing and replacing the Company's previous $450.0 million credit facility that was due to mature in November 2019 ("2014 Revolving Credit Facility").
In securing the 2018 Credit Facility, the Company incurred debt issue costs amounting to $2.7 million which were capitalized and are being amortized using the straight-line method over the five-year term.
The 2018 Credit Facility consists of a $400.0 million revolving credit facility (“2018 Revolving Credit Facility”) and a $200.0 million term loan (“2018 Term Loan”). The 2018 Term Loan amortizes $65.0 million until March 2023 ($5.0 million in 2018, $10.0 million in 2019, $12.5 million in 2020, $15.0 million in 2021, $17.5 million in 2022, and $5.0 million in 2023), and the remaining balance of the 2018 Credit Facility is due upon maturity in June 2023. The 2018 Credit Facility also includes an incremental accordion feature of $200.0 million, which enables the Company to increase the limit of this facility (subject to the credit agreement's terms and lender approval) if needed. The 2018 Credit Facility matures on June 14, 2023 and bears an interest rate based, at the Company’s option, on the London Inter-bank Offered Rate ("LIBOR"), the Federal Funds Rate, or Bank of America’s prime rate, plus a spread varying between 25 and 250 basis points (250 basis points as of December 31, 2018) depending on the debt instrument's benchmark interest rate and the consolidated secured net leverage ratio.
As of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Term Loan's outstanding principal balance amounted to $195.0 million and the 2018 Revolving Credit Facility’s outstanding principal balance amounted to $26.4 million, for a total gross outstanding principal balance under the 2018 Credit Facility of $221.4 million (net outstanding principal balance of $219.1 million, net of $2.3 million in unamortized debt issue costs). Standby letters of credit totalled $7.4 million resulting in total utilization under the 2018 Credit Facility of $228.8 million. Accordingly, the unused availability under the 2018 Credit Facility as of December 31, 2018 amounted to $366.2 million.
The 2018 Credit Facility is secured by a first priority lien on all personal property of the Company and all current and future material subsidiaries who are borrowers or guarantors under the facility.
The 2018 Credit Facility has two financial covenants, a consolidated secured net leverage ratio not to be more than 3.50 to 1.00, with an allowable temporary increase to 4.00 to 1.00 for the quarter in which the Company consummates an acquisition with a price not less than $50 million and the following three quarters, and a consolidated interest coverage ratio not to be less than 3.00 to 1.00. The Company was in compliance with the consolidated secured net leverage ratio and consolidated interest coverage ratio, which were 1.42 and 7.17, respectively, as of December 31, 2018. In addition, the 2018 Credit Facility has certain non-financial covenants, such as covenants regarding indebtedness, investments, and asset dispositions. The Company was in compliance with all covenants as of and for the year ended December 31, 2018.


50


(c)
2014 Revolving Credit Facility
On June 14, 2018, the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility's outstanding balance of $304.7 million was repaid in full resulting in satisfaction and discharge of the first priority lien. A corresponding write-off of debt issue costs of $1.0 million was recorded as interest expense under the caption finance costs in earnings.
In November 2014, the Company secured the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility, a five-year, $300.0 million revolving credit facility with a syndicate of financial institutions. On June 9, 2017, the Company amended the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility to increase its borrowing limit by $150.0 million, bringing the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility credit limit to $450.0 million. The credit agreement also included an incremental accordion feature of $150.0 million, which would have enabled the Company to increase the limit of the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility, subject to the credit agreement’s terms and lender approval, if needed.
The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility bore interest based primarily on the LIBOR, or other floating rate for credit loans denominated in an alternative currency, plus a spread varying between 100 and 225 basis points depending on the consolidated total leverage ratio (175 basis points as of December 31, 2017). Revolving credit loans denominated in the alternative currency of Canadian dollars bore interest primarily at the Canadian Dollar Offer Rate ("CDOR") plus the applicable margin mentioned above and any mandatory costs. As of December 31, 2017, the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility’s total utilization amounted to $272.5 million, which consisted of $256.2 million of borrowed funds ($254.8 million, net of $1.4 million in unamortized debt issue costs) and $16.3 million in standby letters of credit.
The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility was secured by a first priority lien on substantially all personal property of the Company and all current and future material subsidiaries who are borrowers or guarantors under the facility.
The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility had, in summary, three financial covenants: (i) a consolidated total leverage ratio not to be greater than 3.25 to 1.00, with an allowable temporary increase to 3.75 to 1.00 for the four quarters following an acquisition with a price not less than $50.0 million, (ii) a consolidated debt service ratio not to be less than 1.50 to 1.00, and (iii) the aggregated amount of all capital expenditures in any fiscal year may not exceed $100.0 million.
(d)
2018 Powerband Credit Facility
On July 4, 2018, Powerband, one of the Company's subsidiaries, entered into an Indian Rupee ("INR") 1,300.0 million ($19.0 million) credit facility (“2018 Powerband Credit Facility”) subsequently replacing Powerband's previous outstanding debt consisting of a term loan and revolving line of credit ("Powerband Revolving Line of Credit"). In December 2018, Powerband amended the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility to reallocate and increase its credit limit by INR 100 million ($1.4 million), bringing the total 2018 Powerband Credit Facility limit to INR 1,400.0 million ($19.3 million).
The 2018 Powerband Credit Facility is guaranteed by the Parent Company, and local assets (carrying amount of $30.2 million as of December 31, 2018) are required to be pledged. Powerband is prohibited from granting liens on its assets without the consent of the lender under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility. Funding under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility is not committed and could be withdrawn by the lender with 10 days' notice. Additionally, under the terms of the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility, Powerband's debt to net worth ratio (as defined by the credit agreement) must be maintained below 3.00. Powerband was in compliance with the debt to net worth ratio (2.07 as of December 31, 2018) as of and for the year ended December 31, 2018.
As of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility credit limit was INR 1,400.0 million ($20.0 million), consisting of:
INR 960.0 million ($13.7 million) demand term loan (“2018 Powerband Demand Term Loan”) restricted for capital projects with a bullet repayment after five years and bears interest based on the prevailing Indian Marginal Cost-Lending Rate ("IMCLR"), maturing in August 2023;
INR 65.0 million ($0.9 million) term loan ("2018 Powerband Term Loan") restricted for capital projects, payable in monthly installments over four years and bears interest based on the prevailing IMCLR, maturing in December 2021;
INR 175.0 million ($2.5 million) working capital loan facility (“2018 Powerband Working Capital Loan Facility”) that renews annually and is due upon demand and bears interest based on the prevailing IMCLR; and
INR 200 million ($2.9 million) bridge loan ("2018 Powerband Bridge Loan") restricted for capital projects and bears interest based on the prevailing IMCLR, maturing in June 2019.
As of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Powerband Demand Term Loan's outstanding balance amounted to INR 960.0 million ($13.7 million), the 2018 Powerband Term Loan's outstanding balance amounted to INR 61.0 million ($0.9 million), the 2018 Powerband Working Capital Loan Facility’s outstanding balance was INR 26.9 million ($0.4 million), and the 2018 Powerband Bridge Loan outstanding balance was INR 100 million ($1.4 million), for a total gross outstanding balance under the 2018 Powerband Credit


51


Facility of INR 1,147.9 million ($16.4 million). Net of INR 5.5 million ($0.1 million) unamortized debt issue costs, the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility outstanding balance was INR 1,142.4 million ($16.3 million). Including INR 30.2 million ($0.4 million) in standby letters of credit, total utilization under the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility amounted to INR 1,178.1 million ($16.8 million). Accordingly, the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility's unused availability as of December 31, 2018 amounted to INR 221.9 million ($3.2 million).
USD amounts presented above are translated from INR and are impacted by fluctuations in the USD and INR exchange rates.
(e)
Powerband Revolving Line of Credit
Prior to entering into the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility discussed above, Powerband maintained the Powerband Revolving Line of Credit bearing interest based on the prevailing IMCLR plus a premium of 0.60%. The Powerband Revolving Line of Credit had an outstanding balance of INR 610.6 million ($9.6 million) as of December 31, 2017. The Powerband Revolving Line of Credit was repaid in full in 2018.
(f)
2018 Capstone Credit Facility
On February 6, 2018, Capstone, one of the Company's subsidiaries, entered into an INR 975.0 million ($15.0 million) credit facility ("2018 Capstone Credit Facility"). The 2018 Capstone Credit Facility consists of an INR 585.0 million ($9.0 million) term loan facility ("Capstone Term Loan Facility") for financing capital expenditures and INR 390.0 million ($6.0 million) working capital facility ("Capstone Working Capital Facility") and bears interest based on the prevailing IMCLR. The 2018 Capstone Credit Facility matures in June 2023. Funding under the Capstone Term Loan Facility is committed, while the Capstone Working Capital Facility is uncommitted. Borrowings under the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility mature in June 2023, are guaranteed by the Parent Company, and are otherwise unsecured.
As of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility credit limit was INR 975.0 million ($13.9 million). The Capstone Term Loan Facility had an outstanding balance of INR 422.4 million ($6.0 million), and the Capstone Working Capital Facility outstanding balance was INR 108.0 million ($1.6 million) for a total gross outstanding amount of INR 530.4 million ($7.6 million). Including INR 44.5 million ($0.6 million) in standby letters of credit, total utilization under the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility amounted to INR 574.9 million ($8.2 million). Accordingly, as of December 31, 2018, the 2018 Capstone Credit Facility's unused availability was INR 400.1 million ($5.7 million), comprised of committed availability equaling INR 162.6 million ($2.3 million) and uncommitted availability amounting to INR 237.5 million ($3.4 million).
USD amounts presented above are translated from INR and are impacted by fluctuations in the USD and INR exchange rates.
(g)
Forgivable government loans
In August 2015, one of the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiaries entered into a partially forgivable loan. The loan was entered into with Agencia para Investmento Comercio Externo de Portugal, EPE ("AICEP"), the Portuguese agency for investment and external trade, as part of financing a capital expansion project. Based on the terms of the agreement, 50% of the loan will be forgiven in 2020 based on satisfying certain 2019 targets, including financial metrics and headcount additions. The partially forgivable loan is non-interest bearing with semi-annual installments of principal due from July 2018 through January 2024.
To reflect the benefit of the interest-free status, the loan was discounted to its estimated fair value using a discount rate of 1.25% which reflects the borrowing cost of the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiary. The loan had an outstanding balance of €4.4 million ($5.1 million) as of December 31, 2018 and €4.4 million ($5.0 million) as of December 31, 2017. The difference between the gross proceeds and the fair value of the loan, which totalled €4.3 million ($4.9 million) as of December 31, 2018 (€3.8 million ($4.7 million) as of December 31, 2017) is the benefit derived from the interest-free loan and is recognized as deferred income in the Company's consolidated balance sheet in the caption other liabilities in the amount of $0.3 million as of December 31, 2018 and 2017.
In February 2018, the same subsidiary entered into a second partially forgivable loan with the AICEP for up to €8.2 million ($10.2 million) to finance an additional capital expansion project. Based on the terms of the agreement, 60% of the loan will be forgiven in 2022 based on satisfying certain 2021 targets, including financial metrics and headcount additions. The partially forgivable loan is non-interest bearing and semi-annual installments of principal are due beginning in December 2020 through June 2026.
To reflect the benefit of the interest-free status, the loan was discounted to its estimated fair value using a discount rate of 1.25% which reflects the borrowing cost of the Company’s wholly-owned subsidiary. The loan had an outstanding balance of €1.0 million ($1.2 million) as of December 31, 2018. The difference between the gross proceeds and the fair value of the loan, which totalled


52


€0.9 million ($1.1 million) as of December 31, 2018 is the benefit derived from the interest-free loan and is recognized as deferred income in the Company's consolidated balance sheet in the caption other liabilities in the amount of $0.1 million as of December 31, 2018.
USD amounts presented above are translated from Euros and are impacted by fluctuations in the USD and Euro exchange rates.
When the capital expansion assets are placed into service, the deferred income will be recognized in earnings through cost of sales on a systematic basis over the related assets’ useful lives. In addition, imputed interest expense will be recorded over the life of the loans so that at the end of the loan periods the amounts to be reimbursed will equal the nominal amounts. Interest expense of less than $0.1 million was recognized on these loans during the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(h)
Finance lease liabilities
The Company has obligations under finance lease liabilities for the rental of a building, computer hardware, manufacturing equipment and office equipment, payable in monthly installments, including interest, ranging from $238 to $263,450 for 2018 and from $127 to $263,450 for 2017. In addition, a $2.5 million lump sum payment is due in June 2022 under one of the lease liabilities. The finance lease liabilities are secured by the assets under lease with the following carrying amounts included in property, plant and equipment for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Buildings
1,526

 
1,978

Manufacturing equipment (1)
18,233

 
19,304

Furniture, office equipment, and other
301

 

 
20,060

 
21,282

(1) 
The finance lease liabilities related to manufacturing equipment include a secured debt equipment finance agreement for qualifying US capital expenditures during the period of May 2012 through March 31, 2014 totalling $25.7 million, payable in monthly installments ranging from $39,329 to $263,450, including interest, over the applicable terms. The terms of the arrangement include multiple individual finance leases, each of which has a term of 60 months and a fixed interest rate of 2.74%, 2.90%, and 2.95% for leases scheduled prior to January 1, 2013, January 1, 2014, and March 31, 2014, respectively. The finance lease agreements are secured by equipment with a net book value of $16.8 million as of December 31, 2018 ($18.9 million as of 2017).
(i)
Term and other loans
Prior to entering into the 2018 Powerband Credit Facility, as discussed above, Powerband maintained a term loan which was repayable in 61 monthly installments and bore interest based on the prevailing IMCLR, plus a premium of 0.90%. The loan totalled $1.2 million (INR 79.3 million) as of December 31, 2017 and was repaid in full in 2018.


53


Reconciliation of liabilities arising from financing activities
The changes in the Company’s liabilities arising from financing activities can be classified as follows:
 
Borrowings, non-current (excluding finance lease liabilities)
 
Borrowings, current (excluding finance lease liabilities)
 
Finance lease liabilities
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Balance as of December 31, 2016
163,648

 
1,912

 
14,265

 
179,825

Cash flows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds
225,498

 
31,523

 

 
257,021

Repayments
(132,273
)
 
(24,112
)
 
(5,722
)
 
(162,107
)
Debt issuance costs
(683
)
 

 

 
(683
)
Non-cash:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
New finance leases

 

 
276

 
276

Additions through business acquisitions

 
559

 

 
559

Amortization of debt issuance costs
651

 

 

 
651

Foreign exchange and other
3,675

 
248

 
(2
)
 
3,921

Reclassification
(216
)
 
216

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2017
260,300

 
10,346

 
8,817

 
279,463

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Borrowings, non-current (excluding finance lease liabilities)
 
Borrowings, current (excluding finance lease liabilities)
 
Finance lease liabilities
 
Total

$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Balance as of December 31, 2017
260,300

 
10,346

 
8,817

 
279,463

Cash flows:

 

 

 

Proceeds
942,881

 
49,036

 

 
991,917

Repayments
(710,567
)
 
(47,109
)
 
(4,946
)
 
(762,622
)
Debt issuance costs
(7,862
)
 

 

 
(7,862
)
Non-cash:

 

 

 

New finance leases

 

 
1,585

 
1,585

Additions through business acquisitions
346

 
728

 
200

 
1,274

Amortization of debt issuance costs
861

 

 

 
861

Write-off of debt issuance costs
1,045

 

 

 
1,045

Foreign exchange and other
(5,009
)
 
(723
)
 
56

 
(5,676
)
Reclassification
(670
)
 
670

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2018
481,325

 
12,948

 
5,712

 
499,985



54


14 - PROVISIONS AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES
The Company’s current known provisions and contingent liabilities consist of environmental and restoration obligations, termination benefits and other and litigation.
The reconciliation of the Company’s provisions is as follows:
 
Environmental
 
Restoration
 
Termination
benefits and other
 
Litigation
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Balance, December 31, 2016
2,506

 
1,859

 
1,383

 
143

 
5,891

Provisions assumed through business acquisitions
192

 

 

 

 
192

Additional provisions

 
5

 
516

 

 
521

Amounts used
(417
)
 
(505
)
 
(1,200
)
 
(104
)
 
(2,226
)
Amounts reversed

 
(387
)
 
(152
)
 

 
(539
)
Net foreign exchange differences
7

 
25

 
7

 

 
39

Balance, December 31, 2017
2,288

 
997

 
554

 
39

 
3,878

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amount presented as current
106

 
55

 
457

 
39

 
657

Amount presented as non-current
2,182

 
942

 
97

 

 
3,221

Balance, December 31, 2017
2,288

 
997

 
554

 
39

 
3,878

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Provisions assumed through business acquisitions
50

 
602

 
30

 
942

 
1,624

Additional provisions
100

 
7

 
2,054

 
250

 
2,411

Amounts used
(88
)
 
(5
)
 
(769
)
 
(33
)
 
(895
)
Amounts reversed
(506
)
 

 

 

 
(506
)
Net foreign exchange differences
(15
)
 
(33
)
 
(8
)
 

 
(56
)
Balance, December 31, 2018
1,829

 
1,568

 
1,861

 
1,198

 
6,456

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amount presented as current
184

 
50

 
1,772

 
256

 
2,262

Amount presented as non-current
1,645

 
1,518

 
89

 
942

 
4,194

Balance, December 31, 2018
1,829

 
1,568

 
1,861

 
1,198

 
6,456

The environmental provision pertains primarily to the post-closure activities of the Columbia, South Carolina manufacturing facility.
The restoration provision pertains to leases at manufacturing facilities where the Company is obligated to restore the leased properties to the same condition that existed at the lease commencement date. The carrying amount of this obligation is based on management’s best estimate of the costs of the permanent removal of the Company’s manufacturing equipment used in these facilities. The restoration provisions increased during the year ended December 31, 2018, due to the additional leased manufacturing facilities as a result of the Company's purchase of Polyair on August 3, 2018. Refer to Note 17 for additional information on business acquisitions. Restoration obligations settled during the year ended December 31, 2017 were primarily related to the closure of the Fairless Hills, Pennsylvania manufacturing facility other small restructuring initiatives.
Termination benefits added during the year ended December 31, 2018 relate primarily to the closure of the Johnson City, Tennessee manufacturing facility and other restructuring initiatives. Termination benefits settled during the year ended December 31, 2017 were primarily related to the closure of the Fairless Hills, Pennsylvania manufacturing facility. Refer to Note 4 for additional information on manufacturing facility closures, restructuring and other related charges.
The Company is engaged from time-to-time in various legal proceedings and claims that have arisen in the ordinary course of business. The outcome of all of the proceedings and claims against the Company is subject to future resolution, including the uncertainties of litigation. Based on information currently known to the Company and after consultation with outside legal counsel, management believes that the probable ultimate resolution of any such proceedings and claims, individually or in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the financial condition of the Company, taken as a whole, and accordingly, no material amounts have been recorded as of December 31, 2018.


55


As of December 31, 2018, and 2017, no reimbursements are expected to be received by the Company for any of the provided amounts and there were no contingent assets at any of the financial statement reporting dates covered by these consolidated financial statements.
15 - OTHER LIABILITIES
Other liabilities are comprised of the following for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Deferred compensation (1)
2,561

 
939

Amounts due to former shareholders of Polyair (2)
1,653

 

Other
1,010

 
1,017

 
5,224

 
1,956

(1) 
Refer to Note 18 for additional information on other long-term employee benefit plans.
(2) 
Represents amounts payable to the former shareholders of Polyair relating to estimated income tax benefits as a result of the Company's payment of certain deal-related costs on behalf of Polyair. Refer to Note 17 for additional information on the purchase of Polyair and the amounts due to its former shareholders.
16 - CAPITAL STOCK
Authorized
The Company is authorized to issue an unlimited number of common shares without par value.
Class “A” preferred shares, issuable in series, rank in priority to the common shares with respect to dividends and return of capital on dissolution. The Board of Directors is authorized to fix, before issuance, the designation, rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions attached to the shares of each series. No Class A preferred shares have been issued.
Common Shares
The Company’s common shares outstanding as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, were 58,650,310 and 58,799,910, respectively.


56


Dividends
Cash dividends paid are as follows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
Declared Date
Paid date
 
Per common
share
amount
 
Shareholder
record date
 
Common
shares issued
and
outstanding
 
Aggregate
payment (1)
March 9, 2016
March 31, 2016
 
$
0.13

 
March 21, 2016
 
58,522,835
 
$
7,509

May 9, 2016
June 30, 2016
 
$
0.13

 
June 15, 2016
 
58,602,835
 
$
7,574

August 10, 2016
September 30, 2016
 
$
0.14

 
September 15, 2016
 
58,621,585
 
$
8,235

November 10, 2016
December 30, 2016
 
$
0.14

 
December 15, 2016
 
59,060,335
 
$
8,047

March 8, 2017
March 31, 2017
 
$
0.14

 
March 21, 2017
 
59,110,335
 
$
8,316

May 8, 2017
June 30, 2017
 
$
0.14

 
June 15, 2017
 
59,169,710
 
$
8,365

August 10, 2017
September 29, 2017
 
$
0.14

 
September 15, 2017
 
59,036,310
 
$
8,150

November 10, 2017
December 29, 2017
 
$
0.14

 
December 15, 2017
 
58,799,910
 
$
8,368

March 7, 2018
March 30, 2018
 
$
0.14

 
March 20, 2018
 
58,807,410
 
$
8,333

May 9, 2018
June 29, 2018
 
$
0.14

 
June 15, 2018
 
58,817,410
 
$
8,140

August 10, 2018
September 28, 2018
 
$
0.14

 
September 14, 2018
 
58,817,410
 
$
8,214

November 7, 2018
December 28, 2018
 
$
0.14

 
December 14, 2018
 
58,867,410
 
$
8,089

(1) 
Aggregate dividend payment amounts presented in the table above are adjusted for the impact of foreign exchange rates on cash payments to shareholders.
Share Repurchases
On July 23, 2018, the Company renewed its NCIB, under which it is permitted to repurchase for cancellation up to 4,000,000 common shares of the Company at prevailing market prices during the twelve-month period ending July 22, 2019. As of December 31, 2018, and March 12, 2019, 3,782,900 shares remained available for repurchase under the NCIB. The Company's two previous NCIBs, which each allowed repurchases for cancellation up to 4,000,000 common shares, expired on July 16, 2018 and July 13, 2017, respectively.
Information regarding share repurchases is presented in the table below as of:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
Common shares repurchased
217,100

 
487,300

Average price per common share including commissions
CDN$ 16.02
 
CDN$ 18.88
Carrying value of the common shares repurchased
$
1,296

 
$
2,898

Share repurchase premium (1)
$
1,263

 
$
4,553

Total purchase price including commissions
$
2,559

 
$
7,451

(1) 
The excess of the purchase price paid over the carrying value of the common shares repurchased is recorded in deficit in the consolidated balance sheet and in the statement of consolidated changes in equity.
Stock options
In accordance with the TSX rules, no further grants of stock options have been made under the Company's Executive Stock Option Plan ("ESOP") since June 4, 2018, the date on which the ESOP has elapsed. Stock options outstanding under the ESOP are equity-settled and expire no later than ten years after the date of the grant and can be used only to purchase stock and may not be redeemed for cash. Stock options granted to key employees and executives will vest and may be exercisable as to one-third on each of the first, second and third anniversaries of the date of grant. Stock options granted to directors who are not officers of the Company will vest and may be exercisable 25% on the grant date, with another 25% vesting and exercisable on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of grant.
All stock options were granted at a price determined and approved by the Board of Directors, which cannot be less than the closing price of the Company's common shares on the TSX for the day immediately preceding the effective date of the grant.


57


The changes in number of stock options outstanding were as follows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price
 
Number of
options
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price
 
Number of
options
 
Weighted
average
exercise
price
 
Number of
options
 
CDN$
 
 
 
CDN$
 
 
 
CDN$
 
 
Balance, beginning of year
12.29

 
834,375

 
11.38

 
1,061,250

 
8.78

 
1,617,500

Granted
21.76

 
242,918

 

 

 

 

Exercised
12.04

 
(67,500
)
 
8.00

 
(226,875
)
 
3.56

 
(540,000
)
Forfeited

 

 

 

 
12.35

 
(16,250
)
Balance, end of year
14.59

 
1,009,793

 
12.29

 
834,375

 
11.38

 
1,061,250


The weighted average fair value at exercise of stock options exercised during 2018, 2017 and 2016 was $14.19, $17.94 and $17.84, respectively.
The following table summarizes information about stock options outstanding and exercisable for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
 
Options outstanding
 
Options exercisable
Range of exercise prices
 
Number
 
Weighted
average
contractual
life (years)
 
Weighted
average
exercise price
 
Number
 
Weighted
average
exercise price
 
 
 
 
 
 
CDN$
 
 
 
CDN$
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$12.04 to $12.14
 
386,250

 
2.18

 
12.05

 
386,250

 
12.05

$12.55 to $14.34
 
380,625

 
2.88

 
12.59

 
380,625

 
12.59

$21.76
 
242,918

 
6.61

 
21.76

 

 

 
 
1,009,793

 
3.51

 
14.59

 
766,875

 
12.32

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$12.04 to $12.14
 
453,750

 
2.92

 
12.05

 
443,125

 
12.05

$12.55 to $14.34
 
380,625

 
3.88

 
12.58

 
278,125

 
12.60

 
 
834,375

 
3.36

 
12.29

 
721,250

 
12.26

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$1.55 to $1.80
 
90,000

 
0.47

 
1.73

 
90,000

 
1.73

$12.04 to $14.34
 
971,250

 
4.53

 
12.27

 
602,500

 
12.20

 
 
1,061,250

 
4.18

 
11.38

 
692,500

 
10.84

The weighted average fair value of stock options granted during 2018 was $3.65 and was estimated using the Black-Scholes option pricing model, taking into account the following weighted average assumptions:
 
December 31, 2018
Expected life
4.8 years

Expected volatility(1)
32.09
%
Risk-free interest rate
2.05
%
Expected dividends
3.30
%
Stock price at grant date
CDN$ 21.76
Exercise price of awards
CDN$ 21.76
Foreign exchange rate USD to CDN
1.2809

(1) 
Expected volatility was calculated by applying a weighted average of the daily closing price on the TSX for a term commensurate with the expected life of the grant.


58


Restricted Share Units
On March 7, 2018, the Board of Directors approved the addition of RSUs as an available cash-settled award type. A RSU is a right to receive a cash payment equal to the five trading days VWAP of the Company’s common shares on the TSX upon completion of time-based vesting conditions. The purpose of a RSU is to tie a portion of the value of the compensation of participants to the future value of the Company's common shares. Grants of RSUs to employees of the Company are on a discretionary basis and subject to the Board of Directors’ approval. RSUs accrue dividend equivalents which are paid in cash at the end of the vesting period. A dividend equivalent is calculated as the number of settled RSUs multiplied by the amount of cash dividends per share declared by the Company between the date of grant and the settlement date.
During the year ended December 31, 2018, 113,047 RSUs were granted at a weighted average fair value of $16.29 and 1,228 RSUs were forfeited. As of December 31, 2018, there were 111,819 RSUs outstanding at a weighted average fair value of $12.18.
Performance Share Units
A PSU is a right that has a value equal to the VWAP of the Company's common shares, as published by the TSX, for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding a date specified in the grant terms. The purpose of a PSU plan is to tie a portion of the value of the compensation of participants to the future value of the Company's common shares. Grants of PSUs to employees of the Company are on a discretionary basis and subject to the Board of Directors’ approval. PSUs accrue dividend equivalents which are paid in cash at the end of the vesting period. A dividend equivalent is calculated as the number of settled PSUs multiplied by the amount of cash dividends per share declared by the Company between the date of grant and the settlement date.
Grant details for PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017:
The number of PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017 which will be eligible to vest can range from 0% to 150% of the Target Shares ("Target Shares" reflects 100% of the PSUs granted) based on the Company's total shareholder return ("TSR") ranking relative to a specified peer group of companies ("Peer Group") over the measurement period as outlined in the table below:
TSR Ranking Relative to the Peer Group
 
Percent of Target Shares Vested
76th percentile or higher
 
150
%
51st-75th percentile
 
100
%
25th-50th percentile
 
50
%
Less than the 25th percentile
 
0
%
The performance and vesting period is the period from the date of grant through the third anniversary of the date of grant. The PSUs are expensed over the vesting period.
Grant details for PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017:
The number of PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017 which will be eligible to vest can range from 0% to 175% of the Target Shares as determined by multiplying the number of PSUs awarded by the adjustment factors as follows:
50% based on the Company's TSR ranking relative to the Peer Group over the measurement period as set out in the table below; and
50% based on the Company's average return on invested capital over the measurement period as compared to internally developed thresholds (the “ROIC Performance”) as set out in the table below.


59


The relative TSR performance adjustment factor is determined as follows:
TSR Ranking Relative to the Peer Group
 
Percent of Target Shares Vested
90th percentile or higher
 
200
%
75th percentile
 
150
%
50th percentile
 
100
%
25th percentile
 
50
%
Less than the 25th percentile
 
0
%
The ROIC Performance adjustment factor is determined as follows:
ROIC Performance
 
Percent of Target Shares Vested
1st Tier
 
0
%
2nd Tier
 
50
%
3rd Tier
 
100
%
4th Tier
 
150
%
The TSR performance and ROIC Performance adjustment factors between the numbers set out in the two tables above is interpolated on a straight-line basis.
The performance period is the period from January 1st in the year of grant through December 31st of the third calendar year following the date of grant. The PSUs are expensed over the vesting period beginning from the date of grant through February 15th of the fourth calendar year following the date of grant.
The following table summarizes information about PSUs for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
PSUs granted
284,571

 
358,386

 
422,733

Weighted average fair value per PSU granted
$
17.84

 
$
16.15

 
$
13.85

PSUs forfeited/cancelled
16,053

 
7,952

 
28,696

PSUs added/(cancelled) by performance factor (1)
(2,125
)
 
69,600

 

PSUs settled
335,465

 
208,800

 

Weighted average fair value per PSU settled
$
15.87

 
$
18.49

 
$

Cash payment on settlement
$
5,863

 
$
4,174

 
$

(1) 
The table below provides further information regarding the PSUs settled included in the table above. The number of PSUs settled reflects the performance adjustments to the Target Shares:
Grant Date
 
Date Settled
 
Target Shares
 
Performance
 
PSUs settled
June 11, 2014
 
June 22, 2017
 
139,200

 
150
%
 
208,800

March 14, 2015
 
March 21, 2018
 
217,860

 
100
%
 
217,860

May 14, 2015
 
May 22, 2018
 
115,480

 
100
%
 
115,480

May 20, 2015
 
May 28, 2018
 
4,250

 
50
%
 
2,125



60


The weighted average fair value of PSUs granted subsequent to December 31, 2017 was based 50% on the VWAP of the Company's common shares on the TSX for the five trading days preceding the grant date (CDN$21.22) and 50% based on a Monte Carlo simulation model implemented in a risk-neutral framework considering the following assumptions:
 
2018
Expected life
3 years

Expected volatility (1)
30
%
US risk-free interest rate
2.43
%
Canadian risk-free rate
1.96
%
Expected dividends (2)
CDN$ 0.00
Performance period starting price (3)
CDN$ 21.13
Stock price as of estimation date
CDN$ 20.59
The weighted average fair value of PSUs granted prior to December 31, 2017 was estimated based on a Monte Carlo simulation model implemented in a risk-neutral framework, taking into account the following weighted average assumptions for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2017:
 
2017
 
2016
Expected life
3 years

 
3 years

Expected volatility (1)
34
%
 
36
%
US risk-free interest rate
1.57
%
 
1.09
%
Expected dividends (2)
CDN$ 0.00
 
CDN$ 0.00
Performance period starting price (3)
CDN$ 22.26
 
CDN$ 18.89
Stock price as of estimation date
CDN$ 21.94
 
CDN$ 18.90
(1) 
Expected volatility was calculated based on the daily dividend adjusted closing price change on the TSX for a term commensurate with the expected life of the grant.
(2) 
A participant will receive a cash payment from the Company upon PSU settlement that is equivalent to the number of settled PSUs multiplied by the amount of cash dividends per share declared by the Company between the date of grant and the settlement date. As such, there is no impact from expected future dividends in the Monte Carlo simulation model.
(3) 
The performance period starting price is measured as the VWAP for the common shares of the Company on the TSX on the grant dates.
The following table summarizes information about PSUs outstanding as of:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
PSUs outstanding
1,034,239

 
1,103,311

Weighted average fair value per PSU outstanding
$
9.49

 
$
14.14

Based on the Company’s performance adjustment factors as of December 31, 2018, the number of PSUs earned if all of the outstanding awards were to be settled at December 31, 2018, would be as follows:
Grant Date
Performance
March 21, 2016
50
%
December 20, 2016
%
March 20, 2017
50
%
March 21, 2018
113
%


61


Deferred Share Unit Plan
DSUs are granted to non-executive directors as a result of a grant, in lieu of dividends and/or in lieu of cash for semi-annual directors’ fee and must be retained until the director leaves the Company’s Board of Directors. The purpose of the DSU plan is to tie a portion of the value of the compensation of non-executive directors to the future value of the Company's common shares. A DSU is a right that has a value equal to the VWAP of the Company's common shares as published by the TSX, for the five consecutive trading days immediately preceding a date specified in the grant terms.
The following table summarizes information about DSUs for the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
DSUs granted
69,234

 
48,179

 
52,665

Weighted average fair value per DSU granted
$
14.75

 
$
17.79

 
$
16.76

 DSUs settled
37,668

 

 

Weighted average fair value per DSU settled
$
14.50

 
$

 
$

Cash payments on DSUs settled
$
546

 
$

 
$

The following table summarizes information about DSUs outstanding as of:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
DSUs outstanding
198,993

 
167,427

Weighted average fair value per DSU outstanding
$
12.18

 
$
16.91

Stock Appreciation Rights
SAR awards are for directors, executives and other designated employees of the Company. A SAR is a right to receive a cash payment equal to the difference between the base price of the SAR and the market value of a common share of the Company on the TSX on the date of exercise. SARs can be settled only in cash and expire no later than ten years after the date of the grant. All SARs are granted at a price determined and approved by the Board of Directors, which is the closing price of the common shares of the Company on the TSX on the trading day immediately preceding the day on which a SAR is granted. The base price for all SARs issued and outstanding for all periods presented is CDN$7.56. SARs granted to employees and executives will vest and may be exercisable 25% per year over four years. SARs granted to directors who are not officers of the Company will vest and may be exercisable 25% on the grant date, and a further 25% will vest and may be exercisable per year over three years.
There were no SARs granted during the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 and there were no SARs outstanding as of December 31, 2018.
The following table summarizes information regarding SARs activity for three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
SARs exercised (1)
147,500

 
13,250

 
422,202

 
Cash payments on exercise
$
1,481

 
$
155

 
$
4,017

(2) 
(1)     Base price of SARs exercised was CDN$7.56.
(2)    Includes awards exercised but not yet paid.


62


The following table summarizes information regarding SARs outstanding as of:
 
December 31, 2017
SARs outstanding
147,500

Weighted average fair value per SARs outstanding
$
10.85

Aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding vested awards
$
1,634

Summary of Share-based Compensation Expense and Share-based Compensation Liabilities
The following table summarizes share-based compensation expense (benefit) recorded in earnings in SG&A for three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Stock options
467

 
167

 
427

PSUs
866

 
2,903

 
4,369

DSUs
230

 
512

 
884

RSUs
448

 

 

SARs
(97
)
 
(291
)
 
2,521

 
1,914

 
3,291

 
8,201

The following table summarizes share-based liabilities recorded in the consolidated balance sheets for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
Share-based compensation liabilities, current
$
 
$
 
PSUs (1)
2,563

 
5,709

 
DSUs
2,417

(2) 
2,956

(3) 
SARs

 
1,600

 
RSUs (1)
86

 

 
 
5,066

 
10,265

 
 
 
 
 
 
Share-based compensation liabilities, non-current
 
 
 
 
PSUs (1)
3,764

 
4,984

 
RSUs (1)
361

 

 
 
4,125

 
4,984

 
(1)     Includes dividend equivalents accrued on awards.
(2)    Includes dividend equivalent grants.
(3)     Includes effect of DSUs received in lieu of cash for directors' fees not yet granted.


63


Change in Contributed Surplus
The activity for the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 in the consolidated changes in equity under the caption contributed surplus is detailed as follows:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Change in excess tax benefit on exercised share-based awards
(7
)
 
(597
)
 
(2,693
)
Change in excess tax benefit on outstanding share-based awards
(737
)
 
(3,135
)
 
4,302

Share-based compensation expense credited to capital on options exercised
(179
)
 
(495
)
 
(595
)
Share-based compensation expense
 
 
 
 
 
Stock options
467

 
167

 
427

DSUs

 
(1,935
)
 
885

PSUs

 
(6,060
)
 
3,961

 
467

 
(7,828
)
 
5,273

Change in contributed surplus
(456
)
 
(12,055
)
 
6,287

17 - BUSINESS ACQUISITIONS AND GOODWILL
Investment in Capstone and Airtrax Acquisition
On June 23, 2017, the Company, under a Share Subscription and Shareholder Agreement, purchased 3,250,000 or 99.7% of the issued and outstanding shares of Capstone. The principal purpose of the investment in Capstone is to further extend the Company’s woven products business through a global supply of woven products. The Company invested $5.1 million in cash, funded primarily from the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. There were customary representations, warranties and covenants, and indemnification provisions as part of the Capstone investment. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, there were no outstanding obligations or indemnifications.
The balance sheet of Capstone subsequent to the investment was as follows:
 
 
June 23, 2017
 
 
$
Current assets
 
 
Cash
 
5,066

Other assets
 
578

 
 
5,644

Current liabilities
 
 
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
 
20

Borrowings, current
 
559

 
 
579

 
 
5,065

 
 
 
 
 
June 23, 2017
 
 
$
Consideration paid for investment
 
5,050

Plus: remaining non-controlling interest
 
15

Fair value of net assets
 
5,065

On July 19, 2017, the non-controlling shareholders of Capstone acquired 99,000 additional shares of Capstone for a purchase price of approximately $0.2 million. On August 8, 2017, the Company acquired 3,250,000 additional shares of Capstone for a purchase price of approximately $5.1 million. As of December 31, 2017, the Company and the non-controlling shareholders held 98.4% and 1.6% of the issued and outstanding shares of Capstone, respectively. As a result of the share-purchase activity, the Company


64


recorded a $0.2 million increase to equity attributable to non-controlling interest in the consolidated changes in equity for the twelve months ended December 31, 2017.
The advisory fees and other costs associated with establishing the newly-formed enterprise were $0.5 million and are included in the Company’s consolidated earnings in SG&A for the year ended December 31, 2017.
On May 11, 2018, Capstone acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed certain liabilities of Airtrax Polymers Private Limited (d/b/a Airtrax) ("Airtrax Acquisition"). Airtrax manufactures and sells woven products that are used in various applications, including in the building and construction industry. As part of the agreement, the minority shareholders of Capstone contributed in kind certain assets and liabilities valued at $13.4 million that were formerly attributed to Airtrax’s woven product manufacturing operations in exchange for newly-issued shares of Capstone. As a result of the minority shareholders' in-kind contribution made to Capstone and the Company's initial consideration value paid to the minority shareholders through the issuance of Capstone shares, the Company recorded a $10.9 million increase to equity attributable to non-controlling interest as well as a temporary $2.5 million credit to deficit in the consolidated changes in equity for the twelve months ended December 31, 2018.
On August 10, 2018, the Company acquired additional existing and newly-issued shares of Capstone in exchange for $3.6 million in cash as part of the same overall transaction, thus increasing its equity investment in Capstone by the same amount. As a result, the Company recorded a $2.5 million debit to deficit and a $0.1 million decrease to equity attributable to non-controlling interest in the consolidated changes in equity for the twelve months ended December 31, 2018 to reflect the Company's increased equity position in Capstone and the minority shareholders' decreased equity position in Capstone once the shares were issued and sold. The remaining $1.0 million paid for the additional shares was recorded as cash on the balance sheet of Capstone.
As of December 31, 2018, the Company held a 55% controlling ownership stake in Capstone while the minority shareholders held a 45% non-controlling interest in Capstone.
The Airtrax Acquisition is being accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. The acquisition is expected to further enhance and extend the Company’s product offering and provide a globally competitive position in woven products. The Airtrax purchase agreement contains customary indemnification provisions. As of December 31, 2018, there were no outstanding obligations or indemnifications.
The fair values of net identifiable assets acquired at the date of acquisition were as follows:
 
May 11, 2018
 
 $
Current assets
 
     Trade receivables (1)
1,296

     Inventories
1,565

     Parts and supplies
54

     Other current assets
477

Property, plant and equipment
6,454

Intangible assets
1,223

 
11,069

Current liabilities
 
     Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
763

     Borrowings, current
728

Borrowings, non-current
346

Pension, post-retirement and other long-term employee benefits
8

Deferred tax liabilities
1,866

 
3,711

Fair value of net identifiable assets acquired
7,358

(1) 
The gross contractual amounts receivable were $1.3 million. As of December 31, 2018, the Company has collected substantially all of the outstanding trade receivables.


65


Resulting goodwill at the date of acquisition was calculated as follows:
 
May 11, 2018
 
 $
Fair value of increase to non-controlling interest
11,102

Effect of change in IPG's ownership interest in Capstone
2,299

Less: fair value of net identifiable assets acquired
7,358

Goodwill
6,043

Goodwill recognized is primarily related to growth expectations, expected future profitability, and expected cost synergies. The Company does not expect any of the goodwill to be deductible for income tax purposes.
The Airtrax Acquisition’s impact on the Company’s consolidated earnings, including the impact of purchase accounting, was as follows:
 
 
May 11 through December 31, 2018
 
 
 $
Revenue

4,708

Net earnings

99

Had the Airtrax Acquisition been effective as of January 1, 2018, the impact on the Company’s consolidated earnings would have been as follows:
 
Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2018
 
 $
Revenue
9,555

Net earnings (1)
497

(1) 
Adjustments to arrive at net earnings include (i) the alignment of accounting policies to IFRS, (ii) the removal of acquisition costs incurred by Airtrax, (iii) the amortization of recorded intangible assets and other purchase accounting adjustments and (iv) the effect of income tax expense using the effective tax rate of the acquisition post-closing.
The Company's acquisition-related costs of less than $0.1 million are excluded from the consideration transferred and are included in the Company’s consolidated earnings primarily in SG&A for the year ended December 31, 2018.
Polyair Acquisition
On August 3, 2018, the Company acquired 100% of the outstanding equity value in Polyair Inter Pack Inc. (“Polyair”) for total net cash consideration of $145.0 million ("Polyair Acquisition"). Polyair, formerly a private company, is in the protective packaging business with seven manufacturing facilities and a distribution center in North America. Polyair's primary products consist of bubble cushioning, foam, mailers and air pillow systems. The Polyair purchase agreement contains customary indemnification provisions. As of December 31, 2018, the Company has recorded a $3.2 million liability that is payable to the former shareholders of Polyair under the share purchase agreement, primarily relating to estimated state and federal income tax benefits due to the Company's payment of certain deal-related costs on behalf of Polyair through the transaction proceeds ($1.6 million in short-term obligations is included in accounts payable and accrued liabilities and $1.6 million in long-term obligations in other liabilities). As of December 31, 2018, there were no other outstanding obligations or indemnifications relating to this acquisition.
The Polyair Acquisition is being accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. The acquisition is expected to further strengthen the Company's product bundle and bring immediate and additional scale of protective packaging solutions.


66


The net cash consideration paid on the closing date for the acquisition described above was as follows:
 
August 3, 2018
 
 $
Consideration paid in cash
145,102

Less: cash balances acquired
140

 
144,962

The fair values of net identifiable assets acquired at the date of acquisition were as follows:
 
August 3, 2018
 
 $
Current assets
 
Cash
140

     Trade receivables (1)
10,462

     Inventories
11,402

     Other current assets
855

Property, plant and equipment
21,946

Intangible assets
77,600

Other assets
522

 
122,927

Current liabilities
 
     Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
19,331

     Provisions, current
30

     Borrowings, current
46

Borrowings, non-current
154

Deferred tax liabilities
17,625

Provisions, non-current
1,544

Other liabilities
1,653

 
40,383

Fair value of net identifiable assets acquired
82,544

(1) 
The gross contractual amounts receivable were $10.5 million. As of December 31, 2018, the Company has collected substantially all of the outstanding trade receivables.
Resulting goodwill at the date of acquisition was calculated as follows:
 
August 3, 2018
 
 $
Cash consideration transferred
145,102

Plus: Remaining non-controlling interest (1)
421

Less: fair value of net identifiable assets acquired
82,544

Goodwill
62,979

(1) 
As part of the acquisition of Polyair, the Company indirectly obtained a controlling 50.1% interest in Polyair subsidiary GPCP Inc., which is engaged in selling anti-corrosive plastic and paper packaging film under the trade name VCI 2000. The subsidiary is incorporated in the US and is 49.9% owned by a non-controlling entity located in Israel. The initial recorded value of the non-controlling interest is measured using the calculated proportionate share of the subsidiary's identifiable net assets.
Goodwill recognized is primarily related to growth expectations, expected future profitability, and expected cost synergies. The Company does not expect goodwill to be deductible for income tax purposes.


67


The Polyair Acquisition’s impact on the Company’s consolidated earnings, including the impact of purchase accounting, was as follows:
 
 
August 3 through December 31, 2018
 
 
 $
Revenue

55,505

Net loss

(699
)
Had the Polyair Acquisition been effective as of January 1, 2018, the impact on the Company’s consolidated earnings would have been as follows:
 
Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2018
 
 $
Revenue
132,015

Net loss (1)
(5,035
)
(1) 
Adjustments to arrive at a net loss include (i) the alignment of accounting policies to IFRS, (ii) the removal of acquisition costs incurred by Polyair, (iii) the amortization of recorded intangible assets and other purchase accounting adjustments and (iv) the effect of income tax expense using the effective tax rate of the acquisition post-closing.
The Company's acquisition-related costs of $1.4 million are excluded from the consideration transferred and are included in the Company’s consolidated earnings primarily in SG&A for the year ended December 31, 2018.
Maiweave Acquisition
On December 17, 2018, the Company acquired substantially all of the operating assets of Maiweave LLC (“Maiweave”) for total cash consideration of $20.8 million ("Maiweave Acquisition"). Maiweave, formerly a private company, is based in Springfield, Ohio and an integrated US manufacturer of engineered coated polyolefin fabrics. Its products are used in applications such as grain and salt pile covers, pit and pond liners, shelter fabrics, outdoor media, and lumber mill packaging. The former owners of Maiweave have in escrow $3.1 million as of December 31, 2018, related to customary representations, warranties and covenants in the Maiweave purchase agreement. The Maiweave purchase agreement also contains customary indemnification provisions. As of December 31, 2018, there were no outstanding obligations or indemnifications relating to this acquisition.
The Maiweave Acquisition is being accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. The acquisition is expected to further strengthen the Company's woven product bundle and provides additional scale to support demand.
The net cash consideration paid on the closing date for the acquisition described above was as follows:
 
December 17, 2018
 
 $
Consideration paid in cash
20,802

Less: cash balances acquired
1

 
20,801



68


The fair values of net identifiable assets acquired at the date of acquisition were as follows:
 
December 17, 2018
 
 $
Current assets
 
Cash
1

     Trade receivables (1)
3,210

     Inventories
5,977

Property, plant and equipment
9,982

Intangible assets
4,050

 
23,220

Current liabilities
 
     Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
2,482

     Provisions, current
50

 
2,532

Fair value of net identifiable assets acquired
20,688

(1) 
The gross contractual amounts receivable were $3.3 million. As of December 31, 2018, the Company has collected approximately $0.9 million of the outstanding trade receivables and expects to collect substantially all of the remaining uncollected amounts.
Resulting goodwill at the date of acquisition was calculated as follows:
 
December 17, 2018
 
 $
Cash consideration transferred
20,802

Less: fair value of net identifiable assets acquired
20,688

Goodwill
114

Goodwill recognized is primarily related to growth expectations, expected future profitability, and expected cost synergies. The Company does not expect goodwill to be deductible for income tax purposes.
The Maiweave Acquisition had no impact on the Company’s consolidated earnings during the year ended December 31, 2018. Had the Maiweave Acquisition been effective as of January 1, 2018, the impact on the Company’s consolidated earnings would have been as follows:
 
Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2018
 
 $
Revenue
28,050

Net loss (1)
(1,173
)
(1) 
Adjustments to arrive at a net loss include (i) the alignment of accounting policies to IFRS, (ii) the removal of acquisition costs incurred by Maiweave, (iii) the amortization of recorded intangible assets and other purchase accounting adjustments and (iv) the effect of income tax expense using the effective tax rate of the acquisition post-closing.
The Company's acquisition-related costs of $0.5 million are excluded from the consideration transferred and are included in the Company’s consolidated earnings primarily in SG&A for the year ended December 31, 2018.


69


Cantech Acquisition
On July 1, 2017, the Company acquired substantially all of the assets of Canadian Technical Tape Ltd. ("Cantech"), a privately-owned North American supplier of industrial and specialty tapes based in Montreal, Quebec. The assets included the shares of Cantech Industries Inc., Cantech’s US subsidiary (collectively, the “Cantech Acquisition”). The purchase price was financed with funds available under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. The former shareholders of Cantech have in escrow $6.5 million as of December 31, 2018, related to customary representations, warranties and covenants in the Cantech purchase agreement. The Cantech purchase agreement also contains customary indemnification provisions. As of December 31, 2018, there were no outstanding obligations or indemnification claims made against the former shareholders or the escrow.
The net cash consideration paid on the closing date was as follows:
 
July 1, 2017
 
 $
Consideration paid in cash
71,610

Less: cash balances acquired
4,567

 
67,043

The Cantech Acquisition was accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting. The Cantech Acquisition is expected to further enhance and extend the Company’s product offering and provide additional distribution channels for the Company’s products in Canada, the US and Europe.
The fair values of net identifiable assets acquired at the date of acquisition were as follows:
 
July 1, 2017
 
 $
Current assets
 
     Cash
4,567

     Trade receivables (1)
8,899

     Inventories
15,828

     Other current assets
503

Property, plant and equipment
27,275

Intangible assets
11,700

 
68,772

Current liabilities
 
     Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
3,573

Deferred tax liability
2,943

Provisions
192

 
6,708

Fair value of net identifiable assets acquired
62,064

(1) 
The gross contractual amounts receivable were $9.1 million. As of December 31, 2017, the Company had collected substantially all of the outstanding trade receivables.


70


Goodwill recognized is primarily related to growth expectations, expected future profitability, and expected cost synergies. The Company expects a significant portion of the goodwill to be deductible for income tax purposes. Resulting goodwill at the date of acquisition was calculated as follows:
 
July 1, 2017
 
 $
Cash consideration transferred
71,610

Less: fair value of net identifiable assets acquired
62,064

Goodwill
9,546

The Cantech Acquisition’s impact on the Company’s consolidated earnings, including the impact of purchase accounting, was as follows:
 
July 1, 2017 through December 31, 2017
 
 $
Revenue
32,352

Net earnings
137

Had the Cantech Acquisition been effective as of January 1, 2017, the impact on the Company’s consolidated earnings would have been as follows:
 
Twelve Months Ended December 31, 2017
 
 $
Revenue
64,575

Net earnings (1)
1,822

(1) 
Adjustments to arrive at net earnings include (i) the alignment of accounting policies to IFRS, (ii) the removal of acquisition costs incurred by Cantech, (iii) the amortization of recorded intangibles and other purchase accounting adjustments and (iv) the effect of income tax expense using the effective tax rate of the acquisition post-closing.
Acquisition-related costs of $1.7 million are excluded from the consideration transferred and are included in the Company’s consolidated earnings in SG&A for the year ended December 31, 2017.
Goodwill
The following table outlines the changes in goodwill during the period:
 
Total
 
$
Balance as of December 31, 2016
30,841

Acquired through business combinations
9,546

Net foreign exchange differences
1,303

Balance as of December 31, 2017
41,690

Acquired through business combinations
69,136

Net foreign exchange differences
(3,112
)
Balance as of December 31, 2018
107,714



71


18 - PENSION, POST-RETIREMENT AND OTHER LONG-TERM EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
The Company has several contributory and non-contributory defined contribution plans and defined benefit plans for substantially all its employees in Canada and the US.
Defined contribution plans
In the US, the Company maintains a savings retirement plan (401(k) Plan) for the benefit of certain employees who have been employed for at least 90 days. Contribution to this plan is at the discretion of the Company. The Company also maintains 401(k) plans according to the terms of certain collective bargaining agreements.
The Company also contributes to multi-employer plans for employees covered by certain collective bargaining agreements.
In Canada, the Company maintains defined contribution pension plans for its salaried employees and contributes amounts equal to 4% of each participant’s eligible salary.
The amount expensed with respect to the defined contribution plans for the years ended December 31, was $3.5 million in 2018, $4.7 million in 2017 and $4.6 million in 2016.
Defined benefit plans
The Company has, in the US, three defined benefit pension plans (hourly and salaried). Benefits for employees are based on compensation and years of service for salaried employees and fixed benefits per month for each year of service for hourly employees.
In Canada, certain non-union hourly employees of the Company are covered by a plan which provides a fixed benefit per month for each year of service.
In the US, the Company provides group health care benefits to certain retirees. In Canada, the Company provides group health care, dental and life insurance benefits for eligible retired employees.
All defined benefit plans described above are closed to new entrants.
Supplementary executive retirement plans
The Company has Supplementary Executive Retirement Plans (“SERPs”) to provide supplemental pension benefits to certain key executives. The SERPs are not funded and provide for an annual pension benefit, from retirement or termination date, in amounts ranging from $0.2 million to $0.6 million, annually.
Other long-term employee benefit plans
In the US, the Company provides a deferred compensation plan to certain employees. Earnings and losses on the deferral and amounts due to the participants are payable based on participant elections. Assets are held in a Rabbi trust and are composed of corporate owned life insurance policies. Participant investment selections are used to direct the allocation of funds underlying the corporate owned life insurance policies. As of December 31, 2018, the deferred compensation plans assets and liabilities totalled $2.4 million ($1.0 million as of December 31, 2017) and $2.6 million ($0.9 million as of December 31, 2017), respectively, and are presented in other assets and other liabilities, respectively, in the consolidated balance sheets.
Governance and oversight
The defined benefit plans sponsored by the Company are subject to the requirements of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act and related legislation in the US and the Canadian Income Tax Act and provincial legislation in Ontario and Nova Scotia. In addition, all actuarial computations related to defined benefit plans are based on actuarial assumptions and methods determined in accordance with the generally recognized and accepted actuarial principles and practices prescribed by the Actuarial Standards Board, the American Academy of Actuaries and the Canadian Institute of Actuaries.
Minimum funding requirements are computed based on methodologies and assumptions dictated by regulation in the US and Canada. The Company’s practice is to fund at least the statutory minimum required amount for each defined benefit plan’s plan year.  However, on September 12, 2018, the Company made an $11.3 million discretionary contribution to its US defined benefit pension plans. These plans are near wholly funded on an accounting basis and as a result, the Company expects to reduce future


72


contribution requirements and certain plan administration expenses. During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company recognized a net federal tax benefit of approximately $1.3 million primarily due to the discretionary contribution deducted on the 2017 tax return at the higher 2017 US corporate tax rate, partially offset by the reversal of the related deferred tax asset recorded using the lower US corporate tax rate provided under the TCJA. Refer to Note 5 for additional information on the TCJA.
The Company’s Investment Committee, composed of the Company’s Chief Financial Officer, Vice President of Human Resources, Vice President of Treasury, Corporate Controller and General Counsel, makes investment decisions for the Company’s pension plans. The asset liability matching strategy of the pension plans and plan asset performance is reviewed semi-annually in terms of risk and return profiles with external investment management advisors, actuaries and plan trustees. The Investment Committee, together with external investment management advisors, actuaries and plan trustees, has established a target mix of equity, fixed income, and alternative securities based on funded status level and other variables of each defined benefit plan.
The assets of the funded or partially funded defined benefit plans are held separately from those of the Company in funds under the control of trustees.


73


Information Relating to the Various Benefit Plans
A reconciliation of the defined benefit obligations and plan assets is presented in the table below for the years ended:
 
Pension Plans
 
Other plans
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Defined benefit obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of year
86,462

 
79,821

 
3,152

 
2,867

Current service cost
1,193

 
1,076

 
44

 
46

Interest cost
3,031

 
3,096

 
106

 
111

Benefits paid
(3,701
)
 
(3,406
)
 
(71
)
 
(246
)
Actuarial (gains) losses from demographic assumptions
(163
)
 
(1,052
)
 
21

 
(565
)
Actuarial (gains) losses from financial assumptions
(5,186
)
 
3,989

 
(210
)
 
133

Experience losses (gains)
266

 
2,077

 
(113
)
 
707

Foreign exchange rate adjustment
(1,206
)
 
861

 
(149
)
 
99

Balance, end of year
80,696

 
86,462

 
2,780

 
3,152

Fair value of plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of year
60,316

 
51,856

 

 

Interest income
2,217

 
2,025

 

 

Return on plan assets (excluding amounts included in net interest expense)
(2,369
)
 
5,591

 

 

Contributions by the employer
13,805

 
3,956

 

 

Benefits paid
(3,701
)
 
(3,406
)
 

 

Administration expenses
(611
)
 
(507
)
 

 

Foreign exchange rate adjustment
(1,079
)
 
801

 

 

Balance, end of year
68,578

 
60,316

 

 

Funded status – deficit
12,118

 
26,146

 
2,780

 
3,152

The defined benefit obligations and fair value of plan assets broken down by geographical locations is as follows for the years ended:
 
December 31, 2018
 
US
 
Canada
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
Defined benefit obligations
68,411

 
15,065

 
83,476

Fair value of plan assets
(56,186
)
 
(12,392
)
 
(68,578
)
Deficit in plans
12,225

 
2,673

 
14,898

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
US
 
Canada
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
Defined benefit obligations
72,643

 
16,971

 
89,614

Fair value of plan assets
(46,835
)
 
(13,481
)
 
(60,316
)
Deficit in plans
25,808

 
3,490

 
29,298

The defined benefit obligations for pension plans broken down by funding status are as follows for the years ended:


74


 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Wholly unfunded
10,567

 
11,195

Wholly funded or partially funded
70,129

 
75,267

Total obligations
80,696

 
86,462

A reconciliation of pension and other post-retirement benefits recognized in the consolidated balance sheets is as follows for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Pension Plans
 
 
 
Present value of the defined benefit obligation
80,696

 
86,462

Fair value of the plan assets
68,578

 
60,316

Deficit in plans
12,118

 
26,146

Liabilities recognized
12,118

 
26,146

Other plans
 
 
 
Present value of the defined benefit obligation and deficit in the plans
2,780

 
3,152

Liabilities recognized
2,780

 
3,152

Total plans
 
 
 
Total pension and other post-retirement benefits recognized in balance sheets
14,898

 
29,298

The composition of plan assets based on the fair value was as follows for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Asset category
 
 
 
Cash
106

 
1,308

Equity instruments
10,682

 
33,559

Fixed income instruments
57,790

 
23,514

Real estate investment trusts

 
1,935

Total
68,578

 
60,316

Approximately 100% and 80% of equity and fixed income instruments as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively, were held in mutual or exchange traded funds. None of the benefit plan assets were invested in any of the Company’s own equity or financial instruments or in any property or other asset that was used by the Company.
As of December 31, 2018, plan assets held in US government obligations and mutual fund positions were valued at the quoted price, or net asset value, for identical or similar securities reported in active markets. As of December 31, 2017, plan assets held in equity, fixed income and real estate investment trusts have quoted prices, or net asset value, in active markets, and certain US government obligations and mutual fund positions were valued at the quoted price, or net asset value, for identical or similar securities reported in active markets.


75


The following tables present the defined benefit expenses recognized in consolidated earnings for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
Pension Plans
 
Other plans
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Current service cost
1,193

 
1,076

 
1,176

 
44

 
46

 
22

Administration expenses
611

 
507

 
487

 

 

 

Net interest expense
814

 
1,071

 
1,174

 
106

 
111

 
143

Net costs recognized in the statement of consolidated earnings
2,618

 
2,654

 
2,837

 
150

 
157

 
165


 
Total Plans
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Current service cost
1,237

 
1,122

 
1,198

Administration expenses
611

 
507

 
487

Net interest expense
920

 
1,182

 
1,317

Net costs recognized in the statement of consolidated earnings
2,768

 
2,811

 
3,002

The table below presents the defined benefit liability remeasurement recognized in OCI for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
Pension Plans
 
Other plans
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
Actuarial gains (losses) from demographic assumptions
163

 
1,052

 
1,131

 
(21
)
 
565

 
21

Actuarial gains (losses) from financial assumptions
5,186

 
(3,989
)
 
(1,901
)
 
210

 
(133
)
 
(141
)
Experience (losses) gains
(266
)
 
(2,077
)
 
(1,383
)
 
113

 
(707
)
 
835

Return on plan assets (excluding amounts included in net interest expense)
(2,369
)
 
5,591

 
1,705

 

 

 

Total amounts recognized in OCI
2,714

 
577

 
(448
)
 
302

 
(275
)
 
715

The Company currently expects to contribute a total of $1.3 million to its defined benefit pension plans and $0.2 million to its health and welfare plans in 2019.
The weighted average duration of the defined benefit obligation as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 is 12 and 13 years for US plans and 18 and 19 years for Canadian plans, respectively.


76


The significant weighted average assumptions which were used to measure defined benefit obligations are as follows for the years ended:
 
US plans
 
Canadian plans
 
12/31/2018
 
12/31/2017
 
12/31/2018
 
12/31/2017
Discount rate
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pension plans (End of the Year) (1)
4.05
%
 
3.56
%
 
3.95
%
 
3.50
%
Pension plans (Current Service Cost) (2)
3.69
%
 
4.01
%
 
3.55
%
 
4.15
%
Other plans (End of the Year) (1)
3.71
%
 
3.10
%
 
3.95
%
 
3.50
%
Other plans (Current Service Cost) (2)
4.17
%
 
3.67
%
 
3.55
%
 
4.15
%
Life expectancy at age 65 (in years) (3)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current pensioner - Male
20

 
20

 
22

 
22

Current pensioner - Female
22

 
22

 
25

 
24

Current member aged 45 - Male
22

 
21

 
23

 
23

Current member aged 45 - Female
24

 
24

 
26

 
25

(1) 
Represents the discount rate used to calculate the accrued benefit obligation at the end of the year and applied to other components such as interest cost.
(2) 
Represents the discount rate used to calculate annual service cost. Beginning in 2017, the current service cost is calculated using a separate discount rate to reflect the longer duration of future benefit payments associated with the additional year of service to be earned by the plan's active participants. Previously, the current service cost was calculated using the same discount rate used to measure the defined benefit obligation for both active and retired participants.
(3) 
Utilizes mortality tables issued by the Society of Actuaries and the Canadian Institute of Actuaries.
These assumptions are developed by management with the assistance of independent actuaries. Discount rates are determined close to each year-end by reference to market yields of high-quality corporate bonds that are denominated in the currency in which the benefits will be paid and have terms to maturity approximating the terms of the related pension benefit obligation. Other assumptions are based on current actuarial benchmarks and management’s historical experience.
Significant actuarial assumptions for defined benefit obligation measurement purposes are the discount rate and mortality rate. The sensitivity analysis below has been determined based on reasonably possible changes in the assumptions, in isolation from one another, occurring at the end of the reporting period. This analysis may not be representative of the actual change in the defined benefit obligation as it is unlikely that the change in the assumptions would occur in isolation from one another as some of the assumptions may be correlated. An increase or decrease of 1% in the discount rate or an increase or decrease of one year in mortality rate would result in the following increase (decrease) in the defined benefit obligation:
 
12/31/2018
 
12/31/2017
 
$
 
$
Discount rate
 
 
 
Increase of 1%
(9,539
)
 
(10,988
)
Decrease of 1%
11,729

 
13,666

Mortality rate
 
 
 
Life expectancy increased by one year
2,263

 
2,856

Life expectancy decreased by one year
(2,392
)
 
(2,892
)


77


19 - SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES BY GEOGRAPHIC LOCATION AND PRODUCT LINE
The following table presents geographic information about revenue attributed to countries based on the location of external customers for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Canada
96,434

 
78,325

 
54,574

Germany
24,361

 
18,248

 
16,299

United States
834,989

 
714,330

 
670,619

Other
97,235

 
87,223

 
67,309

Total revenue
1,053,019

 
898,126

 
808,801

The following table presents geographic information about long-lived assets by country based on the location of the assets for the years ended:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Property, plant and equipment

 

Canada
33,383

 
32,572

India
53,057

 
26,099

Portugal
19,175

 
16,810

United States
271,461

 
238,039

Total property, plant and equipment
377,076

 
313,520

Goodwill

 

Canada
11,520

 
6,805

India
28,155

 
24,452

United States
68,039

 
10,433

Total goodwill
107,714

 
41,690

Intangible assets

 

Canada
19,622

 
10,012

India
18,712

 
21,904

United States
84,037

 
15,394

Portugal
18

 
8

Total intangible assets
122,389

 
47,318

Other assets

 

Canada
539

 
1,331

India
71

 
94

United States
8,927

 
5,542

Portugal
49

 
31

Total other assets
9,586

 
6,998

The following table presents revenue information based on revenues for the following product categories and their complementary packaging systems for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Tape
672,856

 
606,302

 
538,525

Film
184,743

 
165,597

 
152,610

Engineered coated products
126,973

 
115,538

 
106,720

Protective packaging
57,070


1,375


1,535

Other
11,377

 
9,314

 
9,411

 
1,053,019

 
898,126

 
808,801



78


20 - RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
The Company’s key personnel include all members of the Board of Directors and five members of senior management in 2018, 2017 and 2016. Key personnel remuneration includes the following expenses for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Short-term benefits including employee salaries and bonuses and director retainer and committee fees
4,591

 
4,099

 
4,842

Post-employment and other long-term benefits
289

 
295

 
305

Share-based compensation expense (1)
1,016

 
1,619

 
5,195

Total remuneration
5,896

 
6,013

 
10,342


(1) 
The table above does not include amounts recognized in deficit for share-based compensation arising as a result of the amendments to the DSU and PSU plans.
21 - COMMITMENTS
Commitments Under Operating Leases
For the year ended December 31, 2018, the expense in respect of operating leases was $8.6 million ($6.7 million in 2017 and $5.9 million in 2016). As of December 31, 2018, the Company had commitments aggregating approximately $35.5 million through the year 2028 for the rental of offices, warehouse space, manufacturing equipment, automobiles, computer hardware and other assets. Minimum lease payments for the next five years are expected to be $8.5 million in 2019, $6.2 million in 2020, $5.3 million in 2021, $4.7 million in 2022, $4.7 million in 2023 and $6.1 million for the Company's current commitments thereafter.
Commitments Under Service Contracts
The Company entered into a five-year electricity service contract for one of its manufacturing facilities on May 1, 2016, under which the Company has and expects to continue to reduce the overall cost of electricity consumed by the facility. In the event of early termination, the Company is required to pay for unrecovered power supply costs incurred by the supplier which are estimated to be approximately $5.8 million as of December 31, 2018 and would decline monthly based on actual service billings to date.
The Company entered into a ten-year electricity service contract for one of its manufacturing facilities on November 12, 2013. The service date of the contract commenced in August 2014. The Company is committed to monthly minimum usage requirements over the term of the contract. The Company was provided installation at no cost and is receiving economic development incentive credits and maintenance of the required energy infrastructure at the manufacturing facility as part of the contract. The credits are expected to reduce the overall cost of electricity consumed by the facility over the term of the contract. Effective August 1, 2015, the Company entered into an amendment lowering the minimum usage requirements over the term of the contract. In addition, a new monthly facility charge has been incurred by the Company over the term of the contract. The Company estimates that service billings will total approximately $1.7 million annually in 2019 through 2023 and $1.0 million as the total billings expected over the remainder of the contract up to 2024. Certain penalty clauses exist within the electricity service contract related to early cancellation after the service date of the contract. The costs related to early cancellation penalties include termination fees based on anticipated service billings over the term of the contract and capital expense recovery charges. While the Company does not expect to cancel the contract prior to the end of its term, the penalties that would apply to early cancellation could total as much as $3.9 million as of December 31, 2018. This amount declines annually until the expiration of the contract.
The Company has entered into agreements with various utility suppliers to fix certain energy costs, including natural gas, through December 2022 for minimum amounts of consumption at several of its manufacturing facilities. The Company estimates that utility billings will total approximately $6.4 million over the term of the contracts based on the contracted fixed terms and current market rate assumptions. The Company is also required by the agreements to pay any difference between the fixed price agreed to with the utility and the sales amount received by the utility for resale to a third party if the Company fails to meet the minimum consumption required by the agreements. In the event of early termination, the Company is required to pay the utility suppliers the difference between the contracted amount and the current market value of the energy, adjusted for present value, of any future agreed upon minimum usage. Neither party will be liable for failure to perform for reasons of “force majeure” as defined in the agreements.


79


Commitments to Suppliers
The Company obtains certain raw materials from suppliers under consignment agreements. The suppliers retain ownership of raw materials until the earlier of when the materials are consumed in production or auto billings are triggered based upon maturity. The consignment agreements involve short-term commitments that typically mature within 30 to 60 days of inventory receipt and are typically renewed on an ongoing basis. The Company may be subject to fees in the event the Company requires storage in excess of 30 to 60 days. As of December 31, 2018, the Company had on hand $9.2 million of raw material owned by its suppliers.
The Company has entered into agreements with various raw material suppliers to purchase minimum quantities of certain raw materials at fixed rates through August 2020 totaling approximately $15.0 million as of December 31, 2018. The Company is also required by the agreements to pay any storage costs incurred by the applicable supplier in the event the Company delays shipment in excess of 30 days. In the event the Company defaults under the terms of an agreement, an arbitrator will determine fees and penalties due to the applicable supplier. Neither party will be liable for failure to perform for reasons of “force majeure” as defined in the agreements.
The Company currently knows of no event, trend or uncertainty that may affect the availability or benefits of these arrangements now or in the future.


80


22 - FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
Classification and Fair Value of Financial Instruments
The classification of financial instruments, as well as their carrying amounts, are as follows for the years ended:
 
Amortized cost
 
Fair value
through
earnings
 
Derivatives used
for hedging (fair
value through OCI)
 
$
 
$
 
$
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
Cash
18,651

 

 

Trade receivables
129,285

 

 

Supplier rebates and other receivables
4,823

 

 

Interest rate swap agreements - hedge accounting applied

 

 
2,266

Interest rate swap agreements - not used for hedge accounting

 
339

 

Total financial assets
152,759

 
339

 
2,266

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities (1)
135,644

 

 

Borrowings (2)
494,273

 

 

Non-controlling interest put options

 
10,499

 

Amounts due to former shareholders of Polyair
1,653

 

 

Total financial liabilities
631,570

 
10,499

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
Cash
9,093

 

 

Trade receivables
106,634

 

 

Supplier rebates and other receivables
2,442

 

 

Interest rate swap agreements - hedge accounting applied

 

 
2,139

Total financial assets
118,169

 

 
2,139

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities (1)
85,982

 

 

Borrowings (2)
270,646

 

 

Call option redemption liability
12,725

 

 

Total financial liabilities
369,353

 

 

 
(1) 
Excludes employee benefits
(2) 
Excludes finance lease liabilities



81


Total interest expense (calculated using the effective interest method) for financial assets or financial liabilities that are not at fair value through profit or loss are as follows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018:
 
2018
 
2017
 
2016
 
$
 
$
 
$
Interest expense calculated using the effective interest rate method
19,020

 
8,186

 
3,965


Hierarchy of financial instruments
The Company categorizes its financial instruments into a three-level fair value measurement hierarchy as follows:
Level 1: The fair value is determined directly by reference to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities.
Level 2: The fair value is estimated using a valuation technique based on observable market data, either directly or indirectly.
Level 3: The fair value is estimated using a valuation technique based on unobservable data.
The Company ensures, to the extent possible, that its valuation techniques and assumptions incorporate all factors that market participants would consider in setting a price and are consistent with accepted economic methods for pricing financial instruments. There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 in 2018 or 2017.
The carrying amounts of the following financial assets and liabilities are considered a reasonable approximation of fair value given their short maturity periods:
cash
trade receivables
supplier rebates and other receivables
accounts payable and accrued liabilities
call option redemption liability
amounts due to former shareholders of Polyair
Borrowings
The fair value of the Company's Senior Unsecured Notes is based on the trading levels and bid/offer prices observed by a market participant. As of December 31, 2018, the Senior Unsecured Notes had a carrying value, including unamortized debt issuance cost, of $245.3 million and a fair value of $248.7 million.
The company's borrowings, other than the Senior Unsecured Notes, consist primarily of variable rate debt. The corresponding fair values are estimated using observable market interest rates of similar variable rate loans with similar risk and credit standing. Accordingly, the carrying amounts are considered to be a reasonable approximation of the fair values. Refer to Note 13 for additional information on borrowings.
As of December 31, 2018, and 2017, the Company categorizes its borrowings as Level 2 on the three-level fair value hierarchy.
Interest Rate Swaps
The Company measures the fair value of its interest rate swap agreements using discounted cash flows. Future cash flows are estimated based on forward interest rates (from observable yield curves at the end of a reporting period) and contract interest rates, discounted as a rate that reflects the credit risk of various counterparties.
As of December 31, 2018, and 2017, the Company categorizes its interest rate swaps as Level 2 on the three-level fair value hierarchy.


82


Call option redemption liability
On July 4, 2017, the Company and the non-controlling shareholders of Powerband executed a binding term sheet that confirmed that the Company’s call option on all of the shares owned by the non-controlling shareholders of Powerband had been triggered and substantially reaffirmed the exit terms of the shareholders’ agreement executed between the parties on September 2, 2016. Execution of this agreement resulted in the recognition of $12.7 million in present obligations recorded in call option redemption liability, and a corresponding reduction of equity on the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2017. Execution of this agreement also resulted in a $1.8 million reduction in the previously-recorded liability relating to the non-controlling interest put options with an offsetting benefit in earnings recorded in finance costs in other expense (income), net, followed immediately by the full derecognition of $8.8 million in remaining liability as a result of the extinguishment of obligations relating to these put options.
On November 16, 2018, the Company closed on the previously exercised call option to acquire the outstanding 26% interest in Powerband for $9.9 million, which resulted in the full derecognition of the previously recorded call option redemption liability of $12.7 million on the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2017. Upon derecognition of the call option redemption liability, and to account for the difference between the agreed-upon share purchase price of $9.9 million and the recorded liability of $12.7 million, a $1.4 million increase in equity was recorded on the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2018 and a $1.4 million foreign exchange gain was recorded in consolidated earnings in finance costs in other expense (income), net.
Non-controlling interest put options
As it relates to Powerband, there were no liabilities relating to the non-controlling interest put options recorded on the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, due to their derecognition as discussed above.
In connection with the acquisition of Airtrax, as discussed in Note 17, the Company, through its Capstone subsidiary, is party to a shareholders’ agreement that contains put options, which provide each of the non-controlling interest shareholders with the right to require the Company to purchase their retained interest at a variable purchase price following a five-year lock-in period. The agreed-upon purchase price is equal to the fair market valuation as determined through a future negotiation or, as needed, a valuation to be performed by an independent and qualified expert at the time of exercise. Finalization of the acquisition resulted in the initial recognition of $10.9 million in present obligations recorded in non-controlling interest put options, and a corresponding reduction of equity on the consolidated balance sheet. During the year ended December 31, 2018, the obligation was remeasured due to changes in exchange rates since the acquisition resulting in a $0.4 million reduction in the liability and a corresponding gain recorded in finance costs in other expense (income), net. As of December 31, 2018, the amount recorded on the consolidated balance sheet for this obligation is $10.5 million.
As it relates to Capstone, the Company categorizes its non-controlling interest put options as Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The Company measures the fair value of its non-controlling interest put options by estimating the present value of future net cash inflows from earnings associated with the proportionate shares that are subject to sale to the Company pursuant to an exercise event. This estimation is intended to approximate the redemption value of the options as indicated in the shareholders’ agreement. The calculation was made using significant unobservable inputs including estimations of undiscounted future annual cash inflows ranging between $1.0 million and $2.0 million, and a discount rate of 14.6%, which the Company believed to be commensurate with the risks inherent in the ownership interest as of December 31, 2018. The fair value of the liability is sensitive to changes in projected earnings and thereby, future cash inflows, and the discount rate applied to those future cash inflows, which could have resulted in a higher or lower fair value measurement.


83


A reconciliation of the carrying amount of financial instruments classified within Level 3 follows for the years ended:
 
Non-controlling interest put options
 
$
Balance as of December 31, 2016
10,020

Valuation adjustment made to Powerband non-controlling interest put options
(1,845
)
Extinguishment of Powerband non-controlling interest put options
(8,810
)
Net foreign exchange differences
635

Balance as of December 31, 2017

Non-controlling interest put options resulting from the Airtrax Acquisition
10,888

Net foreign exchange differences
(389
)
Balance as of December 31, 2018
10,499

Refer to Note 17 for more information regarding business acquisitions.
Exchange Risk
The Company’s consolidated financial statements are expressed in US dollars while a portion of its business is conducted in other currencies. Changes in the exchange rates for such currencies into US dollars can increase or decrease revenues, operating profit, earnings and the carrying values of assets and liabilities.
The following table details the Company’s sensitivity to a 10% strengthening of other currencies against the US dollar, and the related impact on finance costs—other expense (income), net. For a 10% weakening of the other currencies against the US dollar, there would be an equal and opposite impact on finance costs—other expense, net.
The estimated increase (decrease) to finance cost-other expense (income), net from financial assets and financial liabilities resulting from a 10% strengthening of other currencies against the US dollar, everything else being equal, would be as follows:
 
2018
 
2017
 
USD$
 
USD$
Canadian dollar
(4,719
)
 
(5,944
)
Euro
(64
)
 
(95
)
Indian Rupee
(881
)
 
227

 
(5,664
)
 
(5,812
)
The Company's risk strategy with respect to its foreign currency exposure is that the Financial Risk Management Committee (i) monitors the Company's exposures and cash flows, taking into account the large extent of naturally offsetting exposures, (ii) considers the Company's ability to adjust its selling prices due to foreign currency movements and other market conditions, and (iii) considers borrowing under available debt facilities in the most advantageous manner, after considering interest rates, foreign currency exposures, expected cash flows and other factors.
Hedge of net investment in foreign operations
A foreign currency exposure arises from the Parent Company’s net investment in its USD functional currency subsidiary, IPG (US) Holdings Inc. The risk arises from the fluctuations in the USD and CDN current exchange rate, which causes the amount of the net investment to vary.
In 2018, the Parent Company completed the private placement of its USD denominated Senior Unsecured Notes which resulted in additional equity investments in IPG (US) Holdings Inc. The Senior Unsecured Notes are being used to hedge the Company’s exposure to the USD foreign exchange risk on this investment. Gains or losses on the retranslation of this borrowing are transferred to OCI to offset any gains or losses on translation of the net investment in the subsidiary. The Senior Unsecured Notes are included as a liability in the borrowings line on the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2018.
There is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument as the net investment creates a translation risk that will match the foreign exchange risk on the USD borrowing designated as the hedging instrument. The Company has


84


established a hedge ration of 1:1 as the underlying risk of the hedging instrument is identical to the hedge risk component. Hedge ineffectiveness will arise when the amount of the investment in the foreign subsidiary becomes lower than the amount of the fixed rate borrowing and is recorded in finance costs in other expense (income), net. To assess hedge effectiveness, the Parent Company determines the economic relationship between the hedging instrument and the hedged item by comparing changes in the carrying amount of the Senior Unsecured Notes that is attributable to a change in the current exchange rate, with changes in the investment in the foreign operation due to movements in the current exchange rate.
The amount related to items designated as hedging instruments in the hedge of a net investment are as follows for the year ended December 31, 2018:
 
Notional Amount
 
Carrying Amount
 
Change in value used for calculating hedge ineffectiveness
 
Change in value of hedging instrument recognized in OCI
 
Hedge ineffectiveness recognized in earnings
 
Foreign exchange impact recognized in CTA
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
 
Senior Unsecured Notes denominated in USD
250,000

 
245,252

 
(10,926
)
 
(9,421
)
 
(1,527
)
 
22


The amounts related to items designated as hedged items are as follows for the year ended December 31, 2018:
 
Change in value used for calculating hedge ineffectiveness
 
Foreign currency translation reserve
 
$
 
$
Net investment in IPG (US) Holdings, Inc.
9,421

 
(9,421
)
Interest Rate Risk
The Company is exposed to a risk of change in cash flows due to the fluctuations in interest rates applicable on its variable rate borrowings. The Company’s overall risk management objective is to minimize the long-term cost of debt, taking into account short-term and long-term earnings and cash flow volatility. The Company’s risk strategy with respect to its exposure associated with variable rate borrowings is that the Financial Risk Management Committee monitors the Company’s amount of variable rate borrowings, taking into account the current and expected interest rate environment, the Company’s leverage and sensitivity to earnings and cash flows due to changes in interest rates. The Company’s risk management objective at this time is to mitigate the variability in 30-day LIBOR and CDOR-based cash flows.
To help accomplish this objective, the Company entered into interest rate swap agreements as follows:
 
Effective Date
 
Maturity
 
Notional amount
 
Settlement
 
Fixed interest
rate paid
Qualifying cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
$
 
 
 
%
 
June 8, 2017
 
June 20, 2022
 
40,000

 
Monthly
 
1.79
 
July 21, 2017
 
July 18, 2022
 
CDN$36,000

(1) 
Monthly
 
1.6825
 
August 20, 2018
 
August 18, 2023
 
60,000

 
Monthly
 
2.045
Non-qualifying cash flow hedge:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
March 18, 2015
 
November 18, 2019
 
40,000

 
Monthly
 
1.61

(1) 
The notional amount will decrease by CDN$18.0 million on July 18, 2021 and 2022.  
On August 20, 2018, an interest rate swap agreement with a notional amount of $60.0 million and fixed interest rate of 1.1970% matured and was settled in full.
The interest rate swap agreements involve the exchange of periodic payments excluding the notional principal amount upon which the payments are based. If the underlying interest rate swap agreement is a qualifying cash flow hedge, these payments are recorded as an adjustment of interest expense on the hedged debt instruments and the related amount payable to or receivable from counterparties is included as an adjustment to accrued interest. Cash payments related to non-qualifying cash flow hedges are


85


recorded as a reduction of the fair value of the corresponding interest rate swap agreement recognized in the balance sheet, which indirectly impacts the change in fair value recorded in earnings.
There is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument as the terms of the interest rate swap match the terms of the corresponding variable rate borrowing and it is expected that the value of the interest rate swap contracts and the value of the corresponding hedged items will systematically change in opposite direction in response to movements in the underlying interest rates. The Company has established a hedge ratio of 1:1 for the hedging relationships as the underlying risk of the interest rate swap is identical to the hedged risk component. The main source of hedge ineffectiveness which could exist in these hedge relationships is the effect of the counterparty and the Company’s own credit risk on the fair value of the interest rate swap contracts, which is not reflected in the fair value of the hedged item attributable to the change in interest rates.
The Company elects to use the hypothetical derivative methodology to measure the ineffectiveness of its hedging relationships in a given reporting period to be recorded in earnings. Under the hypothetical derivative method, the actual interest rate swaps would be recorded at fair value on the balance sheet, and accumulated OCI would be adjusted to a balance that reflects the lesser of either the cumulative change in the fair value of the actual interest rate swaps or the cumulative change in the fair value of the hypothetical derivatives. The determination of the fair values of both the hypothetical derivative and the actual interest rate swaps will use discounted cash flows based on the relevant interest rate swap curves. The amount of ineffectiveness, if any, recorded in earnings in finance costs in other expense (income), net, would be equal to the excess of the cumulative change in the fair value of the actual interest rate swaps over the cumulative change in the fair value of the hypothetical derivatives. Amounts previously included as part of OCI are transferred to earnings in the period during which the hedged item impacts net earnings.

The following table summarizes information regarding interest rate swap agreements designated as hedging instruments:

 
 
Carrying amount included in other assets
 
Change in fair value of the hedging instrument recognized in OCI (1)
 
Change in deferred tax recognized in OCI
 
Amounts reclassified from cash flow hedging reserve to earnings
 
Balance in cash flow hedge reserve for continuing hedges
 
Balance remaining in cash flow hedge reserve from hedging relationship for which hedge accounting no longer applies
 
 
$
 
$
 
 
 
$
 
$
 
$
December 31, 2018
 
2,266

 
970

 
463

 
(531
)
(2) 
2,177

 
313

December 31, 2017
 
2,139

 
2,358

 
(750
)
 

 
1,588

 


(1) 
The hedging gain recognized in OCI before tax is equal to the change in fair value used for measuring effectiveness. There is no ineffectiveness recognized in earnings.
(2) 
Reclassification of unrealized gains from OCI as a result of discontinuation of hedge accounting for certain interest rate swap agreements.
As of December 31, 2018, and 2017, the impact on the Company’s finance costs in interest expense from a 1.0% increase in interest rates, assuming all other variables remained equal, would be an increase of approximately $1.2 million and $0.5 million, respectively.
Credit Risk
Credit risk results from the possibility that a loss may occur from the failure of another party to perform according to the terms of the contract. Generally, the carrying amount reported on the Company’s consolidated balance sheet for its financial assets exposed to credit risk, net of any applicable provisions for losses, represents the maximum amount exposed to credit risk.
Financial assets that potentially subject the Company to credit risk consist primarily of cash, trade receivables and supplier rebate receivables and other receivables.


86


Cash
Credit risk associated with cash is substantially mitigated by ensuring that these financial assets are primarily placed with major financial institutions. The Company performs an ongoing review and evaluation of the possible changes in the status and creditworthiness of its counterparties.
Trade receivables
There was one customer as of December 31, 2018 (three customers as of December 31, 2017) with trade receivables that accounted for more than 5% of the Company’s total trade receivables. These trade receivables were current as of December 31, 2018 and 2017. The Company believes its credit risk with respect to trade receivables is limited due to the Company’s credit evaluation process, reasonably short collection terms and the creditworthiness of its customers and credit insurance. The Company regularly monitors its credit risk exposures and takes steps to mitigate the likelihood of these exposures resulting in actual losses.
The following table presents an analysis of the age of trade receivables and related balance as of:
 
December 31,
2018
 
December 31,
2017
 
$
 
$
Current
105,556

 
91,736

Past due accounts not impaired
 
 
 
1 – 30 days past due
17,985

 
12,435

31 – 60 days past due
2,983

 
1,652

61 – 90 days past due
1,658

 
288

Over 90 days past due
1,103

 
523

 
23,729

 
14,898

Allowance for expected credit loss
659

 
641

Gross accounts receivable
129,944

 
107,275

The Company’s allowance for expected credit loss reflects expected credit losses using a provision matrix model, supplemented by an allowance for individually impaired trade receivables. The provision matrix is based on the Company’s historic credit loss experience, adjusted for any change in risk of the trade receivable population based on credit monitoring indicators, and expectations of general economic conditions that might affect the collection of trade receivables. The provision matrix applies fixed provision rates depending on the number of days that a trade receivable is past due, with higher rates applied the longer a balance is past due. Trade receivables outstanding longer than the agreed upon payment terms are considered past due. The Company determines its allowance for individually impaired trade receivables by considering a number of factors, including notices of liquidation, information provided by credit monitoring services, the length of time trade receivables are past due, the customer’s current ability to pay its obligation to the Company, the customer’s history of paying balances when they are past due, historical results and the condition of the general economy and the industry as a whole. After considering the factors above, at December 31, 2018, the Company has determined there is no significant increase or decrease in its trade receivable credit risk since their initial recognition.
The Company writes off trade receivables when they are determined to be uncollectible and any payments subsequently received on such trade receivables are credited to the allowance for expected credit loss. Amounts are written-off based on the final results of bankruptcy or liquidation proceedings, as well as consideration of local statutes of limitations and other regulations permitting or requiring the write-off of trade receivables. The trade receivables written off during the year ended December 31, 2018 are not subject to enforcement activity.
The Company’s maximum exposure to credit risk at the end of the reporting period would be the gross accounts receivable balance shown in the table above. In general, the Company does not hold collateral with respect to its trade receivables.


87


The following table presents a continuity summary of the Company’s allowance for expected credit loss as of and for the years ended December 31:
 
2018
 
2017
 
$
 
$
Balance, beginning of year
641

 
254

Additions
296

 
1,095

Recoveries
(226
)
 
(397
)
Write-offs
(38
)
 
(300
)
Foreign exchange
(14
)
 
(11
)
Balance, end of year
659

 
641

Supplier rebates and other receivables
Credit risk associated with supplier rebates and other receivables is limited considering the amount is not material, the Company’s large size and diversified counterparties and geography.
Liquidity Risk
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Company will not be able to meet its financial liabilities and obligations as they become due. The Company is exposed to this risk mainly through its borrowings, finance lease liabilities, accounts payable and accrued liabilities and its option liabilities. The Company finances its operations through a combination of cash flows from operations and borrowings.
Liquidity risk management serves to maintain a sufficient amount of cash and to ensure that the Company has financing sources for a sufficient authorized amount. The Company establishes budgets, cash estimates and cash management policies to ensure it has the necessary funds to fulfill its obligations for the foreseeable future.
The following maturity analysis for financial liabilities is based on the remaining contractual maturities as of the balance sheet date. The amounts disclosed reflect the contractual undiscounted cash flows categorized by their earliest contractual maturity date on which the Company can be required to pay its obligation.


88


The maturity analysis for financial liabilities and finance lease liabilities is as follows for the years ended:
 
Non-controlling
interest put
options
 
Other 
borrowings
 
Interests on other borrowings
 
Finance
lease
liabilities
 
Accounts payable
and accrued
liabilities
 (1)
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current maturity

 
12,948

 
29,548

 
1,627

 
135,644

 
179,767

2020

 
13,631

 
29,360

 
839

 

 
43,830

2021

 
17,006

 
28,599

 
688

 

 
46,293

2022

 
18,780

 
28,005

 
2,914

 

 
49,699

2023

 
188,223

 
22,003

 
136

 

 
210,362

2023 and thereafter
10,499

 
250,826

 
48,806

 
34

 

 
310,165

 
10,499

 
501,414

 
186,321

 
6,238

 
135,644

 
840,116

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Call option redemption liability
 
Other long-term
borrowings
 
Interests on other borrowings
 
Finance
lease
liabilities
 
Accounts payable
and accrued
liabilities
(1)
 
Total
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
 
$
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current maturity
12,725

 
10,348

 
7,068

 
4,891

 
85,982

 
121,014

2019

 
257,116

 
6,703

 
1,047

 

 
264,866

2020

 
1,238

 
5,025

 
471

 

 
6,734

2021

 
1,278

 
4,512

 
406

 

 
6,196

2022

 
921

 
3,235

 
2,645

 

 
6,801

2022 and thereafter

 
1,381

 
1,341

 

 

 
2,722

 
12,725

 
272,282

 
27,884

 
9,460

 
85,982

 
408,333

 
(1) 
Excludes employee benefits
As of December 31, 2018, the Company had $18.7 million of cash and $375.1 million of loan availability (comprised of committed funding of $368.5 million and uncommitted funding of $6.6 million), yielding total cash and loan availability of $393.9 million compared to total cash and loan availability of $186.6 million as of December 31, 2017. The increase in cash and loan availability is primarily due to increased capacity under the 2018 Credit Facility and the issuance of the $250 million Senior Unsecured Notes in October, 2018.
Price Risk
The Company’s price risk arises from changes in its raw material prices. A significant portion of the Company’s major raw materials are by-products of crude oil and natural gas and as such, prices are significantly influenced by the fluctuating underlying energy markets. The Company’s objectives in managing its price risk are threefold: (i) to protect its financial result for the period from significant fluctuations in raw material costs, (ii) to anticipate, to the extent possible, and plan for significant changes in the raw material markets, and (iii) to ensure sufficient availability of raw material required to meet the Company’s manufacturing requirements. In order to manage its exposure to price risks, the Company closely monitors current and anticipated changes in market prices and develops pre-buying strategies and patterns and seeks to adjust its selling prices when market conditions permit. Historical results indicate management’s ability to rapidly identify fluctuations in raw material prices and, to the extent possible, incorporate such fluctuations in the Company’s selling prices.
As of December 31, 2018, all other parameters being equal, a hypothetical increase of 10% in the cost of raw materials, with no corresponding sales price adjustments, would result in an increase in cost of sales of $53.6 million ($45.2 million in 2017). A similar decrease of 10% will have the opposite impact.


89


Capital Management
The Company manages its capital to safeguard the Company’s ability to continue as a going concern, provide sufficient liquidity and flexibility to meet strategic objectives and growth and provide adequate return to its shareholders, while taking into consideration financial leverage and financial risk.
The capital structure of the Company consists of cash, borrowings and equity. A summary of the Company’s capital structure is as follows for the years ended:
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
$
 
$
Cash
18,651

 
9,093

Borrowings
499,985

 
279,463

Total equity
261,428

 
254,722

The Company manages its capital structure in accordance with its expected business growth, operational objectives and underlying industry, market and economic conditions. Consequently, the Company will determine, from time to time, its capital requirements and will accordingly develop a plan to be presented and approved by its Board of Directors. The plan may include the repurchase of common shares, the issuance of shares, the payment of dividends and the issuance of new debt or the refinancing of existing debt.
23 - POST REPORTING EVENTS
Adjusting Events
No adjusting events have occurred between the reporting date of these consolidated financial statements and the date of authorization.
Non-Adjusting Events
No significant non-adjusting events have occurred between the reporting date of these consolidated financial statements and the date of authorization with the exception of the items discussed below.
On March 12, 2019, the Company declared a cash dividend of $0.14 per common share payable on March 29, 2019 to shareholders of record at the close of business on March 22, 2019. The estimated amount of this dividend payment is $8.2 million based on 58,650,310 shares of the Company’s common shares issued and outstanding as of March 12, 2019.



90